Cadillac Automobile 2011 DTS User Manual

2011 Cadillac DTS Owner Manual M  
In Brief . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-1  
Theft-Deterrent Systems . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-18  
Starting and Operating Your Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-22  
Mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-35  
Object Detection Systems . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-38  
Universal Home Remote System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-47  
Storage Areas . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-54  
Sunroof . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-56  
Instrument Panel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-2  
Initial Drive Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-4  
Vehicle Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-15  
Performance and Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-21  
Seats and Restraint System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-1  
Head Restraints . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-2  
Front Seats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-3  
Rear Seats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-10  
Safety Belts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-11  
Child Restraints . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-31  
Airbag System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-54  
Restraint System Check . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-70  
Instrument Panel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-1  
Instrument Panel Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-3  
Climate Controls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-34  
Warning Lights, Gauges, and Indicators . . . . . . . . . 4-44  
Driver Information Center (DIC) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-59  
Audio System(s) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-86  
Features and Controls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-1  
Keys . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-3  
Doors and Locks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-9  
Windows . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-14  
Driving Your Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-1  
Your Driving, the Road, and the Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . 5-2  
Towing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-24  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Canadian Owners  
Propriétaires Canadiens  
A French language copy of this manual can be obtained  
from your dealer or from:  
On peut obtenir un exemplaire de ce guide en français  
auprès du concessionnaire ou à l'adresse suivante:  
The names, logos, emblems, slogans, vehicle model  
names, and vehicle body designs appearing in this  
manual including, but not limited to, GM, the GM logo,  
CADILLAC, the CADILLAC Crest and Wreath, and DTS  
are trademarks and/or service marks of General Motors  
LLC, its subsidiaries, affiliates, or licensors.  
Helm, Incorporated  
P.O. Box 07130  
Detroit, MI 48207  
1-800-551-4123  
Numéro de poste 6438 de langue française  
www.helminc.com  
This manual describes features that may or may not  
be on your specific vehicle either because they are  
options that you did not purchase or due to changes  
subsequent to the printing of this owner manual. Please  
refer to the purchase documentation relating to your  
specific vehicle to confirm each of the features found  
on your vehicle. For vehicles first sold in Canada,  
substitute the name General Motors of Canada  
Limitedfor Cadillac Motor Division wherever it appears  
in this manual.  
Index  
To quickly locate information about the vehicle, use the  
index in the back of the manual. It is an alphabetical list  
of what is in the manual and the page number where it  
can be found.  
Keep this manual in the vehicle for quick reference.  
Litho in U.S.A.  
Part No. 20934783 A First Printing  
©2010 General Motors LLC. All Rights Reserved.  
iii  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
A circle with a slash  
through it is a safety  
symbol which means Do  
Not,” “Do not do this,or  
Do not let this happen.”  
Safety Warnings and Symbols  
Warning messages found on vehicle labels and in this  
manual describe hazards and what to do to avoid or  
reduce them.  
Danger indicates a hazard with a high level of risk  
which will result in serious injury or death.  
Warning or Caution indicates a hazard that could result  
in injury or death.  
Vehicle Symbols  
The vehicle has components and labels that use  
symbols instead of text. Symbols are shown along with  
the text describing the operation or information relating  
to a specific component, control, message, gauge,  
or indicator.  
WARNING:  
{
These mean there is something that could hurt  
you or other people.  
M : This symbol is shown when you need to see your  
owner manual for additional instructions or information.  
Notice: This means there is something that could  
result in property or vehicle damage. This would not  
be covered by the vehicle's warranty.  
* : This symbol is shown when you need to see a  
service manual for additional instructions or information.  
iv  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Vehicle Symbol Chart  
. : Fuel Gauge  
Here are some additional symbols that may be found on  
the vehicle and what they mean. For more information  
on the symbol, refer to the Index.  
+ : Fuses  
3 : Headlamp High/Low-Beam Changer  
j : LATCH System Child Restraints  
* : Malfunction Indicator Lamp  
: : Oil Pressure  
9 : Airbag Readiness Light  
# : Air Conditioning  
! : Antilock Brake System (ABS)  
g : Audio Steering Wheel Controls or OnStar®  
$ : Brake System Warning Light  
" : Charging System  
I : Cruise Control  
B : Engine Coolant Temperature  
O : Exterior Lamps  
g : Outside Power Foldaway Mirrors  
} : Power  
/ : Remote Vehicle Start  
> : Safety Belt Reminders  
7 : Tire Pressure Monitor  
F : Traction Control  
M : Windshield Washer Fluid  
# : Fog Lamps  
v
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2 NOTES  
vi  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 1 In Brief  
Instrument Panel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-2  
Vehicle Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-15  
Radio(s) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-15  
Satellite Radio . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-17  
Portable Audio Devices . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-17  
Steering Wheel Controls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-18  
Bluetooth® . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-18  
Navigation System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-18  
Driver Information Center (DIC) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-19  
Cruise Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-20  
Power Outlets . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-20  
Initial Drive Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-4  
Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) System . . . . . . . . . . . 1-4  
Remote Vehicle Start . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-4  
Door Locks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-5  
Trunk Release . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-5  
Windows . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-6  
Seat Adjustment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-6  
Memory Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-8  
Heated and Ventilated Seats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-9  
Head Restraint Adjustment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-9  
Safety Belt . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-10  
Sensing System for Passenger Airbag . . . . . . . . . 1-10  
Mirror Adjustment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-11  
Steering Wheel Adjustment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-12  
Interior Lighting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-13  
Exterior Lighting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-13  
Windshield Wiper/Washer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-14  
Climate Controls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-14  
Performance and Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-21  
Traction Control System (TCS) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-21  
StabiliTrak® System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-21  
Tire Pressure Monitor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-21  
Tire Sealant and Compressor Kit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-22  
Engine Oil Life System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-22  
Driving for Better Fuel Economy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-22  
Roadside Service . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-23  
OnStar® . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-23  
1-1  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Instrument Panel  
Console-Shift Model shown, Column-Shift Model similar  
1-2  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
A. Outlet Adjustment on page 440.  
O. Hood Release on page 613.  
P. Parking Brake on page 329.  
B. Driver Information Center (DIC) Buttons. See  
Driver Information Center (DIC) on page 459.  
Q. Data Link Connector (DLC). See Malfunction  
Indicator Lamp on page 454.  
C. Exterior Lamps on page 425.  
D. Instrument Panel Cluster on page 445.  
E. Horn on page 43.  
R. Heated Steering Wheel on page 44  
(If Equipped).  
S. Cruise Control on page 412 (If Equipped).  
F. Audio Steering Wheel Controls on page 4114.  
Adaptive Cruise Control on page 414  
(If Equipped).  
G. Ultrasonic Front and Rear Parking Assist (UFRPA)  
on page 338  
.
T. Tilt Wheel on page 43  
.
Adaptive Cruise Control on page 414  
(If Equipped).  
Power Tilt Wheel and Telescopic Steering Column  
on page 44 (If Equipped).  
H. Analog Clock on page 434.  
U. Dual Climate Control System on page 434.  
I. Hazard Warning Flashers on page 43.  
J. Audio System(s) on page 486.  
V. Traction Control System Button (Console-Shift  
Vehicles). See Traction Control System (TCS) on  
K. Trunk Release Button. See Trunk on page 312.  
L. Instrument Panel Brightness on page 430.  
M. Lane Departure Warning (LDW) on page 345.  
N. Turn Signal/Multifunction Lever on page 45.  
Windshield Wipers on page 410.  
page 56  
W. Shift Lever. See Automatic Transmission Operation  
on page 326  
X. Accessory Power Outlet(s) on page 433.  
Y. Glove Box on page 354  
Valet Lockout Switch on page 318.  
.
.
.
1-3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Initial Drive Information  
Press Q to lock all doors.  
This section provides a brief overview about some of  
the important features that may or may not be on your  
specific vehicle.  
Lock and unlock feedback can be personalized.  
Press and hold V for approximately one second to  
open the trunk.  
For more detailed information, refer to each of the  
features which can be found later in this owner manual.  
Press L and release to locate the vehicle.  
Press L and hold for more than two seconds to sound  
the panic alarm.  
Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) System  
The RKE transmitter is used to remotely lock and  
unlock the doors from up to 60 m (195 feet) away from  
the vehicle.  
Press L again to cancel the panic alarm.  
See Keys on page 33 and Remote Keyless Entry  
(RKE) System Operation on page 34.  
Press K to unlock  
the driver door.  
Remote Vehicle Start  
With this feature the engine can be started from outside  
of the vehicle.  
Press K again within  
five seconds to unlock  
all remaining doors.  
Starting the Vehicle  
1. Aim the RKE transmitter at the vehicle.  
2. Press Q.  
3. Immediately after completing Step 2, press and  
hold / until the turn signal lamps flash.  
1-4  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
When the vehicle starts, the parking lamps will turn on  
and remain on as long as the engine is running. The  
doors will be locked and the climate control system may  
come on.  
Power Door Locks  
On vehicles with power door locks, the switches are  
located on the front doors.  
" (Unlock): Press to unlock the doors.  
The engine will continue to run for 10 minutes. Repeat  
the steps for a 10-minute time extension. Remote start  
can be extended only once.  
Q (Lock): Remove the key from the ignition and press  
to lock the doors.  
For more information, see:  
Canceling a Remote Start  
To cancel a remote start:  
.
Door Locks on page 39.  
.
Power Door Locks on page 310.  
.
Aim the RKE transmitter at the vehicle and press  
.
Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) System Operation  
and hold / until the parking lamps turn off.  
on page 34  
.
.
Turn on the hazard warning flashers.  
.
Turn the ignition on and then back off.  
Trunk Release  
In addition to the trunk release button on the RKE  
See Remote Vehicle Start on page 37.  
transmitter, there is a remote release V button  
located to the left of the steering wheel, next to the  
instrument panel brightness control. Press to open the  
trunk.  
Door Locks  
From the outside, unlock the door using either the key  
or the RKE transmitter.  
See Trunk on page 312.  
From the inside, use the power door lock switches or  
manual lock knobs located at the top of the door panel  
near the window.  
1-5  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Windows  
Seat Adjustment  
Power Seats  
The power seat controls  
are on the outboard side  
of the seat.  
On vehicles with power windows, the switches are on  
the driver door armrest. Each passenger door has a  
switch that controls only that window.  
Move the seat forward or rearward by moving the  
control forward or rearward.  
Raise or lower the front or rear part of the seat cushion  
by moving the front or rear of the control up or down.  
Press the switch to lower the window. Pull the switch up  
to raise it.  
See Power Seats on page 23.  
For more information, see Power Windows on  
page 315  
.
1-6  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Power Reclining Seatbacks  
Power Lumbar Adjustment  
The control is located on the outboard side of the seat.  
The control is located on the outboard side of the seat.  
To raise or recline the seatback, tilt the top of the  
control forward or rearward.  
Press the front or rear of the control to increase or  
decrease lumbar support.  
See Power Reclining Seatbacks on page 28.  
See Power Lumbar on page 24.  
1-7  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
To recall the memory positions, press and release 1”  
or 2.The vehicle must be in P (Park). A single beep  
will sound. The seat, outside mirrors, and steering  
wheel will move to the position previously stored for the  
identified driver.  
Memory Features  
See Memory Seat, Mirrors and Steering Wheel on  
page 26 for more information.  
Easy Exit Driver Seat  
The easy exit driver seat feature can move the seat  
rearward and the power steering column, if equipped,  
up and forward to allow extra room to exit the vehicle.  
On vehicles with the memory feature, the controls on  
the driver door are used to program and recall memory  
settings for the driver seat, outside mirrors, and the  
steering wheel position, if the vehicle has the power tilt  
wheel and telescopic steering feature.  
S : Press to recall the easy exit seat position. The  
vehicle must be in P (Park).  
A single beep sounds. The driver seat will move  
back, and if the vehicle has the power tilt wheel and  
telescopic steering feature, the power telescopic  
steering column will move up and forward.  
Storing Memory Positions  
To save into memory:  
1. Adjust the driver seat, including the seatback  
recliner and lumbar, both outside mirrors, and the  
steering column.  
See Memory Seat, Mirrors and Steering Wheel on  
page 26 and Easy Exit Recalland Easy Exit Setup”  
under DIC Vehicle Customization on page 477 for  
more information.  
2. Press and hold 1until two beeps sound.  
3. Repeat for a second driver position using 2.”  
1-8  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Heated and Ventilated Seats  
Head Restraint Adjustment  
The vehicle's front seats have adjustable head  
restraints in the outboard seating positions.  
Do not drive until the head restraints for all occupants  
are installed and adjusted properly.  
To achieve a comfortable seating position, change the  
seatback recline angle as little as necessary while  
keeping the seat and the head restraint height in the  
proper position.  
For more information see Head Restraints on  
page 22 and Power Seats on page 23.  
On vehicles with heated and ventilated seats, the  
buttons are on the front doors. The ignition must be on  
to use this feature.  
J : Press to heat the seat and seatback.  
I : Press to heat the seatback.  
H : Press to cool the seat and seatback.  
For more information see Heated and Ventilated Seats  
on page 25  
.
1-9  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Safety Belt  
Sensing System for Passenger  
Airbag  
The passenger sensing system will turn off the right  
front passenger frontal airbag and seatmounted side  
impact airbag under certain conditions. The driver  
airbags and roofrail airbags are not affected by this.  
The passenger airbag status indicator will be visible on  
the overhead console when the vehicle is started.  
Refer to the following sections for important information  
on how to use safety belts properly.  
United States  
Canada  
.
Safety Belts: They Are for Everyone on page 211.  
See Passenger Sensing System on page 264 for  
important information.  
.
How to Wear Safety Belts Properly on page 215.  
.
Lap-Shoulder Belt on page 224.  
.
Lap Belt on page 229.  
.
Lower Anchors and Tethers for Children (LATCH)  
on page 241  
.
1-10  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
To fold the mirrors:  
Mirror Adjustment  
Exterior Mirrors  
Press the selector switch (C) to fold the mirrors out,  
then press (D) to fold the mirror toward the vehicle.  
Controls for the outside  
power folding mirrors are  
located on the driver door  
armrest.  
The vehicle may also have an automatic dimming  
feature on the driver side mirror that adjusts for the  
glare of headlamps behind you. This feature is  
controlled by the on and off settings on the automatic  
dimming inside rearview mirror.  
For more information, see:  
.
Outside Power Foldaway Mirrors on page 336  
.
Automatic Dimming Rearview Mirror on page 335  
Interior Mirror  
The vehicle has an automatic dimming inside rearview  
mirror. Automatic dimming reduces the glare of lights  
from behind the vehicle. The dimming feature comes on  
and the indicator light illuminates each time the vehicle  
is started.  
Press the selector switch (A) or (B) to choose either the  
left or right outside mirror. Then press the control pad to  
move the mirror to the desired direction.  
See Automatic Dimming Rearview Mirror on page 335.  
1-11  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Steering Wheel Adjustment  
This feature allows the position of the steering wheel to  
be adjusted.  
The adjustment lever is  
located on the left side of  
the steering column.  
For vehicles with a power tilt wheel control:  
.
Push the control up or down to tilt the steering  
wheel up or down.  
.
Push the control forward or rearward to move the  
steering wheel toward the front or rear of the  
vehicle.  
1. Pull the lever to move the steering wheel up  
or down.  
See Tilt Wheel on page 43 or Power Tilt Wheel  
and Telescopic Steering Column on page 44  
(If Equipped).  
2. Release the lever to lock the wheel in place.  
1-12  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Interior Lighting  
Exterior Lighting  
This control is located on  
the instrument panel, to  
the left of the steering  
wheel.  
Courtesy Lamps  
The courtesy lamps are located on the headliner above  
the rear seat. These lamps come on by turning the  
instrument panel brightness knob fully clockwise or  
when any door is opened and it is dark outside.  
Reading Lamps  
The reading lamps are located on the overhead console  
on the headliner and in the rear door opening. These  
lamps come on automatically when any door is opened  
and it is dark outside.  
P: Turns off the exterior lamps, except Daytime  
Running Lamps (DRL).  
AUTO: Automatic operation of the headlamps at normal  
brightness, other exterior lamps and IntelliBeam®.  
For manual operation, press the button to turn them on  
or off.  
;: Manual operation of the parking lamps and other  
exterior lamps.  
If the reading lamps are left on, they automatically shut  
off 10 minutes after the ignition has been turned off.  
2: Manual operation of the headlamps and other  
exterior lamps.  
For more information, see:  
.
# : Press to turn on the fog lamps.  
Instrument Panel Brightness on page 430.  
.
For more information, see:  
Entry Lighting on page 430.  
.
.
Exterior Lamps on page 425.  
Parade Dimming on page 431.  
.
.
Daytime Running Lamps (DRL) on page 428.  
Footwell Lamps on page 431.  
.
Fog Lamps on page 429.  
.
Wiper Activated Headlamps on page 428.  
1-13  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
9: Turns the wipers off.  
Windshield Wiper/Washer  
J : Press and release this paddle, located at the top  
of the turn signal/multifunction lever, to spray washer  
fluid on the windshield.  
See Windshield Wipers on page 410 and Windshield  
Washer on page 411.  
Climate Controls  
The windshield wiper lever is located on the left side of  
the steering column.  
8: Use for a single wiping cycle.  
6 : Delays wiping cycle.  
6: Slow wipes.  
1: Fast wipes.  
Dual Climate Control System  
1-14  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Vehicle Features  
Radio(s)  
Dual Climate Control System for Vehicles with Rear  
Climate Control  
A. Fan Control  
B. Display  
F. Outside Air or AUX  
G. Air Recirculation  
C. Air Delivery Mode  
Control  
H. PASS (Passenger  
Climate Control)  
D. Driver and Passenger  
Temperature Controls  
I. Rear Window  
Defogger  
Radio with CD  
O : Press to turn the system on and off. Turn to  
E. Air Conditioning  
increase or decrease the volume.  
BAND: Press to switch between AM, FM, or XM. The  
selection displays.  
See Dual Climate Control System on page 434. For  
vehicles with rear climate control, see Rear Climate  
Control System on page 440.  
a : Turn to select radio stations.  
© SEEK ¨ : Press to seek or scan stations.  
1-15  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The radio clock and analog clock are not synchronized.  
Occasionally you might need to set the digital radio  
clock using the procedure below to synchronize both  
clocks.  
4 (XMSatellite Radio Service, MP3/WMA, and RDS  
Features): Press this button to display additional text  
information related to the current FM-RDS or XM  
station, or MP3/WMA song. When information is not  
available, No Info displays.  
Enabling/Disabling the Digital Radio Clock  
(Single CD Player)  
1. Turn the radio on.  
For more information about these and other radio  
features, see Audio System(s) on page 486.  
Storing a Favorite Station  
2. Press the H button until the clock and date setting  
For vehicles with an XM radio, a maximum of  
36 stations can be stored as favorites using the  
six softkeys located below the radio station frequency  
tabs and by using the radio FAV button. Press FAV to  
go through up to six pages of favorites, each having  
six favorite stations available per page. Each page  
of favorites can contain any combination of AM, FM,  
or XM stations.  
menus appear.  
3. Press the pushbutton located under the forward  
arrow tab until the menu for default clock and date  
settings appear.  
4. Press the pushbutton located under the currently  
displayed status of either ON or OFF. The ON  
display indicates the radio clock display is disabled  
and the OFF display indicates the radio clock  
display is enabled. Press this pushbutton to toggle  
the radio clock display on or off.  
See Radio(s) on page 490.  
Setting the Clock  
The vehicle has an analog clock as well as the digital  
radio clock. At the time of new vehicle delivery, the  
digital radio clock display should be disabled. To use  
the digital radio clock and the analog clock, see detailed  
instructions in Setting the Clock on page 487 for your  
specific audio system.  
1-16  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
A fee is required to receive the XM service.  
For more information, refer to:  
Setting the Time and Date  
(Single CD Player)  
.
1. Turn the radio on.  
www.xmradio.com or call 1-800-929-2100 (U.S.)  
.
www.xmradio.ca or call 1-877-438-9677 (Canada)  
2. Press H and HR, MIN, MM, DD, YYYY (hour,  
minute, month, day, and year) displays.  
See XM Satellite Radio Serviceunder Radio(s) on  
page 490  
.
3. Press the pushbutton located below any one of the  
tabs that you want to change.  
Portable Audio Devices  
4. Increase or decrease the time or date by  
This vehicle may have an auxiliary input, located on the  
audio faceplate. External devices such as iPod®, laptop  
computers, MP3 players, CD changers, etc. can be  
connected to the auxiliary port using a 3.5 mm (1/8 in)  
input jack.  
turning a clockwise or counterclockwise.  
Satellite Radio  
XM is a satellite radio service that is based in the  
48 contiguous United States and 10 Canadian  
provinces. XM satellite radio has a wide variety  
of programming and commercial-free music,  
coast-to-coast, and in digital-quality sound.  
See Using the Auxiliary Input Jackunder Radio(s) on  
page 490  
.
1-17  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
¨ : Press seek the next radio station, or to select tracks  
Steering Wheel Controls  
on a CD or DVD.  
If equipped, these  
For more information, see Audio Steering Wheel  
Controls on page 4114.  
controls are located on  
the right side of the  
steering wheel.  
Bluetooth®  
For vehicles with an in-vehicle Bluetooth system, it  
allows users with a Bluetooth enabled cell phone to  
make and receive hands-free calls using the vehicles  
audio system and controls.  
The Bluetooth enabled cell phone must be paired with  
the in-vehicle Bluetooth system before it can be used in  
the vehicle. Not all phones will support all functions. For  
more information visit www.gm.com/bluetooth.  
For more information, see Bluetooth® on page 4107.  
w : Press to go to the next radio station stored as a  
favorite, or the next track if a CD/DVD is playing.  
Navigation System  
b g : Press to silence the vehicle speakers only. Press  
again to turn the sound on. Press and hold longer than  
two seconds to interact with OnStar® or Bluetooth®  
systems.  
The vehicle's navigation system (if equipped) provides  
detailed maps of most major freeways and roads.  
After a destination has been set, the system provides  
turn-by-turn instructions for reaching the destination. In  
addition, the system can help locate a variety of points  
of interest (POI), such as banks, airports, restaurants,  
and more.  
+ e e : Increases or decreases volume.  
c x : Press to go to the previous radio station stored  
as a favorite, the next track if a CD/DVD is playing, to  
reject an incoming call, or end a current call.  
See the Navigation System manual for more  
information.  
SRCE : Press to switch between the radio, CD, and for  
vehicles with, DVD, front auxiliary, and rear auxiliary.  
1-18  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
U : Press to customize the feature settings on your  
vehicle. See DIC Vehicle Customization on page 477  
for more information.  
Driver Information Center (DIC)  
The DIC display is located at the bottom of the  
instrument panel cluster. It shows the status of  
many vehicle systems and enables access to the  
personalization menu.  
V : Press to reset certain DIC features and to  
acknowledge DIC warning messages and clear them  
from the DIC display.  
y z : Press to scroll up and down the menu items.  
For more information, see Driver Information Center  
(DIC) on page 459.  
Vehicle Customization  
Some vehicle features can be programmed by using the  
DIC buttons on the instrument panel to the left of the  
steering wheel. These features include:  
.
Language  
.
Door Lock and Unlock Settings  
.
The DIC buttons are located on the instrument panel to  
the left of the steering wheel.  
Lighting  
.
Chime Volume  
3 : Press to scroll through the trip and fuel displays.  
.
Memory Settings  
T : Press to scroll through the vehicle information  
displays.  
See DIC Vehicle Customization on page 477.  
1-19  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
For more information, see Cruise Control on  
page 412. For vehicles with adaptive cruise control,  
see Adaptive Cruise Control on page 414.  
Cruise Control  
The cruise control buttons  
are located on the left  
side of the steering wheel.  
Power Outlets  
The accessory power outlets can be used to plug in  
electrical equipment, such as a cell phone or MP3  
player.  
If the vehicle has a center console, the power outlet is  
located inside the lower storage area. Some vehicles  
may have an outlet on the right front lower part of the  
driver's seat and under the climate control system next  
to the ashtray.  
There are two accessory power outlets in the rear seat  
area located on the door armrests next to the ashtrays.  
I : Press to turn the cruise control system on or off.  
+ RES: Press briefly to make the vehicle resume to a  
previously set speed or press and hold to accelerate.  
Remove the cover to access and replace when not  
in use.  
See Accessory Power Outlet(s) on page 433.  
SET: Press to set the speed and activate cruise  
control or make the vehicle decelerate.  
[ (Cancel): Press to disengage cruise control without  
erasing the set speed from memory.  
1-20  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Tire Pressure Monitor  
This vehicle may have a Tire Pressure Monitor  
System (TPMS).  
Performance and Maintenance  
Traction Control System (TCS)  
The traction control system limits wheel spin. The  
system turns on automatically every time the vehicle is  
started.  
The TPMS warming light  
alerts you to a significant  
loss in pressure of one of  
the vehicles tires.  
.
To turn off traction control, press and release i in  
front of the shift lever. F illuminates and the  
appropriate DIC message is displayed. See DIC  
Warnings and Messages on page 465.  
.
Press and release the button again to turn on  
If the warning light comes on, stop as soon as possible  
and inflate the tires to the recommended pressure  
shown on the tire loading information label. See  
Loading the Vehicle on page 518. The warning light  
will remain on until the tire pressure is corrected.  
traction control.  
For more information, see Traction Control System  
(TCS) on page 56.  
StabiliTrak® System  
The vehicle may have the StabiliTrak system that  
assists with directional control of the vehicle in difficult  
driving conditions. The system turns on automatically  
every time the vehicle is started. The system cannot be  
turned off.  
During cooler conditions, the low tire pressure warning  
light may appear when the vehicle is first started and  
then turn off. This may be an early indicator that the  
tire pressures are getting low and the tires need to be  
inflated to the proper pressure.  
The TPMS does not replace normal monthly tire  
maintenance. It is the drivers responsibility to maintain  
correct tire pressures.  
For more information, see StabiliTrak® System on  
page 56  
.
See Tire Pressure Monitor System on page 660 and  
Tire Pressure Monitor Operation on page 661.  
1-21  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Tire Sealant and Compressor Kit  
Driving for Better Fuel Economy  
This vehicle may come with a jack and spare tire or a  
tire sealant and compressor kit. The kit can be used to  
seal small punctures in the tread area of the tire.  
Driving habits can affect fuel mileage. Here are some  
driving tips to get the best fuel economy possible.  
.
Avoid fast starts and accelerate smoothly.  
See Tire Sealant and Compressor Kit on page 675 for  
complete operating information.  
.
Brake gradually and avoid abrupt stops.  
.
Avoid idling the engine for long periods of time.  
If the vehicle came with a jack and spare tire, see  
Changing a Flat Tire on page 683.  
.
When road and weather conditions are  
appropriate, use cruise control, if equipped.  
.
Always follow posted speed limits or drive more  
slowly when conditions require.  
Engine Oil Life System  
The engine oil life system calculates engine oil life  
based on vehicle use and displays a DIC message  
when it is necessary to change the engine oil and filter.  
The oil life system should be reset to 100% only  
following an oil change.  
.
Keep vehicle tires properly inflated.  
.
Combine several trips into a single trip.  
.
Replace the vehicle's tires with the same TPC  
Spec number molded into the tire's sidewall near  
the size.  
Resetting the Oil Life System  
1. Turn the ignition to ON/RUN, with the engine off.  
.
Follow recommended scheduled maintenance.  
2. Press the DIC INFO button until OIL LIFE  
REMAINING displays.  
3. Press and hold the DIC INFO RESET button until  
100% displays.  
4. Turn the key to LOCK/OFF.  
See Engine Oil Life System on page 618.  
1-22  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Roadside Service  
U.S. or Canada: 1-800-882-1112  
TTY Users: 1-888-889-2438  
OnStar®  
As the owner of a new Cadillac, you are automatically  
enrolled in the Roadside Service program which is  
available 24 hours a day, 365 days a year to give minor  
repair information or make towing arrangements.  
For more information see Roadside Service on  
page 123  
.
For vehicles with an active OnStar subscription, OnStar  
uses several innovative technologies and live advisors  
to provide a wide range of safety, security, navigation,  
diagnostics, and calling services.  
Roadside Service and OnStar  
If you have a current OnStar subscription, press  
the Q button and the current GPS location will be sent  
to an OnStar Advisor who will assess your problem,  
contact Roadside Service, and relay exact location to  
get you the help you need.  
Automatic Crash Response  
In a crash, builtin sensors can automatically alert an  
OnStar advisor who is immediately connected to the  
vehicle to see if you need help.  
Online Owner Center  
How OnStar Service Works  
Q : Push this blue button to connect to a specially  
trained OnStar advisor to verify your account  
information and to answer questions.  
The Online Owner Center is a complimentary service  
that includes online service reminders, vehicle  
maintenance tips, online owner manual, special  
privileges and more.  
Sign up today at: www.cadillacownercenter.com  
(U.S.) or www.gm.ca (Canada).  
] : Push this red emergency button to get priority help  
from specially trained OnStar emergency advisors.  
1-23  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
OnStar service requires wireless communication  
networks and the Global Positioning System (GPS)  
satellite network. Not all OnStar services are available  
everywhere or on all vehicles at all times.  
X : Push this button for handsfree, voiceactivated  
calling and to give voice commands for HandsFree  
Calling and TurnbyTurn Navigation.  
Automatic Crash Response, Emergency Services,  
Crisis Assist, Stolen Vehicle Assistance, Vehicle  
Diagnostics, Remote Door Unlock, Roadside  
Assistance, TurnbyTurn Navigation, and HandsFree  
Calling are available on most vehicles. Not all OnStar  
services are available on all vehicles. For more  
information, see the OnStar Owner's Guide; visit  
www.onstar.com (U.S.) or www.onstar.ca (Canada);  
contact OnStar at 1-888-4-ONSTAR (18884667827)  
OnStar service cant work unless your vehicle is in a  
place where OnStar has an agreement with a wireless  
service provider for service in that area, and the  
wireless service provider has coverage, network  
capacity, reception, and technology compatible with  
OnStar's service. Service involving location information  
about your vehicle cant work unless GPS signals are  
available, unobstructed, and compatible with the OnStar  
hardware. The vehicle has to have a working electrical  
system and adequate battery power for the OnStar  
equipment to operate. OnStar service may not work if  
the OnStar equipment isnt properly installed or you  
havent maintained it and your vehicle is in good  
working order and in compliance with all government  
regulations. If you try to add, connect, or modify any  
equipment or software in your vehicle, OnStar service  
may not work. Other problems OnStar cant control  
may prevent service to you, such as hills, tall buildings,  
tunnels, weather, electrical system design and  
or TTY 18772482080; or press Q to speak with an  
OnStar advisor 24 hours a day, 7 days a week.  
For a full description of OnStar services and system  
limitations, see the OnStar Owner's Guide in the  
glove box.  
OnStar service is subject to the OnStar terms and  
conditions included in the OnStar Subscriber  
Information.  
architecture of your vehicle, damage to important parts  
of your vehicle in a crash, or wireless phone network  
congestion or jamming.  
1-24  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
See Radio Frequency Statement on page 818  
for information regarding Part 15 of the Federal  
Communications Commission (FCC) rules and Industry  
Canada Standards RSS-210/220/310.  
Your Responsibility  
Increase the volume of the radio if the OnStar advisor  
cannot be heard.  
If the light next to the OnStar buttons is red, the system  
OnStar Steering Wheel Controls  
may not be functioning properly. Push the Q button  
and request a vehicle diagnostic. If the light appears  
clear (no light appears), your OnStar subscription has  
expired and all services have been deactivated. Push  
This vehicle may have a Talk/Mute button that can be  
used to interact with OnStar Hands-Free calling. See  
Audio Steering Wheel Controls on page 4114 for more  
information.  
the Q button to confirm that the OnStar equipment is  
active.  
On some vehicles, the mute button can be used to  
dial numbers into voice mail systems, or to dial phone  
extensions. See the OnStar Owner's Guide for more  
information.  
1-25  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2 NOTES  
1-26  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 2 Seats and Restraint System  
Head Restraints . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-2  
Where to Put the Restraint . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-39  
Lower Anchors and Tethers for Children  
(LATCH) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-41  
Securing a Child Restraint in a Rear Seat  
Position . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-47  
Securing a Child Restraint in the Center Front  
Seat Position . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-50  
Securing a Child Restraint in the Right Front  
Seat Position . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-50  
Front Seats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-3  
Power Seats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-3  
Power Lumbar . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-4  
Massaging Lumbar . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-4  
Heated and Ventilated Seats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-5  
Memory Seat, Mirrors and Steering Wheel . . . . . . 2-6  
Power Reclining Seatbacks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-8  
Center Seat . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-9  
Airbag System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-54  
Where Are the Airbags? . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-57  
When Should an Airbag Inflate? . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-59  
What Makes an Airbag Inflate? . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-61  
How Does an Airbag Restrain? . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-61  
What Will You See After an Airbag Inflates? . . . 2-62  
Passenger Sensing System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-64  
Servicing Your Airbag-Equipped Vehicle . . . . . . . 2-68  
Adding Equipment to Your Airbag-Equipped  
Rear Seats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-10  
Heated Seats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-10  
Rear Seat Pass-Through Door . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-10  
Safety Belts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-11  
Safety Belts: They Are for Everyone . . . . . . . . . . . 2-11  
How to Wear Safety Belts Properly . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-15  
Lap-Shoulder Belt . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-24  
Safety Belt Use During Pregnancy . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-29  
Lap Belt . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-29  
Safety Belt Extender . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-31  
Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-69  
Restraint System Check . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-70  
Checking the Restraint Systems . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-70  
Replacing Restraint System Parts After a  
Child Restraints . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-31  
Older Children . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-31  
Infants and Young Children . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-34  
Child Restraint Systems . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-37  
Crash . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-71  
2-1  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Head Restraints  
The front seats have adjustable head restraints in the  
outboard seating positions.  
WARNING:  
{
With head restraints that are not installed and  
adjusted properly, there is a greater chance that  
occupants will suffer a neck/spinal injury in a  
crash. Do not drive until the head restraints for all  
occupants are installed and adjusted properly.  
Adjust the head restraint so that the top of the restraint  
is at the same height as the top of the occupant's head.  
This position reduces the chance of a neck injury in a  
crash.  
2-2  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Front Seats  
Power Seats  
The power seat controls  
are on the outboard side  
of the seats.  
Pull the head restraint up to raise it. To lower the head  
restraint, press the button, located on the top of the  
seatback, and push the restraint down.  
.
Move the seat forward or rearward by sliding the  
control forward or rearward.  
Push down on the head restraint after the button is  
released to make sure that it is locked in place.  
.
.
Raise or lower the front part of the seat cushion by  
moving the front of the control up or down.  
The head restraints are not designed to be removed.  
Raise or lower the rear part of the seat cushion by  
moving the rear of the control up or down.  
The front seats also have power reclining seatbacks.  
See Power Reclining Seatbacks on page 28.  
On vehicles with the memory feature, memory settings  
can be programmed and recalled for seat positions.  
See Memory Seat, Mirrors and Steering Wheel on  
page 26  
.
2-3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Power Lumbar  
Massaging Lumbar  
The power lumbar  
controls are located on  
the outboard side of the  
front seats.  
On vehicles with this  
feature, the switch is  
located on the outboard  
side of the front seats  
behind the lumbar switch.  
Press the front or rear of the lumbar control to increase  
or decrease support. Press the top or bottom of the  
control to raise or lower the support mechanism.  
Press the switch to turn the massaging lumbar feature  
on. The ignition must be on for this feature to work. The  
massage cycle will run for up to 10 minutes. To stop  
massage, press the massaging lumbar switch again or  
press the power lumbar switch.  
2-4  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
On vehicles with this  
feature, the buttons are  
on the front doors.  
Heated and Ventilated Seats  
WARNING:  
{
If you cannot feel temperature change or pain to  
the skin, the seat heater may cause burns even at  
low temperatures. To reduce the risk of burns,  
people with such a condition should use care  
when using the seat heater, especially for long  
periods of time. Do not place anything on the seat  
that insulates against heat, such as a blanket,  
cushion, cover or similar item. This may cause the  
seat heater to overheat. An overheated seat  
heater may cause a burn or may damage  
the seat.  
Driver Side Buttons Shown  
J (Heated Seat Cushion and Seatback): Press this  
button to heat the seat cushion and seatback.  
I (Heated Seatback): Press this button to heat the  
seatback.  
H (Ventilated Seat Cushion and Seatback): Press this  
button to cool the seat cushion and seatback.  
To operate the heated and ventilated seats, the ignition  
must be on.  
Press the desired button once to turn this feature on at  
the highest setting. A light on the button turns on to  
show which feature is on.  
The column of three lights near the buttons shows the  
current temperature setting. With each press of the  
button, the seat will change to the next lower setting,  
and then to the off setting. The lights indicate three for  
the highest setting and one for the lowest.  
2-5  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Remote Start Heated Front Seats  
Storing Memory Positions  
During a remote start, the front heated seats can be  
turned on automatically. They are canceled when the  
ignition is turned on. Press the button to use the heated  
seats after the vehicle is started.  
To save into memory:  
1. Adjust the driver seat, including the seatback  
recliner and lumbar, both outside mirrors, and the  
steering column.  
The heated seat indicator lights on the button do not  
turn on during a remote start.  
2. Press and hold 1until two beeps sound.  
3. Repeat for a second driver position using 2.”  
The temperature performance of an unoccupied seat  
may be reduced. This is normal.  
To recall the memory positions, press and release 1”  
or 2.The vehicle must be in P (Park). A single beep  
will sound. The seat, outside mirrors, and steering  
wheel will move to the position previously stored for the  
identified driver.  
See Remote Vehicle Start on page 37 for more  
information.  
Memory Seat, Mirrors and Steering  
Wheel  
Memory Remote Recall  
The memory feature can recall the driver seat, outside  
mirrors, and power steering column, if available, to  
stored positions when entering the vehicle.  
To activate memory remote recall, unlock the driver  
door with the Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) transmitter.  
The driver seat, outside mirrors, and adjustable pedals  
will move to the memory position associated with the  
transmitter used to unlock the vehicle.  
On vehicles with the memory feature, the controls on  
the driver door are used to program and recall memory  
settings for the driver seat, outside mirrors, and the  
steering wheel position if the vehicle has the power tilt  
wheel and telescopic steering feature.  
The automatic recall feature can be turned on or off  
using the vehicle customization menu. See Memory  
Seat RecallDIC Vehicle Customization on page 477  
for more information.  
2-6  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
To stop recall movement, press one of the power seat  
controls, memory or power mirror buttons, or the power  
tilt wheel control.  
If the easy exit seat feature is programmed on in the  
vehicle customization menu, automatic seat and  
steering column movement occur when the ignition key  
is removed.  
If something has blocked the driver seat and/or the  
steering column while recalling a memory position, the  
recall may stop. Remove the obstruction; then press  
and hold the appropriate manual control for the memory  
item that is not recalling for two seconds. Try recalling  
the memory position again by pressing the appropriate  
memory button. If the memory position is still not  
recalling, see your dealer for service.  
A single beep sounds. The driver seat will move  
back, and if the vehicle has the power tilt wheel and  
telescopic steering feature, the power telescopic  
steering column will move up and forward.  
If something has blocked the driver seat while recalling  
the exit position, the recall may stop. Remove the  
obstruction; then press and hold the power seat control  
rearward for two seconds. Try recalling the exit position  
again. If the exit position is still not recalling, see your  
dealer for service.  
Easy Exit Driver Seat  
The easy exit driver seat feature can move the seat  
rearward and the power steering column, if equipped,  
up and forward to allow extra room to exit the vehicle.  
See Easy Exit Recalland Easy Exit Setupunder  
DIC Vehicle Customization on page 477 for more  
information.  
S (Easy Exit Driver Seat): Press to recall the easy exit  
seat position. The vehicle must be in P (Park).  
2-7  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
.
.
Press the control toward the rear of the vehicle to  
recline the seatback.  
Power Reclining Seatbacks  
WARNING:  
Press the control toward the front of the vehicle to  
raise the seatback.  
{
You can lose control of the vehicle if you try to  
adjust the seat while the vehicle is moving. The  
sudden movement could startle and confuse you,  
or make you push a pedal when you do not want  
to. Adjust the driver seat only when the vehicle is  
not moving.  
WARNING:  
{
Sitting in a reclined position when the vehicle is in  
motion can be dangerous. Even when buckled up,  
the safety belts cannot do their job when reclined  
like this.  
The shoulder belt cannot do its job because it will  
not be against your body. Instead, it will be in front  
of you. In a crash, you could go into it, receiving  
neck or other injuries.  
The seats have power  
reclining seatbacks. Use  
the vertical power seat  
control located on the  
outboard side of the seat.  
The lap belt cannot do its job either. In a crash,  
the belt could go up over your abdomen. The belt  
forces would be there, not at your pelvic bones.  
This could cause serious internal injuries.  
For proper protection when the vehicle is in  
motion, have the seatback upright. Then sit well  
back in the seat and wear the safety belt properly.  
2-8  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Center Seat  
The vehicle may have a front center seat. This seat  
can be converted to a storage area by lowering the  
seatback. See Center Flex Storage Unit on page 354.  
Do not have a seatback reclined if the vehicle is  
moving.  
2-9  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
I (Heated Seatback): Press to turn on the heated  
seatback.  
Rear Seats  
J (Heated Seat and Seatback): Press to turn on the  
heated seat and seatback.  
Heated Seats  
Press a button to turn on the desired feature. A light on  
that button will display to show which feature is on.  
WARNING:  
{
Each feature has three temperature settings indicated  
by three lights next to the buttons. The highest setting  
shows three lights, two is medium and one is the  
lowest.  
If you cannot feel temperature change or pain to  
the skin, the seat heater may cause burns even at  
low temperatures. See the Warning under Heated  
and Ventilated Seats on page 25.  
When you press a button, the feature will turn on at the  
highest setting. Each time you press the button, the  
feature will go down one temperature setting.  
Your vehicle may have heated rear seats.  
To turn the feature off, keep pressing the button until the  
display lights turn off.  
To operate the rear heated seats, the ignition must  
be on.  
The buttons are located  
on the rear doors.  
Rear Seat Pass-Through Door  
Your vehicle has a passthrough door that provides  
access to the trunk from the rear seats. See Rear Seat  
PassThrough Doorunder Trunk on page 312.  
2-10  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Safety Belts  
WARNING:  
{
Safety Belts: They Are for Everyone  
It is extremely dangerous to ride in a cargo  
area, inside or outside of a vehicle. In a collision,  
people riding in these areas are more likely to  
be seriously injured or killed. Do not allow people  
to ride in any area of your vehicle that is not  
equipped with seats and safety belts. Be sure  
everyone in your vehicle is in a seat and using a  
safety belt properly.  
This section of the manual describes how to use safety  
belts properly. It also describes some things not to do  
with safety belts.  
WARNING:  
{
Do not let anyone ride where a safety belt cannot  
be worn properly. In a crash, if you or your  
passenger(s) are not wearing safety belts, the  
injuries can be much worse. You can hit things  
inside the vehicle harder or be ejected from the  
vehicle. You and your passenger(s) can be  
seriously injured or killed. In the same crash, you  
might not be, if you are buckled up. Always fasten  
your safety belt, and check that your passenger(s)  
are restrained properly too.  
This vehicle has indicators as a reminder to buckle the  
safety belts. See Safety Belt Reminders on page 447  
for additional information.  
In most states and in all Canadian provinces, the law  
requires wearing safety belts. Here is why:  
You never know if you will be in a crash. If you do have  
a crash, you do not know if it will be a serious one.  
A few crashes are mild, and some crashes can be  
so serious that even buckled up, a person would not  
survive. But most crashes are in between. In many of  
them, people who buckle up can survive and sometimes  
walk away. Without safety belts, they could have been  
badly hurt or killed.  
2-11  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
After more than 40 years of safety belts in vehicles,  
the facts are clear. In most crashes buckling up does  
matter ... a lot!  
Why Safety Belts Work  
When you ride in or on anything, you go as fast as  
it goes.  
Put someone on it.  
Take the simplest vehicle. Suppose it is just a seat on  
wheels.  
2-12  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Get it up to speed. Then stop the vehicle. The rider  
does not stop.  
The person keeps going until stopped by something. In  
a real vehicle, it could be the windshield...  
2-13  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
or the instrument panel...  
or the safety belts!  
With safety belts, you slow down as the vehicle does.  
You get more time to stop. You stop over more distance,  
and your strongest bones take the forces. That is why  
safety belts make such good sense.  
2-14  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Q: If I am a good driver, and I never drive far from  
home, why should I wear safety belts?  
Questions and Answers About Safety  
Belts  
A: You may be an excellent driver, but if you are in a  
crash even one that is not your fault you and  
your passenger(s) can be hurt. Being a good driver  
does not protect you from things beyond your  
control, such as bad drivers.  
Q: Will I be trapped in the vehicle after a crash if I  
am wearing a safety belt?  
A: You could be whether you are wearing a safety  
belt or not. But your chance of being conscious  
during and after an accident, so you can unbuckle  
and get out, is much greater if you are belted. And  
you can unbuckle a safety belt, even if you are  
upside down.  
Most accidents occur within 25 miles (40 km) of  
home. And the greatest number of serious injuries  
and deaths occur at speeds of less than 40 mph  
(65 km/h).  
Safety belts are for everyone.  
Q: If my vehicle has airbags, why should I have to  
wear safety belts?  
How to Wear Safety Belts Properly  
A: Airbags are supplemental systems only; so they  
work with safety belts not instead of them.  
Whether or not an airbag is provided, all occupants  
still have to buckle up to get the most protection.  
That is true not only in frontal collisions, but  
especially in side and other collisions.  
This section is only for people of adult size.  
Be aware that there are special things to know about  
safety belts and children. And there are different rules  
for smaller children and infants. If a child will be riding in  
the vehicle, see Older Children on page 231 or Infants  
and Young Children on page 234. Follow those rules  
for everyone's protection.  
It is very important for all occupants to buckle up.  
Statistics show that unbelted people are hurt more often  
in crashes than those who are wearing safety belts.  
2-15  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Occupants who are not buckled up can be thrown out of  
the vehicle in a crash. And they can strike others in the  
vehicle who are wearing safety belts.  
In a crash, this applies force to the strong pelvic bones  
and you would be less likely to slide under the lap belt.  
If you slid under it, the belt would apply force on your  
abdomen. This could cause serious or even fatal  
injuries. The shoulder belt should go over the shoulder  
and across the chest. These parts of the body are best  
able to take belt restraining forces.  
First, before you or your passenger(s) wear a safety  
belt, there is important information you should know.  
The shoulder belt locks if there is a sudden stop or  
crash.  
Sit up straight and always keep your feet on the floor  
in front of you. The lap part of the belt should be worn  
low and snug on the hips, just touching the thighs.  
2-16  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Q: What is wrong with this?  
WARNING:  
{
You can be seriously hurt if your shoulder belt is  
too loose. In a crash, you would move forward too  
much, which could increase injury. The shoulder  
belt should fit snugly against your body.  
A: The shoulder belt is too loose. It will not give as  
much protection this way.  
2-17  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Q: What is wrong with this?  
WARNING:  
{
You can be seriously hurt if your lap belt is too  
loose. In a crash, you could slide under the lap  
belt and apply force on your abdomen. This could  
cause serious or even fatal injuries. The lap belt  
should be worn low and snug on the hips, just  
touching the thighs.  
A: The lap belt is too loose. It will not give nearly as  
much protection this way.  
2-18  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Q: What is wrong with this?  
WARNING:  
{
You can be seriously injured if your belt is buckled  
in the wrong place like this. In a crash, the belt  
would go up over your abdomen. The belt forces  
would be there, not on the pelvic bones. This  
could cause serious internal injuries. Always  
buckle your belt into the buckle nearest you.  
A: The belt is buckled in the wrong buckle.  
2-19  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Q: What is wrong with this?  
WARNING:  
{
You can be seriously injured if your belt goes over  
an armrest like this. The belt would be much too  
high. In a crash, you can slide under the belt. The  
belt force would then be applied on the abdomen,  
not on the pelvic bones, and that could cause  
serious or fatal injuries. Be sure the belt goes  
under the armrests.  
A: The belt is over an armrest.  
2-20  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Q: What is wrong with this?  
WARNING:  
{
You can be seriously injured if you wear the  
shoulder belt under your arm. In a crash, your  
body would move too far forward, which would  
increase the chance of head and neck injury.  
Also, the belt would apply too much force to the  
ribs, which are not as strong as shoulder bones.  
You could also severely injure internal organs like  
your liver or spleen. The shoulder belt should go  
over the shoulder and across the chest.  
A: The shoulder belt is worn under the arm. It should  
be worn over the shoulder at all times.  
2-21  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Q: What is wrong with this?  
WARNING:  
{
You can be seriously injured by not wearing the  
lap-shoulder belt properly. In a crash, you would  
not be restrained by the shoulder belt. Your body  
could move too far forward increasing the chance  
of head and neck injury. You might also slide  
under the lap belt. The belt force would then be  
applied right on the abdomen. That could cause  
serious or fatal injuries. The shoulder belt should  
go over the shoulder and across the chest.  
A: The belt is behind the body.  
2-22  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Q: What is wrong with this?  
WARNING:  
{
You can be seriously injured by a twisted belt. In a  
crash, you would not have the full width of the belt  
to spread impact forces. If a belt is twisted, make  
it straight so it can work properly, or ask your  
dealer to fix it.  
A: The belt is twisted across the body.  
2-23  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Lap-Shoulder Belt  
All seating positions in the vehicle have a lap-shoulder  
except for the center front passenger position  
(if equipped), which has a lap belt. See Lap Belt on  
page 229 for more information.  
The following instructions explain how to wear a  
lap-shoulder belt properly.  
1. Adjust the seat, if the seat is adjustable, so you  
can sit up straight. To see how, see Seatsin the  
Index.  
2. Pick up the latch plate and pull the belt across you.  
Do not let it get twisted.  
The lap-shoulder belt may lock if you pull the belt  
across you very quickly. If this happens, let the  
belt go back slightly to unlock it. Then pull the belt  
across you more slowly.  
3. Push the latch plate into the buckle until it clicks.  
If the latch plate will not go fully into the buckle,  
check if the correct buckle is being used.  
If the shoulder portion of a passenger belt is pulled  
out all the way, the child restraint locking feature  
may be engaged. If this happens, just let the belt  
go back all the way and start again.  
Pull up on the latch plate to make sure it is secure.  
If the belt is not long enough, see Safety Belt  
Extender on page 231  
.
Engaging the child restraint locking feature in  
the right front seating position may affect the  
passenger sensing system. See Passenger  
Sensing System on page 264 for more  
information.  
Position the release button on the buckle so that  
the safety belt could be quickly unbuckled if  
necessary.  
2-24  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4. If equipped with a shoulder belt height adjuster,  
move it to the height that is right for you. See  
Shoulder Belt Height Adjusterlater in this section  
for instructions on use and important safety  
information.  
To unlatch the belt, push the button on the buckle. The  
belt should return to its stowed position. Slide the latch  
plate up the safety belt webbing when the safety belt is  
not in use. The latch plate should rest on the stitching  
near the guide loop on the side wall.  
Before a door is closed, be sure the safety belt is out  
of the way. If a door is slammed against a safety belt,  
damage can occur to both the belt and the vehicle.  
5. To make the lap part tight, pull up on the  
shoulder belt.  
It may be necessary to pull stitching on the safety  
belt through the latch plate to fully tighten the lap  
belt on smaller occupants.  
2-25  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Shoulder Belt Height Adjuster  
The vehicle has a shoulder belt height adjuster for the  
driver and right front passenger seating positions.  
After the adjuster is set to the desired position, try to  
move it down without pressing the release button to  
make sure it has locked into position.  
Adjust the height so the shoulder portion of the belt is  
on the shoulder and not falling off of it. The belt should  
be close to, but not contacting, the neck. Improper  
shoulder belt height adjustment could reduce the  
effectiveness of the safety belt in a crash. See How to  
Wear Safety Belts Properly on page 215.  
Safety Belt Pretensioners  
This vehicle has safety belt pretensioners for front  
outboard occupants. Although the safety belt  
pretensioners cannot be seen, they are part of the  
safety belt assembly. They can help tighten the safety  
belts during the early stages of a moderate to severe  
frontal or near frontal crash if the threshold conditions  
for pretensioner activation are met. And, if your vehicle  
has side impact airbags, safety belt pretensioners can  
help tighten the safety belts in a side crash.  
Press the release  
button (A) and move the  
height adjuster to the  
desired position. The  
adjuster can be moved  
up by pushing up on the  
shoulder belt guide.  
Pretensioners work only once. If the pretensioners  
activate in a crash, they will need to be replaced, and  
probably other new parts for the vehicle's safety belt  
system. See Replacing Restraint System Parts After a  
Crash on page 271.  
2-26  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Rear Safety Belt Comfort Guides  
This vehicle may have rear shoulder belt comfort guides  
for each outside passenger position in the rear seat.  
If not, they are available through your dealer. The  
guides may provide added safety belt comfort for older  
children who have outgrown booster seats and for some  
adults. When installed the comfort guide positions the  
shoulder belt away from the neck and head.  
Here is how to install a comfort guide to the safety belt:  
2. Place the guide over the belt, and insert the  
two edges of the belt into the slots of the guide.  
1. Remove the guide from its storage pocket on the  
rear side of the seatback.  
2-27  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
WARNING: (Continued)  
The shoulder belt should go over the shoulder and  
across the chest. These parts of the body are best  
able to take belt restraining forces.  
3. Be sure that the belt is not twisted and it lies flat.  
The elastic cord must be under the belt and the  
guide on top.  
WARNING:  
{
A safety belt that is not properly worn may not  
provide the protection needed in a crash. The  
person wearing the belt could be seriously injured.  
4. Buckle, position, and release the safety belt as  
described previously in this section. Make sure the  
shoulder portion of the belt is on the shoulder and  
not falling off of it. The belt should be close to, but  
not contacting, the neck.  
(Continued)  
2-28  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
To remove and store the comfort guide, squeeze the  
belt edges together so that the safety belt can be  
removed from the guide. Slide the guide into its storage  
pocket on the side of the seatback.  
The best way to protect the fetus is to protect the  
mother. When a safety belt is worn properly, it is more  
likely that the fetus will not be hurt in a crash. For  
pregnant women, as for anyone, the key to making  
safety belts effective is wearing them properly.  
Safety Belt Use During Pregnancy  
Safety belts work for everyone, including pregnant  
women. Like all occupants, they are more likely to be  
seriously injured if they do not wear safety belts.  
Lap Belt  
This part is only for the lap belt. To learn how to wear a  
lap-shoulder belt, see Lap-Shoulder Belt on page 224.  
The vehicle may have a center seating position. When  
you sit in the center front seating position, you have a  
lap safety belt, which has no retractor.  
A pregnant woman should wear a lap-shoulder belt, and  
the lap portion should be worn as low as possible,  
below the rounding, throughout the pregnancy.  
2-29  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
To make the belt longer, tilt the latch plate and pull it  
along the belt.  
To make the belt shorter, pull its free end as shown until  
the belt is snug.  
Buckle, position and release it the same way as the lap  
part of a lap-shoulder belt.  
If the belt is not long enough, see Safety Belt Extender  
on page 231  
.
Make sure the release button on the buckle is  
positioned so you would be able to unbuckle the safety  
belt quickly if necessary.  
2-30  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
If you find that the latch plate will not go fully into the  
buckle, see if you are using the correct buckle. Be sure  
that the latch plate clicks when inserted into the buckle.  
Child Restraints  
Older Children  
Safety Belt Extender  
If the vehicle's safety belt will fasten around you, you  
should use it.  
But if a safety belt is not long enough, your dealer will  
order you an extender. When you go in to order it, take  
the heaviest coat you will wear, so the extender will be  
long enough for you. To help avoid personal injury, do  
not let someone else use it, and use it only for the seat  
it is made to fit. The extender has been designed for  
adults. Never use it for securing child seats. To wear it,  
attach it to the regular safety belt. For more information,  
see the instruction sheet that comes with the extender.  
Older children who have outgrown booster seats should  
wear the vehicle's safety belts.  
The manufacturer's instructions that come with the  
booster seat, state the weight and height limitations for  
that booster. Use a booster seat with a lap-shoulder belt  
until the child passes the below fit test:  
.
Sit all the way back on the seat. Do the knees  
bend at the seat edge? If yes, continue. If no,  
return to the booster seat.  
2-31  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
.
Buckle the lap-shoulder belt. Does the shoulder  
belt rest on the shoulder? If yes, continue. If no, try  
using the rear safety belt comfort guide. See Rear  
Safety Belt Comfort Guidesunder Lap-Shoulder  
Belt on page 224 for more information. If the  
shoulder belt still does not rest on the shoulder,  
then return to the booster seat.  
Also see Rear Safety Belt Comfort Guidesunder  
Lap-Shoulder Belt on page 224.  
According to accident statistics, children and infants are  
safer when properly restrained in a child restraint  
system or infant restraint system secured in a rear  
seating position.  
In a crash, children who are not buckled up can strike  
other people who are buckled up, or can be thrown out  
of the vehicle. Older children need to use safety belts  
properly.  
.
.
Does the lap belt fit low and snug on the hips,  
touching the thighs? If yes, continue. If no, return  
to the booster seat.  
Can proper safety belt fit be maintained for length  
of trip? If yes, continue. If no, return to the  
booster seat.  
WARNING:  
{
If you have the choice, a child should sit in a position  
with a lap-shoulder belt and get the additional restraint  
a shoulder belt can provide.  
Never do this.  
Never allow two children to wear the same safety  
belt. The safety belt can not properly spread the  
impact forces. In a crash, the two children can be  
crushed together and seriously injured. A safety  
belt must be used by only one person at a time.  
Q: What is the proper way to wear safety belts?  
A: An older child should wear a lap-shoulder belt and  
get the additional restraint a shoulder belt can  
provide. The shoulder belt should not cross the face  
or neck. The lap belt should fit snugly below the  
hips, just touching the top of the thighs. This applies  
belt force to the child's pelvic bones in a crash.  
It should never be worn over the abdomen, which  
could cause severe or even fatal internal injuries in  
a crash.  
2-32  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
WARNING: (Continued)  
head and neck injury. The child might also slide  
under the lap belt. The belt force would then be  
applied right on the abdomen. That could cause  
serious or fatal injuries. The shoulder belt should  
go over the shoulder and across the chest.  
WARNING:  
{
Never do this.  
Never allow a child to wear the safety belt with the  
shoulder belt behind their back. A child can be  
seriously injured by not wearing the lap-shoulder  
belt properly. In a crash, the child would not be  
restrained by the shoulder belt. The child could  
move too far forward increasing the chance of  
(Continued)  
2-33  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Airbags plus lapshoulder belts offer protection for  
adults and older children, but not for young children and  
infants. Neither the vehicle's safety belt system nor its  
airbag system is designed for them. Every time infants  
and young children ride in vehicles, they should have  
the protection provided by appropriate child restraints.  
Infants and Young Children  
Everyone in a vehicle needs protection! This includes  
infants and all other children. Neither the distance  
traveled nor the age and size of the traveler changes  
the need, for everyone, to use safety restraints. In fact,  
the law in every state in the United States and in every  
Canadian province says children up to some age must  
be restrained while in a vehicle.  
Children who are not restrained properly can strike  
other people, or can be thrown out of the vehicle.  
WARNING:  
{
WARNING:  
{
Never do this.  
Children can be seriously injured or strangled if a  
shoulder belt is wrapped around their neck and  
the safety belt continues to tighten. Never leave  
children unattended in a vehicle and never allow  
children to play with the safety belts.  
Never hold an infant or a child while riding in a  
vehicle. Due to crash forces, an infant or a child  
will become so heavy it is not possible to hold it  
during a crash. For example, in a crash at only  
40 km/h (25 mph), a 5.5 kg (12 lb) infant will  
suddenly become a 110 kg (240 lb) force on a  
person's arms. An infant should be secured in an  
appropriate restraint.  
2-34  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
WARNING: (Continued)  
It is also better to secure a forward-facing child  
restraint in a rear seat. If you must secure a  
forward-facing child restraint in the right front seat,  
always move the front passenger seat as far back  
as it will go.  
WARNING:  
{
Never do this.  
Children who are up against, or very close to,  
any airbag when it inflates can be seriously  
injured or killed. Never put a rear-facing child  
restraint in the right front seat. Secure a  
rear-facing child restraint in a rear seat.  
(Continued)  
2-35  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Q: What are the different types of add-on child  
restraints?  
WARNING:  
{
A: Add-on child restraints, which are purchased by the  
vehicle's owner, are available in four basic types.  
Selection of a particular restraint should take into  
consideration not only the child's weight, height, and  
age but also whether or not the restraint will be  
compatible with the motor vehicle in which it will  
be used.  
To reduce the risk of neck and head injury during  
a crash, infants need complete support. This is  
because an infant's neck is not fully developed  
and its head weighs so much compared with  
the rest of its body. In a crash, an infant in a  
rear-facing child restraint settles into the restraint,  
so the crash forces can be distributed across the  
strongest part of an infant's body, the back and  
shoulders. Infants should always be secured in  
rear-facing child restraints.  
For most basic types of child restraints, there are  
many different models available. When purchasing a  
child restraint, be sure it is designed to be used in a  
motor vehicle. If it is, the restraint will have a label  
saying that it meets federal motor vehicle safety  
standards.  
The restraint manufacturer's instructions that come  
with the restraint state the weight and height  
limitations for a particular child restraint. In addition,  
there are many kinds of restraints available for  
children with special needs.  
2-36  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Child Restraint Systems  
WARNING:  
{
A rear-facing infant  
seat (A) provides restraint  
with the seating surface  
against the back of the  
infant.  
A young child's hip bones are still so small that  
the vehicle's regular safety belt may not remain  
low on the hip bones, as it should. Instead, it may  
settle up around the child's abdomen. In a crash,  
the belt would apply force on a body area that is  
unprotected by any bony structure. This alone  
could cause serious or fatal injuries. To reduce  
the risk of serious or fatal injuries during a crash,  
young children should always be secured in  
appropriate child restraints.  
The harness system holds the infant in place and, in a  
crash, acts to keep the infant positioned in the restraint.  
A forward-facing child  
seat (B) provides restraint  
for the child's body with  
the harness.  
2-37  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Securing an Add-On Child Restraint in  
the Vehicle  
WARNING:  
{
A child can be seriously injured or killed in a crash  
if the child restraint is not properly secured in the  
vehicle. Secure the child restraint properly in the  
vehicle using the vehicle's safety belt or LATCH  
system, following the instructions that came with  
that child restraint and the instructions in this  
manual.  
A booster seat (C-D) is a child restraint designed to  
improve the fit of the vehicle's safety belt system.  
A booster seat can also help a child to see out the  
window.  
To help reduce the chance of injury, the child restraint  
must be secured in the vehicle. Child restraint systems  
must be secured in vehicle seats by lap belts or the lap  
belt portion of a lap-shoulder belt, or by the LATCH  
system. See Lower Anchors and Tethers for Children  
(LATCH) on page 241 for more information. A child  
can be endangered in a crash if the child restraint is not  
properly secured in the vehicle.  
2-38  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
When securing an add-on child restraint, refer to the  
instructions that come with the restraint which may be  
on the restraint itself or in a booklet, or both, and to this  
manual. The child restraint instructions are important,  
so if they are not available, obtain a replacement copy  
from the manufacturer.  
Securing the Child Within the Child  
Restraint  
WARNING:  
{
Keep in mind that an unsecured child restraint can  
move around in a collision or sudden stop and injure  
people in the vehicle. Be sure to properly secure any  
child restraint in the vehicle even when no child is  
in it.  
A child can be seriously injured or killed in a crash  
if the child is not properly secured in the child  
restraint. Secure the child properly following the  
instructions that came with that child restraint.  
In some areas, Certified Child Passenger Safety  
Technicians (CPSTs) are available to inspect and  
demonstrate how to correctly use and install child  
restraints. In the U.S., refer to the National Highway  
Traffic Safety Administration (NHTSA) website to locate  
the nearest child safety seat inspection station. For  
CPST availability in Canada, check with Transport  
Canada or the Provincial Ministry of Transportation  
office.  
Where to Put the Restraint  
According to accident statistics, children and infants  
are safer when properly restrained in a child restraint  
system or infant restraint system secured in a rear  
seating position.  
We recommend that children and child restraints be  
secured in a rear seat, including: an infant or a child  
riding in a rear-facing child restraint; a child riding in a  
forward-facing child seat; an older child riding in a  
booster seat; and children, who are large enough, using  
safety belts.  
2-39  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
A label on your sun visor says, Never put a rear-facing  
child seat in the front.This is because the risk to the  
rear-facing child is so great, if the airbag deploys.  
WARNING: (Continued)  
Secure rear-facing child restraints in a rear  
seat, even if the airbag is off. If you secure a  
forward-facing child restraint in the right front seat,  
always move the front passenger seat as far back  
as it will go. It is better to secure the child restraint  
in a rear seat.  
WARNING:  
{
A child in a rear-facing child restraint can be  
seriously injured or killed if the right front  
passenger airbag inflates. This is because the  
back of the rear-facing child restraint would be  
very close to the inflating airbag. A child in a  
forward-facing child restraint can be seriously  
injured or killed if the right front passenger airbag  
inflates and the passenger seat is in a forward  
position.  
See Passenger Sensing System on page 264  
for additional information.  
WARNING:  
{
Even if the passenger sensing system has turned  
off the right front passenger frontal airbag, no  
system is fail-safe. No one can guarantee that  
an airbag will not deploy under some unusual  
circumstance, even though it is turned off.  
A child in a child restraint in the center front  
seat can be badly injured or killed by the frontal  
airbags if they inflate. Never secure a child  
restraint in the center front seat. It is always better  
to secure a child restraint in a rear seat.  
(Continued)  
2-40  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Do not use child restraints in the center front seat  
position.  
Lower Anchors and Tethers for  
Children (LATCH)  
When securing a child restraint in a rear seating  
The LATCH system holds a child restraint during  
driving or in a crash. This system is designed to make  
installation of a child restraint easier. The LATCH  
system uses anchors in the vehicle and attachments on  
the child restraint that are made for use with the LATCH  
system.  
position, study the instructions that came with your child  
restraint to make sure it is compatible with this vehicle.  
Child restraints and booster seats vary considerably in  
size, and some may fit in certain seating positions  
better than others. Always make sure the child restraint  
is properly secured.  
Make sure that a LATCH-compatible child restraint  
is properly installed using the anchors, or use the  
vehicle's safety belts to secure the restraint, following  
the instructions that came with that restraint, and also  
the instructions in this manual. When installing a child  
restraint with a top tether, you must also use either the  
lower anchors or the safety belts to properly secure the  
child restraint. A child restraint must never be installed  
using only the top tether and anchor.  
Depending on where you place the child restraint and  
the size of the child restraint, you may not be able to  
access adjacent safety belt assemblies or LATCH  
anchors for additional passengers or child restraints.  
Adjacent seating positions should not be used if the  
child restraint prevents access to or interferes with the  
routing of the safety belt.  
Wherever a child restraint is installed, be sure to secure  
the child restraint properly.  
In order to use the LATCH system in your vehicle, you  
need a child restraint that has LATCH attachments.  
The child restraint manufacturer will provide you with  
instructions on how to use the child restraint and its  
attachments. The following explains how to attach a  
child restraint with these attachments in your vehicle.  
Keep in mind that an unsecured child restraint can  
move around in a collision or sudden stop and injure  
people in the vehicle. Be sure to properly secure any  
child restraint in your vehicle even when no child is  
in it.  
Not all vehicle seating positions or child restraints have  
lower anchors and attachments or top tether anchors  
and attachments.  
2-41  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Lower Anchors  
Top Tether Anchor  
Lower anchors (A) are metal bars built into the vehicle.  
There are two lower anchors for each LATCH seating  
position that will accommodate a child restraint with  
lower attachments (B).  
A top tether (A, C) anchors the top of the child restraint  
to the vehicle. A top tether anchor is built into the  
vehicle. The top tether attachment (B) on the child  
restraint connects to the top tether anchor in the vehicle  
in order to reduce the forward movement and rotation of  
the child restraint during driving or in a crash.  
Your child restraint may have a single tether (A) or a  
dual tether (C). Either will have a single attachment (B)  
to secure the top tether to the anchor.  
2-42  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Some child restraints that have top tethers are designed  
for use with or without the top tether being attached.  
Others require the top tether always to be attached.  
In Canada, the law requires that forward-facing child  
restraints have a top tether, and that the tether be  
attached. Be sure to read and follow the instructions for  
your child restraint.  
To assist you in locating  
the lower anchors, each  
seating position with lower  
anchors has two labels,  
near the crease between  
the seatback and the seat  
cushion.  
Lower Anchor and Top Tether Anchor  
Locations  
i (Top Tether Anchor):  
Seating positions with top  
tether anchors.  
To assist you in locating  
the top tether anchors, the  
top tether anchor symbol  
is located on the cover.  
j (Lower Anchor):  
Seating positions with  
two lower anchors.  
Rear Seat  
2-43  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
According to accident statistics, children and infants  
are safer when properly restrained in a child restraint  
system or infant restraint system secured in a rear  
seating position. See Where to Put the Restraint on  
page 239 for additional information.  
The top tether anchors are located under the covers on  
the rear seatback filler panel. Pull open the cover to  
access the anchors. Be sure to use an anchor located  
on the same side of the vehicle as the seating position  
where the child restraint will be placed.  
Securing a Child Restraint Designed for the  
LATCH System  
WARNING:  
{
If a LATCH-type child restraint is not attached to  
anchors, the child restraint will not be able to  
protect the child correctly. In a crash, the child  
could be seriously injured or killed. Install a  
LATCH-type child restraint properly using the  
anchors, or use the vehicle's safety belts to  
secure the restraint, following the instructions that  
came with the child restraint and the instructions  
in this manual.  
Do not secure a child restraint in a position without a  
top tether anchor if a national or local law requires that  
the top tether be attached, or if the instructions that  
come with the child restraint say that the top tether must  
be attached.  
2-44  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Notice: Do not let the LATCH attachments rub  
against the vehicles safety belts. This may damage  
these parts. If necessary, move buckled safety belts  
to avoid rubbing the LATCH attachments.  
WARNING:  
{
Do not attach more than one child restraint to a  
single anchor. Attaching more than one child  
restraint to a single anchor could cause the  
anchor or attachment to come loose or even  
break during a crash. A child or others could be  
injured. To reduce the risk of serious or fatal  
injuries during a crash, attach only one child  
restraint per anchor.  
Do not fold the empty rear seat with a safety belt  
buckled. This could damage the safety belt or the  
seat. Unbuckle and return the safety belt to its  
stowed position, before folding the seat.  
1. Attach and tighten the lower attachments to the  
lower anchors. If the child restraint does not have  
lower attachments or the desired seating position  
does not have lower anchors, secure the child  
restraint with the top tether and the safety belts.  
Refer to your child restraint manufacturer  
instructions and the instructions in this manual.  
WARNING:  
{
1.1. Find the lower anchors for the desired  
seating position.  
Children can be seriously injured or strangled if a  
shoulder belt is wrapped around their neck and  
the safety belt continues to tighten. Buckle any  
unused safety belts behind the child restraint so  
children cannot reach them. Pull the shoulder belt  
all the way out of the retractor to set the lock,  
if your vehicle has one, after the child restraint  
has been installed.  
1.2. Put the child restraint on the seat.  
1.3. Attach and tighten the lower attachments on  
the child restraint to the lower anchors.  
2-45  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2. If the child restraint manufacturer recommends that  
the top tether be attached, attach and tighten the  
top tether to the top tether anchor, if equipped.  
Refer to the child restraint instructions and the  
following steps:  
If the position you are  
using has a fixed or  
adjustable headrest or  
head restraint and you are  
using a dual tether, route  
the tether around the  
headrest or head  
2.1. Find the top tether anchor.  
2.2. Pull open the top tether anchor cover to  
expose the anchor.  
restraint.  
2.3. If you have an adjustable headrest or head  
restraint, raise the headrest or head restraint.  
2.4. Route, attach and tighten the top tether  
according to your child restraint instructions  
and the following instructions:  
If the position you are  
using has an adjustable  
headrest or head restraint  
and you are using a  
If the position you are  
using has a fixed  
single tether, route the  
tether under the headrest  
or head restraint and in  
between the headrest or  
head restraint posts.  
headrest or head restraint  
and you are using a  
single tether, route the  
tether over the headrest  
or head restraint.  
2-46  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3. Before placing a child in the child restraint, make  
sure it is securely held in place. To check, grasp  
the child restraint at the LATCH path and attempt  
to move it sidetoside and backandforth. There  
should be no more than 2.5 cm (1 in) of movement  
for proper installation.  
In Canada, the law requires that forward-facing child  
restraints have a top tether, and that the tether be  
attached.  
If the child restraint does not have the LATCH  
system, you will be using the safety belt to secure the  
child restraint in this position. Be sure to follow the  
instructions that came with the child restraint. Secure  
the child in the child restraint when and as the  
instructions say.  
Securing a Child Restraint in a Rear  
Seat Position  
When securing a child restraint in a rear seating  
position, study the instructions that came with the child  
restraint to make sure it is compatible with this vehicle.  
If more than one child restraint needs to be installed  
in the rear seat, be sure to read Where to Put the  
Restraint on page 239.  
1. Put the child restraint on the seat.  
If the child restraint has the LATCH system, see  
Lower Anchors and Tethers for Children (LATCH) on  
page 241 for how and where to install the child  
restraint using LATCH. If a child restraint is secured in  
the vehicle using a safety belt and it uses a top tether,  
see Lower Anchors and Tethers for Children (LATCH)  
on page 241 for top tether anchor locations.  
2. Pick up the latch plate, and run the lap and  
shoulder portions of the vehicle's safety belt  
through or around the restraint. The child restraint  
instructions will show you how.  
Do not secure a child seat in a position without a top  
tether anchor if a national or local law requires that the  
top tether be anchored, or if the instructions that come  
with the child restraint say that the top strap must be  
anchored.  
2-47  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3. Push the latch plate into the buckle until it clicks.  
4. Pull the shoulder belt all the way out of the  
retractor to set the lock. When the retractor lock is  
set, the belt can be tightened but not pulled out of  
the retractor.  
Position the release button on the buckle so that  
the safety belt could be quickly unbuckled if  
necessary.  
2-48  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
6. If the child restraint has a top tether, follow the  
child restraint manufacturer's instructions regarding  
the use of the top tether. See Lower Anchors and  
Tethers for Children (LATCH) on page 241 for  
more information.  
7. Before placing a child in the child restraint, make  
sure it is securely held in place. To check, grasp  
the child restraint at the safety belt path and  
attempt to move it sidetoside and backandforth.  
When the child restraint is properly installed, there  
should be no more than 2.5 cm (1 in) of movement.  
To remove the child restraint, unbuckle the vehicle  
safety belt and let it return to the stowed position.  
If the top tether is attached to a top tether anchor,  
disconnect it.  
5. To tighten the belt, push down on the child  
restraint, pull the shoulder portion of the belt to  
tighten the lap portion of the belt, and feed the  
shoulder belt back into the retractor. When  
installing a forward-facing child restraint, it may  
be helpful to use your knee to push down on the  
child restraint as you tighten the belt.  
Try to pull the belt out of the retractor to make sure  
the retractor is locked. If the retractor is not locked,  
repeat Steps 4 and 5.  
2-49  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
In addition, the vehicle has a passenger sensing system  
which is designed to turn off the right front passenger  
frontal airbag and seat-mounted side impact airbag  
under certain conditions. See Passenger Sensing  
System on page 264 and Passenger Airbag Status  
Indicator on page 448 for more information, including  
important safety information.  
Securing a Child Restraint in the  
Center Front Seat Position  
WARNING:  
{
A child in a child restraint in the center front seat  
can be badly injured or killed by the frontal  
airbags if they inflate. Never secure a child  
restraint in the center front seat. It is always better  
to secure a child restraint in a rear seat.  
A label on the sun visor says, Never put a rear-facing  
child seat in the front.This is because the risk to the  
rear-facing child is so great, if the airbag deploys.  
WARNING:  
{
Do not use child restraints in the center front seat  
position.  
A child in a rear-facing child restraint can be  
seriously injured or killed if the right front  
passenger airbag inflates. This is because the  
back of the rear-facing child restraint would be  
very close to the inflating airbag. A child in a  
forward-facing child restraint can be seriously  
injured or killed if the right front passenger airbag  
inflates and the passenger seat is in a forward  
position.  
Securing a Child Restraint in the  
Right Front Seat Position  
This vehicle has airbags. A rear seat is a safer place to  
secure a forward-facing child restraint. See Where to  
Put the Restraint on page 239.  
(Continued)  
2-50  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Do not secure a child seat in a position without a top  
tether anchor if a national or local law requires that the  
top tether be anchored, or if the instructions that come  
with the child restraint say that the top strap must be  
anchored.  
WARNING: (Continued)  
Even if the passenger sensing system has turned  
off the right front passenger frontal airbag, no  
system is fail-safe. No one can guarantee that  
an airbag will not deploy under some unusual  
circumstance, even though it is turned off.  
In Canada, the law requires that forward-facing child  
restraints have a top tether, and that the tether be  
attached.  
You will be using the lap-shoulder belt to secure the  
child restraint in this position. Follow the instructions  
that came with the child restraint.  
Secure rear-facing child restraints in a rear  
seat, even if the airbag is off. If you secure a  
forward-facing child restraint in the right front seat,  
always move the front passenger seat as far back  
as it will go. It is better to secure the child restraint  
in a rear seat.  
1. Move the seat as far back as it will go before  
securing the forward-facing child restraint.  
When the passenger sensing system has turned  
off the right front passenger frontal airbag and  
seat-mounted side impact airbag, the off indicator  
on the passenger airbag status indicator should  
light and stay lit when you start the vehicle. See  
Passenger Airbag Status Indicator on page 448.  
See Passenger Sensing System on page 264  
for additional information.  
If the child restraint has the LATCH system, see  
Lower Anchors and Tethers for Children (LATCH) on  
page 241 for how and where to install the child  
restraint using LATCH. If a child restraint is secured  
using a safety belt and it uses a top tether, see Lower  
Anchors and Tethers for Children (LATCH) on  
page 241 for top tether anchor locations.  
2. Put the child restraint on the seat.  
3. Pick up the latch plate, and run the lap and  
shoulder portions of the vehicle's safety belt  
through or around the restraint. The child restraint  
instructions will show you how.  
2-51  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4. Push the latch plate into the buckle until it clicks.  
5. Pull the shoulder belt all the way out of the  
retractor to set the lock. When the retractor lock is  
set, the belt can be tightened but not pulled out of  
the retractor.  
Position the release button on the buckle so that  
the safety belt could be quickly unbuckled if  
necessary.  
2-52  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
7. Before placing a child in the child restraint, make  
sure it is securely held in place. To check, grasp  
the child restraint at the safety belt path and  
attempt to move it side to side and back and forth.  
When the child restraint is properly installed, there  
should be no more than 2.5 cm (1 in) of movement.  
If the airbags are off, the off indicator in the passenger  
airbag status indicator will come on and stay on when  
the vehicle is started.  
If a child restraint has been installed and the on  
indicator is lit, see If the On Indicator is Lit for a Child  
Restraint under Passenger Sensing System on  
page 264 for more information.  
To remove the child restraint, unbuckle the vehicle  
safety belt and let it return to the stowed position.  
6. To tighten the belt, push down on the child  
restraint, pull the shoulder portion of the belt to  
tighten the lap portion of the belt, and feed the  
shoulder belt back into the retractor. When  
installing a forward-facing child restraint, it may  
be helpful to use your knee to push down on the  
child restraint as you tighten the belt.  
Try to pull the belt out of the retractor to make sure  
the retractor is locked. If the retractor is not locked,  
repeat Steps 5 and 6.  
2-53  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
All of the airbags in your vehicle will have the word  
AIRBAG embossed in the trim or on an attached label  
near the deployment opening.  
Airbag System  
The vehicle has the following airbags:  
.
A frontal airbag for the driver.  
For frontal airbags, the word AIRBAG will appear on the  
middle part of the steering wheel for the driver and on  
the instrument panel for the right front passenger.  
.
A frontal airbag for the right front passenger.  
.
A seat-mounted side impact airbag for the driver.  
With seat-mounted side impact airbags, the word  
AIRBAG will appear on the side of the seatback closest  
to the door.  
.
A seat-mounted side impact airbag for the right  
front passenger.  
The vehicle may also have the following airbags:  
With roof-rail airbags, the word AIRBAG will appear  
along the headliner or trim.  
.
A roof-rail airbag for the driver and the passenger  
seated directly behind the driver.  
Airbags are designed to supplement the protection  
provided by safety belts. Even though today's airbags  
are also designed to help reduce the risk of injury from  
the force of an inflating bag, all airbags must inflate very  
quickly to do their job.  
.
A roof-rail airbag for the right front passenger and  
the passenger seated directly behind the right front  
passenger.  
2-54  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Here are the most important things to know about the  
airbag system:  
WARNING:  
{
WARNING:  
{
Airbags inflate with great force, faster than the  
blink of an eye. Anyone who is up against, or  
very close to, any airbag when it inflates can be  
seriously injured or killed. Do not sit unnecessarily  
close to the airbag, as you would be if you were  
sitting on the edge of your seat or leaning forward.  
Safety belts help keep you in position before and  
during a crash. Always wear your safety belt,  
even with airbags. The driver should sit as far  
back as possible while still maintaining control of  
the vehicle.  
You can be severely injured or killed in a crash if  
you are not wearing your safety belt even if  
you have airbags. Airbags are designed to work  
with safety belts, but do not replace them. Also,  
airbags are not designed to deploy in every  
crash. In some crashes safety belts are your only  
restraint. See When Should an Airbag Inflate? on  
page 259  
.
Wearing your safety belt during a crash helps  
reduce your chance of hitting things inside the  
vehicle or being ejected from it. Airbags are  
supplemental restraintsto the safety belts.  
Everyone in your vehicle should wear a safety belt  
properly whether or not there is an airbag for  
that person.  
Occupants should not lean on or sleep against the  
door or side windows in seating positions with  
seat-mounted side impact airbags and/or roof-rail  
airbags.  
2-55  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
There is an airbag  
readiness light on the  
instrument panel, which  
shows the airbag symbol.  
WARNING:  
{
Children who are up against, or very close to, any  
airbag when it inflates can be seriously injured  
or killed. Airbags plus lap-shoulder belts offer  
protection for adults and older children, but not for  
young children and infants. Neither the vehicle's  
safety belt system nor its airbag system is  
designed for them. Young children and infants  
need the protection that a child restraint system  
can provide. Always secure children properly in  
your vehicle. To read how, see Older Children on  
page 231 or Infants and Young Children on  
The system checks the airbag electrical system for  
malfunctions. The light tells you if there is an electrical  
problem. See Airbag Readiness Light on page 448 for  
more information.  
page 234  
.
2-56  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Where Are the Airbags?  
The right front passenger frontal airbag is in the  
instrument panel on the passenger's side.  
The driver frontal airbag is in the middle of the steering  
wheel.  
2-57  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Driver Side shown, Passenger Side similar  
Driver Side shown, Passenger Side similar  
The seat-mounted side impact airbags for the driver and  
right front passenger are in the side of the seatbacks  
closest to the door.  
If the vehicle has roof-rail airbags for the driver, right  
front passenger, and second row outboard passengers,  
they are in the ceiling above the side windows.  
2-58  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
When Should an Airbag Inflate?  
WARNING:  
{
Frontal airbags are designed to inflate in moderate to  
severe frontal or near-frontal crashes to help reduce  
the potential for severe injuries mainly to the driver's or  
right front passenger's head and chest. However, they  
are only designed to inflate if the impact exceeds a  
predetermined deployment threshold. Deployment  
thresholds are used to predict how severe a crash is  
likely to be in time for the airbags to inflate and help  
restrain the occupants.  
If something is between an occupant and an  
airbag, the airbag might not inflate properly or it  
might force the object into that person causing  
severe injury or even death. The path of an  
inflating airbag must be kept clear. Do not put  
anything between an occupant and an airbag,  
and do not attach or put anything on the steering  
wheel hub or on or near any other airbag  
covering.  
Whether your frontal airbags will or should deploy is not  
based on how fast your vehicle is traveling. It depends  
largely on what you hit, the direction of the impact, and  
how quickly your vehicle slows down.  
Do not use seat accessories that block the  
inflation path of a seat-mounted side impact  
airbag.  
Frontal airbags may inflate at different crash speeds.  
For example:  
Never secure anything to the roof of a vehicle with  
roof-rail airbags by routing a rope or tie down  
through any door or window opening. If you do,  
the path of an inflating roof-rail airbag will be  
blocked.  
.
If the vehicle hits a stationary object, the airbags  
could inflate at a different crash speed than if the  
vehicle hits a moving object.  
.
If the vehicle hits an object that deforms, the  
airbags could inflate at a different crash speed  
than if the vehicle hits an object that does not  
deform.  
2-59  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
.
.
If the vehicle hits a narrow object (like a pole), the  
airbags could inflate at a different crash speed  
than if the vehicle hits a wide object (like a wall).  
Your vehicle also has a dual-depth passenger airbag  
that adjusts the restraint according to crash severity,  
seat location, and safety belt status using electronic  
frontal sensor(s) and other special sensors which  
enable the sensing system to monitor the position of the  
front passenger seat. The passenger airbag inflates to a  
reduced depth when the passenger seat is in a forward  
position. For more rearward front seating positions, the  
passenger airbag may inflate to an increased depth (a  
full deployment), based on safety belt status and the  
crash severity measured early in the event. (Always  
wear your safety belt, even with frontal airbags.)  
If the vehicle goes into an object at an angle, the  
airbags could inflate at a different crash speed  
than if the vehicle goes straight into the object.  
Thresholds can also vary with specific vehicle design.  
Frontal airbags are not intended to inflate during vehicle  
rollovers, rear impacts, or in many side impacts.  
Your vehicle has a seat position sensor which enables  
the sensing system to monitor the position of the right  
front passenger's seat. The passenger seat position  
sensor and passenger safety belt buckle switch provide  
information that is used to determine if the airbags  
should deploy at a reduced level or at full deployment.  
Your vehicle has seat-mounted side impact airbags.  
Your vehicle may have roof-rail airbags. See Airbag  
System on page 254. Seat-mounted side impact and  
roof-rail airbags are intended to inflate in moderate to  
severe side crashes. Seat-mounted side impact and  
roof-rail airbags will inflate if the crash severity is above  
the system's designed threshold level. The threshold  
level can vary with specific vehicle design.  
In addition, your vehicle has a dual-stage driver airbag.  
Dual-stage airbags adjust the restraint according to  
crash severity. Your vehicle has electronic frontal  
sensors, which help the sensing system distinguish  
between a moderate frontal impact and a more severe  
frontal impact. For moderate frontal impacts, dual-stage  
airbags inflate at a level less than full deployment. For  
more severe frontal impacts, full deployment occurs.  
Seat-mounted side impact and roof-rail airbags are  
not intended to inflate in frontal impacts, near-frontal  
impacts, rollovers, or rear impacts. A seat-mounted side  
impact airbag is intended to deploy on the side of the  
vehicle that is struck. Both roof-rail airbags will deploy  
when either side of the vehicle is struck.  
2-60  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
In any particular crash, no one can say whether an  
airbag should have inflated simply because of the  
damage to a vehicle or because of what the repair  
costs were. For frontal airbags, inflation is determined  
by what the vehicle hits, the angle of the impact, and  
how quickly the vehicle slows down. For seat-mounted  
side impact and roof-rail airbags, deployment is  
determined by the location and severity of the side  
impact.  
How Does an Airbag Restrain?  
In moderate to severe frontal or near frontal collisions,  
even belted occupants can contact the steering wheel  
or the instrument panel. In moderate to severe side  
collisions, even belted occupants can contact the inside  
of the vehicle.  
Airbags supplement the protection provided by safety  
belts. Frontal airbags distribute the force of the impact  
more evenly over the occupant's upper body, stopping  
the occupant more gradually. Seat-mounted side impact  
and roof-rail airbags distribute the force of the impact  
more evenly over the occupant's upper body.  
What Makes an Airbag Inflate?  
In a deployment event, the sensing system sends an  
electrical signal triggering a release of gas from the  
inflator. Gas from the inflator fills the airbag causing the  
bag to break out of the cover and deploy. The inflator,  
the airbag, and related hardware are all part of the  
airbag module.  
But airbags would not help in many types of collisions,  
primarily because the occupant's motion is not toward  
those airbags. See When Should an Airbag Inflate? on  
page 259 for more information.  
Airbags should never be regarded as anything more  
than a supplement to safety belts.  
Frontal airbag modules are located inside the steering  
wheel and instrument panel. For vehicles with  
seat-mounted side impact airbags, there are airbag  
modules in the side of the front seatbacks closest to the  
door. For vehicles with roof-rail airbags, there are airbag  
modules in the ceiling of the vehicle, near the side  
windows that have occupant seating positions.  
2-61  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
What Will You See After an Airbag  
Inflates?  
WARNING:  
{
After the frontal airbags and seat-mounted side impact  
airbags inflate, they quickly deflate, so quickly that  
some people may not even realize an airbag inflated.  
Roof-rail airbags may still be at least partially inflated for  
some time after they deploy. Some components of the  
airbag module may be hot for several minutes. For  
location of the airbag modules, see What Makes an  
Airbag Inflate? on page 261.  
When an airbag inflates, there may be dust in the  
air. This dust could cause breathing problems for  
people with a history of asthma or other breathing  
trouble. To avoid this, everyone in the vehicle  
should get out as soon as it is safe to do so.  
If you have breathing problems but cannot get out  
of the vehicle after an airbag inflates, then get  
fresh air by opening a window or a door. If you  
experience breathing problems following an airbag  
deployment, you should seek medical attention.  
The parts of the airbag that come into contact with you  
may be warm, but not too hot to touch. There may be  
some smoke and dust coming from the vents in the  
deflated airbags. Airbag inflation does not prevent the  
driver from seeing out of the windshield or being able  
to steer the vehicle, nor does it prevent people from  
leaving the vehicle.  
The vehicle has a feature that may automatically unlock  
the doors, turn on the interior lamps and hazard warning  
flashers, and shut off the fuel system after the airbags  
inflate. You can lock the doors, turn off the interior  
lamps and hazard warning flashers by using the  
controls for those features.  
2-62  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
In many crashes severe enough to inflate the airbag,  
windshields are broken by vehicle deformation.  
Additional windshield breakage may also occur from  
the right front passenger airbag.  
WARNING:  
{
A crash severe enough to inflate the airbags may  
have also damaged important functions in the  
vehicle, such as the fuel system, brake and  
steering systems, etc. Even if the vehicle appears  
to be drivable after a moderate crash, there may  
be concealed damage that could make it difficult  
to safely operate the vehicle.  
.
Airbags are designed to inflate only once. After an  
airbag inflates, you will need some new parts for  
the airbag system. If you do not get them, the  
airbag system will not be there to help protect you  
in another crash. A new system will include airbag  
modules and possibly other parts. The service  
manual for your vehicle covers the need to replace  
other parts.  
Use caution if you should attempt to restart the  
engine after a crash has occurred.  
.
The vehicle has a crash sensing and diagnostic  
module which records information after a crash.  
See Vehicle Data Recording and Privacy on  
page 817 and Event Data Recorders on  
page 817  
.
.
Let only qualified technicians work on the airbag  
systems. Improper service can mean that an  
airbag system will not work properly. See your  
dealer for service.  
2-63  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The passenger sensing system works with sensors  
that are part of the right front passenger seat. The  
sensors are designed to detect the presence of a  
properly-seated occupant and determine if the right  
front passenger frontal airbag and seatmounted side  
impact airbag should be enabled (may inflate) or not.  
Passenger Sensing System  
The vehicle has a passenger sensing system for the  
right front passenger position. The passenger airbag  
status indicator will be visible on the overhead console  
when the vehicle is started.  
According to accident statistics, children are safer  
when properly secured in a rear seat in the correct  
child restraint for their weight and size.  
We recommend that children be secured in a rear seat,  
including: an infant or a child riding in a rear-facing child  
restraint; a child riding in a forward-facing child seat; an  
older child riding in a booster seat; and children, who  
are large enough, using safety belts.  
United States  
Canada  
A label on the sun visor says, Never put a rear-facing  
child seat in the front.This is because the risk to the  
rear-facing child is so great, if the airbag deploys.  
The words ON and OFF, or the symbol for on and off,  
are visible during the system check. If you are using  
remote start, if equipped, to start the vehicle from a  
distance, you may not see the system check. When  
the system check is complete, either the word ON or  
OFF, or the symbol for on or off, will be visible. See  
Passenger Airbag Status Indicator on page 448.  
WARNING:  
{
A child in a rear-facing child restraint can be  
seriously injured or killed if the right front  
passenger airbag inflates. This is because the  
back of the rear-facing child restraint would be  
very close to the inflating airbag. A child in a  
The passenger sensing system turns off the right front  
passenger frontal airbag and seat-mounted side impact  
airbag under certain conditions. The driver airbags and  
the roof-rail airbags are not affected by the passenger  
sensing system.  
(Continued)  
2-64  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
.
.
.
.
The system determines that a small child is  
present in a child restraint.  
WARNING: (Continued)  
The system determines that a small child is  
present in a booster seat.  
forward-facing child restraint can be seriously  
injured or killed if the right front passenger airbag  
inflates and the passenger seat is in a forward  
position.  
A right front passenger takes his/her weight off of  
the seat for a period of time.  
The right front passenger seat is occupied by a  
smaller person, such as a child who has outgrown  
child restraints.  
Even if the passenger sensing system has turned  
off the right front passenger frontal airbag and  
seat-mounted side impact airbag (if equipped),  
no system is fail-safe. No one can guarantee that  
an airbag will not deploy under some unusual  
circumstance, even though the airbag(s) are off.  
.
Or, if there is a critical problem with the airbag  
system or the passenger sensing system.  
When the passenger sensing system has turned off the  
right front passenger frontal airbag and seatmounted  
side impact airbag, the off indicator will light and stay lit  
to remind you that the airbags are off. See Passenger  
Airbag Status Indicator on page 448.  
Secure rear-facing child restraints in a rear seat,  
even if the airbag(s) are off. If you secure a  
forward-facing child restraint in the right front seat,  
always move the front passenger seat as far back  
as it will go. It is better to secure the child restraint  
in a rear seat.  
The passenger sensing system is designed to turn on  
(may inflate) the right front passenger frontal airbag and  
seatmounted side impact airbag anytime the system  
senses that a person of adult size is sitting properly in  
the right front passenger seat.  
The passenger sensing system is designed to turn off  
the right front passenger airbag and seatmounted side  
impact airbag if:  
When the passenger sensing system has allowed the  
airbags to be enabled, the on indicator will light and  
stay lit to remind you that the airbags are active.  
.
The right front passenger seat is unoccupied.  
.
The system determines that an infant is present in  
a rear-facing infant seat.  
2-65  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
For some children who have outgrown child restraints  
and for very small adults, the passenger sensing  
system may or may not turn off the right front passenger  
frontal airbag and seat-mounted side impact airbag,  
depending upon the persons seating posture and body  
build. Everyone in the vehicle who has outgrown child  
restraints should wear a safety belt properly whether  
or not there is an airbag for that person.  
3. Remove any additional items from the seat such  
as blankets, cushions, seat covers, seat heaters,  
or seat massagers.  
4. Reinstall the child restraint following the directions  
provided by the child restraint manufacturer and  
refer to Securing a Child Restraint in the Right  
Front Seat Position on page 250.  
5. If, after reinstalling the child restraint and restarting  
the vehicle, the on indicator is still lit, turn the  
vehicle off. Then slightly recline the vehicle  
WARNING:  
{
seatback and adjust the seat cushion, if adjustable,  
to make sure that the vehicle seatback is not  
pushing the child restraint into the seat cushion.  
If the airbag readiness light ever comes on and  
stays on, it means that something may be wrong  
with the airbag system. To help avoid injury to  
yourself or others, have the vehicle serviced right  
away. See Airbag Readiness Light on page 448  
for more information, including important safety  
information.  
Also make sure the child restraint is not trapped  
under the vehicle head restraint. If this happens,  
adjust the head restraint. See Head Restraints on  
page 22  
.
6. Restart the vehicle.  
If the on indicator is still lit, secure the child in the  
child restraint in a rear seat position in the vehicle,  
and check with your dealer.  
If the On Indicator is Lit for a Child  
Restraint  
If a child restraint has been installed and the on  
indicator is lit:  
1. Turn the vehicle off.  
2. Remove the child restraint from the vehicle.  
2-66  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
If this happens, use the following steps to allow the  
system to detect that person and enable the right front  
passenger frontal airbag and seat-mounted side impact  
airbag:  
If the Off Indicator is Lit for an  
Adult-Size Occupant  
1. Turn the vehicle off.  
2. Remove any additional material from the seat,  
such as blankets, cushions, seat covers, seat  
heaters, or seat massagers.  
3. Place the seatback in the fully upright position.  
4. Have the person sit upright in the seat, centered  
on the seat cushion, with legs comfortably  
extended.  
5. Restart the vehicle and have the person remain in  
this position for two to three minutes after the on  
indicator is lit.  
Additional Factors Affecting System  
Operation  
Safety belts help keep the passenger in position on the  
seat during vehicle maneuvers and braking, which helps  
the passenger sensing system maintain the passenger  
airbag status. See Safety Beltsand Child Restraints”  
in the Index for additional information about the  
importance of proper restraint use.  
If a person of adult-size is sitting in the right front  
passenger seat, but the off indicator is lit, it could be  
because that person is not sitting properly in the seat.  
2-67  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
A thick layer of additional material, such as a blanket  
or cushion, or aftermarket equipment such as seat  
covers, seat heaters, and seat massagers can affect  
how well the passenger sensing system operates. We  
recommend that you not use seat covers or other  
aftermarket equipment except when approved by  
GM for your specific vehicle. See Adding Equipment to  
Your Airbag-Equipped Vehicle on page 269 for more  
information about modifications that can affect how the  
system operates.  
Servicing Your Airbag-Equipped  
Vehicle  
Airbags affect how the vehicle should be serviced.  
There are parts of the airbag system in several places  
around the vehicle. Your dealer and the service manual  
have information about servicing the vehicle and the  
airbag system. To purchase a service manual, see  
Service Publications Ordering Information on  
page 815  
.
WARNING:  
{
WARNING:  
{
Stowing of articles under the passenger seat  
or between the passenger seat cushion and  
seatback may interfere with the proper operation  
of the passenger sensing system.  
For up to 10 seconds after the ignition is turned off  
and the battery is disconnected, an airbag can still  
inflate during improper service. You can be injured  
if you are close to an airbag when it inflates. Avoid  
yellow connectors. They are probably part of the  
airbag system. Be sure to follow proper service  
procedures, and make sure the person performing  
work for you is qualified to do so.  
2-68  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
installed under or on top of the seat fabric, could  
also interfere with the operation of the passenger  
sensing system. This could either prevent proper  
deployment of the passenger airbag(s) or prevent  
the passenger sensing system from properly turning  
off the passenger airbag(s). See Passenger Sensing  
System on page 264.  
Adding Equipment to Your  
Airbag-Equipped Vehicle  
Q: Is there anything I might add to or change about  
the vehicle that could keep the airbags from  
working properly?  
If you have any questions about this, you should  
contact Customer Assistance before you modify  
your vehicle. The phone numbers and addresses  
for Customer Assistance are in Step Two of the  
Customer Satisfaction Procedure in this manual.  
See Customer Satisfaction Procedure on page 82.  
A: Yes. If you add things that change your vehicle's  
frame, bumper system, height, front end or side  
sheet metal, they may keep the airbag system from  
working properly. Changing or moving any parts of  
the front seats, safety belts, the airbag sensing and  
diagnostic module, steering wheel, instrument panel,  
roof-rail airbag modules, ceiling headliner or pillar  
garnish trim, overhead console, front sensors, side  
impact sensors, or airbag wiring can affect the  
operation of the airbag system.  
Q: Because I have a disability, I have to get my  
vehicle modified. How can I find out whether this  
will affect my airbag system?  
In addition, your vehicle has a passenger sensing  
system for the right front passenger's position, which  
includes sensors that are part of the passenger's  
seat. The passenger sensing system may not  
operate properly if the original seat trim is replaced  
with non-GM covers, upholstery or trim, or with GM  
covers, upholstery or trim designed for a different  
vehicle. Any object, such as an aftermarket seat  
heater or a comfort enhancing pad or device,  
A: If you have questions, call Customer Assistance.  
The phone numbers and addresses for Customer  
Assistance are in Step Two of the Customer  
Satisfaction Procedure in this manual. See  
Customer Satisfaction Procedure on page 82.  
In addition, your dealer and the service manual have  
information about the location of the airbag sensors,  
sensing and diagnostic module and airbag wiring.  
2-69  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Airbags  
Restraint System Check  
The airbag system does not need regularly scheduled  
maintenance or replacement. Make sure the airbag  
readiness light is working. See Airbag Readiness Light  
on page 448 for more information.  
Checking the Restraint Systems  
Safety Belts  
Notice: If an airbag covering is damaged, opened,  
or broken, the airbag may not work properly. Do not  
open or break the airbag coverings. If there are any  
opened or broken airbag covers, have the airbag  
covering and/or airbag module replaced. For the  
location of the airbag modules, see What Makes an  
Airbag Inflate? on page 261. See your dealer for  
service.  
Now and then, check that the safety belt reminder light,  
safety belts, buckles, latch plates, retractors, and  
anchorages are all working properly.  
Look for any other loose or damaged safety belt system  
parts that might keep a safety belt system from doing its  
job. See your dealer to have it repaired. Torn or frayed  
safety belts may not protect you in a crash. They can rip  
apart under impact forces. If a belt is torn or frayed, get  
a new one right away.  
Make sure the safety belt reminder light is working.  
See Safety Belt Reminders on page 447 for more  
information.  
Keep safety belts clean and dry. See Care of Safety  
Belts on page 697  
.
2-70  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
If the vehicle has the LATCH system and it was being  
used during a crash, you may need new LATCH system  
parts.  
Replacing Restraint System Parts  
After a Crash  
New parts and repairs may be necessary even if the  
safety belt or LATCH system (if equipped), was not  
being used at the time of the crash.  
WARNING:  
{
If an airbag inflates, you will need to replace airbag  
system parts. See the part on the airbag system earlier  
in this section.  
A crash can damage the restraint systems in your  
vehicle. A damaged restraint system may not  
properly protect the person using it, resulting in  
serious injury or even death in a crash. To help  
make sure your restraint systems are working  
properly after a crash, have them inspected and  
any necessary replacements made as soon as  
possible.  
Have the safety belt pretensioners checked if the  
vehicle has been in a crash, if the airbag readiness light  
stays on after the vehicle is started, or while you are  
driving. See Airbag Readiness Light on page 448  
.
If the vehicle has been in a crash, do you need new  
safety belts or LATCH system (if equipped) parts?  
After a very minor crash, nothing may be necessary. But  
the safety belt assemblies that were used during any  
crash may have been stressed or damaged. See your  
dealer to have the safety belt assemblies inspected or  
replaced.  
2-71  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2 NOTES  
2-72  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 3 Features and Controls  
Keys . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-3  
Starting and Operating Your Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-22  
New Vehicle Break-In . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-22  
Ignition Positions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-22  
Retained Accessory Power (RAP) . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-24  
Starting the Engine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-24  
Engine Coolant Heater . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-25  
Automatic Transmission Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-26  
Performance Shifting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-29  
Parking Brake . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-29  
Shifting Into Park . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-30  
Shifting Out of Park . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-32  
Parking Over Things That Burn . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-33  
Engine Exhaust . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-33  
Running the Vehicle While Parked . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-34  
Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) System . . . . . . . . . . . 3-4  
Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) System  
Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-4  
Remote Vehicle Start . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-7  
Doors and Locks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-9  
Door Locks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-9  
Central Door Unlocking System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-10  
Power Door Locks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-10  
Programmable Automatic Door Locks . . . . . . . . . . 3-10  
Rear Door Security Locks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-10  
Lockout Protection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-11  
Trunk . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-12  
Windows . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-14  
Power Windows . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-15  
Sun Visors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-17  
Mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-35  
Automatic Dimming Rearview Mirror . . . . . . . . . . . 3-35  
Compass . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-35  
Outside Power Foldaway Mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-36  
Outside Automatic Dimming Mirror . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-37  
Park Tilt Mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-37  
Outside Convex Mirror . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-38  
Outside Heated Mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-38  
Theft-Deterrent Systems . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-18  
Valet Lockout Switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-18  
Content Theft-Deterrent . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-19  
PASS-Key® III+ Electronic Immobilizer . . . . . . . . . 3-20  
PASS-Key® III+ Electronic Immobilizer  
Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-20  
3-1  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 3 Features and Controls  
Object Detection Systems . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-38  
Storage Areas . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-54  
Glove Box . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-54  
Cupholders . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-54  
Front Storage Area . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-54  
Center Console Storage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-54  
Center Flex Storage Unit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-54  
Floor Mats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-54  
Rear Seat Armrest . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-56  
Convenience Net . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-56  
Ultrasonic Front and Rear Parking Assist  
(UFRPA) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-38  
Side Blind Zone Alert (SBZA) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-42  
Lane Departure Warning (LDW) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-45  
Universal Home Remote System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-47  
Universal Home Remote System Operation  
(With Three Round LED) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-47  
Sunroof . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-56  
3-2  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Keys  
WARNING:  
{
Leaving children in a vehicle with the ignition key  
is dangerous for many reasons. Children or others  
could be badly injured or even killed. They could  
operate the power windows or other controls or  
even make the vehicle move. The windows will  
function with the keys in the ignition and children  
could be seriously injured or killed if caught in the  
path of a closing window. Do not leave the keys in  
a vehicle with children.  
The master key is used for the driver door, ignition, and  
glove box.  
The valet key is used for the driver door and ignition.  
Notice: If the keys get locked in the vehicle, it may  
have to be damaged to get them out. Always carry a  
spare key.  
In an emergency, contact Roadside Assistance. See  
Roadside Service on page 87.  
3-3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) System Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) System  
Operation  
The Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) transmitter functions  
See Radio Frequency Statement on page 818  
for information regarding Part 15 of the Federal  
Communications Commission (FCC) rules and Industry  
Canada Standards RSS-210/220/310.  
work up to 60 m (195 feet) away from the vehicle.  
There are other conditions which can affect the  
performance of the transmitter. See Remote Keyless  
Entry (RKE) System on page 34.  
If there is a decrease in the RKE operating range,  
try this:  
.
Check the distance. The transmitter may be too  
far from the vehicle. Stand closer during rainy or  
snowy weather.  
.
Check the location. Other vehicles or objects may  
be blocking the signal. Take a few steps to the left  
or right, hold the transmitter higher, and try again.  
.
Check the transmitter's battery. See Battery  
Replacementlater in this section.  
.
If the transmitter is still not working correctly, see  
your dealer or a qualified technician for service.  
With Remote Start  
(Without Remote Start  
Similar)  
/ (Remote Vehicle Start): Press to start the engine  
from outside the vehicle using the RKE transmitter. See  
Remote Vehicle Start on page 37 for additional  
information.  
3-4  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Q (Lock): Press to lock all the doors. If enabled  
through the Driver Information Center (DIC), the parking  
lamps may flash once to indicate locking has occurred.  
L (Vehicle Locator/Panic Alarm): Press and release  
to locate the vehicle. The turn signal lamps flash and  
the horn sounds three times.  
The horn may chirp when Q is pressed again within  
five seconds. See DIC Vehicle Customization on  
page 477 for additional information.  
Press and hold L for more than two seconds to  
activate the panic alarm. The turn signal lamps flash  
and the horn sounds repeatedly for 30 seconds.  
The alarm turns off when the ignition is moved to  
Pressing Q may arm the content theft-deterrent system.  
See Content Theft-Deterrent on page 319.  
ON/RUN or L is pressed again. The ignition must be  
in LOCK/OFF for the panic alarm to work.  
K (Unlock): Press once to unlock the driver door.  
The vehicle comes with two transmitters. Each  
If K is pressed again within five seconds, all remaining  
doors unlock. The interior lamps come on and stay  
on for 20 seconds or until the ignition is turned on.  
If enabled through the DIC, the parking lamps flash  
twice to indicate unlocking has occurred. See DIC  
transmitter will have a number on top of it, 1or 2.  
These numbers correspond to the driver of the vehicle.  
For example, the memory seat position for driver 1 will  
be recalled when using the transmitter labeled 1,  
if enabled through the DIC. See Memory Seat, Mirrors  
and Steering Wheel on page 26 and DIC Vehicle  
Customization on page 477 for more information.  
Vehicle Customization on page 477. Pressing K may  
disarm the content theft-deterrent system. See Content  
Theft-Deterrent on page 319.  
V (Remote Trunk Release): Press and hold for  
about one second to unlock the trunk. The transmission  
must be in P (Park).  
3-5  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Programming Transmitters to the  
Vehicle  
Only RKE transmitters programmed to the vehicle will  
work. If a transmitter is lost or stolen, a replacement can  
be purchased and programmed through your dealer.  
When the replacement transmitter is programmed to  
the vehicle, all remaining transmitters must also be  
programmed. Any lost or stolen transmitters no longer  
work once the new transmitter is programmed. Each  
vehicle can have up to eight transmitters programmed  
to it. See RELEARN REMOTE KEY under DIC  
Operation and Displays on page 460.  
Battery Replacement  
Replace the battery if the REPLACE BATTERY IN  
REMOTE KEY message displays in the DIC. See  
REPLACE BATTERY IN REMOTE KEYunder DIC  
Warnings and Messages on page 465 for additional  
information.  
To replace the battery:  
1. Separate the transmitter with a flat, thin object  
inserted into the notch, located above the  
metal base.  
2. Remove the old battery. Do not use a metal object.  
Notice: When replacing the battery, do not touch  
any of the circuitry on the transmitter. Static from  
your body could damage the transmitter.  
3. Insert the new battery, positive side facing up.  
Replace with a CR2032 or equivalent battery.  
4. Reassemble the transmitter.  
3-6  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
There are other conditions which can affect the  
performance of the transmitter, see Remote Keyless  
Entry (RKE) System Operation on page 34 for  
additional information.  
Remote Vehicle Start  
The remote vehicle starting feature allows you to start  
the engine from outside of the vehicle. It also starts up  
the vehicle's automatic climate control system. When  
the remote start system is active, the climate control  
system will heat and cool the inside of the vehicle  
according to the previous settings of the system before  
turning the vehicle off. The rear window defogger will  
be turned on by the climate control system when it is  
cold outside. If the vehicle has heated seats, they  
will also turn on when it is cold outside. See Heated  
and Ventilated Seats on page 25 for additional  
information. Cooled seats are not activated during a  
remote start. Normal operation of the climate control  
system will return after the key is turned to ON/RUN.  
See Dual Climate Control System on page 434.  
/ (Remote Start): This button will be on the RKE  
transmitter if you have remote start.  
To start the vehicle using the remote start feature:  
1. Aim the transmitter at the vehicle.  
2. Press and release the transmitter's lock button,  
then immediately press and hold the transmitter's  
remote start button until the turn signal lights  
flash or if the vehicle's lights are not visible, press  
and hold the remote start button for at least  
four seconds. Pressing the remote start button  
again after the vehicle has started will turn off the  
ignition.  
Laws in some communities may restrict the use of  
remote starters. For example, some laws may require a  
person using remote start to have the vehicle in view  
when doing so. Check local regulations for any  
requirements on remote starting of vehicles.  
When the vehicle starts, the parking lamps will turn  
on and remain on while the vehicle is running. The  
vehicle's doors will be locked.  
3. If it is the first remote start since the vehicle has  
been driven, repeat these steps, while the engine  
is still running, to extend the engine running time  
by 10 minutes. Remote start can be extended  
one time.  
Do not use the remote start feature if your vehicle is low  
on fuel. Your vehicle may run out of fuel.  
If your vehicle has the remote start feature, the RKE  
transmitter functions will have an increased range of  
operation. However, the range may be less while the  
vehicle is running.  
After entering the vehicle during a remote start, insert  
and turn the key to ON/RUN to drive the vehicle.  
3-7  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
If the vehicle is left running it will automatically shut  
off after 10 minutes unless a time extension has  
been done.  
Once two remote starts or a single start with a time  
extension have been used, the vehicle must be started  
with the ignition key before you can use the remote start  
feature again.  
To manually shut off a remote start:  
The remote vehicle start feature will not operate if the  
key is in the ignition, the hood is not closed, or if there  
is an emission control system malfunction.  
.
Aim the RKE transmitter at the vehicle and press  
the remote start button until the parking lamps  
turn off.  
The engine will turn off during a remote vehicle start  
if the coolant temperature gets too high, or the oil  
pressure is too low.  
.
Turn on the hazard warning flashers.  
.
Turn the ignition switch on and then off.  
The remote vehicle start feature provides two separate  
starts, each with 10 minutes of engine running, or it  
provides one start with 10 minutes of engine running  
that may be extended 10 more minutes. If you press  
and release the transmitter lock button and then press  
and hold the remote start button on the RKE transmitter  
again before the first 10 minutes of engine running time  
has expired, 10 minutes are added to the remaining  
minutes. For example, if the lock button and then  
the remote start buttons are pressed again after  
five minutes of the engine run time, 10 minutes are  
added and you now have 15 minutes of engine running.  
The added ten minutes are considered a second remote  
vehicle start.  
See Engine Exhaust on page 333 for important safety  
information when using remote start in a closed garage.  
Remote Start Ready  
If your vehicle does not have the remote vehicle start  
feature, it may have the remote start ready feature. This  
feature allows your dealer to add the manufacturer's  
remote vehicle start feature. See your dealer if you  
would like to add the manufacturer's remote vehicle  
start feature to your vehicle.  
3-8  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Doors and Locks  
WARNING: (Continued)  
Door Locks  
.
Outsiders can easily enter through an  
unlocked door when you slow down or stop  
your vehicle. Locking your doors can help  
prevent this from happening.  
WARNING:  
{
Unlocked doors can be dangerous.  
.
There are several ways to lock and unlock your vehicle.  
Passengers, especially children, can easily  
open the doors and fall out of a moving  
vehicle. When a door is locked, the handle will  
not open it. The chance of being thrown out of  
the vehicle in a crash is increased if the doors  
are not locked. So, all passengers should  
wear safety belts properly and the doors  
should be locked whenever the vehicle is  
driven.  
Because the vehicle has the theft-deterrent system, you  
must unlock the doors with the key or RKE transmitter  
to avoid setting off the alarm.  
From the outside, use either the key or the  
RKE transmitter.  
From the inside, use the power door lock switches or  
manual lock knobs. The manual lock knobs are located  
at the top of the door panel near the window.  
.
Young children who get into unlocked vehicles  
Push the manual lock knob down to lock the door. To  
unlock the door, pull up on the knob.  
may be unable to get out. A child can be  
overcome by extreme heat and can suffer  
permanent injuries or even death from heat  
stroke. Always lock the vehicle whenever  
leaving it.  
(Continued)  
3-9  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
If someone needs to get out while the vehicle is not in  
P (Park), have the person use the manual lock knob or  
power door lock switch. When the door is closed again,  
it will not lock automatically. Use the manual lock knob  
or power door lock switch to lock the door.  
Central Door Unlocking System  
The vehicle has a central door unlocking mode. When  
unlocking the driver door, the other doors can be  
unlocked at the same time by turning the key clockwise  
in the door lock cylinder twice.  
The door locks can be programmed through prompts  
displayed on the Driver Information Center (DIC). These  
prompts allow the driver to choose various lock and  
unlock settings. For programming information, see DIC  
Vehicle Customization on page 477.  
Power Door Locks  
With power door locks, the switches on the front doors  
can be used to lock and unlock the vehicle.  
K (Unlock): Press to unlock the doors.  
Rear Door Security Locks  
Rear door security locks prevent passengers from  
opening the rear doors from the inside.  
Q (Lock): Remove the key from the ignition and press  
to lock the doors.  
The rear door security locks are located on the inside  
edge of each rear door. The rear doors must be opened  
to access them.  
Programmable Automatic Door  
Locks  
The vehicle is programmed so that, when the doors are  
closed, the ignition is on, and the shift lever is moved  
out of P (Park), all the doors will lock. The doors will  
unlock every time the vehicle is stopped and the shift  
lever is moved into P (Park).  
3-10  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
To assist in finding the lock, the vehicle has the  
following:  
To open a rear door when the security lock is on, do the  
following:  
1. Unlock the door using the Remote Keyless Entry  
(RKE) transmitter, if the vehicle has one, the  
power door lock switch, or by lifting the rear door  
manual lock.  
2. Open the door from the outside.  
To cancel the rear door security lock:  
1. Unlock the door and open it from the outside.  
2. Insert the key into the security lock slot and turn it  
so the slot is in the vertical position.  
3. Do the same for the other rear door.  
Lockout Protection  
To use the lock:  
If the key is in the ignition and the power door lock  
switch is used to lock the doors, all doors will lock  
and then the driver door will unlock. It is always  
recommended that the ignition key is removed from the  
vehicle when locking the doors.  
1. Insert the key into the security lock slot and turn it  
so the slot is in the horizontal position.  
2. Close the door.  
3. Do the same for the other rear door.  
The lockout protection feature can be overridden by  
holding the power door lock switch for three seconds or  
longer.  
3-11  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Remote Trunk Release  
Trunk  
V (Remote Trunk Release): The remote trunk  
release button is located to the left of the steering wheel  
next to the instrument panel brightness control. Press  
the button to open the trunk. The vehicle must be in  
P (Park) or N (Neutral) and the valet lockout switch must  
be off to use this button.  
WARNING:  
{
Exhaust gases can enter the vehicle if it is driven  
with the liftgate, trunk/hatch open, or with any  
objects that pass through the seal between the  
body and the trunk/hatch or liftgate. Engine  
exhaust contains Carbon Monoxide (CO) which  
cannot be seen or smelled. It can cause  
unconsciousness and even death.  
You can also press the button with the trunk symbol on  
the RKE transmitter to open the trunk. To disable this  
feature, see Valet Lockout Switch on page 318.  
The trunk can be accessed using the Rear Seat  
Pass-Through. See Rear Seat Pass-Throughfollowing  
this section.  
If the vehicle must be driven with the liftgate,  
or trunk/hatch open:  
.
Close all of the windows.  
.
Fully open the air outlets on or under the  
instrument panel.  
.
Adjust the Climate Control system to a setting  
that brings in only outside air and set the fan  
speed to the highest setting. See Climate  
Control System in the Index.  
.
If the vehicle is equipped with a power liftgate,  
disable the power liftgate function.  
For more information about carbon monoxide, see  
Engine Exhaust on page 333.  
3-12  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
There is a glow-in-the-dark emergency trunk release  
handle located inside the trunk near the latch. This  
handle will glow following exposure to light. Pull the  
release handle to open the trunk from the inside.  
Emergency Trunk Release Handle  
Rear Seat PassThrough  
The vehicle has a small door in the rear seat. This door  
allows access to the trunk from inside the vehicle.  
The rear seat armrest must be down for the  
pass-through door to open. To release the pass-through  
door, move the release up. To close the door, raise it  
and push it until it latches.  
Notice: Do not use the emergency trunk release  
handle as a tie-down or anchor point when securing  
items in the trunk as it could damage the handle.  
The emergency trunk release handle is only  
intended to aid a person trapped in a latched trunk,  
enabling them to open the trunk from the inside.  
3-13  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Windows  
WARNING:  
{
Leaving children, helpless adults, or pets in a  
vehicle with the windows closed is dangerous.  
They can be overcome by the extreme heat and  
suffer permanent injuries or even death from heat  
stroke. Never leave a child, a helpless adult, or a  
pet alone in a vehicle, especially with the windows  
closed in warm or hot weather.  
The vehicle aerodynamics are designed to improve fuel  
economy performance. This may result in a pulsing  
sound when either rear window is down and the front  
windows are up. To reduce the sound, open either a  
front window or the sunroof (if equipped).  
3-14  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The power window  
switches are located on  
the driver door.  
Power Windows  
WARNING:  
{
Leaving children in a vehicle with the keys is  
dangerous for many reasons. Children or others  
could be badly injured or even killed. They could  
operate the power windows or other controls or  
even make the vehicle move. The windows will  
function and they could be seriously injured or  
killed if caught in the path of a closing window. Do  
not leave keys in a vehicle with children.  
When there are children in the rear seat use the  
window lockout button to prevent unintentional  
operation of the windows.  
In addition, each door has a switch for its own  
window. The front power window switch operates with  
two positions for both up and down movement and the  
rear power window switch operates with one position  
for up and two positions for down movement. Press the  
switch to the first position to lower the window to the  
desired level. Pull the switch up to raise the window.  
The vehicle has Retained Accessory Power (RAP) that  
allows you to use the power windows once the ignition  
has been turned off. For more information, see Retained  
Accessory Power (RAP) on page 324.  
3-15  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Express-Down/Up Windows  
Express Window AntiPinch Override  
Windows with the express feature allow the windows to  
be raised and lowered all the way without holding the  
switch.  
WARNING:  
{
Press or pull the switch fully and release it to activate  
the express feature.  
If express override is activated, the window will  
not reverse automatically. You or others could be  
injured and the window could be damaged. Before  
you use express override, make sure that all  
people and obstructions are clear of the  
window path.  
The express mode can be canceled at any time by  
briefly pressing or pulling the switch.  
Express Window Anti-Pinch Feature  
If any object is in the path of the window when the  
expressup is active, the window will stop at the  
obstruction and autoreverse to a preset factory  
position. Weather conditions such as severe icing  
may also cause the window to autoreverse. The  
window will return to normal operation once the  
obstruction or condition is removed.  
In an emergency, the antipinch feature can be  
overridden in a supervised mode. Hold the window  
switch all the way up to the second position. The  
window will rise for as long as the switch is held.  
Once the switch is released, the express mode is  
reactivated.  
In this mode, the window can still close on an object in  
its path. Use care when using the override mode.  
3-16  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Programming the Power Windows  
Window Lockout  
If the battery on the vehicle has been recharged,  
disconnected, or is not working, you will need to  
reprogram each front power window for the express-up  
feature to work. Before reprogramming, replace or  
recharge the vehicle's battery.  
o (Window Lockout): The rear window lockout button  
is located on the driver door near the window switches.  
Press the right side of the button to disable the rear  
window controls. The light on the button will illuminate,  
indicating the feature is in use. The rear windows still  
can be raised or lowered using the driver window  
switches when the lockout feature is active.  
To program each front window, follow these steps:  
1. With the ignition in ACC/ACCESSORY, ON/RUN,  
or when Retained Accessory Power (RAP) is  
active, close all doors.  
To restore power to the rear windows, press the button  
again. The light on the button will go out.  
2. Press and hold the power window switch until the  
window is fully open.  
Sun Visors  
3. Pull the power window switch up until the window  
is fully closed.  
Swing down the visor to block out glare. The visors also  
have side-to-side slide capability.  
4. Continue holding the switch up for approximately  
two seconds after the window is completely closed.  
Lighted Visor Vanity Mirror  
Pull the visor down and lift the cover to view the mirror.  
The light will come on when the cover is opened. It will  
go out when you close the cover. If your vehicle has the  
adjustable lighting feature, slide the switch up or down  
to brighten or dim the light.  
The window is now reprogrammed. Repeat the process  
for the other windows.  
3-17  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Rear Power Sunshade  
If your vehicle has a rear power sunshade, it helps to  
reduce the amount of heat and light entering the rear  
window.  
Theft-Deterrent Systems  
This vehicle has theft-deterrent features, however, they  
do not make it impossible to steal.  
Valet Lockout Switch  
The switch is located on  
the overhead console.  
The valet lockout switch is  
located inside the  
glove box.  
The rear power sunshade is located in the rear shelf.  
It only works while the ignition is on or while the  
Retained Accessory Power (RAP) is active. See  
Retained Accessory Power (RAP) on page 324.  
9 (Off): Press this side of the button to turn the lockout  
feature off. When the lockout feature is off, you can  
open the trunk using either the keyless entry transmitter  
or the trunk release button located near the headlamp  
switch on the instrument panel.  
To raise the power sunshade, press and release the  
switch. To close the power sunshade, press and release  
the switch again.  
Never store objects on the rear shelf because they may  
get caught in the sunshade or be tossed about in your  
vehicle.  
3-18  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
(On): Press this side of the button to turn the lockout  
feature on. When the lockout feature is turned on,  
the trunk cannot be unlocked with the keyless entry  
transmitter or the trunk release button located near the  
headlamp switch on the instrument panel.  
To arm the system:  
1. Open the door.  
2. Lock the door using the power door lock switch  
with the door open or the Remote Keyless Entry  
(RKE) transmitter. The security light will flash.  
If the valet lockout feature is on it will also disable the  
Universal Home Remote transmitter, if equipped.  
3. Close all the doors. The security light will come on  
and stay on for approximately 30 seconds.  
Locking the glove box with your key will also help to  
secure your vehicle.  
If a door or the trunk is opened without a key or a RKE  
transmitter the horn will sound and the lamps will flash  
for about 30 seconds.  
See Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) System Operation on  
page 34 and Trunk on page 312 for additional  
information.  
The theft-deterrent system will not arm if you lock the  
doors with a key or use the manual door lock. It arms  
only if you use a power door lock with the door open or  
the RKE transmitter.  
Content Theft-Deterrent  
The security light  
is located on the  
instrument panel cluster.  
To avoid arming the alarm by accident:  
.
Lock the vehicle with the door key or the manual  
door lock.  
.
Always unlock a door with a key or use the RKE  
transmitter system. Pressing the unlock button on  
the RKE transmitter, or unlocking a door with the  
key disarms the content theft-deterrent system.  
Unlocking a door any other way will activate the  
alarm when a door or the trunk is opened.  
3-19  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
If you activate the alarm by accident, unlock the driver's  
door with your key. You can also turn off the alarm by  
using the unlock button on the RKE transmitter system,  
or by starting the car with a valid key.  
If the alarm does not sound when it should, check to  
see if the horn works. The horn fuse may be blown. To  
replace the fuse, see Fuses and Circuit Breakers on  
page 6104. If the fuse does not need to be replaced,  
you may need to have your vehicle serviced.  
Changes or modifications made to this system by  
other than an authorized service facility could void  
authorization to use the theft system.  
To reduce the possibility of theft, always arm the  
theft-deterrent system when leaving your vehicle.  
PASS-Key® III+ Electronic  
Immobilizer  
Testing the Alarm  
1. From inside the vehicle, roll down the window, then  
get out of the vehicle, keeping the door open.  
See Radio Frequency Statement on page 818  
for information regarding Part 15 of the Federal  
Communications Commission (FCC) rules and Industry  
Canada Standards RSS-210/220/310.  
2. From outside of the vehicle, with the door open,  
lock the vehicle using the power door lock or the  
RKE system and close the door. Wait 30 seconds  
until the security lamp goes off.  
PASS-Key® III+ Electronic  
Immobilizer Operation  
3. Reach in and unlock the door using the manual  
lock and open the door. The horn will sound and  
the hazard lights will flash.  
Your vehicle has PASS-Key® III+ (Personalized  
Automotive Security System) theft-deterrent system.  
PASS-Key® III+ is a passive theft-deterrent system.  
You can turn off the alarm by unlocking the driver's  
door with your key, using the unlock button on the RKE  
transmitter or by starting the car with a valid key.  
The system is automatically armed when the key is  
removed from the ignition.  
The system is automatically disarmed when the key is  
turned to ON/RUN, ACC/ACCESSORY or START from  
the LOCK/OFF position.  
You do not have to manually arm or disarm the system.  
3-20  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The security light will come on if there is a problem with  
arming or disarming the theft-deterrent system.  
See your dealer or a locksmith who can service  
PASS-Key® III+ to get a new key blank that is cut  
exactly as the ignition key that operates the system.  
When the PASS-Key® III+ system senses that someone  
is using the wrong key, it prevents the vehicle from  
starting. Anyone using a trial-and-error method to start  
the vehicle will be discouraged because of the high  
number of electrical key codes.  
To program the new key:  
1. Verify that the new key has a 1 stamped on it.  
2. Insert the original, already programmed, key in the  
ignition and start the engine. If the engine will not  
start, see your dealer for service.  
If the engine does not start and the security light comes  
on when trying to start the vehicle, there may be a  
problem with your theft-deterrent system. Turn the  
ignition off and try again.  
3. After the engine has started, turn the key to  
LOCK/OFF, and remove the key.  
4. Insert the new key to be programmed and turn it to  
the ON/RUN position within five seconds of turning  
the original key to LOCK/OFF.  
If the engine still does not start, and the key appears to  
be undamaged, try another ignition key. At this time,  
you may also want to check the fuse, see Fuses and  
Circuit Breakers on page 6104. If the engine still does  
not start with the other key, your vehicle needs service.  
If your vehicle does start, the first key may be faulty.  
See your dealer who can service the PASS-Key® III+ to  
have a new key made. In an emergency, contact  
Roadside Assistance.  
It is possible for the PASS-Key® III+ decoder to learn”  
the transponder value of a new or replacement key. Up  
to 10 keys may be programmed for the vehicle. The  
following procedure is for programming additional keys  
only. If all the currently programmed keys are lost or do  
not operate, you must see your dealer or a locksmith  
who can service PASS-Key® III+ to have keys made  
and programmed to the system.  
The security light will turn off once the key has  
been programmed.  
5. Repeat Steps 1 through 4 if additional keys are to  
be programmed.  
If you lose or damage your PASS-Key® III+ key,  
see your dealer or a locksmith who can service  
PASS-Key® III+ to have a new key made.  
Do not leave the key or device that disarms or  
deactivates the theft deterrent system in the vehicle.  
3-21  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Ignition Positions  
The ignition switch has four different positions:  
Starting and Operating Your  
Vehicle  
New Vehicle Break-In  
Notice: The vehicle does not need an elaborate  
break-in. But it will perform better in the long run if  
you follow these guidelines:  
.
Do not drive at any one constant speed,  
fast or slow, for the first 500 miles (805 km).  
Do not make full-throttle starts. Avoid  
downshifting to brake or slow the vehicle.  
.
Avoid making hard stops for the first  
200 miles (322 km) or so. During this time the  
new brake linings are not yet broken in. Hard  
stops with new linings can mean premature  
wear and earlier replacement. Follow this  
breaking-in guideline every time you get new  
brake linings.  
In order to shift out of P (Park), ignition must be in the  
ON/RUN or ACC/ACCESSORY and the brake pedal  
must be applied.  
Notice: Using a tool to force the key to turn in the  
ignition could cause damage to the switch or break  
the key. Use the correct key, make sure it is all the  
way in, and turn it only with your hand. If the key  
cannot be turned by hand, see your dealer.  
.
Do not tow a trailer during break-in. See  
Towing a Trailer on page 526 for the trailer  
towing capabilities of your vehicle and more  
information.  
Following breakin, engine speed and load can be  
gradually increased.  
3-22  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
A (STOPPING THE ENGINE/LOCK/OFF): When the  
vehicle is stopped, turn the ignition switch to LOCK/OFF  
to turn the engine off. Retained Accessory Power (RAP)  
will remain active. See Retained Accessory Power  
(RAP) on page 324.  
The steering can bind with the wheels turned off center.  
If this happens, move the steering wheel from right to  
left while turning the key to ACC/ACCESSORY. If this  
doesn't work, the vehicle needs service.  
B (ACC/ACCESSORY): This position lets the radio  
and windshield wipers operate while the engine is off.  
To use ACC/ACCESSORY, turn the key clockwise.  
This is the only position in which the ignition key can be  
inserted or removed. This position locks the ignition and  
transmission and steering column.  
C (ON/RUN): This position is where the key returns to  
after the vehicle is started. This position displays some  
of the warning and indicator lights.  
Do not turn the engine off when the vehicle is moving.  
This will cause a loss of power assist in the brake and  
steering systems and disable the airbags.  
The battery could be drained if you leave the key in  
the ACC/ACCESSORY or ON/RUN position with the  
engine off. You may not be able to start the vehicle if  
the battery is allowed to drain for an extended period  
of time.  
In an emergency:  
1. Brake using a firm and steady pressure. Do not  
pump the brakes repeatedly. This may deplete  
power assist, requiring increased brake pedal  
force.  
D (START): This position starts the engine.  
2. Shift the vehicle to neutral. This can be done while  
the vehicle is moving. After shifting to neutral,  
firmly apply the brakes and steer the vehicle to a  
safe location.  
A warning chime will sound and the Driver Information  
Center (DIC) will display DRIVER DOOR OPEN when  
the driver door is opened if the ignition is in LOCK/OFF,  
ACC/ACCESSORY and the key is in the ignition. See  
DIC Warnings and Messages on page 465 for more  
information.  
3. Come to a complete stop, shift to P (Park), and  
turn the ignition to LOCK/OFF. On vehicles with  
an automatic transmission, the shift lever must  
be in P (Park) to turn the ignition switch to the  
LOCK/OFF position.  
4. Set the parking brake. See Parking Brake on  
page 329  
.
3-23  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Starting Procedure  
Retained Accessory Power (RAP)  
1. With your foot off the accelerator pedal, turn the  
ignition to START. When the engine starts, let  
go of the key. The idle speed will slow down  
as the engine warms. Do not race the engine  
immediately after starting it. Operate the engine  
and transmission gently to allow the oil to warm up  
and lubricate all moving parts.  
These vehicle accessories can be used for up to  
10 minutes after the ignition key is turned off:  
.
Audio System  
.
Audio Steering Wheel Controls  
.
Power Windows  
.
Sunroof (if equipped)  
The vehicle has a Computer-Controlled Cranking  
System. This feature assists in starting the engine  
and protects components. If the ignition key is  
turned to the START position, and then released  
when the engine begins cranking, the engine will  
continue cranking for a few seconds or until the  
vehicle starts. If the engine does not start and the  
key is held in START, cranking will be stopped  
after 15 seconds to prevent cranking motor  
damage. To prevent gear damage, this system also  
prevents cranking if the engine is already running.  
Engine cranking can be stopped by turning the  
ignition switch to the ACC/ACCESSORY or LOCK/  
OFF position.  
Power to these accessories will work up to 10 minutes  
or until the driver's door is opened. For an additional  
10 minutes of power, close all the doors and turn the  
key to ON/RUN and then back to LOCK/OFF.  
Starting the Engine  
Move the shift lever to P (Park) or N (Neutral). The  
engine will not start in any other position. To restart the  
engine when the vehicle is already moving, use  
N (Neutral) only.  
Notice: Do not try to shift to P (Park) if the vehicle  
is moving. If you do, you could damage the  
transmission. Shift to P (Park) only when the vehicle  
is stopped.  
3-24  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Notice: Cranking the engine for long periods of  
time, by returning the key to the START position  
immediately after cranking has ended, can overheat  
and damage the cranking motor, and drain the  
battery. Wait at least 15 seconds between each try,  
to let the cranking motor cool down.  
Notice: The engine is designed to work with the  
electronics in the vehicle. If you add electrical  
parts or accessories, you could change the way  
the engine operates. Before adding electrical  
equipment, check with your dealer. If you do not,  
the engine might not perform properly. Any  
resulting damage would not be covered by the  
vehicle warranty.  
2. If the engine does not start after 510 seconds,  
especially in very cold weather (below 0°F or  
18°C), it could be flooded with too much gasoline.  
Try pushing the accelerator pedal all the way to  
the floor and holding it there as you hold the key in  
START for up to a maximum of 15 seconds. Wait  
at least 15 seconds between each try, to allow the  
cranking motor to cool down. When the engine  
starts, let go of the key and accelerator. If the  
vehicle starts briefly but then stops again, repeat  
these steps. This clears the extra gasoline from the  
engine. Do not race the engine immediately after  
starting it. Operate the engine and transmission  
gently until the oil warms up and lubricates all  
moving parts.  
Engine Coolant Heater  
The engine coolant heater can provide easier starting  
and better fuel economy during engine warmup in cold  
weather conditions at or below 0°F (18°C). Vehicles  
with an engine coolant heater should be plugged in at  
least four hours before starting.  
3-25  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The length of time the heater should remain plugged in  
depends on several factors. Ask a dealer in the area  
where you will be parking the vehicle for the best advice  
on this.  
To Use the Engine Coolant Heater  
1. Turn off the engine.  
2. Open the hood and unwrap the electrical cord.  
The electrical cord is located on the driver side of  
the engine, behind the transmission dipstick/fluid  
fill location and next to the engine.  
Automatic Transmission Operation  
The automatic transmission may have a shift lever  
located either on the steering column or on the console  
between the seats.  
3. Plug it into a normal, grounded 110-volt AC outlet.  
WARNING:  
{
Plugging the cord into an ungrounded outlet could  
cause an electrical shock. Also, the wrong kind of  
extension cord could overheat and cause a fire.  
You could be seriously injured. Plug the cord into  
a properly grounded three-prong 110-volt AC  
outlet. If the cord will not reach, use a heavy-duty  
three-prong extension cord rated for at least  
15 amps.  
4. Before starting the engine, be sure to unplug and  
store the cord as it was before to keep it away from  
moving engine parts and prevent damage.  
There are several different positions for the shift lever.  
P (Park): This position locks the front wheels. It is the  
best position to use when you start the engine because  
the vehicle cannot move easily.  
3-26  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Make sure the shift lever is fully in P (Park) before  
starting the engine. The vehicle has an automatic  
transmission shift lock control system. You have to  
fully apply the regular brakes before you can shift from  
P (Park) while the ignition key is in ON/RUN. If you  
cannot shift out of P (Park), ease pressure on the shift  
lever. Push the shift lever all the way into P (Park) as  
you maintain brake application. Then move the shift  
lever into another gear. See Shifting Out of Park on  
WARNING:  
{
It is dangerous to get out of the vehicle if the shift  
lever is not fully in P (Park) with the parking brake  
firmly set. The vehicle can roll.  
Do not leave the vehicle when the engine is  
running unless you have to. If you have left the  
engine running, the vehicle can move suddenly.  
You or others could be injured. To be sure the  
vehicle will not move, even when you are on fairly  
level ground, always set the parking brake and  
move the shift lever to P (Park). See Shifting Into  
Park on page 330. If you are pulling a trailer,  
see Towing a Trailer on page 526.  
page 332  
.
R (Reverse): Use this gear to back up.  
Notice: Shifting to R (Reverse) while the vehicle is  
moving forward could damage the transmission.  
The repairs would not be covered by the vehicle  
warranty. Shift to R (Reverse) only after the vehicle  
is stopped.  
Also use this gear to rock the vehicle back and forth  
to get out of snow, ice or sand without damaging the  
transmission. See If Your Vehicle is Stuck in Sand,  
Mud, Ice, or Snow on page 517 for additional  
information.  
3-27  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
N (Neutral): In this position, the engine does not  
connect with the wheels. To restart when you are  
already moving, use N (Neutral) only. Also, use  
N (Neutral) when the vehicle is being towed.  
D (Drive): This position is for normal driving. It provides  
the best fuel economy for the vehicle. If you need more  
power for passing, and you are:  
.
Going less than 35 mph (55 km/h), push the  
accelerator pedal about halfway down.  
.
Going about 35 mph (55 km/h) or more, push the  
accelerator all the way down.  
WARNING:  
{
The transmission will shift down to the next gear  
and have more power.  
Shifting into a drive gear while the engine is  
running at high speed is dangerous. Unless your  
foot is firmly on the brake pedal, the vehicle could  
move very rapidly. You could lose control and hit  
people or objects. Do not shift into a drive gear  
while the engine is running at high speed.  
Downshifting the transmission in slippery road  
conditions could result in skidding, see Skidding under  
Loss of Control on page 510.  
Notice: Driving the vehicle if you notice that it is  
moving slowly or not shifting gears as you increase  
speed may damage the transmission. Have the  
vehicle serviced right away. You can drive in  
2 (Second) when you are driving less than 35 mph  
(55 km/h) and D (Drive) for higher speeds until then.  
Notice: Shifting out of P (Park) or N (Neutral) with  
the engine running at high speed may damage the  
transmission. The repairs would not be covered by  
the vehicle warranty. Be sure the engine is not  
running at high speed when shifting the vehicle.  
D (Drive) can be used for towing. You may want to shift  
the transmission to 3 (Third) or, if necessary, to a lower  
gear if the transmission shifts too often under heavy  
loads and/or hilly conditions.  
See Towing a Trailer on page 526 for more  
information.  
3-28  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3 (Third): This position is also used for normal driving.  
However, it reduces vehicle speed more than D (Drive)  
without using the brakes. You might choose 3 (Third)  
instead of D (Drive) when driving on hilly, winding roads,  
when towing a trailer, so there is less shifting between  
gears and when going down a steep hill.  
Performance Shifting  
If the vehicle has this feature, it can detect a change in  
driving patterns. If you make an aggressive driving  
maneuver, the vehicle's transmission automatically  
shifts to the lowest possible gear to maximize vehicle  
performance. The vehicle will automatically return to  
normal operation when you return to normal driving  
patterns.  
2 (Second): This position reduces vehicle speed more  
than 3 (Third) without using the brakes. You can use  
2 (Second) on hills. It can help control vehicle speed as  
you go down steep mountain roads, but then you would  
also want to use the brakes off and on.  
Parking Brake  
The parking brake pedal  
is located to the left of the  
regular brake pedal, near  
the driver door.  
Notice: Do not shift into 2 (Second) unless you are  
going slower than 65 mph (105 km/h), or you can  
damage the engine and/or transmission.  
1 (First): This position reduces vehicle speed even  
more than 2 (Second) without using the brakes. You can  
use it on very steep hills, or in deep snow or mud. If the  
shift lever is put in 1 (First) while the vehicle is moving  
forward, the transmission will not shift into first gear until  
the vehicle is going slowly enough.  
Notice: Spinning the tires or holding the vehicle in  
one place on a hill using only the accelerator pedal  
may damage the transmission. The repair will not be  
covered by the vehicle warranty. If you are stuck, do  
not spin the tires. When stopping on a hill, use the  
brakes to hold the vehicle in place.  
To set the parking brake, hold the regular brake pedal  
down, then push the parking brake pedal down.  
If the ignition is on, the brake system warning light on  
the instrument panel cluster should come on. If it does  
not, you need to have the vehicle serviced.  
3-29  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
A warning chime will sound if the parking brake is set,  
the ignition is on, and the vehicle speed is greater than  
5 mph (8 km/h). The brake light will come on and stay  
on until the parking brake is released. See Brake  
System Warning Light on page 450 for more  
information.  
Shifting Into Park  
WARNING:  
{
It can be dangerous to get out of the vehicle if the  
shift lever is not fully in P (Park) with the parking  
brake firmly set. The vehicle can roll. If you have  
left the engine running, the vehicle can move  
suddenly. You or others could be injured. To be  
sure the vehicle will not move, even when you are  
on fairly level ground, use the steps that follow.  
If you are pulling a trailer, see Towing a Trailer on  
To release the parking brake, hold the regular brake  
pedal down, then push the parking brake pedal down.  
When you lift your foot off the parking brake pedal, the  
pedal will follow your foot to the released position.  
Notice: Driving with the parking brake on can  
overheat the brake system and cause premature  
wear or damage to brake system parts. Make sure  
that the parking brake is fully released and the  
brake warning light is off before driving.  
page 526  
.
If you are towing a trailer and are parking on any hill,  
see Towing a Trailer on page 526.  
Steering Column Shift Lever  
If the vehicle has a steering column shift lever, use this  
procedure to shift the vehicle into P (Park):  
1. Hold the brake pedal down.  
2. Move the shift lever into P (Park) by pulling the  
shift lever toward you and moving it up as far as it  
will go.  
3. With your foot still holding the brake pedal down,  
set the parking brake. See Parking Brake on  
page 329 for more information.  
3-30  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4. Turn the ignition key to LOCK/OFF.  
Leaving the Vehicle With the Engine  
Running  
5. Remove the key and take it with you. If you can  
leave the vehicle with the ignition key in your hand,  
the vehicle is in P (Park).  
WARNING:  
{
Console Shift Lever  
If the vehicle is equipped with a console shift lever, use  
this procedure to shift the vehicle into P (Park):  
It can be dangerous to leave the vehicle with the  
engine running. The vehicle could move suddenly  
if the shift lever is not fully in P (Park) with the  
parking brake firmly set. And, if you leave the  
vehicle with the engine running, it could overheat  
and even catch fire. You or others could be  
injured. Do not leave the vehicle with the engine  
running.  
1. Hold the brake pedal down.  
2. Move the shift lever into P (Park) by pushing the  
lever all the way toward the front of the vehicle and  
then to the left.  
3. While keeping the brake pedal applied, set the  
parking brake. See Parking Brake on page 329  
for more information.  
If you have to leave the vehicle with the engine running,  
be sure your vehicle is in P (Park) and the parking  
brake is firmly set before you leave it. See Parking  
Brake on page 329 for more information.  
4. Turn the ignition key to LOCK/OFF.  
5. Remove the key and take it with you. If you can  
leave the vehicle with the ignition key in your hand,  
the vehicle is in P (Park).  
3-31  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
If the vehicle has an uncharged battery or a battery with  
low voltage, try charging or jump starting the battery.  
See Jump Starting on page 638.  
Torque Lock  
Torque lock is when the weight of the vehicle puts too  
much force on the parking pawl in the transmission.  
This happens when parking on a hill and shifting the  
transmission into P (Park) is not done properly and then  
it is difficult to shift out of P (Park). To prevent torque  
lock, set the parking brake and then shift into P (Park).  
To find out how, see Shifting Into Parkin this section.  
Console Shift  
If the console shift cannot be moved out of P (Park)  
1. Apply the regular brakes.  
2. Turn the ignition to ON/RUN or ACC/ACCESSORY  
position. See Ignition Positions on page 322 for  
more information.  
If torque lock does occur, your vehicle may need to be  
pushed uphill by another vehicle to relieve the parking  
pawl pressure, so you can shift out of P (Park).  
3. Push the shift lever all the way into P (Park).  
4. Then, shift into the desired gear.  
Shifting Out of Park  
If you still cannot move the shift lever from P (Park),  
consult your dealer or a professional towing service.  
Automatic Transmission Shift Lock  
This vehicle has an electronic shift lock release system.  
The shift lock release is designed to:  
Column Shift  
If the column shift cannot be moved out of P (Park)  
1. Apply the regular brakes.  
.
Prevent ignition key removal unless the shift lever  
is in P (Park)  
2. Turn the ignition key to the ON/RUN or  
ACC/ACCESSORY position. See Ignition  
Positions on page 322 for more information.  
.
Prevent movement of the shift lever out of P (Park),  
unless the ignition is in ON/RUN or ACC/  
ACCESSORY and the regular brake pedal is  
applied.  
3. Shift out of the P (Park) position to the N (Neutral)  
position.  
The shift lock is always functional except in the case of  
a an uncharged or low voltage (less than 9 volt) battery.  
4. Move the column shift to the desired gear.  
If you still cannot move the shift lever from P (Park),  
consult your dealer or a professional towing service.  
3-32  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Parking Over Things That Burn  
WARNING:  
WARNING: (Continued)  
{
.
The exhaust system leaks due to corrosion or  
damage.  
Things that can burn could touch hot exhaust  
parts under the vehicle and ignite. Do not park  
over papers, leaves, dry grass, or other things that  
can burn.  
.
The vehicles exhaust system has been  
modified, damaged or improperly repaired.  
.
There are holes or openings in the vehicle  
body from damage or after-market  
modifications that are not completely sealed.  
Engine Exhaust  
If unusual fumes are detected or if it is suspected  
that exhaust is coming into the vehicle:  
WARNING:  
.
{
Drive it only with the windows  
completely down.  
.
Engine exhaust contains Carbon Monoxide (CO)  
which cannot be seen or smelled. Exposure to CO  
can cause unconsciousness and even death.  
Have the vehicle repaired immediately.  
Never park the vehicle with the engine running in  
an enclosed area such as a garage or a building  
that has no fresh air ventilation.  
Exhaust may enter the vehicle if:  
.
The vehicle idles in areas with poor ventilation  
(parking garages, tunnels, deep snow that  
may block underbody airflow or tail pipes).  
.
The exhaust smells or sounds strange or  
different.  
(Continued)  
3-33  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Running the Vehicle While Parked  
It is better not to park with the engine running. But if you  
ever have to, here are some things to know.  
WARNING:  
{
It can be dangerous to get out of the vehicle if the  
automatic transmission shift lever is not fully in  
P (Park) with the parking brake firmly set. The  
vehicle can roll. Do not leave the vehicle when the  
engine is running unless you have to. If you have  
left the engine running, the vehicle can move  
suddenly. You or others could be injured. To be  
sure the vehicle will not move, even when you are  
on fairly level ground, always set the parking  
brake after you move the shift lever to P (Park).  
WARNING:  
{
Idling a vehicle in an enclosed area with poor  
ventilation is dangerous. Engine exhaust may  
enter the vehicle. Engine exhaust contains  
Carbon Monoxide (CO) which cannot be seen or  
smelled. It can cause unconsciousness and even  
death. Never run the engine in an enclosed area  
that has no fresh air ventilation. For more  
information, see Engine Exhaust on page 333.  
Follow the proper steps to be sure the vehicle will not  
move. See Shifting Into Park on page 330.  
If parking on a hill and pulling a trailer, see Towing a  
Trailer on page 526.  
3-34  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Compass  
Mirrors  
Compass Operation  
Automatic Dimming Rearview Mirror  
Press O or AUTO 3, depending on the vehicle, to  
The vehicle has an automatic dimming inside rearview  
mirror with a compass display. Automatic dimming  
reduces the glare of lights from behind the vehicle.  
The dimming feature comes on and the indicator light  
illuminates each time the vehicle is started.  
turn the compass on or off.  
When the ignition and the compass feature are on, after  
a few seconds, the mirror will display the compass  
heading. The compass automatically calibrates as the  
vehicle is driven.  
O (On/Off): Press and hold O for about three seconds  
to turn the dimming feature and compass display on  
or off.  
Compass Calibration  
If after a few seconds, the display does not show the  
correct direction, (for example, N for North), there may  
be a strong magnetic field interfering with the compass.  
Interference can be caused by a magnetic antenna  
mount, magnetic note pad holder or a similar  
magnetic item.  
AUTO 3 (Vehicles with Intellibeam®): Press  
and hold for approximately three seconds to turn the  
compass display on or off. See Exterior Lamps on  
page 425 for more information.  
Cleaning the Mirror  
Do not spray glass cleaner directly on the mirror. Use a  
soft towel dampened with water.  
The compass can be placed in calibration mode  
manually by pressing and holding O or AUTO 3,  
depending on the vehicle, until a C is shown in the  
compass display.  
The compass can be calibrated by driving the vehicle in  
circles at 5 mph (8 km/h) or less until the display reads a  
direction.  
3-35  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Compass Variance  
The compass is set to zone eight. If you do not live  
in zone eight or drive out of the area, the compass  
variance needs to be changed to the appropriate zone.  
3. Once the zone number displays, press O or  
AUTO 3 repeatedly until the correct zone  
number displays. Stop pressing the button and the  
mirror will return to normal operation. If C appears  
in the compass window, the compass may need  
calibration. See Compass Calibrationlisted  
previously.  
To adjust for compass variance:  
1. Find the current location and variance zone  
number on the following zone map.  
Outside Power Foldaway Mirrors  
Controls for the outside  
power mirrors are located  
on the driver door  
armrest.  
Press the selector switch (A) or (B) to choose either the  
left or right outside mirror. Then press the control pad to  
move the mirror to the desired direction.  
2. Press and hold O or AUTO 3 until a zone  
number displays.  
3-36  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Mirror Adjustment  
Outside Automatic Dimming Mirror  
1. Press (C) to unfold the mirrors out to the driving  
position.  
If the vehicle has this feature, the driver side mirror  
adjusts for the glare of headlamps behind you. This  
feature is controlled by the on and off settings on the  
automatic dimming rearview mirror.  
2. Press (D) to fold the mirrors toward the vehicle.  
Resetting the Power Foldaway Mirrors  
Reset the power foldaway mirrors if:  
Side Blind Zone Alert (SBZA)  
If the vehicle has the Side Blind Zone Alert (SBZA)  
system, see Side Blind Zone Alert (SBZA) on  
page 342 for more information.  
.
The mirrors are accidentally obstructed while  
folding.  
.
They are accidentally manually folded/unfolded.  
.
Park Tilt Mirrors  
The mirrors do not stay in the unfolded position.  
.
The mirrors vibrate at normal driving speeds.  
If your vehicle is equipped with memory mirrors, it is  
capable of performing the park tilt mirror feature. This  
feature allows the driver and passenger side mirror to  
tilt to a factory programmed position when the vehicle is  
in R (Reverse). This feature may be useful in allowing  
you to view the curb when you are parallel parking.  
Fold and unfold the mirrors one time using the mirror  
controls to reset them to their normal position. A noise  
may be heard during the resetting of the power  
foldaway mirrors. This sound is normal after a manual  
folding operation.  
When the vehicle is shifted out of R (Reverse) and  
either a five-second delay has occurred, or the ignition  
is turned to LOCK/OFF, the driver and passenger side  
mirror will return to its original position.  
Turn Signal Indicator (If Equipped)  
The vehicle may have a turn signal indicator lamp that  
is built into the mirror. The turn signal lamp flashes with  
the use of the vehicle's turn signal and hazard flashers.  
This feature can be enabled/disabled through the  
Driver Information Center (DIC). See DIC Vehicle  
Customization on page 477 for more information.  
3-37  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Outside Convex Mirror  
WARNING:  
Object Detection Systems  
Ultrasonic Front and Rear Parking  
Assist (UFRPA)  
{
For vehicles with the Ultrasonic Front and Rear Parking  
Assist (UFRPA) system, it operates at speeds less than  
8 km/h (5mph), and assists the driver with parking and  
avoiding objects. It can determine how close objects are  
to the front bumper, up to 1.2 m (4 ft.) in front of the  
vehicle and the rear bumper, up to 2.5 m (8 ft.) behind  
the vehicle. The distance sensors are located on the  
front and rear bumper.  
A convex mirror can make things, like other  
vehicles, look farther away than they really are.  
If you cut too sharply into the right lane, you could  
hit a vehicle on the right. Check the inside mirror  
or glance over your shoulder before changing  
lanes.  
The passenger side mirror is convex shaped. A convex  
mirror's surface is curved so more can be seen from the  
driver seat.  
Outside Heated Mirrors  
= (Rear Window Defogger): Press to heat the  
mirrors. See Rear Window Defoggerunder Dual  
Climate Control System on page 434 for more  
information.  
3-38  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
WARNING:  
{
The Ultrasonic Front and Rear Park Assist  
(UFRPA) system does not replace driver vision.  
It cannot detect:  
.
objects that are below the bumper, underneath  
the vehicle, or if they are too close or far from  
the vehicle  
.
children, pedestrians, bicyclists, or pets.  
Rear Parking Assist  
Display  
If you do not use proper care before moving  
forward and while backing; vehicle damage, injury,  
or death could occur. Even with UFRPA, always  
check in front of the vehicle before moving  
Front Parking Assist  
Display  
forward and behind the vehicle before backing up.  
While moving forward and backing, be sure to  
look for objects and check the vehicle's mirrors.  
The front display is located on top of the instrument  
panel to the right of the driver. The front display will  
have either three or six lights to provide distance and  
system information. With Adaptive Cruise control (ACC),  
it will have three lights along with the ACC lights.  
Without ACC, it will have six lights. High-toned beeps  
from the front speakers are for objects detected near  
the front bumper.  
The rear display is located near the rear window and  
can be seen by looking over your right shoulder. The  
rear display uses three color-coded lights to provide  
distance and system information. Low-toned beeps from  
the rear speakers are for the rear bumper.  
3-39  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Moving Forward  
How the System Works  
When the vehicle is started, the front display will briefly  
illuminate to let you know the system is working.  
UFRPA comes on automatically when the shift lever is  
moved out of P (Park). The system does not work at a  
forward or reverse speed greater than 5 mph (8 km/h).  
The following describes what will occur with the front  
display as you get closer to a object detected in the  
front of the vehicle:  
To be detected, objects must be at least 25.4 cm (10 in.)  
off the ground and below hood or trunk level. Objects  
must also be within 1.2 m (4 ft.) in front of the vehicle  
and 2.5 m (8 ft.) from the rear bumper. This distance  
may be less during warmer or humid weather.  
Description  
Metric  
English  
amber/amber lights  
ACC one amber light  
1.2 m  
4 ft  
When backing up, if objects are detected at the same  
time near both the front and rear bumpers, both  
color-coded light displays will notify you of objects close  
to each bumper. If there are objects detected near both  
bumpers, the beeps will only be sounded to notify that  
objects are close to the rear bumper. However, if while  
the vehicle is backing up and an object comes within  
0.3 m (1 ft.) of the front bumper, and at the same time  
there is another object further than 0.3 m (1 ft.) from the  
rear bumper, then the beeps will only be sounded to  
notify you of the closer object that is near the front  
bumper.  
four amber lights  
ACC two amber lights  
1.0 m  
0.6 m  
40 in  
23 in  
four amber/ two red lights  
ACC two amber lights/  
one red light  
four amber/ two red lights  
flashing and beep for  
five seconds  
ACC two amber lights/  
one red light flashing and  
beep for five seconds  
0.3 m  
1 ft  
The system can be disabled using the Driver  
Information Center (DIC). See Parking Assistunder  
DIC Operation and Displays on page 460 for more  
information.  
3-40  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Backing  
When the System Does Not Seem to  
Work Properly  
If the URPA system will not activate due to a temporary  
condition, the message PARK ASSIST OFF will be  
displayed on the DIC and a red light will be shown on  
the rear URPA display when the shift lever is moved  
into R (Reverse). This occurs under the following  
conditions:  
Ultrasonic Rear Parking Assist (URPA) comes on  
automatically when the shift lever is moved into  
R (Reverse). The rear display will then briefly illuminate  
to let you know the system is working.  
The following describes what will occur with the rear  
display as you get closer to an object detected in the  
rear of your vehicle:  
.
The driver disables the system.  
Description  
amber light  
Metric  
2.5 m  
1.0 m  
English  
8 ft.  
.
The ultrasonic sensors are not clean. Keep the  
vehicle's rear bumper free of mud, dirt, snow, ice  
and slush. For cleaning instructions, see Washing  
Your Vehicle on page 698.  
amber/amber lights  
40 in.  
amber/amber/red lights and  
continuous beeping for  
five seconds  
0.6 m  
0.3 m  
23 in.  
1 ft.  
.
A trailer was attached to the vehicle, or a bicycle or  
an object was hanging out of the trunk during the  
last drive cycle, the red light may illuminate in the  
rear display. Once the attached object is removed,  
URPA will return to normal operation.  
amber/amber/red lights  
flashing and continuous  
beeping for five seconds  
.
A tow bar is attached to the vehicle.  
The system can be disabled through the Driver  
Information Center (DIC). See Parking Assistunder  
DIC Operation and Displays on page 460 for more  
information.  
.
The vehicle's bumper is damaged. Take the vehicle  
to your dealer to repair the system.  
.
Other conditions may affect system performance,  
such as vibrations from a jackhammer or the  
compression of air brakes on a very large truck.  
If the system is still disabled after driving forward at  
least 25 km/h (15 mph), take the vehicle to your dealer.  
3-41  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
SBZA display, check the outside and rearview mirrors,  
look over your shoulder for vehicles and hazards, and  
use the turn signal.  
Side Blind Zone Alert (SBZA)  
The vehicle may have a Side Blind Zone Alert (SBZA)  
system. Read this entire section before using the  
system.  
WARNING:  
{
SBZA is only a lane changing aid and does not  
replace driver vision. SBZA does not detect:  
.
Vehicles outside the side blind zones which  
may be rapidly approaching.  
.
Pedestrians, bicyclists, or animals.  
Failure to use proper care when changing lanes  
may result in damage to the vehicle, injury,  
or death. Always check the outside and rearview  
mirrors, glance over your shoulder, and use the  
turn signal before changing lanes.  
SBZA Detection Zones  
The SBZA sensor covers a zone of approximately  
one lane over from both sides of the vehicle, 3.5 m  
(11 ft). This zone starts at each side mirror and goes  
back approximately 5 m (16 ft). The height of the zone is  
approximately between 0.5 m (1.5 ft) and 2.0 m (6 ft) off  
the ground.  
When the system detects a vehicle in the side blind  
zone, amber SBZA displays will light up in the side  
mirrors. This indicates that it may be unsafe to change  
lanes. Before making a lane change, always check the  
3-42  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The SBZA detection zones do not change if the vehicle  
is towing a trailer. So be extra careful when changing  
lanes while towing a trailer.  
SBZA can be disabled through the Driver Information  
Center (DIC). See Driver Information Center (DIC) on  
page 459 for more information. If the SBZA is disabled  
by the driver, the SBZA mirror displays will not light up  
during normal driving.  
How the System Works  
When the System Does Not Seem To Work  
Properly  
Occasional missed alerts can occur under normal  
circumstances and will increase in wet conditions.  
The system does not need to be serviced due to an  
occasional missed alert. The number of missed alerts  
will increase with increased rainfall or road spray.  
Left Side Mirror Display Right Side Mirror Display  
If the SBZA displays do not light up when the system is  
on and vehicles are in the blind zone, the system may  
need service. Take the vehicle to your dealer.  
When the vehicle is started, both outside mirror displays  
will briefly come on to indicate that the system is  
operating. While driving forward, the left or right side  
mirror SBZA display will light up if a vehicle is detected  
in that blind zone. If you activate a turn signal and a  
vehicle has been detected on the same side, the SBZA  
display will flash to give you extra warning not to  
change lanes.  
SBZA is designed to ignore stationary objects; however,  
the system may occasionally light up due to guard rails,  
signs, trees, shrubs, and other stationary objects. This  
is normal system operation, the vehicle does not need  
service.  
SBZA does not operate when the left or right corners of  
the rear bumper are covered with mud, dirt, snow, ice,  
slush, or in heavy rainstorms. For cleaning instructions,  
see Washing Your Vehicle on page 698. If the DIC  
still displays the SIDE BLIND ZONE SYSTEM  
UNAVAILABLE message after cleaning the bumper,  
see your dealer.  
SBZA displays do not come on while the vehicle is  
approaching or passing other vehicles. At speeds  
greater then 20 mph (32 km/h), SBZA displays may  
come on when a vehicle you have passed remains in or  
drops back into the detection zone.  
3-43  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The SBZA displays may remain on if a trailer is  
attached to the vehicle, or a bicycle or object is  
extending out to either side of the vehicle.  
SERVICE SIDE BLIND ZONE ALERT SYSTEM: If this  
message appears, both SBZA displays will remain on  
indicating there is a problem with the SBZA system.  
If these displays remain on after continued driving, the  
system needs service. Take the vehicle to your dealer.  
When SBZA is disabled for any reason other than the  
driver turning it off, the driver will not be able to turn  
SBZA back on using the DIC. The SIDE BLIND ZONE  
ALERT ON option will not be selectable if the conditions  
for normal system operation are not met. Until normal  
operating conditions for SBZA are met, you should not  
rely upon SBZA while driving.  
FCC Information  
See Radio Frequency Statement on page 818  
for information regarding Part 15 of the Federal  
Communications Commission (FCC) rules and Industry  
Canada Standards RSS-210/220/310.  
SBZA Error Messages  
Frequency of operation: 24.05GHz 24.25GHz  
The following messages may appear in the DIC:  
Field Strength: Not greater than 2.5V/m peak  
(0.25V/m average) at a distance of 3 m.  
SIDE BLIND ZONE ALERT SYSTEM OFF: This  
message indicates that the driver has turned the  
system off.  
The manufacturer is not responsible for any radio or TV  
interference caused by unauthorized modifications to  
this equipment. Such modifications could void the user's  
authority to operate the equipment.  
SIDE BLIND ZONE SYSTEM UNAVAILABLE: This  
message indicates that the SBZA system is disabled  
because the sensor is blocked and cannot detect  
vehicles in the blind zone. The sensor may be  
blocked by mud, dirt, snow, ice, slush, or even heavy  
rainstorms. This message may also activate during  
heavy rain or due to road spray. The vehicle does not  
need service. For cleaning, see Washing Your Vehicle  
on page 698  
.
3-44  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Lane Departure Warning (LDW)  
The vehicle may have a Lane Departure Warning  
(LDW) system. Read this entire section before using the  
system.  
WARNING: (Continued)  
LDW will indicate the system is working whenever  
it detects either the left or right lane marking. So if  
you depart on the side of the lane that LDW is not  
detecting, LDW will not warn you.  
WARNING:  
{
If you do not carefully maintain your vehicle  
position within the lane, vehicle damage, injury,  
or death could occur. Even with LDW, always  
keep your attention on the road and maintain  
proper vehicle position within the lane. Always  
keep the windshield clean and do not use LDW in  
bad weather conditions.  
The Lane Departure Warning (LDW) system does  
not steer the vehicle and is only an aid to help you  
stay in your driving lane. The LDW system  
may not:  
.
Provide you with enough time to avoid a lane  
change collision.  
.
Be loud enough for you to hear the warning  
When the vehicle crosses a detected lane marking, the  
LDW symbol will flash and you will hear three beeps.  
LDW will not warn you if the turn signal is on or if you  
make a sharp maneuver. Before making a lane change,  
check the vehicle's mirrors, glance over your shoulder  
for vehicles and hazards, and start the turn signal  
before changing lanes.  
beeps.  
.
Work properly under bad weather conditions  
or if the windshield is not kept clean.  
.
Detect lane markings and will not detect road  
edges.  
.
Warn you that your vehicle is crossing a lane  
marking if the system does not detect the lane  
marking.  
(Continued)  
3-45  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
LDW only operates at speeds of 35 mph (56 km)  
or greater. If LDW is turned on when traveling at  
these speeds, the LDW symbol will appear green  
if the system detects a left or right lane marking.  
This symbol will change to amber and flash and  
three beeps will sound if you cross a detected lane  
marking without using the turn signal.  
How the System Works  
LDW uses a camera located between the inside  
rearview mirror and the windshield to detect the lane  
markings.  
@ (Lane Departure Warning): To turn LDW on and  
off, press the LDW control, located by the exterior  
headlamp control. An indicator on the control will light to  
indicate that LDW is on.  
If the LDW symbol does not appear, LDW is not  
currently operating and will not warn you.  
To change the volume of the warning chime, see Chime  
Volume under DIC Vehicle Customization on page 477  
for more information.  
When the System Does Not Seem To Work  
Properly  
The LDW symbol will not appear when the system is  
having difficulty seeing the lines on the road or if the  
view of the camera on the windshield is blocked with  
mud, dirt, snow, ice, or slush, if the windshield is  
damaged, or when weather limits visibility, such as  
while driving in fog, rain, or snow conditions. This is  
normal operation, the vehicle does not need service.  
For cleaning instructions, see Washing Your Vehicle on  
When the vehicle is started, the LDW symbol, located  
in the instrument panel cluster, will briefly come on to  
indicate that the light is operational.  
page 698  
.
3-46  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
LDW warnings may occasionally occur due to tar  
marks, shadows, cracks in the road, or other road  
imperfections. This is normal system operation, the  
vehicle does not need service.  
Universal Home Remote System  
Operation (With Three Round LED)  
LDW Error Message  
SERVICE LANE DEPARTURE SYSTEM: This  
message may appear in the DIC to indicate that LDW is  
not working properly. If this message remains on after  
continued driving, the system needs service. Take your  
vehicle to your dealer.  
LANE DEPARTURE SYSTEM UNAVAILABLE: This  
message may appear in the DIC if LDW does not  
activate due to a temporary condition.  
This vehicle may have the Universal Home Remote  
System. If there are three round Light Emitting Diode  
(LED) indicator lights above the Universal Home  
Remote buttons, follow the instructions below.  
Universal Home Remote  
System  
See Radio Frequency Statement on page 818  
for information regarding Part 15 of the Federal  
Communications Commission (FCC) rules and Industry  
Canada Standards RSS-210/220/310.  
This system provides a way to replace up to three  
remote control transmitters used to activate devices  
such as garage door openers, security systems, and  
home automation devices.  
3-47  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Do not use this system with any garage door opener  
that does not have the stop and reverse feature. This  
includes any garage door opener model manufactured  
before April 1, 1982.  
Programming Universal Home  
Remote Rolling Code  
For questions or help programming the Universal  
Home Remote System, call 1-866-572-2728 or go to  
learcar2u.com.  
Read the instructions completely before attempting to  
program the transmitter. Because of the steps involved,  
it may be helpful to have another person assist with  
programming the transmitter.  
Most garage door openers sold after 1996 are Rolling  
Code units.  
Be sure to keep the original remote control transmitter  
for use in other vehicles, as well as, for future  
programming. Only the original remote control  
transmitter is needed for Fixed Code programming.  
The programmed buttons should be erased when the  
vehicle is sold or the lease ends. See Erasing  
Universal Home Remote Buttonslater in this section.  
Programming a garage door opener involves  
time-sensitive actions, so read the entire procedure  
before starting. Otherwise, the device will time out and  
the procedure will have to be repeated.  
To program up to three devices:  
Park the vehicle outside of the garage when  
programming a garage door. Be sure that people  
and objects are clear of the garage door or gate  
that is being programmed.  
1. From inside the vehicle, press the two outside  
buttons at the same time for one to two seconds,  
and immediately release them.  
3-48  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
door moves. The indicator light, above the selected  
button, should slowly blink. This button may need  
to be held for up to 20 seconds.  
4. Immediately, within one second, release the button  
when the garage door moves. The indicator light  
will blink rapidly until programming is complete.  
5. Press and release the same button again. The  
garage door should move, confirming that  
programming is successful and complete.  
To program another Rolling Code device such as an  
additional garage door opener, a security device,  
or home automation device, repeat Steps 1 through 5,  
choosing a different function button in Step 3 than what  
was used for the garage door opener.  
If these instructions do not work, the garage door  
opener is probably a Fixed Code unit. Follow the  
Programming instructions that follow for a Fixed Code  
garage door opener.  
2. Locate in the garage, the garage door opener  
receiver (motor-head unit). Locate the Learn”  
or Smartbutton. It can usually be found where  
the hanging antenna wire is attached to the  
motor-head unit and may be a colored button.  
Press this button. After pressing this button,  
complete the following steps in less than  
30 seconds.  
Programming Universal Home  
Remote Fixed Code  
For questions or help programming the Universal  
Home Remote System, call 1-866-572-2728 or go to  
learcar2u.com.  
3. Immediately return to the vehicle. Press and hold  
the Universal Home Remote button that will be  
used to control the garage door until the garage  
Most garage door openers sold before 1996 are Fixed  
Code units.  
3-49  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Programming a garage door opener involves  
time-sensitive actions, so read the entire procedure  
before starting. Otherwise, the device will time out and  
the procedure will have to be repeated.  
do not see a row of dip switches, return to the  
previous section for Programming Universal Home  
Remote Rolling Code.  
Your hand held transmitter can have between  
eight to 12 dip switches depending on the brand  
of transmitter.  
To program up to three devices:  
The garage door opener receiver (motor head unit)  
could also have a row of dip switches that can be  
used when programming the Universal Home  
Remote. If the total number of switches on the  
motor head and hand held transmitter are different,  
or if the dip switch settings are different, use the  
dip switch settings on the motor head unit to  
program the Universal Home Remote. The motor  
head dip switch settings can also be used when  
the original hand held transmitter is not available.  
1. To verify that the garage door opener is a Fixed  
Code unit, remove the battery cover on the hand  
held transmitter supplied by the manufacturer of  
the garage door opener motor. If there are a row  
of dip switches similar to the graphic above, the  
garage door opener is a Fixed Code unit. If you  
3-50  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Example of Eight Dip Switches with Two Positions  
Example of Eight Dip Switches with Three Positions  
The panel of switches might not appear exactly as  
they do in the examples above, but they should be  
similar.  
The switch positions on the hand-held transmitter  
could be labeled, as follows:  
.
A switch in the up position could be labeled as  
Up,” “+,or On.”  
.
A switch in the down position could be labeled  
as Down,” “,or Off.”  
.
A switch in the middle position could be labeled  
as Middle,” “0,or Neutral.”  
3-51  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2. Write down the eight to 12 switch settings from left  
to right as follows:  
.
When a switch is in the up position, write Left.”  
.
When a switch is in the down position, write  
Right.”  
.
If a switch is set between the up and down  
position, write Middle.”  
The switch settings written down in Step 2 now  
become the button strokes to be entered into  
the Universal Home Remote in Step 4. Be sure  
to enter the switch settings written down in  
Step 2, in order from left to right, into the  
Universal Home Remote, when completing  
Step 4.  
3. From inside your vehicle, first firmly press all  
three buttons at the same time for about  
4. The indicator lights will blink slowly. Enter each  
switch setting from Step 2 into your vehicle's  
Universal Home Remote. You will have two and  
one-half minutes to complete Step 4. Now press  
one button on the Universal Home Remote for  
each switch setting as follows:  
three seconds. Release the buttons to put the  
Universal Home Remote into programming mode.  
.
If you wrote Left,press the left button in the  
vehicle.  
.
If you wrote Right,press the right button in  
the vehicle.  
.
If you wrote Middle,press the middle button in  
the vehicle.  
3-52  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
5. After entering all of the switch positions, again,  
firmly press and release all three buttons at the  
same time. The indicator lights will turn on.  
Reprogramming Universal Home  
Remote Buttons  
Any of the three buttons can be reprogrammed by  
repeating the instructions.  
6. Press and hold the button that will be used to  
control the garage door until the garage door  
moves. The indicator light above the selected  
button should slowly blink. This button may need to  
be held for up to 55 seconds.  
Erasing Universal Home Remote  
Buttons  
The programmed buttons should be erased when the  
vehicle is sold or the lease ends.  
7. Immediately release the button when the garage  
door moves. The indicator light will blink rapidly  
until programming is complete.  
To erase either Rolling Code or Fixed Code on the  
Universal Home Remote device:  
8. Press and release the same button again. The  
garage door should move, confirming that  
programming is successful and complete.  
1. Press and hold the two outside buttons at the  
same time for approximately 20 seconds, until the  
indicator lights, located directly above the buttons,  
begin to blink rapidly.  
To program another Fixed Code device such as an  
additional garage door opener, a security device,  
or home automation device, repeat Steps 1-8, choosing  
a different button in Step 6 than what was used for the  
garage door opener.  
2. Once the indicator lights begin to blink, release  
both buttons. The codes from all buttons will be  
erased.  
For help or information on the Universal Home Remote  
System, call the customer assistance phone number  
under Customer Assistance Offices on page 86.  
Using Universal Home Remote  
Press and hold the appropriate button for at least half  
of a second. The indicator light will come on while the  
signal is being transmitted.  
3-53  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
front of the armrest and lift the armrest cover to access  
the upper storage area. Pull the strap located behind  
the cup holder to access the lower storage area.  
Storage Areas  
Glove Box  
Center Flex Storage Unit  
Lift up the glove box handle to open it. Use the key to  
lock and unlock the glove box.  
This vehicle may have a center flex storage unit that  
includes a front center seat with a lap belt and an  
underseat storage compartment. The center seatback  
can also be used as an armrest. Cupholders are also  
located at the front edge of the storage unit and can be  
accessed by folding the compartment forward.  
Cupholders  
There are cupholders located in the full floor console,  
or in the front of the center seat console. Cupholders  
are also located in the rear armrest. Slide the cover  
back to access the full floor console cupholder. Fold  
open the front of the console to access the center seat  
console cupholder.  
Pull the handle rearward to open a storage  
compartment and access the accessory power outlet.  
Pull out to remove.  
When not being used, the center seat lap belt can be  
stored in the underseat storage compartment.  
Front Storage Area  
To access the front storage area, push down and then  
release. Push up and forward to remove.  
Floor Mats  
Center Console Storage  
WARNING:  
{
If the vehicle has a full floor console it has two storage  
areas. Lift the left lever located in the front of the  
armrest lid to access the upper storage tray . Lift  
the right lever to access the lower storage area.  
If the vehicle has a center seat console it will have  
two storage areas. Press the button located on the  
If a floor mat is the wrong size or is not properly  
installed, it can interfere with the accelerator pedal  
and/or brake pedal. Interference with the pedals  
can cause unintended acceleration and/or  
(Continued)  
3-54  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
WARNING: (Continued)  
increased stopping distance which can cause a  
crash and injury. Make sure the floor mat does not  
interfere with the accelerator or brake pedal.  
Use the following guidelines for proper floor mat usage.  
.
The original equipment floor mats were designed  
for your vehicle. If the floor mats need replacing, it  
is recommended that GM certified floor mats be  
purchased. Non-GM floor mats may not fit properly  
and may interfere with the accelerator or brake  
pedal. Always check that the floor mats do not  
interfere with the pedals.  
.
Use the floor mat with the correct side up. Do not  
turn it over.  
Removing and Replacing the Floor Mats  
.
Do not place anything on top of the driver side  
1. Pull up on the rear of the mat to remove it from the  
hooks.  
floor mat.  
.
Use only a single floor mat on the driver side.  
2. Reinstall the floor mat by lining up the openings in  
the floor mat over the hooks and push it down into  
position.  
.
Do not place one floor mat on top of another.  
The driver side floor mat is held in place by two hooks.  
3. Make sure the floor mat is properly secured and  
verify that it does not interfere with the accelerator  
or brake pedals.  
3-55  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Rear Seat Armrest  
This vehicle has a rear seat armrest with cupholders.  
Pull the tab on the armrest forward, to access it.  
To open or close the sunroof, the ignition must be  
turned to ON/RUN or Retained Accessory Power (RAP)  
must be active. See Retained Accessory Power (RAP)  
on page 324  
.
Express Open: The express open feature will operate  
from the closed or partially open position. To express  
open the power sunroof, fully press the driver side  
switch rearward once. To stop the sunroof glass in  
a desired position other than to the express-open  
position, press the switch again, in either direction, to  
stop the movement. If the sunshade is in the closed  
position, it will open with the sunroof, or it can be  
opened manually.  
Convenience Net  
Use the convenience net, located in the rear, to store  
small loads as far forward as possible. The net should  
not be used to store heavy loads.  
Sunroof  
The vehicle may have a power sunroof.  
The switches that operate  
the sunroof are located on  
the overhead console.  
Vent Open: From the closed position, press and hold  
the passenger side switch forward to vent the sunroof.  
The rear of the sunroof panel will tilt upward to the full  
vent position. The sunshade must be opened manually.  
3-56  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Close: To close the sunroof, operate the controls  
according to one of the following:  
.
From the open position, press and hold the driver  
side sunroof switch forward. The sunshade must  
be closed manually.  
.
From the vent position, press and hold the  
passenger side sunroof switch rearward.  
Dirt and debris may collect on the sunroof seal or in the  
tracks that could cause an issue with sunroof operation,  
noise or plug the water drainage system. Periodically  
open the sunroof and remove any obstacles or loose  
debris. Wipe the sunroof seal and roof sealing area  
using a clean cloth, mild soap, and water. Do not  
remove grease from sunroof.  
3-57  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2 NOTES  
3-58  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 4 Instrument Panel  
Instrument Panel Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-3  
Entry Lighting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-30  
Parade Dimming . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-31  
Reading Lamps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-31  
Footwell Lamps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-31  
Battery Load Management . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-31  
Electric Power Management . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-32  
Inadvertent Power Battery Saver . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-32  
Battery Run-Down Protection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-33  
Accessory Power Outlet(s) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-33  
Analog Clock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-34  
Hazard Warning Flashers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-3  
Horn . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-3  
Tilt Wheel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-3  
Power Tilt Wheel and Telescopic Steering  
Column . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-4  
Heated Steering Wheel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-4  
Turn Signal/Multifunction Lever . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-5  
Turn and Lane-Change Signals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-5  
Headlamp High/Low-Beam Changer . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-6  
Forward Collision Alert (FCA) System . . . . . . . . . . . 4-6  
Flash-to-Pass . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-10  
Windshield Wipers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-10  
Windshield Washer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-11  
Cruise Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-12  
Adaptive Cruise Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-14  
Exterior Lamps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-25  
Wiper Activated Headlamps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-28  
Headlamps on Reminder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-28  
Daytime Running Lamps (DRL) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-28  
Fog Lamps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-29  
Cornering Lamps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-29  
Exterior Lighting Battery Saver . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-30  
Instrument Panel Brightness . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-30  
Courtesy Lamps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-30  
Climate Controls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-34  
Dual Climate Control System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-34  
Outlet Adjustment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-40  
Rear Climate Control System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-40  
Passenger Compartment Air Filter . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-42  
Warning Lights, Gauges, and Indicators . . . . . . . . 4-44  
Instrument Panel Cluster . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-45  
Speedometer and Odometer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-46  
Tachometer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-46  
Safety Belt Reminders . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-47  
Airbag Readiness Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-48  
Passenger Airbag Status Indicator . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-48  
Charging System Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-49  
Brake System Warning Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-50  
4-1  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 4 Instrument Panel  
Antilock Brake System (ABS) Warning Light . . . 4-51  
Traction Control System (TCS) Warning  
Driver Information Center (DIC) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-59  
DIC Operation and Displays . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-60  
DIC Warnings and Messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-65  
DIC Vehicle Customization . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-77  
Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-51  
StabiliTrak® Indicator Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-52  
Lane Departure Warning (LDW) Light . . . . . . . . . . 4-52  
Engine Coolant Temperature Warning Light . . . . 4-53  
Engine Coolant Temperature Gauge . . . . . . . . . . . 4-53  
Tire Pressure Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-54  
Malfunction Indicator Lamp . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-54  
Oil Pressure Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-57  
Security Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-57  
Front Fog Lamp Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-58  
Lights On Reminder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-58  
Cruise Control Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-58  
Highbeam On Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-58  
Fuel Gauge . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-59  
Audio System(s) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-86  
Setting the Clock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-87  
Radio(s) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-90  
Using an MP3 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-100  
XM Radio Messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-105  
Navigation/Radio System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-106  
Bluetooth® . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-107  
Theft-Deterrent Feature . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-114  
Audio Steering Wheel Controls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-114  
Radio Reception . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-115  
Backglass Antenna . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-116  
XMSatellite Radio Antenna System . . . . . . . . 4-116  
4-2  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Tilt Wheel  
Instrument Panel Overview  
This feature allows the position of the steering wheel to  
be adjusted.  
Hazard Warning Flashers  
| (Hazard Warning Flasher): Press this button  
located on the instrument panel, to make the front and  
rear turn signal lamps flash on and off. This warns  
others that you are having trouble.  
The adjustment lever is  
located on the left side of  
the steering column.  
Press | again to turn the flashers off.  
Horn  
Press near or on the horn symbols on the steering  
wheel pad to sound the horn.  
1. Pull the lever to move the steering wheel up  
or down.  
2. Release the lever to lock the wheel in place.  
Do not adjust the steering wheel while driving.  
4-3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Power Tilt Wheel and Telescopic  
Steering Column  
Heated Steering Wheel  
The vehicle may have a heated steering wheel.  
If the vehicle has this  
feature, the power tilt and  
telescope wheel control is  
located on the outboard  
side of the steering  
column.  
The button for this feature  
is located on the steering  
wheel.  
Press to turn the heated steering wheel on or off. A light  
on the button displays while the feature is turned on.  
Heating will begin in about three minutes.  
Press the control up or down to tilt the steering wheel  
up or down.  
Press the control forward or rearward and the  
steering wheel moves toward the front or rear of the  
vehicle. To set the memory position, see DIC Vehicle  
Customization on page 477 and Memory Seat, Mirrors  
and Steering Wheel on page 26.  
4-4  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Turn Signal/Multifunction Lever  
Turn and Lane-Change Signals  
An arrow on the  
instrument panel cluster  
flashes in the direction of  
the turn or lane change.  
For vehicles with the side blind zone alert system,  
an arrow in the outside mirror flashes when the turn  
signal is used. See Side Blind Zone Alert (SBZA) on  
page 342 for more information.  
The lever on the left side of the steering column  
includes the following:  
Move the lever all the way up or down to signal a turn.  
G : Turn and Lane-Change Signals  
2 3 : Headlamp High/Low-Beam Changer  
N : Windshield Wipers  
Raise or lower the lever until the arrow starts to flash to  
signal a lane change. Hold it there until the lane change  
is complete. If the lever is briefly pressed and released,  
the turn signal will flash three times.  
L : Windshield Washer  
Flash-To-Pass Feature.  
The lever returns to its starting position when it is  
released.  
Information for these features is on the pages following.  
4-5  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
If after signaling a turn or lane change the arrow flashes  
rapidly or does not come on, a signal bulb may be  
burned out.  
Forward Collision Alert (FCA)  
System  
For vehicles with this feature, read the following section  
before using it.  
Have the bulbs replaced. If the bulb is not burned out,  
check the fuse. See Fuses and Circuit Breakers on  
page 6104  
.
This vehicle has systems that operate on a radio  
frequency that comply with Part 15 of the Federal  
Communications Commission (FCC) rules and with  
Industry Canada Standards RSS210/220/310.  
Turn Signal On Chime  
If the turn signal is left on, a warning chime sounds and  
the Driver Information Center (DIC) will display TURN  
SIGNAL ON after driving about a mile as a reminder  
to turn it off. See DIC Warnings and Messages on  
Operation is subject to the following two conditions:  
1. The device may not cause interference.  
page 465  
.
2. The device must accept any interference received,  
including interference that may cause undesired  
operation of the device.  
Headlamp High/Low-Beam Changer  
Changes or modifications to this system by other than  
an authorized service facility could void authorization to  
use this equipment.  
Push forward to change the headlamps from low beam  
to high. Pull the lever back and then release it to  
change from high beam to low.  
This light on the  
instrument panel cluster  
will be on, indicating  
high-beam usage.  
4-6  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The Forward Collision Alert (FCA) system provides an  
audible and visual alert if you approach a vehicle too  
quickly that is directly ahead. FCA also provides a  
visual alert with no audible alert if you are following  
another vehicle much too closely. The FCA alert symbol  
is located on top of the instrument panel to the right of  
the driver. FCA uses the Adaptive Cruise Control radar  
to detect a vehicle directly ahead, in your path, within a  
distance of 328 ft (100 m) and operates at speeds  
above 20 mph (32 km/h).  
The FCA control is  
located on the steering  
wheel.  
WARNING:  
{
FCA is only a warning system and does not apply  
the brakes. When you are approaching a vehicle  
or object too rapidly or when you are following a  
vehicle too closely that is ahead of you, FCA may  
not provide you with enough time to avoid a  
collision. FCA is not designed to warn the driver of  
pedestrians or animals. Your complete attention is  
always required while driving and you should be  
ready to take action and apply the brakes. For  
more information, see Defensive Driving on  
To enable or disable FCA, press the Adaptive Cruise  
Control button. See Adaptive Cruise Control on  
page 414  
.
page 52  
.
4-7  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
FCA is enabled when the green light on the button  
is lit. FCA is disabled when the indicator light is  
amber.  
WARNING:  
{
When FCA is enabled, the Adaptive Cruise  
Control switch is on. If you press another Adaptive  
Cruise Control button, you might go into cruise  
when you do not want to. You could be startled  
and even lose control. Be careful not to press  
adaptive cruise buttons unless you want to use  
cruise control.  
WARNING:  
{
.
On winding roads, FCA may not detect a  
vehicle ahead. You could crash into a vehicle  
ahead of you. Do not rely on FCA on winding  
roads.  
.
When weather limits visibility, such as in fog,  
rain, or snow, FCA performance is limited.  
There may not be enough warning distance to  
the vehicle in front of you. Do not rely on FCA  
in low visibility conditions.  
Alerting the Driver  
The FCA alert symbol will  
flash and a warning beep  
will sound when driver  
action may be required.  
4-8  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The alert symbol will flash when:  
WARNING: (Continued)  
.
Your vehicle is approaching another vehicle too  
quickly.  
.
when the radar is blocked by snow, ice, or dirt.  
Keep your radar clean. See Cleaning the  
Systemunder Adaptive Cruise Control on  
Your vehicle is following a vehicle ahead of you  
much too closely.  
See Defensive Driving on page 52 for more  
information.  
page 414  
.
Detecting the Vehicle Ahead  
The vehicle ahead symbol, located next to the FCA  
symbol, only appears when a vehicle ahead of you is  
detected in your path. If this symbol does not appear,  
or disappears briefly, FCA will not respond to vehicles  
you may see ahead. The symbol may disappear on  
curves, highway exit ramps, or hills. Also, when another  
vehicle enters the same lane as you, the FCA system  
will not detect the vehicle until it is completely in your  
driving lane.  
WARNING:  
{
FCA may not detect and warn soon enough to  
stationary or slow-moving vehicles or other  
objects ahead of you. You could crash into an  
object ahead of you. Do not rely on FCA when  
approaching stationary or slow-moving vehicles or  
other objects.  
WARNING:  
{
Unnecessary Alerts  
FCA may occasionally provide alerts that you consider  
unnecessary. It could respond to a turning vehicle  
ahead of you, guard rails, signs, and other stationary  
objects. This is normal operation, your vehicle does not  
need service.  
When the Adaptive Cruise Control radar is  
blocked by snow, ice, or dirt, it may not detect a  
vehicle ahead. FCA may not help you avoid a  
collision under these conditions. Do not use FCA  
(Continued)  
4-9  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Other Messages  
Windshield Wipers  
There are three messages that may appear on the  
Driver Information Center (DIC). They are CLEAN  
RADAR, RADAR CRUISE NOT READY and SERVICE  
RADAR CRUISE. See DIC Warnings and Messages on  
page 465  
.
Cleaning the System  
The radar can become blocked by snow, ice, or dirt.  
If so, you may need to turn off the engine and clean the  
lens. See Cleaning the Systemunder Adaptive Cruise  
Control on page 414.  
Flash-to-Pass  
This feature lets you use the high-beam headlamps to  
signal the driver in front of you that you want to pass.  
The windshield wiper lever is located on the left side of  
the steering column.  
Turn the band with the wiper symbol on it to control the  
windshield wipers.  
The flash-to-pass feature will only work with the  
headlamps on. It does not work with Daytime Running  
Lamps (DRL).  
8(Mist): For a single wiping cycle, hold it on mist until  
the wipers start, then release. The wipers stop after  
one wipe. Several wipes, hold the band longer.  
Pull and hold the turn signal lever toward you to use.  
6 (Delay): Use to set the delay time between wipe  
cycles. The wiper speed can be set for a long or short  
delay between wipes. The closer the band is set to the  
top of the lever, the shorter the delay.  
If the headlamps are on low beam, pulling the turn  
signal towards you will flash the high beams.  
4-10  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
6 (Low Speed): Slow wipes.  
1 (High Speed): Fast wipes.  
9 (Off): Turns the wipers off.  
Windshield Washer  
WARNING:  
{
Clear ice and snow from the wiper blades before using  
them. If frozen to the windshield, carefully loosen or  
thaw them. Damaged blades should be replaced.  
In freezing weather, do not use your washer until  
the windshield is warmed. Otherwise the washer  
fluid can form ice on the windshield, blocking your  
vision.  
Heavy snow or ice can overload the wiper motor.  
A circuit breaker will stop the motor until it cools.  
The vehicle has wiper-activated headlamps. After the  
windshield wipers have completed eight wipe cycles  
within four minutes, the headlamps automatically turn  
on. See Wiper Activated Headlamps on page 428 for  
more information.  
J (Washer Fluid): Press and release this paddle,  
located at the top of the turn signal/multifunction lever,  
to spray washer fluid on the windshield. The wipers will  
clear the windshield and either stop or return to the  
preset speed. For more washer cycles, press and hold  
the paddle.  
4-11  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
If your vehicle is in cruise control when the Traction  
Control System (TCS) begins to limit wheel spin, the  
cruise control automatically turns off. See Traction  
Control System (TCS) on page 56. When road  
conditions let you safely use it again, the cruise control  
can be turned back on.  
Cruise Control  
With cruise control, a speed of approximately 40 km/h  
(25 mph) or more can be maintained without keeping  
your foot on the accelerator. Cruise control does not  
work at speeds below about 40 km/h (25 mph). A cruise  
control light appears in the instrument panel cluster  
when the cruise control is on.  
The cruise control buttons  
are located on left side of  
the steering wheel.  
When the brakes are applied, the cruise control  
shuts off.  
WARNING:  
{
Cruise control can be dangerous where you  
cannot drive safely at a steady speed. So, do not  
use the cruise control on winding roads or in  
heavy traffic.  
Cruise control can be dangerous on slippery  
roads. On such roads, fast changes in tire traction  
can cause excessive wheel slip, and you could  
lose control. Do not use cruise control on slippery  
roads.  
I (On/Off): Press to turn the cruise control system on  
or off.  
+ RES (Resume/Accelerate): Press briefly to make the  
vehicle resume to a previously set speed or press and  
hold to accelerate.  
4-12  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
SET(Set): Press to set the speed and activate cruise  
control or make the vehicle decelerate.  
Resuming a Set Speed  
If the cruise control is set at a desired speed and then  
the brakes are applied, the cruise control is disengaged  
without erasing the set speed from memory.  
[ (Cancel): Press to disengage cruise control without  
erasing the set speed from memory.  
Once the vehicle speed is 40 km/h (25 mph) or greater,  
press the +RES button on the steering wheel. The  
vehicle returns to the previously set speed and stays  
there.  
Setting Cruise Control  
If the cruise button is on when not in use, it could get  
bumped and go into cruise when not desired. Keep the  
cruise control switch off when cruise is not being used.  
If you press and hold the +RES button, the vehicle  
speed increases until the button is released or the  
brake is applied. Do not hold in the +RES button, if you  
do not want the vehicle speed to increase.  
The cruise light on the instrument panel cluster comes  
on after the cruise control has been set to the desired  
speed.  
1. Press I.  
2. Get up to the speed desired.  
Increasing Speed While Using Cruise  
Control  
3. Press the SETbutton located on the steering  
If the cruise control is already activated,  
wheel and release it.  
.
Press the +RES button. Hold it there until the  
4. Take your foot off the accelerator.  
desired speed is reached, and then release the  
button.  
.
To increase the vehicle speed in small amounts,  
briefly press the +RES button and then release it.  
Each time this is done, the vehicle goes about  
1.6 km/h (1 mph) faster.  
The accelerate feature only works after the cruise  
control speed is set by pressing the SETbutton.  
4-13  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Reducing Speed While Using Cruise  
Control  
Ending Cruise Control  
There are three ways to end cruise control:  
.
If the cruise control is already activated,  
To disengage cruise control, step lightly on the  
.
brake pedal.  
Press the SETbutton until the lower speed  
desired is reached, then release it.  
.
Press the [ button.  
.
To slow down in small amounts, press the  
.
Press the I button.  
SETbutton briefly. Each time this is done, the  
vehicle goes about 1.6 km/h (1 mph) slower.  
Erasing Speed Memory  
Passing Another Vehicle While Using  
Cruise Control  
The cruise control set speed is erased from memory by  
pressing the I button or if the ignition is turned off.  
Use the accelerator pedal to increase the vehicle  
speed. When you take your foot off the pedal, the  
vehicle slows down to the previous cruise control  
speed.  
Adaptive Cruise Control  
For vehicles with this feature, be sure to read this entire  
section before using it.  
Using Cruise Control on Hills  
This vehicle has systems that operate on a radio  
frequency that comply with Part 15 of the Federal  
Communications Commission (FCC) rules and with  
Industry Canada Standards RSS-210/220/310.  
How well your cruise control works on hills depends  
upon the vehicle speed, load, and the steepness of the  
hills. When going up steep hills, you might have to step  
on the accelerator pedal to maintain the vehicle speed.  
When going downhill, you might have to brake or shift  
to a lower gear to keep the vehicle speed down. When  
the brakes are applied or you shift into a lower gear the  
cruise control is disengaged.  
Operation is subject to the following two conditions:  
1. This device may not cause interference.  
2. This device must accept any interference received,  
including interference that may cause undesired  
operation of the device.  
4-14  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Changes or modifications to this system by other than  
an authorized service facility could void authorization to  
use this equipment.  
WARNING:  
{
Adaptive Cruise Control (ACC) is an enhancement to  
traditional cruise control. It allows you to keep cruise  
control engaged in moderate traffic conditions without  
having to constantly reset your cruise control. ACC  
uses radar to detect a vehicle directly ahead in your  
path, within a distance of 100 m (330 ft), and operates  
at speeds above 40 km/h (25 mph). When it is engaged  
by the driver, the system can apply limited braking or  
acceleration of the vehicle automatically to maintain a  
selected follow distance to the vehicle ahead. Braking is  
limited to 2.45 m/sec2 (0.25 g's) of deceleration, which is  
comparable to moderate application of the vehicle's  
brakes. To disengage ACC, apply the brake. If no  
vehicle is in your path, the vehicle will react like  
traditional cruise control.  
Adaptive Cruise Control will not apply hard  
braking or bring the vehicle to a complete  
stop. It will not respond to stopped vehicles,  
pedestrians or animals. When you are  
approaching a vehicle or object, Adaptive Cruise  
Control may not have time to slow your vehicle  
enough to avoid a collision. Your complete  
attention is always required while driving and you  
should be ready to take action and apply the  
brakes. For more information, see Defensive  
Driving on page 52.  
4-15  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
WARNING:  
WARNING: (Continued)  
{
.
.
On slippery roads, fast changes in tire traction  
On winding roads, Adaptive Cruise Control  
may not detect a vehicle ahead. You could  
crash into a vehicle ahead of you. Do not use  
Adaptive Cruise Control on winding roads.  
can cause needless wheel spinning, and you  
could lose control. Do not use cruise control  
on slippery roads.  
.
.
When weather limits visibility, such as when in  
Adaptive Cruise Control may not have time to  
slow your vehicle enough to avoid a crash  
when you are driving in conditions where  
vehicles may suddenly slow or stop ahead of  
you, enter your lane, or cross your vehicle's  
path. If you are driving in these conditions, do  
not use Adaptive Cruise Control. The warning  
beep and alert symbol may indicate that you  
are driving in conditions where Adaptive  
Cruise Control should not be used. See  
Alerting the Driverin this section.  
fog, rain, or snow conditions, Adaptive Cruise  
Control performance is limited. There may not  
be enough distance to adapt to the changing  
traffic conditions. Do not use cruise control  
when visibility is low.  
(Continued)  
4-16  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
+GAP (Increase Following Distance): Press to  
increase the distance between your vehicle and other  
vehicles.  
GAP (Decrease Following Distance): Press to  
decrease the distance between your vehicle and other  
vehicles.  
ACC will not work if the master cylinder brake fluid level  
is low.  
Engaging ACC With the Set Button  
If the adaptive cruise control switch is on when not in  
use, it could get bumped and go into cruise when not  
desired. Keep the adaptive cruise control switch off  
when cruise is not being used.  
The ACCs are located on the steering wheel.  
The set speed is selected by the driver. This is the  
speed your vehicle will travel if there is no vehicle  
detected in its path.  
The cruise control buttons are located on left side of the  
steering wheel.  
] (On): Press to turn the system on.  
To set ACC, do the following:  
+ Res (Resume/Accelerate): Press to make the  
vehicle resume to a previously set speed or to increase  
the set speed when ACC is already active.  
1. Press the ] button.  
2. Get up to the speed desired.  
Set: Press to set the speed or to decrease the set  
speed when ACC is already active.  
3. Press in the SETbutton and release it.  
4. Take your foot off the accelerator pedal.  
[ (Cancel): Press to disengage ACC without erasing  
the set speed from memory.  
Once ACC is set, it may immediately apply the brakes if  
it detects a vehicle ahead is too close or moving slower  
than your vehicle.  
4-17  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The on symbol is located on the display at the top of the  
instrument panel to the right of the driver. When the on  
symbol is lit on the display, it indicates that ACC is  
active.  
Decreasing Set Speed While Using ACC  
If the ACC is already activated,  
.
Press the SETbutton until the lower speed  
desired is reached, then release it.  
A message on the DIC will also display when ACC is  
set. See DIC Warnings and Messages on page 465.  
.
To slow down in small amounts, briefly press the  
SETbutton. Each time this is done, the set speed  
decreases by 1 km/h (1 mph) slower.  
Keep in mind speed limits, surrounding traffic speeds,  
and weather conditions when adjusting your set speed.  
Resuming a Set Speed  
If the vehicle is in ACC when the traction control system  
begins to limit wheel spin, the ACC will automatically  
disengage. See Traction Control System (TCS) on  
page 56 and StabiliTrak® System on page 56.  
When road conditions allow you to safely use it again,  
the ACC can be turned back on.  
If the ACC is set at a desired speed and then the  
brakes are applied, the ACC is disengaged without  
erasing the set speed from memory.  
Once the vehicle speed is 40 km/h (25 mph) or greater,  
press the +RES button. The vehicle returns to the  
previously set speed and stays there.  
Increasing Set Speed While Using ACC  
If the ACC is already activated,  
Selecting the Follow Distance (GAP)  
.
Press the +RES button. Hold it there until the  
When the system detects a slower moving vehicle, it  
adjusts your vehicle speed and maintains the follow  
distance (gap) you select.  
desired set speed is displayed on the Driver  
Information Center (DIC), then release the switch.  
.
To increase the set speed in small amounts, move  
Use the plus and minus buttons on the steering wheel  
to adjust the follow distance.  
the switch briefly to +RES. Each time this is done,  
the set speed increases by 1 km/h (1 mph).  
Press the plus button to increase the distance or the  
minus button to decrease the distance. The first button  
press shows the current follow distance setting on  
the DIC. The current follow distance setting will be  
maintained until it is changed.  
Your vehicle will not reach the set speed until the  
system determines there is not a vehicle in front of you.  
At that point, your vehicle speed will increase to the set  
speed.  
4-18  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
.
.
A temporary condition prohibits ACC from  
operating. See DIC Warnings and Messages on  
page 465 for more information.  
There are six follow distances to choose from. The  
follow distance selection ranges from near to far  
(one second to two seconds follow time). The distance  
maintained for a selected follow distance will vary  
based on vehicle speed. The faster the vehicle speed  
the further back your vehicle will follow. Consider traffic  
and weather conditions when selecting the follow  
distance. The range of selectable distances may not be  
appropriate for all drivers and driving conditions. If you  
prefer to travel at a follow distance farther than ACC  
allows, disengage the system and drive manually.  
A malfunction is detected in the system. See DIC  
Warnings and Messages on page 465 for more  
information.  
See Defensive Driving on page 52.  
WARNING:  
{
Alerting the Driver  
Adaptive Cruise Control has only limited braking  
ability to slow your vehicle. In some cases,  
Adaptive Cruise Control may not have time to  
slow your vehicle enough to avoid a collision. Be  
ready to take action and apply the brakes  
yourself. See Defensive Driving on page 52.  
The ACC alert symbol is  
located on the display at  
the top of the instrument  
panel to the right of the  
driver.  
The alert symbol flashes and a warning beep sounds  
when driver action may be required. If ACC is engaged,  
the alert symbol will flash when:  
.
ACC cannot apply sufficient braking because you  
are approaching a vehicle too rapidly.  
.
The vehicle speed drops below about 32 km/h  
(20 mph).  
4-19  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ACC automatically slows your vehicle down when  
approaching a slower moving vehicle. It then adjusts  
your vehicle speed to follow the vehicle in front at the  
selected follow distance. Your vehicle speed increases  
or decreases to follow the vehicle in front of you, but will  
not exceed the set speed. It may apply limited braking,  
if necessary. When braking is active, your brake lights  
will come on. Braking may feel or sound different than if  
you were applying the brakes yourself. This is normal.  
Approaching and Following a Vehicle  
The vehicle ahead symbol  
is located on the top of  
the instrument panel to  
the right of the driver.  
Stationary or Very Slow-Moving Objects  
The vehicle ahead symbol only appears when a vehicle  
is detected in your path.  
WARNING:  
{
If this symbol does not appear, or disappears briefly,  
ACC will not respond to vehicles you may see ahead.  
Adaptive Cruise Control may not detect and react  
to stationary or slowmoving vehicles or other  
objects ahead of you. You could crash into an  
object ahead of you. Do not use Adaptive  
Cruise Control when approaching stationary or  
slowmoving vehicles or other objects.  
WARNING:  
{
When the Adaptive Cruise Control radar is  
blocked by snow, ice, or dirt, it may not detect a  
vehicle ahead. Adaptive Cruise Control may not  
have time to slow your vehicle enough to avoid a  
collision. Do not use Adaptive Cruise Control  
when the radar is blocked by snow, ice, or dirt.  
Keep your radar clean. See Cleaning the  
Systemlater in this section.  
4-20  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Passing a Vehicle/ACC Override  
WARNING:  
{
To increase speed to pass a vehicle, use the  
accelerator pedal. While you are doing this, the system  
will not automatically apply the brakes. A message will  
appear on the DIC. See DIC Warnings and Messages  
on page 465. Once you remove your foot from the  
accelerator pedal, ACC will return to normal operation  
and be able to apply the brakes, if needed.  
Adaptive Cruise Control may not detect and react  
to stationary or slow-moving vehicles or other  
objects ahead of you. Your vehicle may accelerate  
toward objects, such as a stopped vehicle that  
suddenly appears after the lead vehicle changes  
lanes. Your complete attention is always required  
while driving and you should be ready to take  
action and apply the brakes.  
WARNING:  
{
If you rest your foot on the accelerator pedal, the  
system will not automatically apply the brakes.  
You could crash into a vehicle ahead of you. Do  
not rest your foot on the accelerator pedal when  
using Adaptive Cruise Control.  
Low-Speed Deactivation  
If your vehicle speed falls below 32 km/h (20 mph) while  
following a vehicle ahead, ACC will begin to disengage.  
The Driver Alert symbol will flash and the warning beep  
will sound. The driver must take action since ACC will  
not slow the vehicle to a stop.  
4-21  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Curves in the Road  
WARNING:  
{
Due to Adaptive Cruise Control limitations in  
curves, it may respond to a vehicle in another  
lane, or may not have time to react to a vehicle in  
your lane. You could crash into a vehicle ahead of  
you, or lose control of your vehicle. Give extra  
attention in curves and be ready to use the brakes  
if necessary. Select an appropriate speed while  
driving in curves.  
ACC may operate differently in a sharp curve. It may  
reduce your vehicle speed if the curve is too sharp.  
When following a vehicle and entering a curve, ACC  
could lose track of the vehicle in your lane and  
accelerate your vehicle. When this happens the Vehicle  
Ahead symbol will not appear.  
4-22  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Highway Exit Ramps  
WARNING:  
{
Adaptive Cruise Control may lose track of the  
vehicle ahead and accelerate up to your set  
speed while entering or on highway exit ramps.  
You could be startled by this acceleration and  
even lose control of the vehicle. Disengage  
Adaptive Cruise Control before entering a  
highway exit ramp. Do not use Adaptive Cruise  
Control while entering or on exit ramps.  
Other Vehicle Lane Changes  
ACC may detect a vehicle that is not in your lane and  
apply the brakes.  
ACC may, occasionally, provide a driver alert and/or  
braking that you consider unnecessary. It could respond  
to signs, guardrails, and other stationary objects when  
entering or exiting a curve. This is normal operation.  
Your vehicle does not need service.  
If another vehicle enters the same lane as you, ACC will  
not detect the vehicle until it is completely in the lane.  
Be ready to take action and apply the brakes yourself.  
4-23  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using ACC on Hills and When Towing a  
Trailer  
Disengaging ACC  
To turn off the system, apply the brake pedal, press the  
cancel button, or press the ACC button.  
Erasing Set Speed Memory  
Press the ACC button or turn the ignition off.  
Other Messages  
There are three additional messages that may appear  
on the DIC. They are SERVICE RADAR CRUISE,  
RADAR CRUISE NOT READY and CLEAN RADAR.  
These messages will appear to indicate a problem  
with the ACC. See DIC Warnings and Messages on  
page 465 for more information.  
How well ACC will work on hills and when towing a  
trailer depends on your vehicle's speed, vehicle load,  
traffic conditions and the steepness of the hills. It may  
not detect a vehicle in your lane while driving on hills.  
When going up steep hills, you may want to use the  
accelerator pedal to maintain your vehicle's speed.  
When going downhill, especially when towing a trailer,  
you may want to brake to keep your speed down.  
Applying the brake disengages the system. You may  
choose not to use ACC on steep hills, especially when  
towing a trailer.  
Cleaning the System  
The radar can become blocked by snow, ice, or dirt.  
If so, you may need to turn off the engine and clean the  
lens. Remember, do not use ACC in icy conditions,  
or when visibility is low, such as in fog, rain or snow.  
The emblem/lens is located in the center of the grille.  
To clean the emblem/lens, wipe the surface with a soft  
cloth. After cleaning the emblem/lens, try to engage the  
ACC. If you are unable to do so, see your dealer.  
4-24  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
AUTO (Automatic): Automatically turns on the  
headlamps at normal brightness, together with the  
following:  
Exterior Lamps  
The exterior lamps  
control is located on the  
instrument panel to the  
left of the steering wheel.  
.
Parking Lamps  
.
Instrument Panel Lights  
IntelliBeam®  
.
; (Parking Lamps): Turns on the parking lamps  
together with the following:  
.
Instrument Panel Lights  
It controls the following systems:  
.
License Plate Lamps  
.
Headlamps  
.
Taillamps  
.
Taillamps  
.
Side Marker Lamps  
.
Parking Lamps  
The parking brake indicator light comes on and stays on  
while the parking lamps are on with the engine off and  
the ignition in ACC/ACCESSORY or ON/RUN.  
.
License Plate Lamps  
.
Instrument Panel Lights  
2 (Headlamps): Turns on the headlamps together with  
the previously listed lamps. A warning chime sounds if  
the driver's door is opened while the ignition switch is  
off and the headlamps are on.  
.
Fog Lamps  
The exterior lamps control has four positions:  
O (Off): Turns off the exterior lamps except for  
Daytime Running Lamps (DRL).  
# (Fog Lamps): Press the exterior lamps control to  
turn on the fog lamps. See Fog Lamps on page 429.  
4-25  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
IntelliBeam® Intelligent High-Beam  
Headlamp Control System  
For vehicles with this feature, be sure to read this entire  
section before using it.  
Driving with IntelliBeam  
IntelliBeam only activates the high-beams when driving  
over 20 mph (32 km/h).  
The high-beam headlamps remain on, under the  
automatic control of IntelliBeam, until any of the  
following situations occur:  
IntelliBeam is an enhancement to the vehicle's  
headlamp system. Using a digital light sensor on the  
rearview mirror, this system turns the vehicle's  
high-beam headlamps on and off according to  
surrounding traffic conditions.  
.
The system detects an approaching vehicle's  
headlamps.  
.
The system detects a preceding vehicle's  
taillamps.  
The IntelliBeam system turns the high-beam headlamps  
on when it is dark enough, there is no other traffic  
present, and the IntelliBeam system is enabled.  
.
The outside light is bright enough that high-beam  
headlamps are not required.  
.
The vehicle's speed drops below 15 mph  
(24 km/h).  
Turning On and Enabling IntelliBeam  
Press and release the IntelliBeam button on the inside  
rear view mirror. The IntelliBeam indicator on the mirror  
turns on to indicate the system is on. Once the system  
has been turned on, it remains on each time the vehicle  
is started, but the IntelliBeam system must be enabled.  
.
The headlamp stalk is moved forward to the  
high-beam position or the flash-to-pass feature is  
used. See Headlamp High/Low-Beam Changer on  
page 46 and Flash-to-Pass on page 410  
.
When either of these conditions occur, the  
To enable the IntelliBeam system, turn the exterior lamp  
control to AUTO, with the turn signal/multifunction lever  
in its neutral position. The High-Beam On Light appears  
on the instrument panel cluster when the high-beams  
are on. See Highbeam On Light on page 458.  
IntelliBeam feature is disabled and the IntelliBeam  
light in the mirror turns off until the high-beam stalk  
is returned to the neutral position.  
.
If IntelliBeam was using low-beams prior to this  
action, the IntelliBeam feature is temporarily  
disabled until the stalk is returned to the neutral  
position.  
4-26  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
.
.
The exterior lamp control is turned to any setting  
except AUTO.  
You might need to manually disable or cancel the  
high-beam headlamps by turning the low-beam  
headlamps on, if any of the above conditions exist.  
When this occurs, IntelliBeam is disabled until the  
control is turned back to the AUTO position.  
Disabling and Resetting IntelliBeam at the  
Rearview Mirror  
The IntelliBeam system is turned off at the inside  
rearview mirror.  
IntelliBeam can be disabled by using the controls on the  
inside rearview mirror.  
IntelliBeam might not turn off the high-beams if the  
system cannot detect other vehicle's lamps because of  
any of the following:  
AUTO 3 (On/Off): Press this button on the inside  
rearview mirror to disable the system. The IntelliBeam  
indicator turns off and does not come back on until the  
IntelliBeam button is pressed again.  
.
The other vehicle's lamp(s) are missing, damaged,  
obstructed from view, or otherwise undetected.  
.
The other vehicle's lamp(s) are covered with dirt,  
When IntelliBeam has turned on the high-beams, pull or  
push the high-beam stalk. This will disable IntelliBeam.  
The IntelliBeam indicator on the mirror turns off. To turn  
IntelliBeam back on, press the IntelliBeam button on the  
mirror.  
snow, and/or road spray.  
.
The other vehicle's lamp(s) cannot be detected  
due to dense exhaust, smoke, fog, snow, road  
spray, mist, or other airborne obstructions.  
.
Your vehicle's windshield is dirty, cracked,  
or obstructed by something that blocks the view of  
the IntelliBeam light sensor.  
A different sensitivity setting is available for dealer  
diagnostics. This is done by pushing and holding this  
button for 20 seconds until the IntelliBeam indicator light  
flashes three times. If you accidentally activate this, the  
vehicle' s setting automatically is reset when the ignition  
is turned off and then on again.  
.
Your vehicle's windshield is covered with ice, dirt,  
haze, or other obstructions.  
.
Your vehicle is loaded such that the front end of  
the vehicle points upward, causing the IntelliBeam  
sensor to aim high and not detect headlamps and  
taillamps.  
.
You are driving on winding or hilly roads.  
4-27  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Cleaning the IntelliBeam Light Sensor  
Headlamps on Reminder  
The light sensor is located  
A warning chime will sound if the exterior lamp control  
is left on in either the headlamp or parking lamp position  
and the driver's door is opened with the ignition off.  
on the inside of the  
vehicle in front of the  
inside rearview mirror.  
Daytime Running Lamps (DRL)  
Daytime Running Lamps (DRL) can make it easier for  
others to see the front of your vehicle during the day.  
Fully functional daytime running lamps are required on  
all vehicles first sold in Canada.  
The DRL system makes the turn signal lamps come on  
when the following conditions are met:  
.
It is still daylight and the ignition is on.  
Clean the light sensor window, periodically, using glass  
cleaner on a soft cloth. Gently wipe the sensor window.  
Do not spray glass cleaner directly on the surface of the  
sensor window.  
.
.
The exterior lamp control is in the off position.  
The transmission is not in P (Park) (United  
States only).  
.
The light sensor is covered or not detecting light.  
See Sensorsunder Dual Climate Control System  
Wiper Activated Headlamps  
This feature activates the headlamps and parking lamps  
after the windshield wipers are turned on and have  
completed eight wipe cycles within four minutes.  
on page 434  
.
When DRL are on, no other exterior lamps such as the  
parking lamps, taillamps, etc. will be on when the DRL  
are being used. The instrument panel will not be lit up  
either.  
When the ignition is turned to LOCK/OFF, the  
wiper-activated headlamps immediately turn off. The  
wiper-activated headlamps also turn off if the windshield  
wipers are turned off.  
When automatic lighting is on and it is dark enough  
outside, the turn signal lamps turn off and normal  
low-beam headlamp operation occurs.  
4-28  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
When automatic lighting is on and it is bright enough  
outside, the regular lamps go off, and the DRL takes  
over. If the vehicle is started in a dark garage, the  
automatic headlamp system comes on immediately.  
Once you leave the garage, it will take approximately  
one minute for the automatic headlamp system to  
change to DRL if there is light outside. During that  
delay, the instrument panel cluster may not be as bright  
as usual. Make sure the instrument panel brightness  
knob is in the full bright position. See Instrument Panel  
Brightness on page 430.  
Fog Lamps  
The fog lamps button is on the exterior lamps control to  
the left of the steering column.  
# (Fog Lamps): Press to turn the fog lamps on or off.  
A light comes on in the instrument panel cluster when  
the fog lamps are in use. See Instrument Panel Cluster  
on page 445. The ignition must be in the ON/RUN  
position for the fog lamps to work.  
The fog lamps will go off when the headlamps are  
changed to high-beam.  
Turning on automatic lighting or the headlamps will  
deactivate the DRL. If the parking lamps or the fog  
lamps were turned on instead, the DRL will still  
deactivate.  
Some localities have laws that require the headlamps to  
be on along with the fog lamps.  
Cornering Lamps  
To idle the vehicle with the DRL off at night, turn off  
automatic lighting and shift the transmission into  
P (Park). Placing the vehicle in P (Park) disables the  
DRL. The DRL will stay off until the vehicle is shifted  
out of P (Park).  
The cornering lamps come on when the headlamps or  
parking lamps are on and you signal a turn with the  
multifunction lever. They provide more light for  
cornering.  
To drive the vehicle with the DRL off, turn off automatic  
lighting and manually turn on the parking lamps or fog  
lamps, if the vehicle has them.  
The regular headlamp system should be turned on  
when needed.  
4-29  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Exterior Lighting Battery Saver  
Courtesy Lamps  
If the exterior lamp button has been left on, the exterior  
lamps will turn off about 10 minutes after the ignition is  
turned to LOCK/OFF and a door has been opened. This  
protects against draining the battery if the headlamps or  
parking lamps are accidentally left on. If the lamps need  
to be left on for more than 10 minutes, use the exterior  
lamp control to turn the lamps back on after the ignition  
is turned to LOCK/OFF and any door is opened.  
The courtesy lamps are located on the headliner above  
the rear seat. These lamps come on by turning the  
instrument panel brightness knob fully clockwise or  
when any door is opened and it is dark outside. Puddle  
lamps are located on the bottom of the front and rear  
door trim.  
Professional vehicles have an additional dome lamp  
and also opera lamps.  
Instrument Panel Brightness  
D (Instrument Panel Brightness): This feature  
controls the brightness of the instrument panel and  
footwell lights, if equipped.  
Entry Lighting  
This feature turns on the courtesy lamps and the  
backlighting for the door switches and the exterior lamp  
control when a door is opened or if the remote keyless  
entry transmitter unlock button is pressed. If activated  
due to the transmitter, the lighting remains active for  
about 40 seconds. Since the entry lighting system uses  
the light sensor, it must be dark outside in order for the  
courtesy lamps to turn on. The courtesy lamps turn off  
approximately 25 seconds after the last door is closed.  
They will dim to off if the ignition key is turned to ON/  
RUN, or immediately deactivate if the power locks are  
activated.  
The button for this control is located below the exterior  
lamps control.  
Push the button in and release to extend the button.  
Turn the button clockwise or counterclockwise to  
brighten or dim the lights.  
4-30  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Footwell lighting brightness can be adjusted with the  
instrument panel brightness control located below the  
exterior lamps control. See Instrument Panel Brightness  
on page 430. The footwell lights will turn off before the  
instrument panel lights are at their lowest level of  
brightness.  
Parade Dimming  
This feature prohibits dimming of the digital displays  
and backlighting during daylight hours when the key is  
in the ignition and the headlamps are on. This feature is  
fully automatic. When the light sensor reads darkness  
outside and the parking lamps are active, the digital  
displays can be adjusted by turning the instrument  
panel brightness knob counterclockwise to dim and  
clockwise to brighten lighting.  
Battery Load Management  
This feature monitors the vehicle's electrical load and  
determines when the battery is in a heavy discharge  
condition. During times of high electrical loading, the  
engine may idle at a higher revolutions per minute (rpm)  
setting than normal to make sure the battery charges.  
High electrical loads may occur when several of the  
following are on: headlamps, high beams, fog lamps,  
rear window defogger, the climate control fan at high  
speeds, heated seats and engine cooling fans.  
Reading Lamps  
The reading lamps are located on the overhead console  
on the headliner and in the rear door opening. These  
lamps come on automatically when any door is opened  
and it is dark outside.  
For manual operation, press the button to turn them on.  
Press it again to turn them off.  
If the battery continues to discharge, even with the  
engine idling at a higher rpm setting, some electrical  
loads will automatically be reduced. When this occurs,  
the rear window defogger may take slightly longer to  
clear the glass, the heated seats may not get as warm  
as they usually do and the climate control fan may  
cut back to a lower speed. For more battery saving  
information, see Battery Saver Active Messageunder  
DIC Warnings and Messages on page 465.  
If the reading lamps are left on, they automatically shut  
off 10 minutes after the ignition has been turned off.  
Footwell Lamps  
For vehicles with footwell lamps, they are located under  
the instrument panel and at the rear of the front seats.  
These lamps provide soft light to the front and rear floor  
areas. They dim with the instrument panel cluster lights.  
4-31  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
EPM works to prevent excessive discharge of the  
battery. It does this by balancing the generator's output  
and the vehicle's electrical needs. It can increase  
engine idle speed to generate more power, whenever  
needed. It can temporarily reduce the power demands  
of some accessories.  
Electric Power Management  
The vehicle has Electric Power Management (EPM) that  
estimates the battery's temperature and state of charge.  
It then adjusts the voltage for best performance and  
extended life of the battery.  
When the battery's state of charge is low, the voltage  
is raised slightly to quickly bring the charge back up.  
When the state of charge is high, the voltage is lowered  
slightly to prevent overcharging. If the vehicle has a  
voltmeter gauge or a voltage display on the Driver  
Information Center (DIC), you may see the voltage  
move up or down. This is normal. If there is a problem,  
an alert will be displayed.  
Normally, these actions occur in steps or levels, without  
being noticeable. In rare cases at the highest levels  
of corrective action, this action may be noticeable to  
the driver. If so, a Driver Information Center (DIC)  
message might be displayed, such as BATTERY  
SAVER ACTIVE, BATTERY VOLTAGE LOW, or  
LOW BATTERY. If this message is displayed, it is  
recommended that the driver reduce the electrical loads  
as much as possible. See DIC Warnings and Messages  
The battery can be discharged at idle if the electrical  
loads are very high. This is true for all vehicles. This is  
because the generator (alternator) may not be spinning  
fast enough at idle to produce all the power that is  
needed for very high electrical loads.  
on page 465  
.
Inadvertent Power Battery Saver  
This feature protects the vehicle battery against  
drainage from the interior lamps, trunk lamp, glove box  
lamp, or the garage door opener. When the ignition is  
turned off, the power to these features automatically  
turns off after 10 minutes. Power is restored for an  
additional 10 minutes if any door or trunk is opened,  
or the courtesy lamp switch is turned on.  
A high electrical load occurs when several of the  
following are on, such as: headlamps, high beams, fog  
lamps, rear window defogger, climate control fan at high  
speed, heated seats, engine cooling fans, trailer loads,  
and loads plugged into accessory power outlets.  
4-32  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
There are two accessory power outlets in the rear seat  
area located on the door armrests next to the ashtrays.  
Battery Run-Down Protection  
This feature helps prevent the battery from being  
drained, if the interior courtesy lamps, reading/map  
lamps, visor vanity lamps or trunk lamp are accidentally  
left on. If any of these lamps are left on, they  
automatically turn off after 10 minutes, if the ignition is  
off. The lamps will not come back on again until one of  
the following occurs:  
Remove the cover to access and replace when not  
in use.  
The accessory power outlet can be used at any time.  
WARNING:  
{
.
The ignition is turned on.  
Power is always supplied to the outlets. Do not  
leave electrical equipment plugged in when the  
vehicle is not in use because the vehicle could  
catch fire and cause injury or death.  
.
The exterior lamps control is turned off, then on  
again.  
The headlamps will timeout after 10 minutes, if they are  
manually turned on with the ignition on or off.  
Notice: Leaving electrical equipment plugged in for  
an extended period of time while the vehicle is off  
will drain the battery. Always unplug electrical  
equipment when not in use and do not plug in  
equipment that exceeds the maximum 20 ampere  
rating.  
Accessory Power Outlet(s)  
The accessory power outlets can be used to plug in  
electrical equipment, such as a cell phone or MP3  
player.  
If the vehicle has a center console, the power outlet is  
located inside the lower storage area. Some vehicles  
may have an outlet on the right front lower part of the  
driver's seat and under the climate control system  
next to the ashtray. See Center Console Storage on  
Certain accessory power plugs may not be compatible  
with the accessory power outlet and could overload  
vehicle or adapter fuses. If a problem is experienced,  
see your dealer.  
page 354  
.
4-33  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
When adding electrical equipment, be sure to follow  
the proper installation instructions included with the  
equipment. See Add-On Electrical Equipment on  
Climate Controls  
Dual Climate Control System  
page 6103  
.
The heating, cooling, and ventilation for the vehicle can  
be controlled with this system.  
Notice: Hanging heavy equipment from the power  
outlet can cause damage not covered by the vehicle  
warranty. The power outlets are designed for  
accessory power plugs only, such as cell phone  
charge cords.  
Analog Clock  
The analog clock is located on the instrument panel  
above the radio. The clock is not connected with any  
other vehicle system and runs by itself. To adjust the  
clock:  
1. Locate the adjustment button directly below the  
clock face.  
Dual Climate Control System  
2. Push and hold the adjustment button to advance  
the clock hands. Holding the button down will  
cause the clock to advance faster. Release the  
button before reaching the desired time.  
3. Push and release the button to increase the time  
by one minute increments until the desired time is  
reached.  
4-34  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
To use automatic operation:  
1. Turn the fan control to the AUTO position.  
2. Turn the air delivery mode to the AUTO position.  
3. Adjust the temperature to a comfortable setting  
between 21°C (68°F) and 26°C (78°F).  
Choosing the coldest or warmest temperature  
setting will not cause the system to heat or cool  
any faster. In cold weather, the system will start  
at reduced fan speeds to avoid blowing cold air  
into the vehicle until warmer air is available. The  
system starts out blowing air at the floor but may  
change modes automatically as the vehicle warms  
up to maintain the chosen temperature setting. The  
length of time needed to warm the interior depends  
on the outside temperature and temperature of the  
vehicle.  
Dual Climate Control System for Vehicles with Rear  
Climate Control  
A. Fan Control  
B. Display  
E. Air Conditioning  
F. Outside Air or AUX  
G. Recirculation  
C. Air Delivery Mode  
Control  
4. Wait 20 to 30 minutes for the system to stabilize  
in order for the system to regulate automatically.  
Then adjust the temperature as necessary to find  
your comfort setting.  
H. PASS (Passenger  
Climate Control)  
D. Driver and Passenger  
Temperature Controls  
I. Rear Window Defogger  
Do not cover the solar sensor located in the center of  
the instrument panel near the windshield. For more  
information on the solar sensor, see Sensorslater in  
this section.  
Automatic Operation  
AUTO 9 (Automatic Fan): When this position is  
selected on the fan control, the system adjusts the fan  
speed.  
After the vehicle is started, the display shows the  
interior temperature settings and the outside  
temperature.  
4-35  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
If the AUTO position is selected on the fan or mode  
control, the system automatically controls the air  
conditioning compressor. The A/C compressor will run  
automatically even at cool outside temperatures in order  
to dehumidify the air. The A/C indicator light is lit when  
the system is operating automatically, even at near  
Manual Operation  
9 (Off): Turns the entire climate control system off.  
Outside air still enters the vehicle and is directed to the  
floor. The airflow direction and temperature can be  
adjusted, as indicated below.  
If the temperature is adjusted while the system is off,  
the display will light to show the current settings.  
freezing outside temperatures. Press # on the fan  
control to turn off the A/C. For improved window  
clearing performance in defog or defrost modes, the  
A/C compressor runs automatically.  
w x (Driver's Temperature Controls): Press the up  
or down buttons next to the fan control to manually  
increase or decrease the temperature inside the  
vehicle.  
h (AUTO RECIRCULATION): If the AUTO position is  
selected on either the fan or air delivery mode control,  
the system automatically controls the air inlet to supply  
fresh outside air or recirculate the interior air to cool the  
car faster. The light on the recirculation button will come  
on when the system changes to recirculation. Outside  
w x (Passenger's Temperature Controls): Press the  
up or down buttons next to the air delivery mode control  
to manually increase or decrease the temperature for  
the front passenger. If the passenger climate control  
system is off, pressing one of these buttons turns it on.  
air can be forced by pressing h when the light is lit.  
For vehicles without rear climate controls, press : to  
force outside air. The next time AUTO fan or mode is  
selected, the air inlet will reset back to AUTO operation.  
9 (Fan Control): Turn clockwise or counterclockwise  
to increase or decrease the fan speed. Turning this  
control completely counterclockwise will turn on the  
automatic fan operation. If the airflow seems low when  
the fan speed is at the highest setting, the passenger  
compartment air filter may need to be replaced. See  
Passenger Compartment Air Filter on page 442.  
4-36  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Air Delivery Mode Control: Turn clockwise or  
counterclockwise to change the current airflow mode.  
0 (Defrost): This mode clears the windshield of fog  
or frost more quickly. Air is directed to the windshield  
and side window outlets. When selected, the system  
automatically turns off recirculation and runs the  
air conditioning compressor, unless the outside  
temperature is at or below freezing. Recirculation  
cannot be selected while in the defrost mode. Do not  
drive the vehicle until all the windows are clear.  
Select one of the following:  
AUTO: Turns on the automatic delivery mode  
operation.  
F (Vent): Air is directed to the instrument panel outlets.  
* (Bi-Level): Air is divided between the instrument  
panel and the floor outlets. In automatic operation,  
cooler air is directed to the upper outlets and warmer air  
to the floor outlets.  
For professional vehicles, air will be allowed to flow  
through the rear outlets. For quicker defrost, press the  
AUX button on the front climate control system so that  
the light is not lit.  
7 (Floor): Air is directed to the floor outlets with  
some air directed to the side window outlets and the  
windshield.  
# (Air Conditioning): Press to turn the air  
conditioning system on or off and override the  
automatic system. When in AUTO, the air conditioning  
compressor comes on automatically, as necessary.  
To avoid window fogging on rainy and humid days at  
temperatures above freezing, run the air conditioning.  
If recirculation is selected, it only stays on for  
three minutes to reduce windshield fogging.  
W (Floor/Defog): This mode clears the windows of  
fog or moisture. Air is directed to the floor outlets,  
with some air going to the side window outlets and  
windshield. When selected, the system turns off  
recirculation and runs the air conditioning compressor  
unless the outside temperature is at or below freezing.  
The recirculation mode cannot be selected while in the  
floor/defog mode.  
The air conditioning system removes moisture from  
the air, so a small amount of water may drip under the  
vehicle while idling or after turning off the engine. This  
is normal.  
4-37  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
PASS (Passenger Climate Control): Press to turn the  
passenger climate control systems on or off. When the  
passenger climate control system is on, the passenger  
temperature setting is displayed. The temperature  
selected by the front passenger also controls the rear  
system air temperature unless the rear seat passengers  
select their own comfort setting.  
: (Outside Air): Press to turn the outside air mode  
on or off. An indicator light comes on to show it is on.  
Air is pulled from outside the vehicle. Pressing ? will  
cancel this mode.  
? (Recirculation): Press to turn the recirculation  
mode on or off. An indicator light below the button  
comes on to show that this mode is on. This mode  
recirculates and helps to quickly cool the air inside the  
vehicle. It can be used to prevent outside air and odors  
from entering the vehicle. This mode cannot be selected  
while in the defog or defrost modes. If you try to select  
the recirculation mode, the indicator light flashes  
three times and turns off.  
If the PASS button is pressed to turn the passenger  
temperature setting off, the driver's temperature knob  
will control the temperature for the entire vehicle.  
Rear Window Defogger  
The rear window defogger uses a warming grid to  
remove fog or frost from the rear window.  
Operation in this mode during periods of high humidity  
and cool outside temperatures may result in increased  
window fogging. If window fogging is experienced,  
select the defrost mode.  
< (Rear Defogger): Press to turn the rear window  
defogger on or off. Be sure to clear as much snow from  
the rear window as possible. The rear window defogger  
will turn off approximately 20 minutes after the button  
is pressed if the vehicle is moving at slower vehicle  
speeds. At higher vehicle speeds, the rear defogger  
may stay on continuously. Each additional press will run  
the defogger for approximately 10 minutes.  
AUX: For vehicles with a rear climate control system,  
press to turn the rear climate control fan on for  
automatic operation. After the AUX button is pressed,  
the indicator light comes on. Press the button again to  
turn the auxiliary fan off. See Rear Climate Control  
System on page 440.  
4-38  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The heated outside rearview mirrors will turn on to help  
clear fog or frost from the surface of the mirror when the  
rear window defogger is on.  
There is also an interior  
temperature sensor  
located next to the  
steering wheel that  
measures the temperature  
of the air inside the  
vehicle.  
Notice: Do not use a razor blade or sharp object  
to clear the inside rear window. Do not adhere  
anything to the defogger grid lines in the rear glass.  
These actions may damage the rear defogger.  
Repairs would not be covered by your warranty.  
Sensors  
There is also an exterior temperature sensor located  
behind the front grille. This sensor reads the outside air  
temperature and helps maintain the temperature inside  
the vehicle. Any cover on the front of the vehicle could  
cause a false reading in the displayed temperature.  
The solar sensor, located in the defrost grille, middle of  
the instrument panel, monitors the solar radiation. Do  
not cover the solar sensor or the system will not work  
properly.  
4-39  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
In order to prevent false temperature readings at  
startup, the displayed temperature will not change until  
the following occurs:  
Operation Tips  
.
Clear away any ice, snow or leaves from the air  
inlets at the base of the windshield that may block  
the flow of air into your vehicle.  
.
Vehicle speed is above 16 km/h (10 mph) for  
5 minutes.  
.
.
Use of non-GM approved hood deflectors may  
adversely affect the performance of the system.  
.
Vehicle speed is above 51 km/h (32 mph) for 2 and  
a half minutes.  
Keep the path under the front seats clear of  
objects to help circulate the air inside of your  
vehicle more effectively.  
The climate control system uses the information from  
these sensors to maintain your comfort setting by  
adjusting the outlet temperature, fan speed, and the  
air delivery mode. The system may also supply cooler  
air to the side of the vehicle facing the sun. The  
recirculation mode will also be used as needed to  
maintain cool outlet temperatures.  
Rear Climate Control System  
For vehicles with a rear climate control system, the rear  
seat passengers can adjust the direction of the airflow,  
fan speed and temperature for the rear seating area.  
This system also works with the main climate control  
system in the vehicle.  
Outlet Adjustment  
For the front outlets, use the thumbwheel located below  
each outlet to change the direction of the airflow. Use  
the thumbwheel located next to the outlets to shut the  
airflow or to open the outlets and re-direct the air.  
For the rear outlets, slide the lever left or right and up or  
down to change the direction of the airflow.  
4-40  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
To adjust the rear climate control system, the rear  
passenger can select a different temperature, mode  
or fan speed. Whenever the rear passengers have  
adjusted settings on the rear climate control system,  
the AUX light is lit on the front climate control system.  
When the front climate control system is turned off or in  
defrost mode, the rear climate control system is turned  
off. The rear system will turn back on once another front  
mode is selected.  
For more information on how to use the front climate  
control system, see Dual Climate Control System on  
page 434. For more information on the air outlets, see  
Outlet Adjustment on page 440.  
Automatic Operation  
The rear climate control system is located on the back  
of the center console.  
« A ª (Fan Control): Press until AUTO appears  
on the display to place the system in automatic mode.  
When automatic operation is active, the system  
automatically controls the fan speed. If in auto fan  
mode, pressing the up arrow button will cancel  
automatic operation and places the system in manual  
mode. If in auto mode, pressing the down arrow will  
turn the rear climate control system off.  
A. Display  
C. Temperature Control  
B. Fan Control D. Air Delivery Mode Control  
AUX (Auxiliary): Press the AUX button located on  
the front climate control panel to turn the rear climate  
control system on or off. When turned on the rear  
system operates in automatic mode and the  
temperature settings selected for the front climate  
control panel will also be selected for the rear  
passengers.  
« N ª (Air Delivery Mode Control): Press until  
AUTO appears on the display to place the system in  
automatic mode. When automatic operation is active,  
the system controls the air delivery mode.  
4-41  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Manual Operation  
Passenger Compartment Air Filter  
« A ª (Fan Control): Press to increase or  
The passenger compartment air filter traps most of the  
pollen from the air entering the vehicle. The filter may  
need to be changed periodically. For how often to  
change the passenger compartment air filter, see  
Scheduled Maintenance on page 73.  
decrease the fan speed.  
« b ª (Temperature Control): Press to increase or  
decrease the temperature for the rear seat passengers.  
Once the rear temperature setting is changed from  
following the front temperature setting, it will no longer  
follow changes to the front temperature setting until the  
front climate control AUX button resets it.  
« N ª (Air Delivery Mode Control): Press these  
buttons to change the air delivery mode. If in AUTO  
air delivery mode, pressing the up arrow button will  
cancel automatic operation and place the system in  
manual mode.  
Y (Vent): Air is directed to the upper outlets.  
% (Bi-Level): Air is divided between the upper outlets  
and the floor outlets.  
[ (Floor): Air is directed to the floor outlets.  
The access panel for the passenger compartment air  
filter is located under the hood near the windshield, on  
the passenger's side of the vehicle.  
4-42  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
To access the passenger compartment air filter:  
2. Then, insert a tool behind the push pin located on  
the inboard side of the air filter compartment to  
carefully pry the pin out.  
1. Use a tool to remove the cover. If the vehicle has  
tabs that allow the cover to be unlatched with your  
fingers, a tool will not be needed for this step.  
4-43  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Warning Lights, Gauges, and  
Indicators  
Warning lights and gauges can signal that something is  
wrong before it becomes serious enough to cause an  
expensive repair or replacement. Paying attention to the  
warning lights and gauges could prevent injury.  
Warning lights come on when there might be or there is  
a problem with one of the vehicle's functions. Some  
warning lights come on briefly when the engine is  
started to indicate they are working.  
Gauges can indicate when there might be or there is  
a problem with one of the vehicle's functions. Often  
gauges and warning lights work together to indicate a  
problem with the vehicle.  
3. To remove the air filter, insert a tool between the  
air filter and the compartment wall on the outboard  
side of the vehicle. Then, push in to flatten the pin  
holding the air filter in place. Gently remove the air  
filter and any loose debris that may be inside the  
air filter compartment.  
When one of the warning lights comes on and stays on  
while driving, or when one of the gauges shows there  
could be a problem, check the section that explains  
what to do. Follow this manual's advice. Waiting to do  
repairs can be costly and even dangerous.  
4. Insert the new air filter by pushing until you hear a  
click. Then, reinstall the push pin and snap the  
cover into place.  
4-44  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Instrument Panel Cluster  
English Shown, Metric Similar  
4-45  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Speedometer and Odometer  
Tachometer  
The speedometer shows the speed in both miles  
per hour (mph) and kilometers per hour (km/h). See  
MPH (km)under DIC Operation and Displays on  
page 460 for more information.  
This gauge indicates  
the engine speed  
in revolutions per  
minute (rpm).  
The odometer mileage can be checked without the  
vehicle running. The vehicle's odometer works together  
with the driver information center. Trip A and Trip B can  
be set on the odometer. See Trip Fuelunder DIC  
Operation and Displays on page 460 for more  
information.  
If the vehicle ever needs a new odometer installed, the  
new one is set to the correct mileage total of the old  
odometer.  
4-46  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Passenger Safety Belt Reminder Light  
Safety Belt Reminders  
For vehicles equipped with the passenger safety belt  
reminder light, several seconds after the engine is  
started, a chime sounds for several seconds to remind  
the front passenger to buckle their safety belt. The  
passenger safety belt light, located on the instrument  
panel, comes on and stays on for several seconds and  
then flashes for several more.  
Driver Safety Belt Reminder Light  
When the engine is started, a chime sounds for  
several seconds to remind a driver to fasten the safety  
belt, unless the driver safety belt is already buckled.  
The safety belt light  
comes on and stays on  
for several seconds, then  
flashes for several more.  
This chime and light are  
repeated if the passenger  
remains unbuckled and  
the vehicle is in motion.  
This chime and light are repeated if the driver remains  
unbuckled and the vehicle is in motion. If the driver  
safety belt is already buckled, neither the chime nor the  
light comes on.  
If the passenger safety belt is buckled, neither the  
chime nor the light comes on.  
The front passenger safety belt warning light and chime  
may turn on if an object is put on the seat such as a  
briefcase, handbag, grocery bag, laptop or other  
electronic device. To turn off the warning light and or  
chime, remove the object from the seat or buckle the  
safety belt.  
4-47  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
If there is a problem with the airbag system, an airbag  
Driver Information Center (DIC) message can also  
come on. See DIC Warnings and Messages on  
page 465 for more information.  
Airbag Readiness Light  
The system checks the airbag's electrical system for  
possible malfunctions. If the light stays on it indicates  
there is an electrical problem. The system check  
includes the airbag sensor, the pretensioners, the  
airbag modules, the wiring and the crash sensing and  
diagnostic module. For more information on the airbag  
system, see Airbag System on page 254.  
Passenger Airbag Status Indicator  
The vehicle has the passenger sensing system. See  
Passenger Sensing System on page 264 for important  
safety information. The overhead console has a  
passenger airbag status indicator.  
The airbag readiness light  
flashes for a few seconds  
when the engine is  
started. If the light does  
not come on then, have it  
fixed immediately.  
United States  
Canada  
WARNING:  
{
When the vehicle is started, the passenger airbag  
status indicator will light ON and OFF, or the symbol for  
on and off, for several seconds as a system check.  
If the airbag readiness light stays on after the  
vehicle is started or comes on while driving, it  
means the airbag system might not be working  
properly. The airbags in the vehicle might not  
inflate in a crash, or they could even inflate  
without a crash. To help avoid injury, have the  
vehicle serviced right away.  
If you are using remote start to start the vehicle from a  
distance, if equipped, you may not see the system  
check.  
4-48  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Then, after several more seconds, the status indicator  
will light either ON or OFF, or either the on or off  
symbol, to let you know the status of the right front  
passenger frontal and seat-mounted side impact  
airbags.  
WARNING:  
{
If the airbag readiness light ever comes on and  
stays on, it means that something may be wrong  
with the airbag system. To help avoid injury to  
yourself or others, have the vehicle serviced right  
away. See Airbag Readiness Light on page 448  
for more information, including important safety  
information.  
If the word ON or the on symbol is lit on the passenger  
airbag status indicator, it means that the right front  
passenger frontal airbag and seat-mounted side impact  
airbag are enabled (may inflate).  
If the word OFF or the off symbol is lit on the passenger  
airbag status indicator, it means that the passenger  
sensing system has turned off the right front passenger  
frontal and seatmounted side impact airbag.  
Charging System Light  
If, after several seconds, both status indicator lights  
remain on, or if there are no lights at all, there may be  
a problem with the lights or the passenger sensing  
system. See your dealer for service.  
This light comes on briefly  
when the ignition key is  
turned to START, but the  
engine is not running, as  
a check to show it is  
working.  
If it does not, have the vehicle serviced by your dealer.  
The light should go out once the engine starts. If it stays  
on, or comes on while driving, there could be a problem  
with the charging system. A charging system message  
in the Driver Information Center (DIC) can also appear.  
4-49  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
See DIC Warnings and Messages on page 465 for  
more information. This light could indicate that there are  
problems with a generator drive belt, or that there is an  
electrical problem. Have it checked right away. If the  
vehicle must be driven a short distance with the light  
on, turn off accessories, such as the radio and air  
conditioner.  
When the ignition is on, the brake system warning light  
also comes on when the parking brake is set. The light  
will stay on if the parking brake does not release fully.  
If it stays on after the parking brake is fully released, it  
means there is a brake problem.  
If the light comes on while driving, pull off the road and  
stop carefully.The pedal may be harder to push, or the  
pedal may go closer to the floor. It may take longer to  
stop. If the light is still on, have the vehicle towed for  
service. See Towing Your Vehicle on page 524.  
Brake System Warning Light  
The vehicle brake system consists of two hydraulic  
circuits. If one circuit is not working, the remaining  
circuit can still work to stop the vehicle. For normal  
braking performance, both circuits need to be working.  
WARNING:  
{
If the warning light comes on, there is a brake problem.  
Have the brake system inspected right away.  
The brake system might not be working properly if  
the brake system warning light is on. Driving with  
the brake system warning light on can lead to a  
crash. If the light is still on after the vehicle has  
been pulled off the road and carefully stopped,  
have the vehicle towed for service.  
English  
Metric  
This light comes on briefly when the engine is turned  
on. If it does not come on then, have it fixed so it will be  
ready to warn if there is a problem.  
4-50  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
For vehicles with a Driver Information Center (DIC), see  
DIC Warnings and Messages on page 465 for all  
brake related DIC messages.  
Antilock Brake System (ABS)  
Warning Light  
For vehicles with the  
Traction Control System (TCS)  
Warning Light  
Antilock Brake System  
(ABS), this light comes on  
briefly when the engine is  
started.  
This warning light comes  
on briefly while starting  
the engine.  
If it does not, have the vehicle serviced by your dealer.  
If the system is working normally the indicator light then  
goes off.  
If the ABS light stays on, turn the ignition off. If the light  
comes on while driving, stop as soon as it is safely  
possible and turn the ignition off. Then start the engine  
again to reset the system. If the ABS light stays on,  
or comes on again while driving, the vehicle needs  
service. If the regular brake system warning light is not  
on, the vehicle still has brakes, but not antilock brakes.  
If the regular brake system warning light is also on, the  
vehicle does not have antilock brakes and there is a  
problem with the regular brakes. See Brake System  
Warning Light on page 450.  
If it does not, have the vehicle serviced by your dealer.  
If the system is working normally the indicator light will  
then go off.  
If it stays on, or comes on while driving, there may be a  
problem with the traction control system and the vehicle  
needs service. When this warning light is on, the  
system will not limit wheel spin.  
If the traction control system warning light comes on  
and stays on when the system is turned on, the vehicle  
needs service. See Traction Control System (TCS) on  
page 56 for more information.  
4-51  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
StabiliTrak® Indicator Light  
Lane Departure Warning (LDW) Light  
For vehicles with the  
For vehicles with the  
lane departure warning  
system, this light briefly  
comes on green while  
starting the vehicle.  
StabiliTrak® system, this  
light comes on briefly  
while starting the engine.  
If it does not, have the vehicle serviced by your dealer.  
If the system is working normally the indicator light then  
goes off.  
If the light comes on and stays on while driving, there  
could be a problem with the StabiliTrak® system and the  
vehicle might need service. When this warning light is  
on, the StabiliTrak® system is off and does not limit  
wheel spin.  
If it does not, have the vehicle serviced by your dealer.  
If the system is working normally the indicator light then  
goes off.  
This light also comes on green if the system detects a  
left or right lane marking. It flashes, changes to amber,  
and three beeps sound, if a detected lane marking  
is crossed without using a turn signal. For more  
information, see the Index in the Navigation Manual.  
The light flashes if the system is active and is working  
to assist the driver with directional control of the vehicle  
in difficult driving conditions.  
See StabiliTrak® System on page 56 for more  
information.  
4-52  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Engine Coolant Temperature  
Warning Light  
Engine Coolant Temperature Gauge  
This gauge shows  
the engine coolant  
temperature.  
The engine coolant  
temperature warning light  
comes on when the  
engine is very hot.  
This light also comes on briefly when the vehicle is  
started.  
It indicates when the engine has warmed up and if  
the cooling system is operating properly. If the gauge  
pointer moves into the shaded area, the engine coolant  
is too hot and the engine coolant temperature warning  
light comes on. See Engine Overheating on page 629  
for more information.  
If the light does not go out or comes on and stays on  
while driving, there may be a problem with the cooling  
system. Driving with engine coolant temperature light on  
could cause the vehicle to overheat, see Overheated  
Engine Protection Operating Mode on page 631. See  
Engine Overheating on page 629 and DIC Warnings  
and Messages on page 465 for more information.  
4-53  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
When the Light Flashes First and Then is  
On Steady  
Tire Pressure Light  
For vehicles with a Tire  
Pressure Monitoring  
System, this light comes  
on briefly when the engine  
is started. It provides  
information about tire  
pressures and the Tire  
Pressure Monitoring  
System.  
This indicates that there may be a problem with the Tire  
Pressure Monitor System. The light flashes for about a  
minute and stays on steady for the remainder of the  
ignition cycle. This sequence repeats with every ignition  
cycle. See Tire Pressure Monitor Operation on  
page 661 for more information.  
Malfunction Indicator Lamp  
When the Light is On Steady  
A computer system called OBD II (On-Board  
Diagnostics-Second Generation) monitors operation  
of the fuel, ignition, and emission control systems.  
It ensures that emissions are at acceptable levels for  
the life of the vehicle, helping to produce a cleaner  
environment.  
This indicates that one or more of the tires is  
significantly underinflated.  
A tire pressure message in the Driver Information  
Center (DIC), can accompany the light. See Driver  
Information Center (DIC) on page 459 for more  
information. Stop and check the tires as soon as it is  
safe to do so. If underinflated, inflate to the proper  
pressure. See Inflation - Tire Pressure on page 657  
for more information.  
This light should come on  
when the ignition is on,  
but the engine is not  
running, as a check to  
show it is working. If it  
does not, have the vehicle  
serviced by your dealer.  
If the Malfunction Indicator Lamp comes on and stays  
on, while the engine is running, this indicates that there  
is an OBD II problem and service is required.  
4-54  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Malfunctions often are indicated by the system before  
any problem is apparent. Being aware of the light can  
prevent more serious damage to the vehicle. This  
system assists the service technician in correctly  
diagnosing any malfunction.  
To prevent more serious damage to the vehicle:  
.
Reduce vehicle speed.  
.
Avoid hard accelerations.  
.
Avoid steep uphill grades.  
.
Notice: If the vehicle is continually driven with this  
light on, after a while, the emission controls might  
not work as well, the vehicle fuel economy might  
not be as good, and the engine might not run as  
smoothly. This could lead to costly repairs that  
might not be covered by the vehicle warranty.  
If towing a trailer, reduce the amount of cargo  
being hauled as soon as it is possible.  
If the light continues to flash, when it is safe to do so,  
stop the vehicle. Find a safe place to park the vehicle.  
Turn the vehicle off, wait at least 10 seconds, and  
restart the engine. If the light is still flashing, follow the  
previous steps and see your dealer for service as soon  
as possible.  
Notice: Modifications made to the engine,  
transmission, exhaust, intake, or fuel system of  
the vehicle or the replacement of the original tires  
with other than those of the same Tire Performance  
Criteria (TPC) can affect the vehicle's emission  
controls and can cause this light to come on.  
Modifications to these systems could lead to costly  
repairs not covered by the vehicle warranty. This  
could also result in a failure to pass a required  
Emission Inspection/Maintenance test. See  
Accessories and Modifications on page 63.  
Light On Steady: An emission control system  
malfunction has been detected on the vehicle.  
Diagnosis and service might be required.  
An emission system malfunction might be corrected by  
doing the following:  
.
Make sure the fuel cap is fully installed. See Filling  
the Tank on page 68. The diagnostic system  
can determine if the fuel cap has been left off or  
improperly installed. A loose or missing fuel cap  
allows fuel to evaporate into the atmosphere. A few  
driving trips with the cap properly installed should  
turn the light off.  
This light comes on during a malfunction in one of  
two ways:  
Light Flashing: A misfire condition has been detected.  
A misfire increases vehicle emissions and could  
damage the emission control system on the vehicle.  
Diagnosis and service might be required.  
4-55  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
.
.
If the vehicle has been driven through a deep  
puddle of water, the vehicle's electrical system  
might be wet. The condition is usually corrected  
when the electrical system dries out. A few driving  
trips should turn the light off.  
Emissions Inspection and Maintenance  
Programs  
Some state/provincial and local governments may have  
programs to inspect the on-vehicle emission control  
equipment For the inspection, the emission system  
test equipment is connected to the vehicles Data Link  
Connector (DLC).  
Make sure to fuel the vehicle with quality fuel.  
Poor fuel quality causes the engine not to run as  
efficiently as designed and can cause: stalling  
after start-up, stalling when the vehicle is changed  
into gear, misfiring, hesitation on acceleration,  
or stumbling on acceleration. These conditions  
might go away once the engine is warmed up.  
If one or more of these conditions occurs, change  
the fuel brand used. It will require at least one full  
tank of the proper fuel to turn the light off.  
See Gasoline Octane on page 65.  
The DLC is under the instrument panel to the left  
of the steering wheel. See your dealer if assistance is  
needed.  
If none of the above have made the light turn off,  
your dealer can check the vehicle. The dealer has the  
proper test equipment and diagnostic tools to fix any  
mechanical or electrical problems that might have  
developed.  
The vehicle may not pass inspection if:  
.
the Malfunction Indicator Lamp is on with the  
engine running, or if the light does not come on  
when the ignition is turned to ON/RUN while the  
engine is off.  
4-56  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
.
the critical emission control systems have not been  
completely diagnosed by the system. This can  
happen if the battery has recently been replaced or  
if the battery has run down. The diagnostic system  
evaluates critical emission control systems during  
normal driving. This can take several days of  
routine driving. If this has been done and the  
vehicle still does not pass the inspection, your  
dealer can prepare the vehicle for inspection.  
Notice: Lack of proper engine oil maintenance  
can damage the engine. The repairs would not be  
covered by the vehicle warranty. Always follow the  
maintenance schedule for changing engine oil.  
This light comes on briefly while starting the engine.  
If it does not, have the vehicle serviced by your dealer.  
If the system is working normally the indicator light then  
goes off.  
If the light comes on and stays on, it means that oil is  
not flowing through the engine properly. The vehicle  
could be low on oil and it might have some other  
system problem.  
Oil Pressure Light  
Security Light  
For information regarding  
this light and the vehicle's  
security system, see  
Content Theft-Deterrent  
on page 319  
.
WARNING:  
{
Do not keep driving if the oil pressure is low. The  
engine can become so hot that it catches fire.  
Someone could be burned. Check the oil as soon  
as possible and have the vehicle serviced.  
4-57  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Front Fog Lamp Light  
Cruise Control Light  
The fog lamp light comes  
on when the fog lamps  
are in use.  
This light comes on  
whenever the cruise  
control is set.  
The light goes out when the fog lamps are turned off.  
See Fog Lamps on page 429 for more information.  
The light goes out when the cruise control is turned off.  
See Cruise Control on page 412 and Adaptive Cruise  
Control on page 414 for more information.  
Lights On Reminder  
Highbeam On Light  
This light comes on  
whenever the parking  
lamps are on.  
This light comes on when  
the high-beam headlamps  
are in use.  
See Exterior Lamps on page 425 for more information.  
See Headlamp High/Low-Beam Changer on page 46  
for more information.  
4-58  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
.
It takes a little more or less fuel to fill the tank than  
the gauge indicated. For example, the gauge may  
have indicated that the tank was half full, but it  
actually took a little more or less than half the  
tank's capacity to fill the tank.  
Fuel Gauge  
The fuel gauge shows  
approximately how much  
fuel is in the tank. It works  
only when the engine  
is on.  
Driver Information Center (DIC)  
The Driver Information Center (DIC) gives you the  
status of many of your vehicle's systems. The DIC is  
also used to display warning/status messages. All  
messages will appear in the DIC display located at  
the bottom of the instrument panel cluster, below the  
tachometer and speedometer. The DIC buttons are  
located on the instrument panel, to the left of the  
steering wheel.  
An arrow on the fuel gauge indicates the side of the  
vehicle the fuel door is on.  
The DIC comes on when the ignition is on. After a short  
delay, the DIC will display the information that was last  
displayed before the engine was turned off.  
If the fuel supply gets low, the FUEL LEVEL LOW  
message appears in the Driver Information Center  
and a single chime sounds. See DIC Warnings and  
Messages on page 465 for more information.  
The top line of the DIC display shows the vehicle  
system information and the warning/status messages.  
The bottom line of the DIC display shows the odometer  
on the left side. The bottom line of the DIC display also  
shows a digital speedometer on the right side.  
Here are a few situations that may occur with the fuel  
gauge. All of these situations are normal and do not  
indicate that anything is wrong with the fuel gauge:  
.
At the gas station the gas pump shuts off before  
the gauge reads full.  
If a problem is detected, a warning message will appear  
on the display. Be sure to take any message that  
appears on the display seriously and remember that  
clearing the message will only make the message  
disappear, not correct the problem.  
.
The gauge may change when the vehicle is  
turning, stops quickly or accelerates quickly.  
4-59  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
y z Menu Up/Down: Press this button to scroll up  
DIC Operation and Displays  
and down the menu items.  
The Driver Information  
Center (DIC) has different  
displays which can be  
accessed by pressing the  
DIC buttons located on  
the instrument panel, to  
the left of the steering  
wheel.  
Trip/Fuel Display Menu Items  
3 (Trip/Fuel): The following display menu items can  
be displayed by pressing the trip/fuel button:  
TRIP A or TRIP B  
These displays show the current distance traveled  
since the last reset for each trip odometer in either  
kilometers (km) or miles (mi). Both odometers can be  
used at the same time. Each trip odometer can be reset  
to zero separately by pressing and holding the set/reset  
button for a few seconds while the desired trip odometer  
is displayed.  
3 Trip/Fuel: Press this button to scroll through the  
trip and fuel displays. See Trip/Fuel Display Menu  
Itemsfollowing for more information on these displays.  
FUEL RANGE  
T Vehicle Information: Press this button to scroll  
through the vehicle information displays. See Vehicle  
Information Display Menu Itemsfollowing for more  
information on these displays.  
This display shows the approximate number of  
remaining kilometers (km) or miles (mi) you can drive  
without refilling the fuel tank. This estimate is based on  
the current driving conditions and will change if the  
driving conditions change. For example, if you are  
driving in traffic and making frequent stops, the display  
may read one number, but if you enter the freeway, the  
number may change even though you still have the  
same amount of fuel in the fuel tank. This is because  
different driving conditions produce different fuel  
economies. Generally, freeway driving produces better  
fuel economy than city driving.  
U Customization: Press this button to scroll through  
each of the customization features. See DIC Vehicle  
Customization on page 477 for more information on  
the customization features.  
V Set/Reset: Press this button to reset certain DIC  
features and to acknowledge DIC warning messages  
and clear them from the DIC display.  
4-60  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Once the range drops below an estimated 64 km  
(40 miles) remaining, the display will show FUEL  
RANGE LOW.  
TIMER ON/OFF  
This display can be used like a stopwatch. You can  
record the time it takes to travel from one point to  
another. To access the timer, press the trip/fuel button  
until 00:00:00 TIMER OFF displays.  
If your vehicle is low on fuel, the FUEL LEVEL LOW  
message will be displayed. See FUEL LEVEL LOW”  
under DIC Warnings and Messages on page 465 for  
more information.  
To turn on the timer, press the set/reset button until  
TIMER ON displays. The timer will then start.  
AVERAGE ECONOMY (AFE)  
To turn off the timer, press the set/reset button again  
until TIMER OFF displays. The timer will stop and  
display the end timing value.  
This display shows the approximate average liters per  
100 kilometers (L/100 km) or miles per gallon (mpg).  
This number is calculated based on the number of  
L/100 km (mpg) recorded since the last time this display  
was reset. To reset this display, press the set/reset  
button. The display will return to zero.  
To reset the timer, press and hold the set/reset button  
after the timer has been stopped. The display will return  
to zero.  
AVERAGE SPEED  
INST (Instantaneous) ECONOMY (IFE)  
This display shows the average speed of the vehicle  
in either kilometers per hour (km/h) or miles per  
hour (mph). This average is calculated based on the  
various vehicle speeds recorded since the last reset of  
this display. To reset this display, press the set/reset  
button. The display will return to zero.  
This display shows the current fuel economy in either  
liters per 100 kilometers (L/100 km) or miles per  
gallon (mpg). This number reflects only the fuel  
economy that the vehicle has right now and will  
change frequently as driving conditions change.  
Unlike average economy, this display cannot be reset.  
FUEL USED  
This display shows the number of liters (L) or  
gallons (gal) of fuel used since the last reset of this  
display. To reset this display, press the set/reset button.  
The display will return to zero.  
4-61  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
BATTERY VOLTAGE  
Vehicle Information Display Menu Items  
This display shows the current battery voltage. If the  
voltage is in the normal range, the value will display. For  
example, the display may read BATTERY VOLTAGE  
13.2 VOLTS. If the voltage is low, the display will show  
LOW. If the voltage is high, the display will show HIGH.  
Your vehicle's charging system regulates voltage based  
on the state of the battery. The battery voltage may  
fluctuate when viewing this information on the DIC. This  
is normal. See Charging System Light on page 449 for  
more information.  
T (Vehicle Information): The following display  
menu items can be displayed by pressing the vehicle  
information button:  
OIL LIFE REMAINING  
If the vehicle has this display, it shows the estimated oil  
life remaining. If you see 99% OIL LIFE REMAINING on  
the display, that means that 99% of the current oil life  
remains.  
When the oil life is depleted, the CHANGE ENGINE OIL  
SOON message will appear on the display. You should  
change the oil as soon as possible. In addition to the  
engine oil life system monitoring the oil life, additional  
maintenance is recommended in the Maintenance  
Schedule in this manual. See Scheduled Maintenance  
on page 73 and Engine Oil on page 615.  
If there is a problem with the battery charging system,  
the DIC will display a message. See DIC Warnings  
and Messages on page 465 and Electric Power  
Management on page 432 for more information.  
Blank Display  
This display shows no information.  
Remember, you must reset the OIL LIFE yourself after  
each oil change. It will not reset itself. Also, be careful  
not to reset the OIL LIFE accidentally at any time other  
than when the oil has just been changed. It cannot be  
reset accurately until the next oil change. To reset the  
engine oil life system, See Engine Oil Life System on  
page 618. The display will show 100% when the  
system is reset.  
4-62  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
UNITS  
SIDE BLIND ZONE ALERT  
This display allows you to select between English or  
Metric units of measurement. Once in this display, press  
the set/reset button to select between ENGLISH or  
METRIC units.  
If your vehicle has the Side Blind Zone Alert (SBZA)  
system, this display allows the system to be turned on  
or off. Once in this display, press the set/reset button  
to select between ON or OFF. If you choose ON, the  
system will be turned on. If you choose OFF, the system  
will be turned off. When the SBZA system is turned off,  
the DIC will display the SIDE BLIND ZONE ALERT  
SYSTEM OFF message as a reminder that the system  
has been turned off. See DIC Warnings and Messages  
on page 465 and Side Blind Zone Alert (SBZA) on  
page 342 for more information.  
PARKING ASSIST  
If your vehicle has the Ultrasonic Front and Rear  
Parking Assist (UFRPA) system, this display allows  
the system to be turned on or off. Once in this display,  
press the set/reset button to select between ON or OFF.  
If you choose ON, the system will be turned on. If you  
choose OFF, the system will be turned off. The UFRPA  
system automatically turns back on after each vehicle  
start. When the UFRPA system is turned off and the  
vehicle is shifted out of P (Park), the DIC will display the  
PARKING ASSIST OFF message as a reminder that the  
system has been turned off. See DIC Warnings and  
Messages on page 465 and Ultrasonic Front and  
Rear Parking Assist (UFRPA) on page 338 for more  
information.  
FRONT TIRES or REAR TIRES  
On vehicles with the Tire Pressure Monitor System  
(TPMS), the pressure for each tire can be viewed in the  
DIC. The tire pressure will be shown in either pounds  
per square inch (psi) or kilopascals (kPa). Press the  
vehicle information button until the DIC displays FRONT  
TIRES PSI (kPa) LEFT ## RIGHT ##. Press the vehicle  
information button again until the DIC displays REAR  
TIRES PSI (kPa) LEFT ## RIGHT ##.  
4-63  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
If a low tire pressure condition is detected by the  
system while driving, a message advising you to add  
air to a specific tire will appear in the display. See  
Inflation - Tire Pressure on page 657 and DIC  
Warnings and Messages on page 465 for more  
information.  
SPEED ALERT  
This display will allow you to customize the speed alert  
warning. You can choose to have no warning display,  
or to have it display at the limit, at 5 km/h (mph) over  
the limit, or at 10 km/h (mph) over the limit. The DIC  
will toggle between OFF, AT LIMIT, +5 , +10 (Km/h or  
MPH). Press the reset button to make your selection.  
If the tire pressure display shows dashes instead of a  
value, there may be a problem with your vehicle. If this  
consistently occurs, see your dealer for service.  
RELEARN REMOTE KEY  
This display allows you to match Remote Keyless Entry  
(RKE) transmitters to your vehicle. This procedure will  
erase all previously learned transmitters. Therefore,  
they must be relearned as additional transmitters.  
SPEED LIMIT: XXX MPH (SPEED LIMIT:  
XXX Km/h) or ADVISORY: XXX MPH  
(ADVISORY: XXX Km/h)  
This display will show the speed limit or the advised  
speed as determined by the information on the map  
disc in the navigation system. If there is no map disc in  
the navigation system, this display will not be available.  
To match an RKE transmitter to your vehicle:  
1. Press the vehicle information button until  
PRESS V TO RELEARN REMOTE KEY displays.  
2. Press the set/reset button until REMOTE KEY  
LEARNING ACTIVE is displayed.  
The speed limit and speed advisory displays on the DIC  
are for reference only. There may be segments of road  
where speed data has not been captured or times  
where incorrect speed data, or no speed data, will be  
displayed by the DIC due to the navigation system not  
correctly matching the vehicles position to the actual  
road. Be aware of this and obey posted speed limits  
wherever you drive.  
3. Press and hold the lock and unlock buttons on  
the first transmitter at the same time for about  
15 seconds.  
On vehicles with memory recall seats, the  
first transmitter learned will match driver 1 and  
the second will match driver 2.  
A chime will sound indicating that the transmitter is  
matched.  
4-64  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4. To match additional transmitters at this time,  
repeat Step 3.  
AUTOMATIC LIGHT CONTROL OFF  
This message displays when the automatic headlamps  
are turned off. See Exterior Lamps on page 425 for  
more information.  
Each vehicle can have a maximum of  
eight transmitters matched to it.  
5. To exit the programming mode, you must cycle  
the key to LOCK/OFF.  
AUTOMATIC LIGHT CONTROL ON  
This message displays when the automatic headlamps  
are turned on. See Exterior Lamps on page 425 for  
more information.  
Blank Display  
This display shows no information.  
BATTERY SAVER ACTIVE  
DIC Warnings and Messages  
This message displays when the system detects that  
the battery voltage is dropping beyond a reasonable  
level. The battery saver system starts reducing certain  
features of the vehicle that you may be able to notice.  
At the point that the features are disabled, this message  
is displayed. It means that the vehicle is trying to save  
the charge in the battery.  
These messages appear if there is a problem detected  
in one of your vehicle's systems.  
You must acknowledge a message to clear it from the  
screen for further use. To clear a message, press the  
set/reset button.  
Be sure to take any message that appears on the  
screen seriously and remember that clearing the  
message will only make the message disappear, not  
the problem.  
Turn off all unnecessary accessories to allow the  
battery to recharge.  
The normal battery voltage range is 11.5 to 15.5 volts.  
You can monitor battery voltage on the Driver  
Information Center (DIC) by pressing the trip/fuel  
button until BATTERY VOLTAGE is displayed.  
ADVISORY XXX MPH (km/h)  
This message displays when the Speed Alert has been  
turned on through the DIC Information Menu and the  
vehicle is at or above the advised speed. See DIC  
Operation and Displays on page 460.  
4-65  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
You can receive more than one tire pressure message  
at a time. To read the other messages that may have  
been sent at the same time, press the set/reset button.  
The DIC also shows the tire pressure values. See DIC  
CHANGE ENGINE OIL SOON  
This message displays when service is required for  
your vehicle. See your dealer. See Engine Oil on  
page 615 and Scheduled Maintenance on page 73  
for more information.  
Operation and Displays on page 460  
.
CLEAN RADAR  
When you reset the CHANGE ENGINE OIL SOON  
message by clearing it from the display, you still must  
reset the engine oil life system separately. For more  
information on resetting the engine oil life system, see  
Engine Oil Life System on page 618.  
This message displays when the Adaptive Cruise  
Control (ACC) system and the Forward Collision Alert  
(FCA) system are disabled because the radar is  
blocked and cannot detect vehicles in your path. It may  
also activate during heavy rain or due to road spray. To  
clean the system, see Cleaning the Systemunder  
Adaptive Cruise Control on page 414.  
CHECK TIRE PRESSURE or ADD AIR  
TO TIRE  
On vehicles with the Tire Pressure Monitor System  
(TPMS), this message displays when the pressure in  
one or more of the vehicle's tires is low. This message  
also displays LEFT FRONT, RIGHT FRONT, LEFT  
REAR, or RIGHT REAR to indicate which tire needs to  
be checked. The low tire pressure warning light will also  
come on. See Tire Pressure Light on page 454. If a  
tire pressure message appears on the DIC, stop as  
soon as you can. Have the tire pressures checked and  
set to those shown on the Tire Loading Information  
label. See Tires on page 648, Loading the Vehicle on  
CRUISE SET TO XXX MPH (km/h)  
This message displays whenever the cruise control is  
set. See Cruise Control on page 412 and Adaptive  
Cruise Control on page 414 for more information.  
If your vehicle has Adaptive Cruise Control (ACC), after  
a few seconds, this message clears and the message  
SET SPD XXdisplays at the bottom of the DIC. See  
SET SPD (Speed)later in this section.  
page 518, and Inflation - Tire Pressure on page 657  
.
4-66  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
If this message continues to appear, have the system  
repaired by your dealer as soon as possible to avoid  
damage to the engine.  
DRIVER DOOR OPEN  
This symbol appears with  
this message.  
ENGINE OVERHEATED IDLE ENGINE  
Notice: If you drive your vehicle while the engine is  
overheating, severe engine damage may occur. If an  
overheat warning appears on the instrument panel  
cluster and/or DIC, stop the vehicle as soon as  
possible. Do not increase the engine speed above  
normal idling speed. See Engine Overheating on  
page 629 for more information.  
This message displays when the driver door is not  
closed completely. Make sure that the door is closed  
completely.  
This message displays when the engine coolant  
temperature is too hot. Stop and allow the vehicle  
to idle until it cools down. See Engine Coolant  
Temperature Warning Light on page 453.  
ENGINE HOT A/C  
(Air Conditioning) OFF  
See Overheated Engine Protection Operating Mode on  
page 631 for information on driving to a safe place in  
an emergency.  
This message displays when the engine coolant  
becomes hotter than the normal operating temperature.  
See Engine Coolant Temperature Gauge on  
page 453. To avoid added strain on a hot engine, the  
air conditioning compressor automatically turns off.  
When the coolant temperature returns to normal, the  
air conditioning compressor turns back on. You can  
continue to drive your vehicle.  
4-67  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
time the vehicle is driven. The vehicle may be driven  
at a reduced speed while this message is on, but  
acceleration and speed may be reduced. Anytime this  
message stays on, the vehicle should be taken to your  
dealer for service as soon as possible.  
ENGINE OVERHEATED STOP ENGINE  
Notice: If you drive your vehicle while the engine is  
overheating, severe engine damage may occur. If an  
overheat warning appears on the instrument panel  
cluster and/or DIC, stop the vehicle as soon as  
possible. See Engine Overheating on page 629 for  
more information.  
FOLLOWING GAP  
This message displays when the engine has  
overheated. Immediately look for a safe place to pull  
your vehicle over and turn the engine off right away to  
avoid severe engine damage. See Engine Overheating  
on page 629 and Overheated Engine Protection  
Operating Mode on page 631. A chime also sounds  
when this message is displayed.  
This symbol appears with this message.  
ENGINE POWER REDUCED  
If your vehicle has Adaptive Cruise Control (ACC), this  
message displays to show the follow distance that has  
been set. There are six follow distances to choose from.  
Each follow distance is shown on the DIC by displaying  
from one to six bars between two car symbols. See  
Adaptive Cruise Control on page 414 for more  
information.  
This message displays when the engine power is being  
reduced to protect the engine from damage. There  
could be several malfunctions that might cause this  
message. Reduced engine power can affect the  
vehicle's ability to accelerate. If this message is on, but  
there is no reduction in performance, proceed to your  
destination. The performance may be reduced the next  
4-68  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
FUEL LEVEL LOW  
ICE POSSIBLE DRIVE WITH CARE  
This message displays when the outside temperature is  
cold enough to create icy road conditions. Adjust your  
driving accordingly.  
This symbol appears with  
this message.  
LANE DEPARTURE SYSTEM  
UNAVAILABLE  
If your vehicle has the Lane Departure Warning (LDW)  
system, this message may display if the LDW system  
does not activate due to a temporary condition. See  
Lane Departure Warning (LDW) on page 345 for more  
information.  
This message displays when your vehicle is low on fuel.  
Refill the fuel tank as soon as possible. A single chime  
sounds when this message is displayed. See Filling the  
Tank on page 68.  
LEFT REAR DOOR OPEN  
HOOD OPEN  
This symbol appears with  
this message.  
This symbol appears with  
this message.  
This message displays when the driver side rear door is  
not closed completely. Make sure that the door is closed  
completely.  
This message displays when the hood is not closed  
completely. Make sure that the hood is closed  
completely. See Hood Release on page 613.  
4-69  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
A multiple chime sounds when this message is  
displayed. See Engine Oil on page 615 for more  
information.  
NO CRUISE BRAKING GAS PEDAL  
APPLIED  
This message displays when the Adaptive Cruise  
Control (ACC) is engaged and you are pressing the  
accelerator pedal enough to disable ACC automatic  
braking. See Adaptive Cruise Control on page 414 for  
more information.  
Stop the vehicle immediately, as engine damage can  
result from driving a vehicle with low oil pressure. Have  
the vehicle serviced by your dealer as soon as possible  
when this message is displayed.  
PARKING ASSIST OFF  
OIL PRESSURE LOW STOP ENGINE  
If your vehicle has the Ultrasonic Front and Rear  
Parking Assist (UFRPA) system, after the vehicle is  
shifted out of P (Park), this message displays to remind  
the driver that the UFRPA system has been turned off.  
Press the set/reset button to acknowledge this message  
and clear it from the DIC display. To turn the UFRPA  
system back on, see PARKING ASSISTunder DIC  
Operation and Displays on page 460. See Ultrasonic  
Front and Rear Parking Assist (UFRPA) on page 338  
for more information.  
Notice: If you drive your vehicle while the engine  
oil pressure is low, severe engine damage may  
occur. If a low oil pressure warning appears on  
the instrument panel cluster and/or DIC, stop the  
vehicle as soon as possible. Do not drive the  
vehicle until the cause of the low oil pressure is  
corrected. See Engine Oil on page 615 for more  
information.  
This message displays when the vehicle's engine oil  
pressure is low. The oil pressure light also appears on  
the instrument panel cluster. See Oil Pressure Light on  
page 457  
.
4-70  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
PASSENGER DOOR OPEN  
REMOTE KEY LEARNING ACTIVE  
This message displays while you are matching a  
Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) transmitter to your  
vehicle. See Matching Transmitter(s) to Your Vehicle”  
under Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) System Operation  
on page 34 and DIC Operation and Displays on  
page 460 for more information.  
This symbol appears with  
this message.  
REPLACE BATTERY IN REMOTE KEY  
This message displays when the battery in the Remote  
Keyless Entry (RKE) transmitter needs to be replaced.  
To replace the battery, see Battery Replacementunder  
Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) System Operation on  
This message displays when the passenger side front  
door is not closed completely. Make sure that the door  
is closed completely.  
page 34  
.
RADAR CRUISE NOT READY  
RIGHT REAR DOOR OPEN  
This message displays when the Adaptive Cruise  
Control (ACC) system will not activate due to a  
This symbol appears with  
this message.  
temporary condition. Your vehicle does not require  
service. If this message appears when you attempt to  
activate the system, continue driving for several minutes  
and then try activating the system again. See Adaptive  
Cruise Control on page 414 for more information.  
This message displays when the passenger side rear  
door is not closed completely. Make sure that the door  
is closed completely.  
4-71  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
SERVICE AIR BAG  
SERVICE BRAKE ASSIST  
This message displays when there is a problem with  
the airbag system. Have your vehicle serviced by your  
dealer immediately. See Airbag Readiness Light on  
page 448 for more information.  
This message displays if there is a problem with the  
brake system. The brake system warning light and  
the antilock brake system warning light may also be  
displayed on the instrument panel cluster. See Brake  
System Warning Light on page 450 and Antilock  
Brake System (ABS) Warning Light on page 451 for  
more information. If this happens, stop as soon as  
possible and turn off the vehicle. Restart the vehicle  
and check for the message on the DIC display. If the  
message is displayed or appears again when you begin  
driving, the brake system needs service. See your  
dealer as soon as possible. See Brakes on page 633  
for more information.  
SERVICE A/C SYSTEM  
This message displays when the air delivery mode door  
or the electronic sensors that control the air conditioning  
and heating systems are no longer working. Have the  
climate control system serviced by your dealer if you  
notice a drop in heating and air conditioning efficiency.  
SERVICE BATTERY CHARGING  
SYSTEM  
SERVICE BRAKE SYSTEM  
This message displays when a problem with the  
charging system has been detected. The charging  
system light also displays on the instrument panel  
cluster. See Charging System Light on page 449 for  
more information. Have your vehicle serviced by your  
dealer.  
This message displays if the ignition is on to inform the  
driver that the brake fluid level is low. Have the brake  
system serviced by your dealer as soon as possible.  
SERVICE LANE DEPARTURE SYSTEM  
If your vehicle has the Lane Departure Warning (LDW)  
system, this message may display to indicate that the  
LDW system is not working properly. If this message  
remains on after continued driving, the system needs  
service. See your dealer. See Lane Departure Warning  
(LDW) on page 345 for more information.  
4-72  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
SERVICE PARKING ASSIST  
SERVICE SIDE BLIND ZONE ALERT  
SYSTEM  
If your vehicle has the Ultrasonic Front and Rear  
Parking Assist (UFRPA) system, this message displays  
if there is a problem with the UFRPA system. Do not  
use this system to help you park. See Ultrasonic Front  
and Rear Parking Assist (UFRPA) on page 338 for  
more information. See your dealer for service.  
If your vehicle has the Side Blind Zone Alert (SBZA)  
system and this message displays, both SBZA displays  
will remain on indicating there is a problem with the  
SBZA system. If these displays remain on after  
continued driving, the system needs service. See your  
dealer. See Side Blind Zone Alert (SBZA) on page 342  
for more information.  
SERVICE POWER STEERING  
Your vehicle may have a speed variable assist steering  
system. See Steering on page 58.  
SERVICE STABILITRAK  
Your vehicle may have a vehicle stability enhancement  
This message displays if a problem is detected with  
the speed variable assist steering system. When this  
message is displayed, you may notice that the effort  
required to steer the vehicle decreases or feels lighter,  
but you will still be able to steer the vehicle.  
system called StabiliTrak®. See StabiliTrak® System on  
page 56  
.
This message displays if there has been a problem  
detected with the StabiliTrak system.  
If this message comes on while you are driving, pull off  
the road as soon as possible and stop carefully. Try  
resetting the system by turning the ignition off then back  
on. If this message still stays on or comes back on  
again while you are driving, your vehicle needs service.  
Have the StabiliTrak system inspected by your dealer  
as soon as possible.  
SERVICE RADAR CRUISE  
This message displays when the Adaptive Cruise  
Control (ACC) system and the Forward Collision Alert  
(FCA) system are disabled and need service. See your  
dealer.  
4-73  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
SERVICE SUSPENSION SYS (System)  
SERVICE TRACTION CONTROL  
This message displays when the magnetic ride control  
or automatic leveling control system is not operating  
properly. Have your vehicle serviced by your dealer.  
This message displays when there is a problem with the  
Traction Control System (TCS). When this message is  
displayed, the system will not limit wheel spin. Adjust  
your driving accordingly. See your dealer for service.  
See Traction Control System (TCS) on page 56 for  
more information.  
SERVICE THEFT DETERRENT SYSTEM  
This message displays when there is a problem with the  
theft-deterrent system programmed in the key. A fault  
has been detected in the system which means that the  
system is disabled and it is not protecting the vehicle.  
The vehicle usually restarts; however, you may want to  
take the vehicle to your dealer before turning off the  
engine. See PASS-Key® III+ Electronic Immobilizer  
Operation on page 320 for more information.  
SERVICE TRANSMISSION  
This message displays when there is a problem with the  
vehicle's transmission. Have your vehicle serviced by  
your dealer.  
SERVICE VEHICLE SOON  
This message displays when a non-emissions related  
malfunction occurs. Have your vehicle serviced by your  
dealer as soon as possible.  
SERVICE TIRE MONITOR SYSTEM  
On vehicles with the Tire Pressure Monitor System  
(TPMS), this message displays if a part on the TPMS  
is not working properly. The tire pressure light also  
flashes and then remains on during the same ignition  
cycle. See Tire Pressure Light on page 454. Several  
conditions may cause this message to appear. See Tire  
Pressure Monitor Operation on page 661 for more  
information. If the warning comes on and stays on,  
there may be a problem with the TPMS, see your  
dealer.  
SET SPD (Speed)  
If your vehicle has Adaptive Cruise Control (ACC), this  
message displays whenever the cruise control is set.  
First, the CRUISE SET TO XXX MPH (km/h)message  
appears. After a few seconds, the CRUISE SET TO  
XXX MPH (km/h)message clears and the message  
SET SPD XXdisplays at the bottom of the DIC. See  
CRUISE SET TO XXX MPH (km/h)earlier in this  
section and Adaptive Cruise Control on page 414 for  
more information.  
4-74  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
SIDE BLIND ZONE ALERT  
SYSTEM OFF  
If your vehicle has the Side Blind Zone Alert (SBZA)  
system, this message displays when the SBZA system  
has been turned off. See Side Blind Zone Alert (SBZA)  
on page 342 and DIC Operation and Displays on  
page 460 for more information.  
SPEED LIMIT XXX MPH (km/h)  
This message displays when the Speed Alert has  
been turned on through the DIC Information Menu  
and the vehicle is at or above the speed limit. See DIC  
Operation and Displays on page 460 for more  
information.  
SPEED LIMITED TO XXX MPH (km/h)  
SIDE BLIND ZONE SYSTEM  
UNAVAILABLE  
This message displays when your vehicle speed is  
limited to 128 km/h (80 mph) because the vehicle  
detects a problem in the speed variable assist steering,  
magnetic ride control, or automatic leveling control  
systems. Have your vehicle serviced by your dealer.  
If your vehicle has the Side Blind Zone Alert (SBZA)  
system, this message displays when the SBZA system  
is disabled because the sensor is blocked and cannot  
detect vehicles in your blind zone. The sensor may be  
blocked by mud, dirt, snow, ice, or slush. This message  
may also display during heavy rain or due to road spray.  
It may also come on when driving in isolated areas  
with no guardrails, trees, or road signs and light traffic.  
Your vehicle does not need service. For cleaning  
STABILITRAK NOT READY  
If your vehicle has StabiliTrak, this message may  
display and the Traction Control System and StabiliTrak  
Warning Light on the instrument panel cluster may be  
on after first driving the vehicle and exceeding 30 km/h  
(19 mph) for 30 seconds. The StabiliTrak system is not  
functional until the light has turned off. See StabiliTrak®  
System on page 56 for more information.  
instructions, see Washing Your Vehicle on page 698  
See Side Blind Zone Alert (SBZA) on page 342 for  
more information.  
.
STARTING DISABLED SERVICE  
THROTTLE  
This message displays when your vehicle's throttle  
system is not functioning properly. Have your vehicle  
serviced by your dealer.  
4-75  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
See Tire Inspection and Rotation on page 665  
,
THEFT ATTEMPTED  
Tire Pressure Monitor System on page 660, and  
Inflation - Tire Pressure on page 657 for more  
information.  
This symbol appears with  
this message.  
TRACTION CONTROL OFF  
This message displays when the Traction Control  
System (TCS) is turned off. Adjust your driving  
accordingly. See Traction Control System (TCS) on  
page 56 for more information.  
This message displays if the content theft-deterrent  
system has detected a break-in attempt while you were  
away from your vehicle. See Content Theft-Deterrent on  
page 319 for more information.  
TRACTION CONTROL ON  
This message displays when the Traction Control  
System (TCS) is turned on. See Traction Control  
System (TCS) on page 56 for more information.  
TIGHTEN GAS CAP  
This message displays when the fuel cap has not been  
fully tightened. Recheck the fuel cap to ensure that it is  
on and tightened properly.  
TRANSMISSION HOT IDLE ENGINE  
Notice: If you drive the vehicle while the  
transmission fluid is overheating and the  
transmission temperature warning is displayed  
on the instrument panel cluster and/or DIC, you  
can damage the transmission. This could lead to  
costly repairs that would not be covered by the  
warranty. Do not drive your vehicle with overheated  
transmission fluid or while the transmission  
temperature warning is displayed.  
TIRE LEARNING ACTIVE  
This message displays when the Tire Pressure Monitor  
System (TPMS) is re-learning the tire positions on your  
vehicle. The tire positions must be re-learned after  
rotating the tires or after replacing a tire or sensor.  
4-76  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
This message displays when the transmission fluid in  
your vehicle is too hot. Stop the vehicle and allow it to  
idle until the transmission cools down or until this  
message is removed.  
WASHER FLUID LOW ADD FLUID  
This symbol appears with  
this message.  
TRUNK OPEN  
This symbol appears with  
this message.  
This message displays when your vehicle is low on  
windshield washer fluid. Refill the windshield washer  
fluid reservoir as soon as possible. See Windshield  
Washer Fluid on page 632 for more information.  
This message displays when the trunk is not closed  
completely. Make sure that the trunk is closed  
completely.  
DIC Vehicle Customization  
Your vehicle has customization capabilities that allow  
you to program certain features to one preferred setting.  
Customization features can only be programmed to  
one setting on the vehicle and cannot be programmed  
to a preferred setting for two different drivers.  
TURN SIGNAL ON  
This message displays as a reminder to turn off the turn  
signal if you drive your vehicle for more than about  
1 mile (1.6 km) with a turn signal on. A multiple chime  
sounds when this message is displayed.  
All of the customization options may not be available  
on your vehicle. Only the options available will be  
displayed on the DIC.  
4-77  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The default settings for the customization features were  
set when your vehicle left the factory, but may have  
been changed from their default state since then.  
Feature Settings Menu Items  
The following are customization features that allow you  
to program settings to the vehicle:  
The customization preferences are automatically  
recalled.  
DISPLAY IN ENGLISH  
To change customization preferences, use the following  
procedure.  
This feature will only display if a language other than  
English has been set. This feature allows you to change  
the language in which the DIC messages appear to  
English.  
Entering the Feature Settings Menu  
1. Turn the ignition on and place the vehicle in  
P (Park).  
Press the customization button until the PRESS V TO  
DISPLAY IN ENGLISH screen appears on the DIC  
display. Press the set/reset button once to display all  
DIC messages in English.  
To avoid excessive drain on the battery, it is  
recommended that the headlamps are turned off.  
2. Press the customization button to enter the feature  
settings menu.  
DISPLAY LANGUAGE  
This feature allows you to select the language in which  
the DIC messages will appear.  
If the menu is not available, FEATURE SETTINGS  
AVAILABLE IN PARK will display. Before entering  
the menu, make sure the vehicle is in P (Park).  
Press the customization button until the DISPLAY  
LANGUAGE screen appears on the DIC display. Press  
the set/reset button once to access the settings for this  
feature. Then press the menu up/down button to scroll  
through the following settings:  
ENGLISH (default): All messages will appear in  
English.  
DEUTSCH: All messages will appear in German.  
FRANCAIS: All messages will appear in French.  
4-78  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ESPANOL: All messages will appear in Spanish.  
JAPANESE: All messages will appear in Japanese.  
ARABIC: All messages will appear in Arabic.  
AT VEHICLE SPEED: The doors automatically lock  
when the vehicle speed is above 5 mph (8 km/h) for  
three seconds.  
NO CHANGE: No change will be made to this feature.  
The current setting will remain.  
NO CHANGE: No change will be made to this feature.  
The current setting will remain.  
To select a setting, press the set/reset button while the  
desired setting is displayed on the DIC.  
To select a setting, press the set/reset button while the  
desired setting is displayed on the DIC.  
AUTO DOOR UNLOCK  
AUTO DOOR LOCK  
This feature allows you to select whether or not to turn  
off the automatic door unlocking feature. It also allows  
you to select which doors and when the doors will  
automatically unlock. See Programmable Automatic  
Door Locks on page 310 for more information.  
This feature allows you to select when the vehicle's  
doors will automatically lock. See Programmable  
Automatic Door Locks on page 310 for more  
information.  
Press the customization button until AUTO DOOR  
LOCK appears on the DIC display. Press the set/reset  
button once to access the settings for this feature. Then  
press the menu up/down button to scroll through the  
following settings:  
Press the customization button until AUTO DOOR  
UNLOCK appears on the DIC display. Press the  
set/reset button once to access the settings for this  
feature. Then press the menu up/down button to scroll  
through the following settings:  
SHIFT OUT OF PARK (default): The doors  
automatically lock when the doors are closed and  
the vehicle is shifted out of P (Park).  
OFF: None of the doors will automatically unlock.  
DRIVER AT KEY OUT: Only the driver's door will  
unlock when the key is taken out of the ignition.  
4-79  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DRIVER IN PARK: Only the driver's door will unlock  
when the vehicle is shifted into P (Park).  
Press the customization button until REMOTE DOOR  
LOCK appears on the DIC display. Press the set/reset  
button once to access the settings for this feature. Then  
press the menu up/down button to scroll through the  
following settings:  
ALL AT KEY OUT: All of the doors will unlock when the  
key is taken out of the ignition.  
ALL IN PARK (default): All of the doors will unlock  
when the vehicle is shifted into P (Park).  
OFF: There will be no feedback when you press the  
lock button on the RKE transmitter.  
NO CHANGE: No change will be made to this feature.  
The current setting will remain.  
LIGHTS ONLY: The exterior lamps will flash when you  
press the lock button on the RKE transmitter.  
To select a setting, press the set/reset button while the  
desired setting is displayed on the DIC.  
HORN ONLY: The horn will sound on the second press  
of the lock button on the RKE transmitter.  
REMOTE DOOR LOCK  
HORN & LIGHTS (default): The exterior lamps will  
flash when you press the lock button on the RKE  
transmitter, and the horn will sound when the lock  
button is pressed again within five seconds of the  
previous command.  
This feature allows you to select the type of feedback  
you will receive when locking the vehicle with the  
Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) transmitter. You will not  
receive feedback when locking the vehicle with the RKE  
transmitter if the doors are open. See Remote Keyless  
Entry (RKE) System Operation on page 34 for more  
information.  
NO CHANGE: No change will be made to this feature.  
The current setting will remain.  
To select a setting, press the set/reset button while the  
desired setting is displayed on the DIC.  
4-80  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
REMOTE DOOR UNLOCK  
DELAY DOOR LOCK  
This feature allows you to select the type of feedback  
you will receive when unlocking the vehicle with the  
Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) transmitter. You will not  
receive feedback when unlocking the vehicle with the  
RKE transmitter if the doors are open. See Remote  
Keyless Entry (RKE) System Operation on page 34  
for more information.  
This feature allows you to select whether or not the  
locking of the vehicle's doors will be delayed. When  
locking the doors with the power door lock switch and a  
door is open, this feature will delay locking the doors  
until five seconds after the last door is closed. You will  
hear three chimes to signal that the delayed locking  
feature is in use. The key must be out of the ignition  
for this feature to work. You can temporarily override  
delayed locking by pressing the power door lock switch  
twice or the lock button on the RKE transmitter twice.  
Press the customization button until REMOTE DOOR  
UNLOCK appears on the DIC display. Press the set/  
reset button once to access the settings for this feature.  
Then press the menu up/down button to scroll through  
the following settings:  
Press the customization button until DELAY DOOR  
LOCK appears on the DIC display. Press the set/reset  
button once to access the settings for this feature. Then  
press the menu up/down button to scroll through the  
following settings:  
LIGHTS OFF: The exterior lamps will not flash when  
you press the unlock button on the RKE transmitter.  
LIGHTS ON (default): The exterior lamps will flash  
when you press the unlock button on the RKE  
transmitter.  
OFF: There will be no delayed locking of the vehicle's  
doors.  
ON (default): The doors will not lock until five seconds  
after the last door is closed.  
NO CHANGE: No change will be made to this feature.  
The current setting will remain.  
NO CHANGE: No change will be made to this feature.  
The current setting will remain.  
To select a setting, press the set/reset button while the  
desired setting is displayed on the DIC.  
To select a setting, press the set/reset button while the  
desired setting is displayed on the DIC.  
4-81  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
EXIT LIGHTING  
APPROACH LIGHTING  
This feature allows you to select the amount of time you  
want the exterior lamps to remain on when it is dark  
enough outside. This happens after the key is turned  
from ON/RUN to LOCK/OFF.  
This feature allows you to select whether or not to have  
the exterior lights turn on briefly during low light periods  
after unlocking the vehicle using the Remote Keyless  
Entry (RKE) transmitter.  
Press the customization button until EXIT LIGHTING  
appears on the DIC display. Press the set/reset button  
once to access the settings for this feature. Then press  
the menu up/down button to scroll through the following  
settings:  
Press the customization button until APPROACH  
LIGHTING appears on the DIC display. Press the set/  
reset button once to access the settings for this feature.  
Then press the menu up/down button to scroll through  
the following settings:  
OFF: The exterior lamps will not turn on.  
OFF: The exterior lights will not turn on when you  
unlock the vehicle with the RKE transmitter.  
30 SECONDS (default): The exterior lamps will stay on  
for 30 seconds.  
ON (default): If it is dark enough outside, the exterior  
lights will turn on briefly when you unlock the vehicle  
with the RKE transmitter.  
1 MINUTE: The exterior lamps will stay on for  
one minute.  
The lights will remain on for 20 seconds or until the lock  
button on the RKE transmitter is pressed, or the vehicle  
is no longer off. See Remote Keyless Entry (RKE)  
System Operation on page 34 for more information.  
2 MINUTES: The exterior lamps will stay on for  
two minutes.  
NO CHANGE: No change will be made to this feature.  
The current setting will remain.  
NO CHANGE: No change will be made to this feature.  
The current setting will remain.  
To select a setting, press the set/reset button while the  
desired setting is displayed on the DIC.  
To select a setting, press the set/reset button while the  
desired setting is displayed on the DIC.  
4-82  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Press the customization button until PARK TILT  
MIRRORS appears on the DIC display. Press the  
set/reset button once to access the settings for this  
feature. Then press the menu up/down button to scroll  
through the following settings:  
CHIME VOLUME  
This feature allows you to select the volume level of the  
chime.  
Press the customization button until CHIME VOLUME  
appears on the DIC display. Press the set/reset button  
once to access the settings for this feature. Then press  
the menu up/down button to scroll through the following  
settings:  
OFF (default): Neither outside mirror will be tilted down  
when the vehicle is shifted into R (Reverse).  
DRIVER MIRROR: The driver's outside mirror will be  
tilted down when the vehicle is shifted into R (Reverse).  
NORMAL: The chime volume will be set to a normal  
level.  
PASSENGER MIRROR: The passenger's outside  
mirror will be tilted down when the vehicle is shifted into  
R (Reverse).  
LOUD: The chime volume will be set to a loud level.  
NO CHANGE: No change will be made to this feature.  
The current setting will remain.  
BOTH MIRRORS: The driver's and passenger's outside  
mirrors will be tilted down when the vehicle is shifted  
into R (Reverse).  
There is no default for chime volume. The volume will  
stay at the last known setting.  
NO CHANGE: No change will be made to this feature.  
The current setting will remain.  
To select a setting, press the set/reset button while the  
desired setting is displayed on the DIC.  
To select a setting, press the set/reset button while the  
desired setting is displayed on the DIC.  
PARK TILT MIRRORS  
If your vehicle has this feature, it allows you to select  
whether or not the outside mirror(s) will automatically tilt  
down when the vehicle is shifted into R (Reverse). See  
Park Tilt Mirrors on page 337 for more information.  
4-83  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
NO CHANGE: No change will be made to this feature.  
The current setting will remain.  
EASY EXIT RECALL  
If your vehicle has this feature, it allows you to select  
your preference for the automatic easy exit seat feature.  
See Memory Seat, Mirrors and Steering Wheel on  
page 26 for more information.  
To select a setting, press the set/reset button while the  
desired setting is displayed on the DIC.  
EASY EXIT SETUP  
Press the customization button until EASY EXIT  
RECALL appears on the DIC display. Press the set/  
reset button once to access the settings for this feature.  
Then press the menu up/down button to scroll through  
the following settings:  
If your vehicle has this feature, it allows you to select  
which areas will recall with the automatic easy exit seat  
feature. It also allows you to turn off the automatic easy  
exit feature. See Memory Seat, Mirrors and Steering  
Wheel on page 26 and EASY EXIT RECALLearlier  
for more information.  
DOOR BUTTON ONLY: No automatic seat exit recall  
will occur. The recall will only occur after pressing the  
easy exit seat button.  
Press the customization button until EASY EXIT SETUP  
appears on the DIC display. Press the set/reset button  
once to access the settings for this feature. Then press  
the menu up/down button to scroll through the following  
settings:  
BUTTON AND KEY OUT (default): If the features are  
enabled through the EASY EXIT SETUP menu, the  
driver's seat will move back, and if the vehicle has the  
power tilt wheel and telescopic steering feature, the  
power steering column will move up and forward when  
the key is removed from the ignition or after pressing  
the easy exit seat button.  
OFF: No automatic seat exit will recall.  
SEAT ONLY: The driver's seat will recall.  
TILT ONLY: The steering wheel tilt feature will recall.  
The automatic easy exit seat movement will only occur  
one time after the key is removed from the ignition.  
If the automatic movement has already occurred, and  
you put the key back in the ignition and remove it again,  
the seat and steering column will stay in the original exit  
position, unless a memory recall took place prior to  
removing the key again.  
TELESCOPE ONLY: The steering column telescope  
feature will recall.  
SEAT/TILT: The driver's seat and the steering wheel tilt  
feature will recall.  
SEAT/TELESCOPE: The driver's seat and the steering  
column telescope feature will recall.  
4-84  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
TILT/TELESCOPE: The steering wheel tilt and steering  
column telescope features will recall.  
steering feature. See Power Tilt Wheel and Telescopic  
Steering Column on page 44 for more information.  
See RELEARN REMOTE KEYunder DIC Operation  
and Displays on page 460 for more information on  
matching transmitters to driver ID numbers.  
ALL (default): The driver's seat and the steering wheel  
tilt and steering column telescope features will recall,  
if your vehicle has this option.  
NO CHANGE: No change will be made to this feature.  
The current setting will remain.  
NO CHANGE: No change will be made to this feature.  
The current setting will remain.  
To select a setting, press the set/reset button while the  
desired setting is displayed on the DIC.  
To select a setting, press the set/reset button while the  
desired setting is displayed on the DIC.  
REMOTE START  
MEMORY SEAT RECALL  
If the vehicle has remote start, this feature allows it to  
be turned on or off. When REMOTE START displays,  
press and hold the reset button, the select ON or OFF.  
OFF disables the remote start feature. See Remote  
Vehicle Start on page 37 for more information.  
If your vehicle has this feature, it allows you to select  
your preference for the remote memory seat recall  
feature. See Memory Seat, Mirrors and Steering Wheel  
on page 26 for more information.  
Press the customization button until MEMORY SEAT  
RECALL appears on the DIC display. Press the set/  
reset button once to access the settings for this feature.  
Then press the menu up/down button to scroll through  
the following settings:  
FACTORY SETTINGS  
This feature allows you to set all of the customization  
features back to their factory default settings.  
Press the customization button until FACTORY  
SETTINGS appears on the DIC display. Press the  
set/reset button once to access the settings for this  
feature. Then press the menu up/down button to scroll  
through the following settings:  
OFF (default): No remote memory seat recall will  
occur.  
ON: The driver's seat and outside mirrors will  
automatically move to the stored driving position when  
the unlock button on the Remote Keyless Entry (RKE)  
transmitter is pressed. The steering column will also  
move on vehicles with the power tilt and telescopic  
RESTORE ALL (default): The customization features  
will be set to their factory default settings.  
4-85  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DO NOT RESTORE: The customization features will  
not be set to their factory default settings.  
Audio System(s)  
Determine which radio the vehicle has and read the  
following pages to become familiar with its features.  
To select a setting, press the set/reset button while the  
desired setting is displayed on the DIC.  
Exiting the Feature Settings Menu  
The feature settings menu will be exited when any of  
the following occurs:  
WARNING:  
{
Taking your eyes off the road for extended periods  
could cause a crash resulting in injury or death to  
you or others. Do not give extended attention to  
entertainment tasks while driving.  
.
The vehicle is shifted out of P (Park).  
.
The vehicle is no longer in ON/RUN.  
.
The trip/fuel or vehicle information DIC buttons are  
pressed.  
.
This system provides access to many audio and non  
audio listings.  
The end of the feature settings menu is reached  
and exited.  
.
A 40 second time period has elapsed with no  
selection made.  
To minimize taking your eyes off the road while driving,  
do the following while the vehicle is parked:  
.
Become familiar with the operation and controls of  
the audio system.  
.
Set up the tone, speaker adjustments, and preset  
radio stations.  
For more information, see Defensive Driving on  
page 52  
.
4-86  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Notice: Contact your dealer before adding any  
equipment.  
Enabling/Disabling the Digital Radio  
Clock  
Adding audio or communication equipment could  
interfere with the operation of the vehicle's engine,  
radio, or other systems, and could damage them.  
Follow federal rules covering mobile radio and  
telephone equipment.  
For the Single CD Player  
To turn the radio clock display on or off:  
1. Turn the radio on.  
2. Press the H button until the clock and date setting  
The vehicle has Retained Accessory Power (RAP). With  
RAP, the audio system can be played even after the  
ignition is turned off. See Retained Accessory Power  
(RAP) on page 324 for more information.  
menus appear.  
3. Press the pushbutton located under the forward  
arrow tab until the menu for default clock and date  
settings appear.  
Setting the Clock  
4. Press the pushbutton located under the currently  
displayed status of either ON or OFF. The ON  
display indicates the radio clock display is disabled  
and the OFF display indicates the radio clock  
display is enabled. Press this pushbutton to toggle  
the radio clock display on or off.  
Radio with a Single CD or a Six-Disc  
CD Player  
The vehicle has an analog clock as well as the digital  
radio clock. At the time of new vehicle delivery, the  
digital radio clock display should be disabled. If you  
decide to use the digital radio clock as well as the  
analog clock, you can change the setting to enable the  
radio clock display.  
If the radio clock display is turned on, the screen  
displays Radio Clock ON for 10 seconds, then  
returns to the original clock display menu.  
If the radio clock display is turned off, the screen  
displays Radio Clock OFF for 10 seconds. The  
menus for clock and date settings are removed,  
and ON displays as a current status indicating that  
the clock display can be turned on, if desired.  
4-87  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The radio clock and analog clock are not synchronized.  
Occasionally you might need to set the digital radio  
clock using the procedure below to synchronize both  
clocks.  
If the radio clock display is turned off, the screen  
displays Radio Clock OFF for 10 seconds. The  
menus for clock and date settings are removed,  
and ON displays as a current status indicating that  
the clock display can be turned on, if desired.  
For a Six-Disc CD Player  
To turn the radio clock display on or off:  
1. Turn the radio on.  
Setting the Time and Date  
For the Single CD Player  
2. Press the MENU button until H is displayed  
This type of radio has a H button for setting the time  
and date. To set the time and date:  
3. Press the pushbutton located under H until the  
1. Turn the radio on.  
clock and date settings appear.  
4. Press the pushbutton located under the forward  
arrow tab until the menu for default clock and date  
settings appear.  
2. Press H and HR, MIN, MM, DD, YYYY (hour,  
minute, month, day, and year) displays.  
3. Press the pushbutton located under any one of  
the tabs that you want to change. Every time the  
pushbutton is pressed again, the time or the date if  
selected, increases by one.  
5. Press the pushbutton located under the currently  
displayed status of either ON or OFF. The ON  
display indicates the radio clock display is disabled  
and the OFF display indicates the radio clock  
display is enabled. Press this pushbutton to toggle  
the radio clock display on or off.  
.
Another way to increase the time or date, is to  
press the right SEEK arrow or the \ FWD  
button.  
If the radio clock display is turned on, the screen  
displays Radio Clock ON for 10 seconds, then  
returns to the original clock display menu.  
.
To decrease the time or date, press the left  
SEEK arrow or the s REV button. You can  
also turn the a knob, located on the upper  
right side of the radio faceplate, to adjust the  
selected setting.  
4-88  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
For a Six-Disc CD Player  
Changing the Time and Date Default  
Setting  
This type of radio has a MENU button for setting the  
time and date. To set the time and date:  
For the Single CD Player  
1. Turn the radio on.  
To change the time and date default setting:  
2. Press the MENU button until H option is displayed.  
1. Change the time default setting from 12 hour to  
24 hour or the date default setting from month/day/  
3. Press the pushbutton located under H and the HR,  
MIN, MM, DD, YYYY (hour, minute, month, day,  
and year) displays.  
year to day/month/year, by pressing the H button.  
2. Once the clock and date settings display along  
with the forward arrow tab, press the pushbutton  
located under the forward arrow tab until the  
time 12H and 24H, and the date MM/DD/YYYY  
(month, day, and year) and DD/MM/YYYY (day,  
month, and year) displays.  
4. Press the pushbutton located under any one of  
the tabs that you want to change. Every time the  
pushbutton is pressed again, the time or the date if  
selected, increases by one.  
.
Another way to increase the time or date, is to  
3. Press the pushbutton located under the desired  
press the right SEEK arrow or the \ FWD  
button.  
option, then press the H button again to apply the  
selected default, or let the screen time out.  
.
To decrease the time or date, press the left  
SEEK arrow or the s REV button. You can  
also turn the a knob, located on the upper  
right side of the radio faceplate, to adjust the  
selected setting.  
4-89  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
For the Six-Disc CD Player  
Radio(s)  
To change the time and date default setting:  
1. Change the time default setting from 12 hour to  
24 hour or the date default setting from month/day/  
year to day/month/year, by pressing the MENU  
button.  
2. Once H displays, press the pushbutton located  
under H until the time and date settings display  
along with a forward arrow.  
3. Press the pushbutton located under the forward  
arrow tab until the time 12H and 24H, and the date  
MM/DD/YYYY (month, day, and year) and DD/MM/  
YYYY (day, month, and year) displays.  
4. Press the pushbutton located under the desired  
option, then press the MENU button again to apply  
the selected default, or let the screen time out.  
Radio with CD shown, Radio with Six-Disc CD similar  
Radio Data System (RDS)  
The audio system has RDS. The RDS feature is  
available for use only on FM stations that broadcast  
RDS information. This system relies upon receiving  
specific information from these stations and only works  
when the information is available. While the radio is  
tuned to an FM-RDS station, the station name or  
call letters display. In rare cases, a radio station can  
broadcast incorrect information that causes the radio  
features to work improperly. If this happens, contact the  
radio station.  
4-90  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
AudioPilot®: If the vehicle has the Bose® audio  
system, it has AudioPilot noise compensation  
technology.  
Playing the Radio  
O (Power/Volume): Press to turn the system on  
and off.  
To use AudioPilot:  
Turn to increase or decrease the volume.  
1. Set the radio volume to the desired level.  
Speed Compensated Volume (SCV): Radios with SCV  
automatically adjusts the radio volume to compensate  
for road and wind noise while driving. That way, the  
volume level should sound about the same while  
driving. To activate SCV:  
2. Press the MENU button to display the radio  
setup menu.  
3. Press the pushbutton located under the AUTO  
VOLUM tab on the radio display.  
4. Press the ON or OFF button to turn this feature on  
or off.  
1. Set the radio volume to the desired level.  
2. Press the MENU button to display the radio  
setup menu.  
When turned ON, AudioPilot continuously adjusts  
the audio system equalization, to compensate for  
background noise, so that the music always sounds the  
same at the set volume level.  
3. Press the pushbutton under the AUTO VOLUM  
(automatic volume) tab on the radio display.  
4. Press the pushbutton under the desired Speed  
Compensated Volume setting (OFF, Low, Med,  
or High) to select the level of radio volume  
compensation. The display times out after  
approximately 10 seconds. Each higher setting  
allows for more radio volume compensation at  
faster vehicle speeds.  
The feature is most effective at lower radio volume  
settings where background noise can affect how well  
you hear the music being played through the vehicle's  
audio system. At high volume settings there might  
be little or no adjustments by AudioPilot. For more  
information on AudioPilot, visit bose.com/audiopilot.  
4-91  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Finding a Station  
Storing a Radio Station as a Favorite  
BAND: Press to switch between AM, FM, or XM. The  
selection displays.  
Drivers are encouraged to set up their radio station  
favorites while the vehicle is in P (Park). Tune to  
favorite stations using the presets, favorites button,  
and steering wheel controls, if the vehicle has this  
feature. See Defensive Driving on page 52.  
a (Tune): Turn to select radio stations.  
© SEEK ¨ : Press the arrows to go to the next or to the  
previous station and stay there.  
FAV (Favorites): A maximum of 36 stations can be  
programmed as favorites using the six pushbuttons  
positioned below the radio station frequency tabs and  
by using the radio favorites page button. Press the FAV  
button to go through up to six pages of favorites, each  
having six favorite stations available per page. Each  
page of favorites can contain any combination of AM,  
FM, or XM stations. To store a station as a favorite:  
To scan stations, press and hold either arrow for  
three seconds until a beep sounds. The radio goes to a  
station, plays for a few seconds, then goes to the next  
station. Press either arrow again to stop scanning.  
The radio only seeks and scans stations with a strong  
signal that are in the selected band.  
4 (Information) (XMSatellite Radio Service,  
MP3/WMA, and RDS Features): Press this button to  
display additional text information related to the current  
FM-RDS or XM station, or MP3/WMA song. A choice of  
additional information such as: Channel, Song, Artist,  
CAT (category) can display. Continue pressing the  
information button to highlight the desired label,  
or press the pushbutton positioned under any one of  
the tabs and the information about that tab displays.  
1. Tune to the desired radio station.  
2. Press the FAV button to display the page where  
you want the station stored.  
3. Press and hold one of the six pushbuttons until a  
beep sounds. When that pushbutton is pressed  
and released, the station that was set, returns.  
4. Repeat the steps for each pushbutton radio station  
you want stored as a favorite.  
When information is not available, No Info displays.  
4-92  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The number of favorites pages can be setup using the  
MENU button. To setup the number of favorites pages:  
To quickly adjust bass, midrange, or treble to the middle  
position, press the pushbutton positioned under the  
BASS, MID, or TREB label for more than two seconds.  
A beep sounds and the level adjusts to the middle  
position.  
1. Press the MENU button to display the radio  
setup menu.  
2. Press the pushbutton located below the  
FAV 1-6 label.  
To quickly adjust all tone and speaker controls to the  
middle position, press the a knob for more than  
two seconds until a beep sounds.  
EQ (Equalization): For the non-Bose® amplified radio,  
perform the following steps to setup the equalization  
settings:  
3. Select the desired number of favorites pages  
by pressing the pushbutton located below the  
displayed page numbers.  
4. Press the FAV button, or let the menu time out, to  
return to the original main radio screen showing  
the radio station frequency labels and to begin the  
process of programming your favorites for the  
chosen amount of numbered pages.  
1. Press the a knob until the equalization label  
displays.  
2. Press the pushbutton located under the  
equalization label to get choices of POP,  
ROCK, CTRY (country), TALK, JAZZ, and  
CLAS (classical), to display.  
Setting the Tone (Bass/Midrange/Treble)  
BASS/MID/TREB (Bass, Midrange, or Treble): To  
adjust bass, midrange, or treble, press the a knob  
until the tone control labels display. Continue pressing  
to highlight the desired label, or press the pushbutton  
3. Press the pushbutton located under the desired  
setting.  
positioned under the desired label. Turn the a knob  
to adjust the highlighted setting. The highlighted  
setting can also be adjusted by pressing either SEEK  
arrow, \ FWD, or s REV button until the desired  
levels are obtained. If a station's frequency is weak or  
has static, decrease the treble.  
4-93  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
For the Bose amplified radio, perform the following  
steps to setup the equalization settings:  
To quickly adjust balance or fade to the middle position,  
press the pushbutton positioned under the BAL or  
FADE label for more than two seconds. A beep sounds  
and the level adjusts to the middle position.  
1. Press the a knob until the DSP label displays.  
2. Press the pushbutton located under the DSP label  
to get choices of Norm, Driv, Rear, and Surround,  
to display.  
To quickly adjust all speaker and tone controls to the  
middle position, press the a knob for more than  
two seconds until a beep sounds.  
3. Press the pushbutton located under the desired  
setting.  
Digital Signal Processing (DSP)  
To select Surround, press either the fourth or fifth  
pushbutton located under the displayed Surround  
until Centerpoint displays.  
This feature is used to provide a choice of four different  
listening experiences. DSP can be used while listening  
to the audio system or a CD. To change the DSP mode,  
To return to the manual mode, press the tune knob.  
Select either BASS, MID, or TREB and start to manually  
press the a knob until the DSP control label displays.  
Press the pushbutton located under the DSP label until  
the control labels display. Continue by pressing the  
desired button below the control labels on the display.  
adjust the settings by turning the a knob.  
Adjusting the Speakers (Balance/Fade)  
BAL/FADE (Balance/Fade): To adjust balance or  
For more information on the control label displays, see  
the following:  
.
fade, press the a knob until the speaker control labels  
display. Continue pressing to highlight the desired label,  
or press the pushbutton positioned under the desired  
Norm (Normal): Select this screen button to adjust  
the audio for normal mode. This provides the best  
sound quality for all seating positions.  
.
label. Turn the a knob to adjust the highlighted setting.  
The highlighted setting can be adjusted by pressing  
Driv (Driver): Select this screen button to adjust  
the audio for the driver to receive the best possible  
sound quality.  
either SEEK arrow, \ FWD, or s REV buttons until  
the desired levels are obtained.  
.
Rear: Select this screen button to adjust the audio  
for the rear seat passengers to receive the best  
possible sound quality.  
4-94  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Surround (Centerpoint®): Select this screen  
button to enable Bose® Centerpoint signal  
.
3. Turn the a knob, press the pushbuttons below the  
displayed right or left arrows, or press either SEEK  
arrow to go to the previous or the next XM station  
within the selected category.  
processing circuitry. Centerpoint produces a full  
vehicle surround sound listening experience from a  
CD, MP3/WMA, or XM stereo digital audio source  
and delivers five independent audio channels from  
conventional two channel stereo recordings. (Not  
available for AM, FM, or auxiliary sources.) For  
more details visit www.bose.com/centerpoint.  
4. To exit the category search mode, press the FAV  
button or BAND button to display your favorites  
again.  
Undesired XM categories can be removed through the  
setup menu. To remove an undesired category:  
DSP is only available on vehicles that have the Bose  
Premium audio system.  
1. Press the MENU button to display the radio  
setup menu.  
Finding a Category (CAT) Station  
2. Press the pushbutton located below the XM  
CAT tab.  
CAT (Category): The CAT button is used to find  
XM stations while the radio is in the XM mode. To find  
XM channels within a desired category, perform the  
following:  
3. Turn the a knob to display the category to be  
removed.  
1. Press the BAND button until the XM frequency  
displays. Press the CAT button to display the  
category tabs. Continue pressing the CAT button  
until the desired category name displays. Another  
4. Press the pushbutton located under the Remove  
tab until the category name along with the word  
Removed displays.  
5. Repeat the steps to remove more categories.  
way to select a category is to press the s REV  
or \ FWD button until the desired category is  
selected.  
Removed categories can be restored by pressing the  
pushbutton under the Add label when a removed  
category is displayed or by pressing the pushbutton  
under the Restore All label.  
2. Press either of the two pushbuttons below the  
desired category tab to immediately tune to the  
first XM station associated with that category.  
The radio does not let you remove or add categories  
while the vehicle is moving faster than 5 mph (8 km/h).  
4-95  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The CAT button also toggles between compressed and  
uncompressed audio when a mixed disc is present. See  
Compressed Audiolater in this section.  
Playing a CD (Single CD Player)  
Insert a CD partway into the slot, label side up. The  
player pulls it in and the CD should begin playing.  
Radio Message  
Locked: This message displays when the  
THEFTLOCK® system has locked up the radio.  
Take the vehicle to your dealer for service.  
If the ignition or radio is turned off with a CD in the  
player, it stays in the player. When the ignition or radio  
is turned on, the CD starts playing where it stopped, if it  
was the last selected audio source.  
When a CD is inserted, the CD symbol displays. As  
each new track starts to play the track number displays.  
If any error occurs repeatedly or if an error cannot be  
corrected, contact your dealer.  
Care of CDs  
XMSatellite Radio Service  
If playing a CD-R, the sound quality can be reduced  
due to CD-R quality, the method of recording, the  
quality of the music that has been recorded, and  
the way the CD-R has been handled. Handle them  
carefully. Store CD-R(s) in their original cases or other  
protective cases and away from direct sunlight and  
dust. The CD player scans the bottom surface of the  
disc. If the surface of a CD is damaged, such as  
cracked, broken, or scratched, the CD does not play  
properly or not at all. Do not touch the bottom side of a  
CD while handling it; this could damage the surface.  
Pick up CDs by grasping the outer edges or the edge of  
the hole and the outer edge.  
XM is a satellite radio service that is based in the  
48 contiguous United States and 10 Canadian  
provinces. XM Satellite Radio has a wide variety  
of programming and commercial-free music,  
coast-to-coast, and in digital-quality sound. A service  
fee is required to receive the XM service. If XM Service  
needs to be reactivated, the radio will display No  
Subscription Please Renewon channel XM1. For more  
information, contact XM at www.xmradio.com or call  
1-800-929-2100 in the U.S. and www.xmradio.ca or call  
1-877-438-9677 in Canada.  
Radio Messages for XMOnly  
See XM Radio Messages on page 4105 later in this  
section for further detail.  
4-96  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
If the surface of a CD is soiled, take a soft, lint free  
cloth or dampen a clean, soft cloth in a mild, neutral  
detergent solution mixed with water, and clean it. Make  
sure the wiping process starts from the center to  
the edge.  
Playing a CD(s) (Six-Disc CD Player)  
LOAD ^ : Press to load CDs into the CD player. The  
CD player holds up to six CDs.  
To insert one CD:  
Care of The CD Player  
1. Press and release the load button.  
2. Wait for the message to insert the disc.  
Do not add any label to a CD, it could get caught in the  
CD player. If a CD is recorded on a personal computer  
and a description label is needed, try labeling the top of  
the recorded CD with a marking pen.  
3. Load a CD. Insert the CD partway into the slot,  
label side up. The player pulls the CD in.  
To insert multiple CDs:  
The use of CD lens cleaners for CDs is not advised,  
due to the risk of contaminating the lens of the CD  
optics with lubricants internal to the CD player  
mechanism.  
1. Press and hold the LOAD button for five seconds.  
A beep sounds and Load All Discs displays.  
2. Follow the displayed instruction on when to insert  
the discs. The CD player takes up to six CDs.  
Notice: If a label is added to a CD, or more than one  
CD is inserted into the slot at a time, or an attempt  
is made to play scratched or damaged CDs, the  
CD player could be damaged. While using the CD  
player, use only CDs in good condition without any  
label, load one CD at a time, and keep the CD player  
and the loading slot free of foreign materials,  
liquids, and debris.  
3. Press the Load button again to cancel loading  
more CDs.  
Z (Eject): Press to eject the CD. If the CD is not  
removed, after several seconds, the CD automatically  
pulls back into the player.  
For the Radio with Six-Disc CD player, press and hold  
for two seconds to eject all discs, if one or more discs  
are loaded.  
If an error displays, see CD Messageslater in this  
section.  
a (Tune): Turn to select tracks on the CD currently  
playing.  
4-97  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
RDM (Random) (Radio with Six-Disc CD Player):  
With the random setting, CD tracks can be played in  
random, rather than sequential order, on one CD or all  
CDs in a six-disc CD player. To use random:  
© SEEK ¨ : Press the left arrow to go to the start of the  
current track, if more than ten seconds have played.  
Press the right arrow to go to the next track. If either  
arrow is held or pressed multiple times, the player  
continues moving backward or forward through the CD.  
.
Press the pushbutton positioned under the RDM  
tab until Randomize Current Disc displays to  
play the tracks in random order from the CD  
that is currently playing. Press again to turn off  
random play.  
s REV (Fast Reverse): Press and hold to reverse  
playback quickly within a track. You will hear sound at a  
reduced volume. Release to resume playing the track.  
The elapsed time of the track displays.  
.
Press the pushbutton positioned under the RDM  
\ FWD (Fast Forward): Press and hold to advance  
playback quickly within a track. You will hear sound at a  
reduced volume. Release to resume playing the track.  
The elapsed time of the track displays.  
tab until Randomize All Discs displays to play  
tracks from all CDs loaded in a six-disc CD  
player in random order. Press again to turn off  
random play.  
RDM (Random): With the random setting, CD tracks  
can be played in random, rather than sequential order.  
This feature is not available in playlist mode. To use  
random, do the following:  
4 (Information): Press to switch the display between  
the track number, elapsed time of the track, and the  
time. When the ignition is off, press to display the  
time (if the clock display is enabled). See Enabling/  
Disabling the Digital Radio Clockunder, Setting the  
Clock on page 487 for more information.  
1. To play tracks in random order from the CD that is  
currently playing, press the pushbutton positioned  
under the RDM label. The random icon displays.  
BAND: Press to listen to the radio when a CD is  
playing. The CD remains inside the radio for future  
listening.  
2. Press the same pushbutton again to turn off  
random play. The random icon is no longer  
highlighted.  
4-98  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
.
.
.
The air is very humid. If so, wait about an hour and  
try again.  
CD/AUX (CD/Auxiliary): Press to play a CD when  
listening to the radio. The CD icon and track number  
displays when a CD is in the player. Press again and  
the system automatically searches for an auxiliary input  
device, such as a portable audio player. If a portable  
audio player is not connected, No Aux Input Device  
Founddisplays.  
There could have been a problem while burning  
the CD.  
The label could be caught in the CD player.  
If the CD is not playing correctly, for any other reason,  
try a known good CD.  
Playing an MP3/WMA CD-R or  
CD-RW Disc  
Radios with the MP3 feature are capable of playing an  
MP3/WMA CD-R or CD-RW disc. For more information  
on how to play an MP3/WMA CD-R or CD-RW disc, see  
Using an MP3 on page 4100 later in this section.  
If any error occurs repeatedly or if an error cannot be  
corrected, contact your dealer. If the radio displays an  
error message, write it down and provide it to your  
dealer when reporting the problem.  
Using the Auxiliary Input Jack  
The radio system has an auxiliary input jack located  
on the lower right side of the faceplate. This is not an  
audio output; do not plug the headphone set into the  
front auxiliary input jack. You can however, connect  
an external audio device such as an iPod, laptop  
computer, MP3 player, CD changer, or cassette tape  
player, etc. to the auxiliary input jack for use as another  
source for audio listening.  
CD Messages  
DISC ERROR: If this message displays and/or the CD  
ejects, it could be for one of the following reasons:  
.
The radio system does not support the playlist  
format, the compressed audio format, or the data  
file format.  
.
It is very hot. When the temperature returns to  
Drivers are encouraged to set up any auxiliary device  
while the vehicle is in P (Park). See Defensive Driving  
on page 52 for more information on driver distraction.  
normal, the CD should play.  
.
You are driving on a very rough road. When the  
road becomes smoother, the CD should play.  
.
The CD is dirty, scratched, wet, or upside down.  
4-99  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
To use a portable audio player, connect a 3.5 mm  
(1/8 inch) cable to the radio's front auxiliary input  
jack. When connecting an auxiliary device, the radio  
automatically detects the device and Aux Input Device”  
displays. The device begins playing audio over the  
vehicle speakers. If an auxiliary device has already  
been connected, the device does not begin playing  
audio until the radio's CD/AUX button is pressed.  
Using an MP3  
MP3/WMA CD-R or CD-RW Disc  
The radio plays MP3 and WMA files that were recorded  
on a CD-R or CD-RW disc. The files can be recorded  
with the following fixed bit rates: 32 kbps, 40 kbps,  
56 kbps, 64 kbps, 80 kbps, 96 kbps, 112 kbps,  
128 kbps, 160 kbps, 192 kbps, 224 kbps, 256 kbps, and  
320 kbps or a variable bit rate. Song title, artist name,  
and album can display when files are recorded using  
ID3 tags version 1 and 2.  
O (Power/Volume): Turn to increase or decrease the  
volume of the portable player. You might need to do  
additional volume adjustments from the portable device.  
BAND: Press to listen to the radio when a portable  
audio device is playing. The portable audio device  
continues playing, so you might want to stop it or power  
it off.  
Compressed Audio  
The radio also plays discs that contain both  
uncompressed CD audio (.CDA files) and MP3/WMA  
files. By default the radio reads only the uncompressed  
audio and ignores the MP3/WMA files. Pressing the  
CAT button toggles between compressed and  
uncompressed audio format.  
CD/AUX (CD/Auxiliary): Press to play a CD when  
a portable audio device is playing. Press again and  
the system begins playing audio from the connected  
portable audio player. If a portable audio player is not  
connected, No Aux Input Device Founddisplays.  
MP3/WMA Format  
If you burn your own MP3/WMA disc on a personal  
computer:  
.
Make sure the MP3/WMA files are recorded on a  
CD-R or CD-RW disc.  
.
Do not mix standard audio and MP3/WMA files on  
one disc.  
4-100  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
.
.
The CD player is able to read and play a maximum  
of 50 folders, 50 playlists, and 255 files.  
Playlists can be changed by using the  
S c and c T folder buttons, the a knob,  
or the SEEK arrows. An MP3/WMA CD-R or CD-RW  
that was recorded using no file folders can also be  
played. If a CD-R or CD-RW contains more than the  
maximum of 50 folders, 50 playlists, and 255 files,  
the player lets you access and navigate up to the  
maximum, but all items over the maximum cannot be  
accessed.  
Create a folder structure that makes it easy to find  
songs while driving. Organize songs by albums  
using one folder for each album. Each folder or  
album should contain 18 songs or less.  
.
Avoid subfolders. The system can support up to  
8 subfolders deep, however, keep the total number  
of folders to a minimum in order to reduce the  
complexity and confusion in trying to locate a  
particular folder during playback.  
Root Directory  
The root directory of the CD-R or CD-RW is treated as a  
folder. If the root directory has compressed audio files,  
the directory displays as F1 ROOT. All files contained  
directly under the root directory are accessed prior to  
any root directory folders. However, playlists (Px) are  
always accessed before root folders or files.  
.
.
Make sure playlists have a .m3u or .wpl extension  
(other file extensions might not work).  
Minimize the length of the file, folder or playlist  
names. Long file, folder, or playlist names, or a  
combination of a large number of files and folders,  
or playlists can cause the player to be unable to  
play up to the maximum number of files, folders,  
playlists, or sessions. If you wish to play a large  
number of files, folders, playlists, or sessions,  
minimize the length of the file, folder, or playlist  
name. Long names also take up more space on  
the display, potentially getting cut off.  
Empty Directory or Folder  
If a root directory or a folder exists somewhere in the  
file structure that contains only folders/subfolders and  
no compressed files directly beneath them, the player  
advances to the next folder in the file structure that  
contains compressed audio files. The empty folder does  
not display.  
.
Finalize the audio disc before you burn it. Trying to  
add music to an existing disc can cause the disc  
not to function in the player.  
4-101  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
.
Play begins from the first track in the first folder  
and continues sequentially through all tracks in  
each folder. When the last track of the last folder  
has played, play continues from the first track of  
the first folder.  
No Folder  
When the CD contains only compressed files, the files  
are located under the root folder. The next and previous  
folder functions do not display on a CD that was  
recorded without folders or playlists. When displaying  
the name of the folder the radio displays ROOT.  
When play enters a new folder, the display does not  
automatically show the new folder name unless the  
folder mode has been chosen as the default display.  
The new track name displays.  
When the CD contains only playlists and compressed  
audio files, but no folders, all files are located under the  
root folder. The folder down and the folder up buttons  
search playlists (Px) first and then goes to the root  
folder. When the radio displays the name of the folder  
the radio displays ROOT.  
File System and Naming  
The song name that displays is the song name that  
is contained in the ID3 tag. If the song name is not  
present in the ID3 tag, then the radio displays the file  
name without the extension (such as .mp3) as the  
track name.  
Order of Play  
Tracks recorded to the CD-R or CD-RW play in the  
following order:  
Track names longer than 32 characters or four pages  
are shortened. Parts of words on the last page of text  
and the extension of the filename does not display.  
.
Play begins from the first track in the first playlist  
and continues sequentially through all tracks in  
each playlist. When the last track of the last playlist  
has played, play continues from the first track of  
the first playlist.  
Playlists can be changed by pressing  
the S c and c T folder buttons,  
the a knob, or the SEEK arrows.  
4-102  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Preprogrammed Playlists  
Z (Eject): Press this button to eject CD-R(s) or  
CD-RW(s). To eject the CD-R or CD-RW that is  
currently playing, press and release this button. A beep  
sounds and Ejecting Disc displays. Once the disc is  
ejected, Remove Disc displays. The CD-R or CD-RW  
can be removed. If it is not removed, after several  
seconds, the CD-R or CD-RW automatically pulls back  
into the player and begins playing.  
Preprogrammed playlists that were created using  
WinAmp, MusicMatch, or Real Jukeboxsoftware  
can be accessed, however, they cannot be edited using  
the radio. These playlists are treated as special folders  
containing compressed audio song files. Playlists must  
have a file extension of PLS, M3U, or WPL.  
Playlists can be changed by using the  
S c and c T folder buttons, the a knob,  
or the SEEK arrows. Tracks cannot be changed.  
For the Six-Disc CD player, press and hold this button  
for two seconds to eject all discs.  
a (Tune): Turn this knob to select MP3/WMA files on  
the CD-R currently playing.  
Songs are played sequentially; press the s REV  
or \ FWD to reverse or advance through the currently  
playing song.  
© SEEK ¨ : Press the left SEEK arrow to go to the start  
of the current MP3/WMA file, if more than ten seconds  
have played. Press the right SEEK arrow to go to the  
next MP3/WMA file. If either SEEK arrow is held or  
pressed multiple times, the player continues moving  
backward or forward through MP3/WMA files on the CD.  
Playing an MP3/WMA  
Insert a CD-R or CD-RW partway into the slot  
(Single CD Player), or press the load button and wait  
for the message to insert disc (Six-Disc CD Player),  
label side up. The player pulls it in, and the CD-R or  
CD-RW should begin playing.  
S c (Previous Folder): Press the pushbutton  
positioned under the Folder tab to go to the first track  
in the previous folder.  
c T (Next Folder): Press the pushbutton positioned  
under the Folder tab to go to the first track in the next  
folder.  
4-103  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
s REV (Fast Reverse): Press and hold to reverse  
playback quickly within an MP3/WMA file. Sound is  
heard at a reduced volume. Release this button to  
resume playing the file. The elapsed time of the file  
displays.  
h (Music Navigator): Use the music navigator  
feature to play MP3/WMA files on the CD-R or CD-RW  
in order by artist or album. Press the pushbutton located  
below the music navigator label. The player scans  
the disc to sort the files by artist and album ID3 tag  
information. It may take several minutes to scan the  
disc depending on the number of MP3/WMA files  
recorded to the CD-R or CD-RW. The radio might begin  
playing while it is scanning the disc in the background.  
When the scan is finished, the CD-R or CD-RW begins  
playing again.  
\ FWD (Fast Forward): Press and hold to advance  
playback quickly within an MP3/WMA file. Sound is  
heard at a reduced volume. Release this button to  
resume playing the file. The elapsed time of the file  
displays.  
RDM (Random): With the random setting, MP3/WMA  
files on the CD-R can be played in random, rather than  
sequential order, on one CD-R/CD-RW or all discs in a  
six-disc CD player. To use random:  
Once the disc has scanned, the player defaults to  
playing MP3/WMA files in order by artist. The current  
artist playing is shown on the second line of the display  
between the arrows. Once all songs by that artist  
have played, the player moves to the next artist in  
alphabetical order on the CD-R or CD-RW and begins  
playing MP3/WMA files by that artist. If you want to  
listen to MP3/WMA files by another artist, press the  
pushbutton located below either arrow button. The CD  
goes to the next or previous artist in alphabetical order.  
Continue pressing either button until the desired artist  
displays.  
1. Press the pushbutton positioned under the RDM  
label until Random Current Disc displays to play  
MP3/WMA files from the CD-R or CD-RW in  
random order. Press the same pushbutton again  
to turn off random play.  
2. Press the pushbutton positioned under the RDM  
label until Randomize All Discs displays to play  
songs from all CDs loaded in a six-disc CD player  
in random order. Press the same pushbutton again  
to turn off random play.  
4-104  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
To change from playback by artist to playback by  
album, press the pushbutton located below the Sort  
By label. From the sort screen, push one of the  
buttons below the album button. Press the pushbutton  
below the Back label to return to the main music  
navigator screen. Now the album name displays on the  
second line between the arrows and songs from the  
current album begins to play. Once all songs from that  
album have played, the player moves to the next album  
in alphabetical order on the CD-R or CD-RW and begins  
playing MP3/WMA files from that album.  
XM Radio Messages  
XL (Explicit Language Channels): These channels,  
or any others, can be blocked at a customer's  
request, by calling 1-800-929-2100 in the U.S. and  
1-877-438-9677 in Canada.  
XM Updating: The encryption code in the receiver is  
being updated, and no action is required. This process  
should take no longer than 30 seconds.  
No XM Signal: The system is functioning correctly, but  
the vehicle is in a location that is blocking the XM™  
signal. When the vehicle is moved into an open area,  
the signal should return.  
To exit music navigator mode, press the button below  
the Back label to return to normal MP3/WMA playback.  
BAND: Press to listen to the radio when a CD is  
playing. The inactive CD remains inside the radio for  
future listening.  
Loading XM: The audio system is acquiring and  
processing audio and text data. No action is needed.  
This message should disappear shortly.  
CD/AUX (CD/Auxiliary): Press to play a CD when  
listening to the radio. The CD icon and a message  
showing disc and/or track number displays when a CD  
is in the player. Press this button again and the system  
automatically searches for an auxiliary input device  
such as a portable audio player. If a portable audio  
player is not connected, No Aux Input Device Found”  
displays.  
Channel Off Air: This channel is not currently in  
service. Tune in to another channel.  
Channel Unauth: This channel is blocked or cannot be  
received with your XM Subscription package.  
Channel Unavail: This previously assigned channel  
is no longer assigned. Tune to another station. If this  
station was one of the presets, choose another station  
for that preset button.  
4-105  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
No Artist Info: No artist information is available at this  
time on this channel. The system is working properly.  
XM Radio ID: If tuned to channel 0, this message  
alternates with the XMRadio 8 digit radio ID label.  
This label is needed to activate the service.  
No Title Info: No song title information is available at  
this time on this channel. The system is working  
properly.  
Unknown: If this message is received when tuned to  
channel 0, there could be a receiver fault. Consult with  
your dealer.  
No CAT Info: No category information is available at  
this time on this channel. The system is working  
properly.  
Check Antenna: If this message does not clear within  
a short period of time, the receiver or antenna could  
have a fault. Consult with your dealer.  
No Information: No text or informational messages are  
available at this time on this channel. The system is  
working properly.  
Check XM Receivr: If this message does not clear  
within a short period of time, the receiver could have a  
fault. Consult with your dealer.  
No Subscription Please Renew: The XM  
subscription needs to be reactivated. Contact XM at  
www.xmradio.com or call 1-800-929-2100 in the U.S.  
and www.xmradio.ca or call 1-877-438-9677 in Canada.  
XM Not Available: If this message does not clear  
within a short period of time, the receiver could have a  
fault. Consult with your dealer.  
CAT Not Found: There are no channels available for  
the selected category. The system is working properly.  
Navigation/Radio System  
For vehicles with a navigation radio system, see the  
separate Navigation System manual.  
XM Theftlocked: The XM receiver in the vehicle could  
have previously been in another vehicle. For security  
purposes, XM receivers cannot be swapped between  
vehicles. If this message is received after having the  
vehicle serviced, check with your dealer.  
4-106  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Bluetooth®  
Audio System  
When using the invehicle Bluetooth system, sound  
comes through the vehicle's front audio system  
speakers and overrides the audio system. Use the  
audio system volume knob, during a call, to change the  
volume level. The adjusted volume level remains in  
memory for later calls. To prevent missed calls, a  
minimum volume level is used if the volume is turned  
down too low.  
Vehicles with a Bluetooth system can use a Bluetooth  
capable cell phone with a Hands Free Profile to make  
and receive phone calls. The system can be used while  
the key is in ON/RUN or ACC/ACCESSORY position.  
The range of the Bluetooth system can be up to 9.1 m  
(30 ft). Not all phones support all functions, and not all  
phones are guaranteed to work with the in-vehicle  
Bluetooth system. See www.gm.com/bluetooth for more  
information on compatible phones.  
Bluetooth Controls  
Voice Recognition  
The Bluetooth system uses voice recognition to  
interpret voice commands to dial phone numbers and  
name tags.  
Use the buttons located on the steering wheel to  
operate the invehicle Bluetooth system. See Audio  
Steering Wheel Controls on page 4114 for more  
information.  
b g (Push To Talk): Press to answer incoming calls, to  
confirm system information, and to start speech  
recognition.  
For additional information say Helpwhile you are in a  
voice recognition menu.  
Noise: Keep interior noise levels to a minimum. The  
system may not recognize voice commands if there is  
too much background noise.  
c x (Phone On Hook): Press to end a call, reject a  
call, or to cancel an operation.  
When to Speak: A short tone sounds after the system  
responds indicating when it is waiting for a voice  
command. Wait until the tone and then speak.  
How to Speak: Speak clearly in a calm and natural  
voice.  
4-107  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Pairing a Phone  
Pairing  
A Bluetooth cell phone must be paired to the Bluetooth  
system and then connected to the vehicle before it can  
be used. See your cell phone manufacturers user guide  
for Bluetooth functions before pairing the cell phone. If a  
Bluetooth phone is not connected, calls will be made  
using OnStar® HandsFree Calling, if available. Refer to  
the OnStar owner's guide for more information.  
1. Press and hold b g for two seconds.  
2. Say Bluetooth.  
3. Say Pair. The system responds with instructions  
and a fourdigit PIN number. The PIN number is  
used in Step 5.  
4. Start the pairing process on the cell phone that you  
want to pair. For help with this process, see your  
cell phone manufacturers user guide.  
Pairing Information  
.
Up to five cell phones can be paired to the  
5. Locate the device named Your Vehiclein the list  
on the cell phone. Follow the instructions on the  
cell phone to enter the PIN number that was  
provided in Step 3. After the PIN number is  
successfully entered, the system prompts you to  
provide a name for the paired cell phone. This  
name will be used to indicate which phones are  
paired and connected to the vehicle, see Listing  
All Paired and Connected Phoneslater in this  
section for more information.  
Bluetooth system.  
.
The pairing process is disabled when the vehicle is  
moving.  
.
Pairing only needs to be completed once, unless  
the pairing information on the cell phone changes  
or the cell phone is deleted from the system.  
.
Only one paired cell phone can be connected to  
the Bluetooth system at a time.  
.
If multiple paired cell phones are within range  
6. Repeat Steps 1 through 5 to pair additional  
phones.  
of the system, the system connects to the  
first available paired cell phone in the order  
that they were first paired to the system. To link  
to a different paired phone, see Linking to a  
Different Phonelater in this section.  
4-108  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Listing All Paired and Connected Phones  
Connecting to a Different Phone  
The system can list all cell phones paired to it. If a  
paired cell phone is also connected to the vehicle,  
the system responds with is connectedafter that  
phone name.  
To connect to a different cell phone, the Bluetooth  
system looks for the next available cell phone in the  
order in which all the available cell phones were paired.  
Depending on which cell phone you want to connect to,  
you may have to use this command several times.  
1. Press and hold b g for two seconds.  
2. Say Bluetooth.  
1. Press and hold b g for two seconds.  
2. Say Bluetooth.  
3. Say List.  
3. Say Change phone.  
Deleting a Paired Phone  
.
If another cell phone is found, the response will  
If the phone name you want to delete is unknown, see  
Listing All Paired and Connected Phones.  
be <Phone name> is now connected.  
.
If another cell phone is not found, the original  
phone remains connected.  
1. Press and hold b g for two seconds.  
2. Say Bluetooth.  
Storing and Deleting Phone Numbers  
The system can store up to 30 phone numbers as name  
tags in the Hands Free Directory that is shared between  
the Bluetooth and OnStar systems.  
3. Say Delete. The system asks for which phone to  
delete.  
4. Say the name of the phone you want to delete.  
The following commands are used delete and store  
phone numbers.  
Store: This command will store a phone number, or a  
group of numbers as a name tag.  
Digit Store: This command allows a phone number to  
be stored as a name tag by entering the digits one at  
a time.  
4-109  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Delete: This command is used to delete individual  
name tags.  
3. Say each digit, one at a time, that you want to  
store. After each digit is entered, the system  
repeats back the digit it heard followed by a tone.  
After the last digit has been entered, say Store,  
and then follow the directions given by the system  
to save a name tag for this number.  
Delete All Name Tags: This command deletes all  
stored name tags in the Hands Free Calling Directory  
and the OnStarTurn by Turn Destinations Directory.  
Using the StoreCommand  
Using the DeleteCommand  
1. Press and hold b g for two seconds.  
2. Say Store.  
1. Press and hold b g for two seconds.  
2. Say Delete.  
3. Say the phone number or group of numbers you  
want to store all at once with no pauses, then  
follow the directions given by the system to save  
a name tag for this number.  
3. Say the name tag you want to delete.  
Using the Delete All Name Tags”  
Command  
Using the Digit StoreCommand  
This command deletes all stored name tags in the  
Hands Free Calling Directory and the OnStarTurn by  
Turn Destinations Directory.  
If an unwanted number is recognized by the system,  
say Clearat any time to clear the last number.  
To delete all name tags:  
To hear all of the numbers recognized by the system,  
say Verifyat any time.  
1. Press and hold b g for two seconds.  
2. Say Delete all name tags.  
1. Press and hold b g for two seconds.  
2. Say Digit Store.  
4-110  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using the Dialor CallCommand  
Listing Stored Numbers  
The list command will list all the stored numbers and  
name tags.  
1. Press and hold b g for two seconds.  
2. Say Dialor Call.  
Using the ListCommand  
3. Say the entire number without pausing or say the  
name tag.  
1. Press and hold b g for two seconds.  
2. Say Directory.  
Once connected, the person called will be heard  
through the audio speakers.  
3. Say Hands Free Calling.  
4. Say List.  
Using the Digit DialCommand  
The digit dial command allows a phone number to be  
dialed by entering the digits one at a time. After each  
digit is entered, the system repeats back the digit it  
heard followed by a tone.  
Making a Call  
Calls can be made using the following commands.  
Dial or Call: The dial or call command can be used  
interchangeably to dial a phone number or a stored  
name tag.  
If an unwanted number is recognized by the system,  
say Clearat any time to clear the last number.  
To hear all of the numbers recognized by the system,  
say Verifyat any time.  
Digit Dial: This command allows a phone number to be  
dialed by entering the digits one at a time.  
1. Press and hold b g for two seconds.  
2. Say Digit Dial.  
Redial: This command is used to dial the last number  
used on the cell phone.  
3. Say each digit, one at a time, that you want to dial.  
After each digit is entered, the system repeats  
back the digit it heard followed by a tone. After the  
last digit has been entered, say Dial.  
Once connected, the person called will be heard  
through the audio speakers.  
4-111  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using the RedialCommand  
ThreeWay Calling  
Threeway calling must be supported on the cell phone  
and enabled by the wireless service carrier.  
1. Press and hold b g for two seconds.  
2. After the tone, say Redial.  
1. While on a call, press b g.  
2. Say Threeway call.  
Once connected, the person called will be heard  
through the audio speakers.  
3. Use the dial or call command to dial the number of  
the third party to be called.  
Receiving a Call  
When an incoming call is received, the audio system  
mutes and a ring tone is heard in the vehicle.  
4. Once the call is connected, press b g to link all  
the callers together.  
.
Press b g to answer the call.  
Ending a Call  
.
Press c x to ignore a call.  
Press c x to end a call.  
Call Waiting  
Call waiting must be supported on the cell phone and  
enabled by the wireless service carrier.  
Muting a Call  
During a call, all sounds from inside the vehicle can be  
muted so that the person on the other end of the call  
cannot hear them.  
.
Press b g to answer an incoming call when  
another call is active. The original call is placed  
on hold.  
To mute a call, press b g, and then say Mute Call.  
.
Press b g again to return to the original call.  
To ignore the incoming call, no action is required.  
To cancel mute, press b g, and then say  
Unmute Call.  
.
.
Press c x to disconnect the current call and  
switch to the call on hold.  
4-112  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Transferring a Call  
Voice Pass-Thru  
Audio can be transferred between the Bluetooth system  
and the cell phone.  
Voice passthru allows access to the voice recognition  
commands on the cell phone. See your cell phone  
manufacturers user guide to see if the cell phone  
supports this feature.  
The cell phone must be paired and connected with the  
Bluetooth system before a call can be transferred. The  
connection process can take up to two minutes after the  
ignition is turned to ON/RUN.  
To access contacts stored in the cell phone:  
1. Press and hold b g for two seconds.  
2. Say Bluetooth. The system responds Bluetooth  
ready, followed by a tone.  
To Transfer Audio From the Bluetooth  
System to a Cell Phone  
During a call with the audio in the vehicle:  
3. Say Voice. The system responds OK, accessing  
<phone name>.  
1. Press b g.  
2. Say Transfer Call.  
.
The cell phone's normal prompt messages will  
go through its cycle according to the phone's  
operating instructions.  
To Transfer Audio to the Bluetooth System  
From a Cell Phone  
Dual Tone Multi-Frequency (DTMF)  
Tones  
During a call with the audio on the cell phone,  
press b g. The audio transfers to the vehicle. If the  
audio does not transfer to the vehicle, use the audio  
transfer feature on the cell phone. See your cell phone  
manufacturers user guide for more information.  
The Bluetooth system can send numbers and the  
numbers stored as name tags during a call. You can  
use this feature when calling a menu driven phone  
system. Account numbers can also be stored for use.  
4-113  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Sending a Number or Name Tag During  
a Call  
Theft-Deterrent Feature  
THEFTLOCK® is designed to discourage theft of the  
vehicle's radio by learning a portion of the Vehicle  
Identification Number (VIN). The radio does not operate  
if it is stolen or moved to a different vehicle.  
1. Press b g. The system responds Ready,  
followed by a tone.  
2. Say Dial.  
3. Say the number or name tag to send.  
Audio Steering Wheel Controls  
Clearing the System  
Vehicles with audio  
steering wheel controls  
could differ depending  
on the vehicle's options.  
Some audio controls  
can be adjusted at the  
steering wheel.  
Unless information is deleted out of the invehicle  
Bluetooth system, it will be retained indefinitely. This  
includes all saved name tags in the phone book and  
phone pairing information. For information on how to  
delete this information, see the previous sections on  
Deleting a Paired Phone and Deleting Name Tags.  
Other Information  
The Bluetooth® word mark and logos are owned by the  
Bluetooth® SIG, Inc. and any use of such marks by  
General Motors is under license. Other trademarks and  
trade names are those of their respective owners.  
See Radio Frequency Statement on page 818 for FCC  
information.  
w (Next): Press to go to the next radio station stored  
as a favorite, or the next track if a CD/DVD is playing.  
c x (Previous/End): Press to go to the previous  
radio station stored as a favorite, the next track if a  
CD/DVD is playing, to reject an incoming call, or end a  
current call.  
4-114  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
b g (Mute/Push to Talk): Press to silence the vehicle  
Radio Reception  
speakers only. Press again to turn the sound on.  
Frequency interference and static can occur during  
normal radio reception if items such as cell phone  
chargers, vehicle convenience accessories, and  
external electronic devices are plugged into the  
accessory power outlet. If there is interference or static,  
unplug the item from the accessory power outlet.  
For vehicles with Bluetooth or OnStar® systems press  
and hold for longer than two seconds to interact with  
those systems. See Bluetooth® on page 4107 or the  
OnStar Owner's Guide for more information.  
SRCE (Source): Press to switch between the radio  
(AM, FM, XM), CD, and for vehicles with, DVD, front  
auxiliary, and rear auxiliary.  
AM  
The range for most AM stations is greater than for FM,  
especially at night. The longer range can cause station  
frequencies to interfere with each other. For better radio  
reception, most AM radio stations boost the power  
levels during the day, and then reduce these levels  
during the night. Static can also occur when things like  
storms and power lines interfere with radio reception.  
When this happens, try reducing the treble on the radio.  
For vehicles with the navigation system, press and hold  
this button for longer than two seconds to initiate voice  
recognition. See Voice Recognitionin the Navigation  
System manual for more information.  
+ e e (Volume): Press to increase or to decrease  
the radio volume.  
¨ (Seek): Press to go to the next radio station while in  
AM, FM, or XM. Press ¨ to go to the next track or  
chapter while sourced to the CD or DVD slot. Press  
FM Stereo  
FM signals only reach about 10 to 40 miles  
(16 to 65 km). Although the radio has a built-in  
electronic circuit that automatically works to reduce  
interference, some static can occur, especially around  
tall buildings or hills, causing the sound to fade in  
and out.  
the ¨ if multiple discs are loaded to go to the next disc  
while sourced to a CD player.  
4-115  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
If a cellular telephone antenna needs to be attached to  
the glass, make sure that the grid lines for the AM-FM  
antenna are not damaged. There is enough space  
between the grid lines to attach a cellular telephone  
antenna without interfering with radio reception.  
XMSatellite Radio Service  
XM Satellite Radio Service gives digital radio reception  
from coast-to-coast in the 48 contiguous United States,  
and in Canada. Just as with FM, tall buildings or hills  
can interfere with satellite radio signals, causing the  
sound to fade in and out. In addition, traveling or  
standing under heavy foliage, bridges, garages,  
or tunnels may cause loss of the XM signal for a period  
of time.  
Notice: Using a razor blade or sharp object to clear  
the inside rear window can damage the rear window  
antenna and/or the rear window defogger. Repairs  
would not be covered by the vehicle warranty. Do  
not clear the inside rear window with sharp objects.  
Cellular Phone Usage  
Notice: Do not apply aftermarket glass tinting  
with metallic film. The metallic film in some tinting  
materials will interfere with or distort the incoming  
radio reception. Any damage caused to your  
backglass antenna due to metallic tinting materials  
will not be covered by the vehicle warranty.  
Cellular phone usage may cause interference with  
the vehicle's radio. This interference may occur  
when making or receiving phone calls, charging the  
phone's battery, or simply having the phone on. This  
interference causes an increased level of static while  
listening to the radio. If static is received while listening  
to the radio, unplug the cellular phone and turn it off.  
XMSatellite Radio Antenna  
System  
Backglass Antenna  
The XM Satellite Radio antenna is located on the roof of  
the vehicle. Keep the antenna clear of obstructions for  
clear radio reception.  
The AM-FM antenna is integrated with the rear window  
defogger, located in the rear window. Make sure that the  
inside surface of the rear window is not scratched and  
that the lines on the glass are not damaged. If the  
inside surface is damaged, it could interfere with radio  
reception. For proper radio reception, the antenna  
connector needs to be properly attached to the post on  
the glass.  
If the vehicle has a sunroof, the performance of the XM  
system may be affected if the sunroof is open.  
4-116  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 5 Driving Your Vehicle  
Your Driving, the Road, and the Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . 5-2  
Driving at Night . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-12  
Driving in Rain and on Wet Roads . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-12  
Before Leaving on a Long Trip . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-13  
Highway Hypnosis . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-14  
Hill and Mountain Roads . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-14  
Winter Driving . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-15  
If Your Vehicle is Stuck in Sand, Mud, Ice,  
or Snow . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-17  
Rocking Your Vehicle to Get It Out . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-17  
Loading the Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-18  
Defensive Driving . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-2  
Drunk Driving . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-2  
Control of a Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-3  
Braking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-3  
Antilock Brake System (ABS) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-4  
Braking in Emergencies . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-5  
StabiliTrak® System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-6  
Traction Control System (TCS) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-6  
Magnetic Ride Control. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-8  
Steering . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-8  
Off-Road Recovery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-10  
Passing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-10  
Loss of Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-10  
Towing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-24  
Towing Your Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-24  
Recreational Vehicle Towing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-24  
Towing a Trailer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-26  
5-1  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Drunk Driving  
Your Driving, the Road, and the  
Vehicle  
WARNING:  
{
Defensive Driving  
Drinking and then driving is very dangerous.  
Your reflexes, perceptions, attentiveness, and  
judgment can be affected by even a small amount  
of alcohol. You can have a serious or even  
fatal collision if you drive after drinking. Do not  
drink and drive or ride with a driver who has been  
drinking. Ride home in a cab; or if you are with a  
group, designate a driver who will not drink.  
Defensive driving means always expect the  
unexpected.The first step in driving defensively is to  
wear your safety belt See Safety Belts: They Are for  
Everyone on page 211.  
WARNING:  
{
Assume that other road users (pedestrians,  
bicyclists, and other drivers) are going to be  
careless and make mistakes. Anticipate what they  
might do and be ready. In addition:  
Death and injury associated with drinking and driving is  
a global tragedy.  
Alcohol affects four things that anyone needs to drive a  
vehicle: judgment, muscular coordination, vision, and  
attentiveness.  
.
Allow enough following distance between you  
and the driver in front of you.  
.
Focus on the task of driving.  
Police records show that almost 40 percent of all motor  
vehicle-related deaths involve alcohol. In most cases,  
these deaths are the result of someone who was  
drinking and driving. In recent years, more than  
17,000 annual motor vehicle-related deaths have  
been associated with the use of alcohol, with about  
250,000 people injured.  
Driver distraction can cause collisions resulting in  
injury or possible death. These simple defensive  
driving techniques could save your life.  
5-2  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
For persons under 21, it is against the law in every  
U.S. state to drink alcohol. There are good medical,  
psychological, and developmental reasons for  
these laws.  
Braking  
See Brake System Warning Light on page 450.  
Braking action involves perception time and reaction  
time. Deciding to push the brake pedal is perception  
time. Actually doing it is reaction time.  
The obvious way to eliminate the leading highway  
safety problem is for people never to drink alcohol and  
then drive.  
Average reaction time is about threefourths of a  
second. But that is only an average. It might be less  
with one driver and as long as two or three seconds or  
more with another. Age, physical condition, alertness,  
coordination, and eyesight all play a part. So do alcohol,  
drugs, and frustration. But even in threefourths of a  
second, a vehicle moving at 100 km/h (60 mph) travels  
20 m (66 feet). That could be a lot of distance in an  
emergency, so keeping enough space between the  
vehicle and others is important.  
Medical research shows that alcohol in a person's  
system can make crash injuries worse, especially  
injuries to the brain, spinal cord, or heart. This means  
that when anyone who has been drinking driver or  
passenger is in a crash, that person's chance of  
being killed or permanently disabled is higher than if the  
person had not been drinking.  
Control of a Vehicle  
And, of course, actual stopping distances vary greatly  
with the surface of the road, whether it is pavement or  
gravel; the condition of the road, whether it is wet, dry,  
or icy; tire tread; the condition of the brakes; the weight  
of the vehicle; and the amount of brake force applied.  
The following three systems help to control the vehicle  
while driving brakes, steering, and accelerator. At  
times, as when driving on snow or ice, it is easy to ask  
more of those control systems than the tires and road  
can provide. Meaning, you can lose control of the  
vehicle. See Traction Control System (TCS) on  
page 56  
.
Adding nondealer accessories can affect vehicle  
performance. See Accessories and Modifications on  
page 63  
.
5-3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Avoid needless heavy braking. Some people drive in  
spurts, heavy acceleration followed by heavy braking,  
rather than keeping pace with traffic. This is a mistake.  
The brakes might not have time to cool between hard  
stops. The brakes will wear out much faster with a lot  
of heavy braking. Keeping pace with the traffic and  
allowing realistic following distances eliminates a lot of  
unnecessary braking. That means better braking and  
longer brake life.  
Antilock Brake System (ABS)  
This vehicle has the Antilock Brake System (ABS), an  
advanced electronic braking system that helps prevent  
a braking skid.  
When the engine is started and the vehicle begins to  
drive away, ABS checks itself. A momentary motor or  
clicking noise might be heard while this test is going on,  
and it might even be noticed that the brake pedal  
moves a little. This is normal.  
If the engine ever stops while the vehicle is being  
driven, brake normally but do not pump the brakes.  
If the brakes are pumped, the pedal could get harder to  
push down. If the engine stops, there will still be some  
power brake assist but it will be used when the brake is  
applied. Once the power assist is used up, it can take  
longer to stop and the brake pedal will be harder  
to push.  
If there is a problem with  
ABS, this warning light  
stays on. See Antilock  
Brake System (ABS)  
Warning Light on  
page 451  
.
Adding nondealer accessories can affect vehicle  
performance. See Accessories and Modifications on  
page 63  
.
Let us say the road is wet and you are driving safely.  
Suddenly, an animal jumps out in front of you. You slam  
on the brakes and continue braking. Here is what  
happens with ABS:  
A computer senses that the wheels are slowing  
down. If one of the wheels is about to stop rolling, the  
computer will separately work the brakes at each front  
wheel and at both rear wheels.  
5-4  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ABS can change the brake pressure to each wheel, as  
required, faster than any driver could. This can help the  
driver steer around the obstacle while braking hard.  
Braking in Emergencies  
ABS allows the driver to steer and brake at the same  
time. In many emergencies, steering can help more  
than even the very best braking.  
As the brakes are applied, the computer keeps  
receiving updates on wheel speed and controls braking  
pressure accordingly.  
Brake Assist  
Remember: ABS does not change the time needed to  
get a foot up to the brake pedal or always decrease  
stopping distance. If you get too close to the vehicle in  
front of you, there will not be enough time to apply the  
brakes if that vehicle suddenly slows or stops. Always  
leave enough room up ahead to stop, even with ABS.  
This vehicle has a Brake Assist feature designed to  
assist the driver in stopping or decreasing vehicle  
speed in emergency driving conditions. This feature  
uses the stability system hydraulic brake control module  
to supplement the power brake system under conditions  
where the driver has quickly and forcefully applied the  
brake pedal in an attempt to quickly stop or slow down  
the vehicle. The stability system hydraulic brake control  
module increases brake pressure at each corner of  
the vehicle until the ABS activates. Minor brake pedal  
pulsations or pedal movement during this time is normal  
and the driver should continue to apply the brake pedal  
as the driving situation dictates The Brake Assist  
feature will automatically disengage when the brake  
pedal is released or brake pedal pressure is quickly  
decreased.  
Using ABS  
Do not pump the brakes. Just hold the brake pedal  
down firmly and let antilock work. The antilock pump or  
motor operating might be heard and the brake pedal  
might be felt to pulsate, but this is normal.  
5-5  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
StabiliTrak® System  
The TCS/StabiliTrak warning light on the instrument  
panel cluster will flash when the system is operating.  
See Traction Control System (TCS) Warning Light on  
page 451 and StabiliTrak® Indicator Light on  
page 452 for more information. The system may be  
heard or felt while it is working. This is normal.  
The vehicle may have the StabiliTrak system which  
combines antilock brake, traction and stability control  
systems and helps the driver maintain directional  
control of the vehicle in most driving conditions. This is  
accomplished by selectively applying any one of the  
vehicle's brakes and reducing engine power.  
The SERVICE STABILITRAK message is displayed  
and the TCS/StabiliTrak warning light on the instrument  
panel cluster comes on if there is a problem with  
the system. When this light and the SERVICE  
STABILITRAK message are on, the system is not  
working. Adjust your driving accordingly.  
The StabiliTrak system comes on automatically  
whenever the vehicle is started. The system cannot be  
turned off.  
This light will flash when  
the system is operating.  
Traction Control System (TCS)  
The vehicle has a Traction Control System (TCS) that  
limits wheel spin. This is especially useful in slippery  
road conditions. The system operates only if it senses  
that the front wheels are spinning too much or  
beginning to lose traction. When this happens, the  
system works the front brakes and reduces engine  
power (by closing the throttle and managing engine  
spark) to limit wheel spin.  
The STABILITRAK NOT READY message may be  
displayed in the Driver Information Center (DIC) and the  
Traction Control System (TCS)/StabiliTrak warning light  
on the instrument panel cluster comes on after first  
driving the vehicle and exceeding 19 mph (30 km/h) for  
30 seconds. The StabiliTrak system is off until the light  
has turned off. This could take up to 15 minutes.  
5-6  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The TCS and StabiliTrak®  
light will flash when the  
system is limiting  
To turn the system off or  
on, press and release this  
button located in front of  
the shift lever.  
wheel spin.  
The system may be heard or felt while it is working, but  
this is normal. See Traction Control System (TCS)  
Warning Light on page 451 for more information.  
TCS automatically comes on whenever the vehicle is  
started. To limit wheel spin, especially in slippery road  
conditions, always leave the system turned on. TCS  
can be turned off if needed.  
If the vehicle is in cruise control when TCS begins to  
limit wheel spin, the cruise control will automatically  
disengage. The cruise control may be re-engaged when  
road conditions allow. See Cruise Control on page 412.  
The system can be turned on or off at any time by  
pressing the TCS button. The DIC will display  
TRACTION CONTROL OFF when the button is  
pressed, and part of the traction control system is  
disabled. The vehicle will still have brake-traction  
control, but will not be able to use the engine speed  
management system. System noises may be heard as  
a result of the brake-traction control working. If the  
controller detects excessive wheel spin in this mode,  
the TCS/StabiliTrak light may blink.  
The SERVICE TRACTION CONTROL message in the  
DIC and the TCS/StabiliTrak warning light comes on if  
there is a problem with the traction control system. See  
DIC Warnings and Messages on page 465.  
When this light and the SERVICE TRACTION  
CONTROL message are on, the system will not limit  
wheel spin. Adjust your driving accordingly.  
It is recommended to leave the system on for normal  
driving conditions, but it may be necessary to turn the  
system off if the vehicle is stuck in sand, mud, ice or  
snow, and you want to rockthe vehicle to attempt to  
free it. See If Your Vehicle is Stuck in Sand, Mud, Ice,  
or Snow on page 517.  
5-7  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Adding nondealer accessories can affect the vehicle's  
performance. See Accessories and Modifications on  
page 63 for more information.  
Steering  
Power Steering  
If power steering assist is lost because the engine stops  
or the system is not functioning, the vehicle can be  
steered but it will take more effort.  
Magnetic Ride Control  
The vehicle may have Magnetic Ride Control that  
automatically adjusts the ride of the vehicle. The  
controller receives input from the system to determine  
the proper ride. If the controller detects a problem within  
the system, the Driver Information Center (DIC) displays  
a SERVICE SUSPENSION SYS message. See DIC  
Warnings and Messages on page 465 for more  
information. If this message appears, have the vehicle  
serviced at your dealer.  
Magnetic Speed Variable Assist  
Steering System  
This system continuously adjusts the effort felt when  
steering at all vehicle speeds. It provides ease when  
parking, yet a firm, solid feel at highway speeds.  
Steering Tips  
Electronically Controlled Air Ride  
Suspension  
It is important to take curves at a reasonable speed.  
Traction in a curve depends on the condition of the tires  
and the road surface, the angle at which the curve is  
banked, and vehicle speed. While in a curve, speed is  
the one factor that can be controlled.  
Professional Vehicles may have Electronically  
Controlled Air Suspension. The air ride controller  
receives input from the system to determine the proper  
ride. If the controller detects a problem with the system,  
the DIC will display a SERVICE SUSPENSION SYS  
message. If this message appears, have the vehicle  
serviced at your dealer.  
If there is a need to reduce speed, do it before entering  
the curve, while the front wheels are straight.  
Try to adjust the speed so you can drive through the  
curve. Maintain a reasonable, steady speed. Wait to  
accelerate until out of the curve, and then accelerate  
gently into the straightaway.  
5-8  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Steering in Emergencies  
There are times when steering can be more effective  
than braking. For example, you come over a hill and  
find a truck stopped in your lane, or a car suddenly pulls  
out from nowhere, or a child darts out from between  
parked cars and stops right in front of you. These  
problems can be avoided by braking if you can  
stop in time. But sometimes you cannot stop in time  
because there is no room. That is the time for evasive  
action steering around the problem.  
The vehicle can perform very well in emergencies  
like these. First apply the brakes. See Braking on  
page 53. It is better to remove as much speed as  
possible from a collision. Then steer around the  
problem, to the left or right depending on the space  
available.  
An emergency like this requires close attention and a  
quick decision. If holding the steering wheel at the  
recommended 9 and 3 o'clock positions, it can be  
turned a full 180 degrees very quickly without removing  
either hand. But you have to act fast, steer quickly, and  
just as quickly straighten the wheel once you have  
avoided the object.  
The fact that such emergency situations are always  
possible is a good reason to practice defensive driving  
at all times and wear safety belts properly.  
5-9  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Off-Road Recovery  
Passing  
The vehicle's right wheels can drop off the edge of a  
road onto the shoulder while driving.  
Passing another vehicle on a two-lane road can be  
dangerous. To reduce the risk of danger while passing:  
.
Look down the road, to the sides, and to  
crossroads for situations that might affect a  
successful pass. If in doubt, wait.  
.
Watch for traffic signs, pavement markings, and  
lines that could indicate a turn or an intersection.  
Never cross a solid or doublesolid line on your  
side of the lane.  
.
Do not get too close to the vehicle you want to  
pass. Doing so can reduce your visibility.  
.
Wait your turn to pass a slow vehicle.  
.
When you are being passed, ease to the right.  
Loss of Control  
Let us review what driving experts say about what  
happens when the three control systems brakes,  
steering, and acceleration do not have enough  
friction where the tires meet the road to do what the  
driver has asked.  
If the level of the shoulder is only slightly below the  
pavement, recovery should be fairly easy. Ease off the  
accelerator and then, if there is nothing in the way, steer  
so that the vehicle straddles the edge of the pavement.  
Turn the steering wheel 8 to 13 cm (3 to 5 inches),  
about one-eighth turn, until the right front tire contacts  
the pavement edge. Then turn the steering wheel to go  
straight down the roadway.  
In any emergency, do not give up. Keep trying to steer  
and constantly seek an escape route or area of less  
danger.  
5-10  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
If the vehicle has StabiliTrak®, the system may be  
Skidding  
active. See StabiliTrak® System on page 56.  
In a skid, a driver can lose control of the vehicle.  
Defensive drivers avoid most skids by taking  
reasonable care suited to existing conditions, and by  
not overdriving those conditions. But skids are always  
possible.  
Of course, traction is reduced when water, snow, ice,  
gravel, or other material is on the road. For safety, slow  
down and adjust your driving to these conditions. It is  
important to slow down on slippery surfaces because  
stopping distance will be longer and vehicle control  
more limited.  
The three types of skids correspond to the vehicle's  
three control systems. In the braking skid, the wheels  
are not rolling. In the steering or cornering skid, too  
much speed or steering in a curve causes tires to slip  
and lose cornering force. And in the acceleration skid,  
too much throttle causes the driving wheels to spin.  
While driving on a surface with reduced traction, try  
your best to avoid sudden steering, acceleration,  
or braking, including reducing vehicle speed by shifting  
to a lower gear. Any sudden changes could cause the  
tires to slide. You may not realize the surface is slippery  
until the vehicle is skidding. Learn to recognize warning  
clues such as enough water, ice, or packed snow on  
the road to make a mirrored surface and slow down  
when you have any doubt.  
Remember: Any traction control system helps avoid  
only the acceleration skid. If the traction control system  
is off, then an acceleration skid is best handled by  
easing your foot off the accelerator pedal.  
If the vehicle starts to slide, ease your foot off the  
accelerator pedal and quickly steer the way you want  
the vehicle to go. If you start steering quickly enough,  
the vehicle may straighten out. Always be ready for a  
second skid if it occurs.  
Remember: Antilock brakes help avoid only the  
braking skid.  
5-11  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Driving at Night  
Driving in Rain and on Wet Roads  
Night driving is more dangerous than day driving  
because some drivers are likely to be impaired by  
alcohol or drugs, with night vision problems, or by  
fatigue.  
Rain and wet roads can reduce vehicle traction and  
affect your ability to stop and accelerate. Always drive  
slower in these types of driving conditions and avoid  
driving through large puddles and deepstanding or  
flowing water.  
Night driving tips include:  
.
Drive defensively.  
WARNING:  
.
{
Do not drink and drive.  
.
Reduce headlamp glare by adjusting the inside  
Wet brakes can cause crashes. They might not  
work as well in a quick stop and could cause  
pulling to one side. You could lose control of the  
vehicle.  
rearview mirror.  
.
Slow down and keep more space between you and  
other vehicles because headlamps can only light  
up so much road ahead.  
.
After driving through a large puddle of water or a  
car/vehicle wash, lightly apply the brake pedal  
until the brakes work normally.  
Watch for animals.  
.
When tired, pull off the road.  
.
Do not wear sunglasses.  
Flowing or rushing water creates strong forces.  
Driving through flowing water could cause your  
vehicle to be carried away. If this happens, you  
and other vehicle occupants could drown. Do not  
ignore police warnings and be very cautious about  
trying to drive through flowing water.  
.
Avoid staring directly into approaching headlamps.  
.
Keep the windshield and all glass on your vehicle  
clean inside and out.  
.
Keep your eyes moving, especially during turns or  
curves.  
No one can see as well at night as in the daytime.  
But, as we get older, these differences increase.  
A 50-year-old driver might need at least twice as much  
light to see the same thing at night as a 20-year-old.  
5-12  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Hydroplaning  
Before Leaving on a Long Trip  
Hydroplaning is dangerous. Water can build up under  
your vehicle's tires so they actually ride on the water.  
This can happen if the road is wet enough and you are  
going fast enough. When your vehicle is hydroplaning, it  
has little or no contact with the road.  
To prepare your vehicle for a long trip, consider having  
it serviced by your dealer before departing.  
Things to check on your own include:  
.
Windshield Washer Fluid: Reservoir full? Windows  
clean inside and outside?  
There is no hard and fast rule about hydroplaning. The  
best advice is to slow down when the road is wet.  
.
Wiper Blades: In good shape?  
.
Fuel, Engine Oil, Other Fluids: All levels checked?  
Other Rainy Weather Tips  
Besides slowing down, other wet weather driving tips  
include:  
.
Lamps: Do they all work and are lenses clean?  
.
Tires: Are treads good? Are tires inflated to  
recommended pressure?  
.
Allow extra following distance.  
.
Weather and Maps: Safe to travel? Have  
up-to-date maps?  
.
Pass with caution.  
.
Keep windshield wiping equipment in good shape.  
.
Keep the windshield washer fluid reservoir filled.  
.
Have good tires with proper tread depth. See Tires  
on page 648  
.
.
Turn off cruise control.  
5-13  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Highway Hypnosis  
Always be alert and pay attention to your surroundings  
while driving. If you become tired or sleepy, find a safe  
place to park your vehicle and rest.  
WARNING:  
{
If you do not shift down, the brakes could get so  
hot that they would not work well. You would then  
have poor braking or even none going down a hill.  
You could crash. Shift down to let the engine  
assist the brakes on a steep downhill slope.  
Other driving tips include:  
.
Keep the vehicle well ventilated.  
.
Keep interior temperature cool.  
.
Keep your eyes moving scan the road ahead  
and to the sides.  
.
Check the rearview mirror and vehicle instruments  
WARNING:  
{
often.  
Hill and Mountain Roads  
Driving on steep hills or through mountains is different  
than driving on flat or rolling terrain. Tips for driving in  
these conditions include:  
Coasting downhill in N (Neutral) or with the  
ignition off is dangerous. The brakes will have to  
do all the work of slowing down and they could  
get so hot that they would not work well. You  
would then have poor braking or even none going  
down a hill. You could crash. Always have the  
engine running and the vehicle in gear when  
going downhill.  
.
Keep the vehicle serviced and in good shape.  
.
Check all fluid levels and brakes, tires, cooling  
system, and transmission.  
.
Going down steep or long hills, shift to a  
lower gear.  
5-14  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
.
Stay in your own lane. Do not swing wide or cut  
across the center of the road. Drive at speeds that  
let you stay in your own lane.  
Try not to break the fragile traction. If you accelerate too  
fast, the drive wheels will spin and polish the surface  
under the tires even more.  
.
.
Top of hills: Be alert something could be in your  
lane (stalled car, accident).  
The Traction Control System (TCS) on page 56  
improves the ability to accelerate on slippery roads,  
but slow down and adjust your driving to the road  
conditions. When driving through deep snow, turn off  
the traction control system to help maintain vehicle  
motion at lower speeds.  
Pay attention to special road signs (falling rocks  
area, winding roads, long grades, passing or  
no-passing zones) and take appropriate action.  
Winter Driving  
The Antilock Brake System (ABS) on page 54  
improves vehicle stability during hard stops on a  
slippery roads, but apply the brakes sooner than when  
on dry pavement.  
Driving on Snow or Ice  
Drive carefully when there is snow or ice between the  
tires and the road, creating less traction or grip. Wet ice  
can occur at about 0°C (32°F) when freezing rain  
begins to fall, resulting in even less traction. Avoid  
driving on wet ice or in freezing rain until roads can be  
treated with salt or sand.  
Allow greater following distance on any slippery road  
and watch for slippery spots. Icy patches can occur on  
otherwise clear roads in shaded areas. The surface  
of a curve or an overpass can remain icy when the  
surrounding roads are clear. Avoid sudden steering  
maneuvers and braking while on ice.  
Drive with caution, whatever the condition. Accelerate  
gently so traction is not lost. Accelerating too quickly  
causes the wheels to spin and makes the surface under  
the tires slick, so there is even less traction.  
Turn off cruise control, if equipped, on slippery surfaces.  
5-15  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Blizzard Conditions  
WARNING: (Continued)  
Being stuck in snow can be in a serious situation. Stay  
with the vehicle unless there is help nearby. If possible,  
use the Roadside Service on page 87. To get help  
and keep everyone in the vehicle safe:  
.
Open a window about 5 cm (two inches) on  
the side of the vehicle that is away from the  
wind to bring in fresh air.  
.
Turn on the Hazard Warning Flashers on  
page 43  
.
.
.
Fully open the air outlets on or under the  
instrument panel.  
.
Tie a red cloth to an outside mirror.  
Adjust the Climate Control system to a setting  
that circulates the air inside the vehicle and  
set the fan speed to the highest setting. See  
Climate Control System in the Index.  
WARNING:  
{
Snow can trap engine exhaust under the vehicle.  
This may cause exhaust gases to get inside.  
Engine exhaust contains carbon monoxide (CO)  
which cannot be seen or smelled. It can cause  
unconsciousness and even death.  
For more information about carbon monoxide, see  
Engine Exhaust on page 333.  
Snow can trap exhaust gases under your vehicle.  
This can cause deadly CO (carbon monoxide) gas  
to get inside. CO could overcome you and kill you.  
You cannot see it or smell it, so you might not  
know it is in your vehicle. Clear away snow from  
around the base of your vehicle, especially any  
that is blocking the exhaust.  
If the vehicle is stuck in the snow:  
.
Clear away snow from around the base of  
your vehicle, especially any that is blocking  
the exhaust pipe.  
.
Check again from time to time to be sure  
snow does not collect there.  
To save fuel, run the engine for only short periods as  
needed to warm the vehicle and then shut the engine  
off and close the window most of the way to save heat.  
(Continued)  
5-16  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Repeat this until help arrives but only when you feel  
really uncomfortable from the cold. Moving about to  
keep warm also helps.  
WARNING:  
{
If it takes some time for help to arrive, now and then  
when you run the engine, push the accelerator pedal  
slightly so the engine runs faster than the idle speed.  
This keeps the battery charged to restart the vehicle  
and to signal for help with the headlamps. Do this as  
little as possible to save fuel.  
If the vehicle's tires spin at high speed, they can  
explode, and you or others could be injured.  
The vehicle can overheat, causing an engine  
compartment fire or other damage. Spin the  
wheels as little as possible and avoid going above  
55 km/h (35 mph) as shown on the speedometer.  
If Your Vehicle is Stuck in Sand,  
Mud, Ice, or Snow  
For information about using tire chains on the vehicle,  
see Tire Chains on page 673.  
Slowly and cautiously spin the wheels to free the  
vehicle when stuck in sand, mud, ice, or snow. See  
Rocking Your Vehicle to Get It Out on page 517.  
Rocking Your Vehicle to Get It Out  
Turn the steering wheel left and right to clear the area  
around the front wheels. Turn off any traction or stability  
system. Shift back and forth between R (Reverse) and a  
forward gear, spinning the wheels as little as possible.  
To prevent transmission wear, wait until the wheels stop  
spinning before shifting gears. Release the accelerator  
pedal while shifting, and press lightly on the accelerator  
pedal when the transmission is in gear. Slowly spinning  
the wheels in the forward and reverse directions causes  
a rocking motion that could free the vehicle. If that does  
not get the vehicle out after a few tries, it might need to  
be towed out. If the vehicle does need to be towed out,  
see Towing Your Vehicle on page 524.  
If the vehicle has a traction system, it can often help to  
free a stuck vehicle. Refer to the vehicle's traction  
system in the Index. If stuck too severely for the traction  
system to free the vehicle, turn the traction system off  
and use the rocking method.  
5-17  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Tire and Loading Information Label  
Loading the Vehicle  
It is very important to know how much weight your  
vehicle can carry. This weight is called the vehicle  
capacity weight and includes the weight of all  
occupants, cargo, and all nonfactoryinstalled  
options. Two labels on your vehicle show how  
much weight it may properly carry, the Tire and  
Loading Information label and the Certification  
label.  
WARNING:  
{
Do not load the vehicle any heavier than the  
Gross Vehicle Weight Rating (GVWR),  
or either the maximum front or rear Gross  
Axle Weight Rating (GAWR). If you do, parts  
on the vehicle can break, and it can change  
the way the vehicle handles. These could  
cause you to lose control and crash. Also,  
overloading can shorten the life of the  
vehicle.  
Label Example  
A vehicle specific Tire and Loading Information  
label is attached to the vehicle's center pillar  
(B-pillar). With the driver's door open, you will  
find the label attached below the door lock post  
(striker). The Tire and Loading Information  
label shows the number of occupant seating  
positions (A), and the maximum vehicle capacity  
weight (B) in kilograms and pounds.  
5-18  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The Tire and Loading Information label also  
shows the tire size of the original equipment  
tires (C) and the recommended cold tire inflation  
pressures (D). For more information on tires and  
inflation see Tires on page 648 and Inflation - Tire  
Steps for Determining Correct Load Limit  
1. Locate the statement The combined weight  
of occupants and cargo should never exceed  
XXX kg or XXX lbson your vehicle's placard.  
2. Determine the combined weight of the driver  
and passengers that will be riding in your  
vehicle.  
Pressure on page 657  
.
There is also important loading information on the  
Certification label. It tells you the Gross Vehicle  
Weight Rating (GVWR) and the Gross Axle  
Weight Rating (GAWR) for the front and rear axle;  
see Certification Labellater in this section.  
3. Subtract the combined weight of the driver  
and passengers from XXX kg or XXX lbs.  
4. The resulting figure equals the available  
amount of cargo and luggage load capacity.  
For example, if the XXXamount equals  
1400 lbs and there will be five 150 lb  
If you have a Professional Vehicle, a Tire and  
Loading Information label specific to your vehicle  
will be provided and installed by the final body  
manufacturer. The Tire and Loading Information  
label, should be attached to the Bpillar of your  
vehicle. See the final stage manufacturer's  
manual or contact them directly. The label shows  
the original tires installed on your professional  
vehicle and the recommended cold tire inflation  
pressures for those tires. The label also tells you  
the professional vehicle's capacity weight.  
passengers in your vehicle, the amount of  
available cargo and luggage load capacity is  
650 lbs (1400 750 (5 x 150) = 650 lbs).  
5-19  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
5. Determine the combined weight of luggage  
and cargo being loaded on the vehicle. That  
weight may not safely exceed the available  
cargo and luggage load capacity calculated in  
Step 4.  
6. If your vehicle will be towing a trailer, the load  
from your trailer will be transferred to your  
vehicle. Consult this manual to determine  
how this reduces the available cargo and  
luggage load capacity of your vehicle.  
Example 1  
Description  
If your vehicle can tow a trailer, see Towing a  
Trailerfor important information on towing a  
trailer, towing safety rules, and trailering tips.  
Item  
Total  
1,000 lbs  
Vehicle Capacity  
Weight for  
Example 1 =  
A
(453 kg)  
Subtract Occupant  
Weight @ 150 lbs  
(68 kg) × 2 =  
B
C
300 lbs (136 kg)  
700 lbs (317 kg)  
Available Occupant  
and Cargo Weight =  
5-20  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Example 2  
Description  
Example 3  
Description  
Item  
Total  
1,000 lbs  
Item  
Total  
1,000 lbs  
Vehicle Capacity  
Weight for  
Example 2 =  
Vehicle Capacity  
Weight for  
Example 3 =  
A
A
(453 kg)  
(453 kg)  
Subtract Occupant  
Weight @ 150 lbs  
(68 kg) × 5 =  
Subtract Occupant  
Weight @ 200 lbs  
(91 kg) × 5 =  
1,000 lbs  
(453 kg)  
B
C
750 lbs (340 kg)  
250 lbs (113 kg)  
B
C
Available Cargo  
Weight =  
Available Cargo  
Weight =  
0 lbs (0 kg)  
5-21  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Refer to your vehicle's Tire and Loading  
Information label for specific information about  
your vehicle's capacity weight and seating  
positions. The combined weight of the driver,  
passengers, and cargo should never exceed your  
vehicle's capacity weight.  
The GVWR includes the weight of the vehicle, all  
occupants, fuel, and cargo. Never exceed the  
GVWR for your vehicle, or the Gross Axle Weight  
Rating (GAWR) for either the front or rear axle.  
If your vehicle is a Professional Vehicle,  
the vehicle specific Certification label is  
provided by the final stage manufacturer. The  
coachbuilder should be consulted if the final  
stage manufacturer's label is not present. The  
Gross Vehicle Weight Rating GVWR label should  
be on the driver's door edge.  
Certification Label  
If you do have a heavy load, you should spread it  
out. See Steps for Determining Correct Load  
Limitearlier in this section.  
A vehicle specific Certification label is attached  
to the rear edge of the driver's door. This label  
shows the gross weight capacity of your vehicle,  
called the Gross Vehicle Weight Rating (GVWR).  
5-22  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
WARNING:  
WARNING:  
{
{
Do not load the vehicle any heavier than  
the Gross Vehicle Weight Rating (GVWR),  
or either the maximum front or rear Gross  
Axle Weight Rating (GAWR). If you do,  
parts on the vehicle can break, and it  
can change the way the vehicle handles.  
These could cause you to lose control and  
crash. Also, overloading can shorten the life  
of the vehicle.  
Things you put inside your vehicle can strike  
and injure people in a sudden stop or turn,  
or in a crash.  
.
Put things in the trunk of your vehicle. In  
a trunk, put them as far forward as you  
can. Try to spread the weight evenly.  
.
Never stack heavier things, like  
suitcases, inside the vehicle so that some  
of them are above the tops of the seats.  
.
Do not leave an unsecured child restraint  
in your vehicle.  
Notice: Overloading the vehicle may cause  
damage. Repairs would not be covered by the  
vehicle warranty. Do not overload the vehicle.  
.
When you carry something inside the  
vehicle, secure it whenever you can.  
If you put things inside your vehicle, like  
suitcases, tools, packages, or anything else, they  
will go as fast as the vehicle goes. If you have to  
stop or turn quickly, or if there is a crash, they will  
keep going.  
5-23  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Automatic Level Control  
This feature keeps the rear of your vehicle level  
as the load changes. It is automatic, you do not  
need to adjust anything.  
Towing  
Towing Your Vehicle  
Consult your dealer or a professional towing service if  
the disabled vehicle must be towed. See Roadside  
Service on page 87.  
This type of level control is fully automatic and will  
provide a better leveled riding position as well as  
better handling under a variety of passenger and  
loading conditions. An air compressor connected  
to the rear shocks will raise or lower the rear of  
the vehicle to maintain proper vehicle height. The  
system is activated when the ignition key is turned  
to ON/RUN and will automatically adjust vehicle  
height thereafter. The system may exhaust (lower  
vehicle height) for up to ten minutes after the  
ignition key has been turned to LOCK/OFF. You  
may hear the air compressor operating when the  
height is being adjusted.  
To tow the vehicle behind another vehicle for  
recreational purposes (such as behind a motorhome),  
see Recreational Vehicle Towingfollowing.  
Recreational Vehicle Towing  
Recreational vehicle towing means towing the vehicle  
behind another vehicle such as behind a motorhome.  
The two most common types of recreational vehicle  
towing are known as dinghy towing and dolly towing.  
Dinghy towing is towing the vehicle with all four wheels  
on the ground. Dolly towing is towing the vehicle with  
two wheels on the ground and two wheels up on a  
device known as a dolly.  
5-24  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Here are some important things to consider before  
recreational vehicle towing:  
Dinghy Towing  
.
What's the towing capacity of the towing vehicle?  
Be sure to read the tow vehicle manufacturer's  
recommendations.  
.
How far will the vehicle be towed? Some vehicles  
have restrictions on how far and how long they  
can tow.  
.
Does the vehicle have the proper towing  
equipment? See your dealer or trailering  
professional for additional advice and equipment  
recommendations.  
.
Is the vehicle ready to be towed? Just as preparing  
the vehicle for a long trip, make sure the vehicle is  
prepared to be towed. See Before Leaving on a  
Long Trip on page 513.  
Notice: If the vehicle is towed with all four wheels  
on the ground, the drivetrain components could be  
damaged. The repairs would not be covered by the  
vehicle warranty. Do not tow the vehicle with all  
four wheels on the ground.  
The vehicle was not designed to be towed with all  
four wheels on the ground. Use a dolly if the vehicle  
must be towed. See Dolly Towinglater in this section  
for more information.  
5-25  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
5. Remove the key from the ignition.  
6. Secure the vehicle to the dolly.  
7. Release the parking brake.  
Dolly Towing  
Towing a Trailer  
The Cadillac Professional Vehicle cannot tow a trailer.  
WARNING:  
{
The driver can lose control when pulling a trailer if  
the correct equipment is not used or the vehicle is  
not driven properly. For example, if the trailer is  
too heavy, the brakes may not work well or  
even at all. The driver and passengers could be  
seriously injured. The vehicle may also be  
damaged; the resulting repairs would not be  
covered by the vehicle warranty. Pull a trailer only  
if all the steps in this section have been followed.  
Ask your dealer for advice and information about  
towing a trailer with the vehicle.  
The vehicle can be towed using a dolly. To tow the  
vehicle using a dolly, follow these steps:  
1. Put the front wheels on a dolly.  
2. Put the gear shift lever in P (Park).  
3. Set the parking brake.  
4. Clamp the steering wheel in a straight-ahead  
position with a clamping device designed for  
towing.  
5-26  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Notice: Pulling a trailer improperly can damage the  
vehicle and result in costly repairs not covered by  
the vehicle warranty. To pull a trailer correctly,  
follow the advice in this section and see your dealer  
for important information about towing a trailer with  
the vehicle.  
Pulling A Trailer  
Here are some important points:  
.
There are many different laws, including speed  
limit restrictions, having to do with trailering. Make  
sure the rig will be legal, not only where you live  
but also where you will be driving. A good source  
for this information can be state or provincial  
police.  
The vehicle can tow a trailer if it is equipped with  
the proper trailer towing equipment. To identify the  
trailering capacity of the vehicle, read the information  
in Weight of the Trailerthat appears later in this  
section. Trailering is different than just driving the  
vehicle by itself. Trailering means changes in handling,  
acceleration, braking, durability and fuel economy.  
Successful, safe trailering takes correct equipment, and  
it has to be used properly.  
.
Do not tow a trailer at all during the  
first 1,000 miles (1600 km) the new vehicle  
is driven. The engine, transmission or other  
parts could be damaged. The repairs would  
not be covered by the vehicle's warranty.  
.
Then, during the first 500 miles (800 km) that a  
trailer is towed, do not drive over 50 mph (80 km/h)  
and do not make starts at full throttle. This helps  
the engine and other parts of the vehicle wear in at  
the heavier loads.  
The following information has many time-tested,  
important trailering tips and safety rules. Many of  
these are important for the safety of the driver and the  
passengers. So please read this section carefully before  
pulling a trailer.  
.
Vehicles can tow in D (Drive). Shift the  
transmission to a lower gear if the transmission  
shifts too often under heavy loads and/or hilly  
conditions.  
Load-pulling components such as the engine,  
transmission, axles, wheel assemblies and tires are  
forced to work harder against the drag of the added  
weight. The engine is required to operate at relatively  
higher speeds and under greater loads, generating  
extra heat. The trailer also adds considerably to wind  
resistance, increasing the pulling requirements.  
.
Obey speed limit restrictions when towing a trailer.  
Do not drive faster than the maximum posted  
speed for trailers, or no more than 55 mph  
(90 km/h), to save wear on the vehicle's parts.  
5-27  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
.
.
Do not tow a trailer when the outside temperature  
is above 100°F (38°C).  
Maximum trailer weight is calculated assuming only the  
driver is in the tow vehicle and it has all the required  
trailering equipment. The weight of additional optional  
equipment, passengers and cargo in the tow vehicle  
must be subtracted from the maximum trailer weight.  
If the vehicle has the Side Blind Zone Alert (SBZA)  
system and it doesn't seem to be working properly  
while pulling a trailer, turn the system off. See Side  
Blind Zone Alert (SBZA) on page 342 for more  
information.  
Ask your dealer for trailering information or advice,  
or write us at our Customer Assistance Offices. See  
Customer Assistance Offices on page 86 for more  
information.  
Three important considerations have to do with weight:  
.
The weight of the trailer  
.
Weight of the Trailer Tongue  
The weight of the trailer tongue  
.
The total weight on the vehicle's tires  
The tongue load (A) of any trailer is an important weight  
to measure because it affects the total gross weight of  
the vehicle. The Gross Vehicle Weight (GVW) includes  
the curb weight of the vehicle, any cargo carried in it,  
and the people who will be riding in the vehicle. If there  
are a lot of options, equipment, passengers or cargo in  
the vehicle, it will reduce the tongue weight the vehicle  
can carry, which will also reduce the trailer weight the  
vehicle can tow. If towing a trailer, the tongue load must  
be added to the GVW because the vehicle will be  
carrying that weight, too. See Loading the Vehicle on  
page 518 for more information about the vehicle's  
maximum load capacity.  
Weight of the Trailer  
How heavy can a trailer safely be?  
It should never weigh more than 1,000 lbs (454 kg). But  
even that can be too heavy.  
It depends on how the rig is used. For example,  
speed, altitude, road grades, outside temperature and  
how much the vehicle is used to pull a trailer are all  
important. It can depend on any special equipment  
on the vehicle, and the amount of tongue weight the  
vehicle can carry. See Weight of the Trailer Tongue”  
later in this section for more information.  
5-28  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Hitches  
It is important to have the correct hitch equipment.  
Crosswinds, large trucks going by and rough roads are  
a few reasons why the right hitch is needed. Here are  
some rules to follow:  
.
The rear bumper on the vehicle is not intended  
for hitches. Do not attach rental hitches or  
other bumper-type hitches to it. Use only a  
frame-mounted hitch that does not attach to the  
bumper.  
.
Will any holes be made in the body of the vehicle  
Using a weight-carrying hitch, the trailer tongue (A)  
should weigh 10 to 15 percent of the total loaded trailer  
weight (B).  
when the trailer hitch is installed? If there are, then  
be sure to seal the holes later when the hitch is  
removed. If the holes are not sealed, dirt, water,  
and deadly carbon monoxide (CO) from the  
exhaust can get into the vehicle. See Engine  
Exhaust on page 333 for more information.  
After loading the trailer, weigh the trailer and then the  
tongue, separately, to see if the weights are proper.  
If they are not, adjustments might be made by moving  
some items around in the trailer.  
Safety Chains  
Total Weight on the Vehicle's Tires  
Always attach chains between the vehicle and the  
trailer. Cross the safety chains under the tongue of  
the trailer to help prevent the tongue from contacting  
the road if it becomes separated from the hitch.  
Instructions about safety chains may be provided by  
the hitch manufacturer or by the trailer manufacturer.  
Be sure the vehicle's tires are inflated to the upper limit  
for cold tires. These numbers can be found on the  
Certification/Tire label. See Loading the Vehicle on  
page 518. Make sure not to go over the GVW limit for  
the vehicle, including the weight of the trailer tongue.  
5-29  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Follow the manufacturer's recommendation for attaching  
safety chains and do not attach them to the bumper.  
Always leave just enough slack so the rig can turn.  
Never allow safety chains to drag on the ground.  
During the trip, check occasionally to be sure that the  
load is secure, and that the lamps and any trailer  
brakes are still working.  
Following Distance  
Trailer Brakes  
Stay at least twice as far behind the vehicle ahead as  
you would when driving the vehicle without a trailer.  
This can help to avoid situations that require heavy  
braking and sudden turns.  
Because the vehicle has StabiliTrak®, do not tap into  
the vehicle's hydraulic brake system. If you do, both  
brake systems will not work well, or at all.  
Be sure to read and follow the instructions for the trailer  
brakes so they are installed, adjusted and maintained  
properly.  
Passing  
More passing distance is needed when towing a trailer.  
Because the rig is longer, it is necessary to go much  
farther beyond the passed vehicle before returning to  
the lane.  
Driving with a Trailer  
Towing a trailer requires a certain amount of  
experience. Get to know the rig before setting out for  
the open road. Get acquainted with the feel of handling  
and braking with the added weight of the trailer. And  
always keep in mind that the vehicle you are driving is  
now longer and not as responsive as the vehicle is by  
itself.  
Backing Up  
Hold the bottom of the steering wheel with one hand.  
Then, to move the trailer to the left, move that hand to  
the left. To move the trailer to the right, move your hand  
to the right. Always back up slowly and, if possible,  
have someone guide you.  
Before starting, check all trailer hitch parts and  
attachments, safety chains, electrical connectors,  
lamps, tires and mirror adjustments. If the trailer has  
electric brakes, start the vehicle and trailer moving and  
then apply the trailer brake controller by hand to be  
sure the brakes are working. This checks the electrical  
connection at the same time.  
Making Turns  
Notice: Making very sharp turns while trailering  
could cause the trailer to come in contact with the  
vehicle. The vehicle could be damaged. Avoid  
making very sharp turns while trailering.  
5-30  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
When turning with a trailer, make wider turns than  
normal. Do this so the trailer will not strike soft  
shoulders, curbs, road signs, trees or other objects.  
Avoid jerky or sudden maneuvers. Signal well in  
advance.  
Reduce speed and shift to a lower gear before starting  
down a long or steep downgrade. If the transmission is  
not shifted down, the brakes might have to be used so  
much that they would get hot and no longer work well.  
On a long uphill grade, shift down and reduce the  
vehicle's speed to around 45 mph (70 km/h) to reduce  
the possibility of the engine and the transmission  
overheating. If the engine does overheat, see Engine  
Overheating on page 629.  
Turn Signals When Towing a Trailer  
The arrows on the instrument panel flash whenever  
signaling a turn or lane change. Properly hooked up,  
the trailer lamps also flash, telling other drivers the  
vehicle is turning, changing lanes or stopping.  
Parking on Hills  
When towing a trailer, the arrows on the instrument  
panel flash for turns even if the bulbs on the trailer are  
burned out. For this reason you may think other drivers  
are seeing the signal when they are not. It is important  
to check occasionally to be sure the trailer bulbs are still  
working.  
WARNING:  
{
Parking the vehicle on a hill with the trailer  
attached can be dangerous. If something goes  
wrong, the rig could start to move. People can be  
injured, and both the vehicle and the trailer can be  
damaged. When possible, always park the rig on  
a flat surface.  
Driving on Grades  
Notice: Do not tow on steep continuous grades  
exceeding 9.6 km (6 miles). Extended, higher than  
normal engine and transmission temperatures may  
result and damage the vehicle. Frequent stops are  
very important to allow the engine and transmission  
to cool.  
If parking the rig on a hill:  
1. Press the brake pedal, but do not shift into P (Park)  
yet. Turn the wheels into the curb if facing downhill  
or into traffic if facing uphill.  
2. Have someone place chocks under the trailer  
wheels.  
5-31  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3. When the wheel chocks are in place, release the  
brake pedal until the chocks absorb the load.  
Maintenance When Trailer Towing  
The vehicle needs service more often when pulling a  
trailer. See Scheduled Maintenance on page 73 for  
more information. Things that are especially important  
in trailer operation are automatic transmission fluid,  
engine oil, belts, cooling system and brake system. It is  
a good idea to inspect these before and during the trip.  
4. Reapply the brake pedal. Then apply the parking  
brake and shift the transmission into P (Park).  
5. Release the brake pedal.  
Leaving After Parking on a Hill  
1. Apply and hold the brake pedal while you:  
Check periodically to see that all hitch nuts and bolts  
are tight.  
.
start the engine,  
.
shift into a gear, and  
Engine Cooling When Trailer Towing  
The cooling system may temporarily overheat during  
.
release the parking brake.  
2. Let up on the brake pedal.  
severe operating conditions. See Engine Overheating  
on page 629  
.
3. Drive slowly until the trailer is clear of the chocks.  
4. Stop and have someone pick up and store the  
chocks.  
Changing a Tire When Trailer Towing  
If the vehicle gets a flat tire while towing a trailer, be  
sure to secure the trailer and disconnect it from the  
vehicle before changing the tire.  
5-32  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 6 Service and Appearance Care  
Service . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-3  
Overheated Engine Protection  
Accessories and Modifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-3  
California Proposition 65 Warning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-4  
California Perchlorate Materials  
Requirements . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-4  
Doing Your Own Service Work . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-4  
Adding Equipment to the Outside of the  
Operating Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-31  
Power Steering Fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-32  
Windshield Washer Fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-32  
Brakes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-33  
Battery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-36  
Jump Starting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-38  
Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-5  
Headlamp Aiming . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-43  
Fuel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-5  
Gasoline Octane . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-5  
Gasoline Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-6  
California Fuel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-6  
Additives . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-6  
Fuels in Foreign Countries . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-7  
Filling the Tank . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-8  
Filling a Portable Fuel Container . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-11  
Bulb Replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-46  
High Intensity Discharge (HID) Lighting . . . . . . . . 6-46  
Windshield Wiper Blade Replacement . . . . . . . . . . . 6-46  
Tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-48  
Tire Sidewall Labeling . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-49  
Tire Terminology and Definitions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-54  
Inflation - Tire Pressure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-57  
High-Speed Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-59  
Tire Pressure Monitor System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-60  
Tire Pressure Monitor Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-61  
Tire Inspection and Rotation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-65  
When It Is Time for New Tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-67  
Buying New Tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-68  
Different Size Tires and Wheels . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-70  
Uniform Tire Quality Grading . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-70  
Wheel Alignment and Tire Balance . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-72  
Wheel Replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-72  
Checking Things Under the Hood . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-12  
Hood Release . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-13  
Engine Compartment Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-14  
Engine Oil . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-15  
Engine Oil Life System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-18  
Engine Air Cleaner/Filter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-19  
Automatic Transmission Fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-21  
Cooling System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-24  
Engine Coolant . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-26  
Engine Overheating . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-29  
6-1  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 6 Service and Appearance Care  
Tire Chains . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-73  
Finish Care . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-98  
Windshield and Wiper Blades . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-99  
Aluminum or Chrome-Plated Wheels  
and Trim . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-100  
Tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-101  
Sheet Metal Damage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-101  
Finish Damage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-101  
Underbody Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-101  
Chemical Paint Spotting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-101  
If a Tire Goes Flat . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-73  
Tire Sealant and Compressor Kit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-75  
Tire Sealant and Compressor Kit Storage . . . . . . 6-82  
Changing a Flat Tire . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-83  
Removing the Spare Tire and Tools . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-84  
Removing the Flat Tire and Installing the  
Spare Tire . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-86  
Storing a Flat or Spare Tire and Tools . . . . . . . . . 6-91  
Spare Tire . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-93  
Vehicle Identification . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-102  
Vehicle Identification Number (VIN) . . . . . . . . . . . 6-102  
Service Parts Identification Label . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-102  
Appearance Care . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-94  
Interior Cleaning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-94  
Fabric/Carpet . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-95  
Leather . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-96  
Instrument Panel, Vinyl, and Other Plastic  
Electrical System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-103  
Add-On Electrical Equipment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-103  
Headlamp Wiring . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-103  
Windshield Wiper Fuses . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-103  
Power Windows and Other Power Options . . . 6-104  
Fuses and Circuit Breakers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-104  
Underhood Fuse Block . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-104  
Rear Underseat Fuse Block . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-107  
Surfaces . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-97  
Wood Panels . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-97  
Speaker Covers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-97  
Care of Safety Belts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-97  
Weatherstrips . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-97  
Washing Your Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-98  
Cleaning Exterior Lamps/Lenses . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-98  
Capacities and Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-112  
6-2  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Accessories and Modifications  
Service  
When nondealer accessories are added to the vehicle,  
they can affect vehicle performance and safety,  
including such things as airbags, braking, stability, ride  
and handling, emissions systems, aerodynamics,  
durability, and electronic systems like antilock brakes,  
traction control, and stability control. Some of these  
accessories could even cause malfunction or damage  
not covered by the vehicle warranty.  
For service and parts needs, visit your dealer. You  
will receive genuine GM parts and GM-trained and  
supported service people.  
Genuine GM parts have one of these marks:  
Damage to vehicle components resulting from the  
installation or use of nonGM certified parts, including  
control module modifications, is not covered under the  
terms of the vehicle warranty and may affect remaining  
warranty coverage for affected parts.  
GM Accessories are designed to complement and  
function with other systems on the vehicle. Your GM  
dealer can accessorize the vehicle using genuine GM  
Accessories. When you go to your GM dealer and ask  
for GM Accessories, you will know that GM-trained and  
supported service technicians will perform the work  
using genuine GM Accessories.  
Also, see Adding Equipment to Your Airbag-Equipped  
Vehicle on page 269.  
6-3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
California Proposition 65 Warning  
Doing Your Own Service Work  
WARNING:  
Most motor vehicles, including this one, contain and/or  
emit chemicals known to the State of California to  
cause cancer and birth defects or other reproductive  
harm. Engine exhaust, many parts and systems, many  
fluids, and some component wear by-products contain  
and/or emit these chemicals.  
{
You can be injured and the vehicle could be  
damaged if you try to do service work on a vehicle  
without knowing enough about it.  
California Perchlorate Materials  
Requirements  
Certain types of automotive applications, such as  
airbag initiators, seat belt pretensioners, and lithium  
batteries contained in remote keyless transmitters,  
may contain perchlorate materials. Special handling  
may be necessary. For additional information, see  
www.dtsc.ca.gov/hazardouswaste/perchlorate.  
.
Be sure you have sufficient knowledge,  
experience, the proper replacement parts,  
and tools before attempting any vehicle  
maintenance task.  
.
Be sure to use the proper nuts, bolts, and  
other fasteners. English and metric fasteners  
can be easily confused. If the wrong fasteners  
are used, parts can later break or fall off. You  
could be hurt.  
If doing some of your own service work, use the proper  
service manual. It tells you much more about how to  
service the vehicle than this manual can. To order the  
proper service manual, see Service Publications  
Ordering Information on page 815.  
6-4  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
This vehicle has an airbag system. Before attempting  
to do your own service work, see Servicing Your  
Airbag-Equipped Vehicle on page 268.  
Keep a record with all parts receipts and list the mileage  
and the date of any service work performed. See  
Maintenance Record on page 712.  
Adding Equipment to the Outside of  
the Vehicle  
Things added to the outside of the vehicle can affect  
the airflow around it. This can cause wind noise and  
can affect fuel economy and windshield washer  
performance. Check with your dealer before adding  
equipment to the outside of the vehicle.  
Fuel  
Use of the recommended fuel is an important part  
of the proper maintenance of this vehicle. To help  
keep the engine clean and maintain optimum vehicle  
performance, we recommend the use of gasoline  
advertised as TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline.  
Gasoline Octane  
Use premium unleaded gasoline with a posted  
octane rating of 91 or higher. You can also use  
regular unleaded gasoline rated at 87 octane or higher,  
but the vehicle's acceleration could be slightly reduced,  
and a slight audible knocking noise, commonly referred  
to as spark knock, might be heard. If the octane is less  
than 87, you might notice a heavy knocking noise  
when you drive. If this occurs, use a gasoline rated  
at 87 octane or higher as soon as possible.  
Look for the TOP TIER label on the fuel pump to ensure  
gasoline meets enhanced detergency standards  
developed by auto companies. A list of marketers  
providing TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline can be found  
at www.toptiergas.com.  
6-5  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Otherwise, you could damage the engine. If heavy  
knocking is heard when using gasoline rated  
at 87 octane or higher, the engine needs service.  
See Malfunction Indicator Lamp on page 454. If this  
occurs, return to your authorized dealer for diagnosis.  
If it is determined that the condition is caused by the  
type of fuel used, repairs might not be covered by the  
vehicle warranty.  
Gasoline Specifications  
At a minimum, gasoline should meet ASTM  
specification D 4814 in the United States or  
CAN/CGSB3.5 or 3.511 in Canada. Some  
gasolines contain an octane-enhancing additive  
called methylcyclopentadienyl manganese tricarbonyl  
(MMT). We recommend against the use of gasolines  
containing MMT. See Additives on page 66 for  
additional information.  
Additives  
To provide cleaner air, all gasolines in the United States  
are now required to contain additives that help prevent  
engine and fuel system deposits from forming, allowing  
the emission control system to work properly. In most  
cases, nothing should have to be added to the fuel.  
However, some gasolines contain only the minimum  
amount of additive required to meet U.S. Environmental  
Protection Agency regulations. To help keep fuel  
injectors and intake valves clean, or if the vehicle  
experiences problems due to dirty injectors or valves,  
look for gasoline that is advertised as TOP TIER  
Detergent Gasoline.  
California Fuel  
If the vehicle is certified to meet California Emissions  
Standards, it is designed to operate on fuels that meet  
California specifications. See the underhood emission  
control label. If this fuel is not available in states  
adopting California emissions standards, the vehicle  
will operate satisfactorily on fuels meeting federal  
specifications, but emission control system performance  
might be affected. The malfunction indicator lamp could  
turn on and the vehicle might fail a smogcheck test.  
For customers who do not use TOP TIER Detergent  
Gasoline regularly, one bottle of GM Fuel System  
Treatment PLUS, added to the fuel tank at every engine  
oil change, can help clean deposits from fuel injectors  
and intake valves. GM Fuel System Treatment PLUS is  
the only gasoline additive recommended by General  
Motors.  
6-6  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Also, your dealer has additives that will help correct and  
prevent most depositrelated problems.  
Some gasolines that are not reformulated for low  
emissions can contain an octane-enhancing additive  
called methylcyclopentadienyl manganese tricarbonyl  
(MMT); ask the attendant where you buy gasoline  
whether the fuel contains MMT. We recommend against  
the use of such gasolines. Fuels containing MMT can  
reduce the life of spark plugs and the performance of  
the emission control system could be affected. The  
malfunction indicator lamp might turn on. If this occurs,  
return to your dealer for service.  
Gasolines containing oxygenates, such as ethers and  
ethanol, and reformulated gasolines might be available  
in your area. We recommend that you use these  
gasolines, if they comply with the specifications  
described earlier. However, E85 (85% ethanol) and  
other fuels containing more than 10% ethanol must not  
be used in vehicles that were not designed for those  
fuels.  
Notice: This vehicle was not designed for fuel that  
contains methanol. Do not use fuel containing  
methanol. It can corrode metal parts in the fuel  
system and also damage plastic and rubber parts.  
That damage would not be covered under the  
vehicle warranty.  
Fuels in Foreign Countries  
If you plan on driving in another country outside the  
United States or Canada, the proper fuel might be hard  
to find. Never use leaded gasoline or any other fuel  
not recommended in the previous text on fuel. Costly  
repairs caused by use of improper fuel would not be  
covered by the vehicle warranty.  
To check the fuel availability, ask an auto club,  
or contact a major oil company that does business  
in the country where you will be driving.  
6-7  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Filling the Tank  
WARNING:  
{
Fuel vapor burns violently and a fuel fire can  
cause bad injuries. To help avoid injuries to you  
and others, read and follow all the instructions on  
the fuel pump island. Turn off the engine when  
refueling. Do not smoke near fuel or when  
refueling the vehicle. Do not use cellular phones.  
Keep sparks, flames, and smoking materials away  
from fuel. Do not leave the fuel pump unattended  
when refueling the vehicle. This is against the law  
in some places. Do not re-enter the vehicle while  
pumping fuel. Keep children away from the fuel  
pump; never let children pump fuel.  
The tethered fuel cap is located behind a hinged fuel  
door on the driver side of the vehicle.  
6-8  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
While refueling, hang the tethered fuel cap from the  
hook on the fuel door.  
WARNING:  
{
Fuel can spray out on you if you open the fuel cap  
too quickly. If you spill fuel and then something  
ignites it, you could be badly burned. This spray  
can happen if the tank is nearly full, and is more  
likely in hot weather. Open the fuel cap slowly and  
wait for any hiss noise to stop. Then unscrew the  
cap all the way.  
To open the fuel door, push the rearward center edge in  
and release and it will open.  
To remove the fuel cap, turn it slowly counterclockwise.  
The fuel cap has a spring in it; if the cap is released too  
soon, it will spring back to the right.  
Be careful not to spill fuel. Do not top off or overfill the  
tank and wait a few seconds after you have finished  
pumping before removing the nozzle. Clean fuel from  
painted surfaces as soon as possible. See Washing  
Your Vehicle on page 698.  
6-9  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
When replacing the fuel cap, turn it clockwise until  
it clicks. Make sure the cap is fully installed. The  
diagnostic system can determine if the fuel cap has  
been left off or improperly installed. This would allow  
fuel to evaporate into the atmosphere. See Malfunction  
Indicator Lamp on page 454.  
WARNING:  
{
If a fire starts while you are refueling, do not  
remove the nozzle. Shut off the flow of fuel by  
shutting off the pump or by notifying the station  
attendant. Leave the area immediately.  
The TIGHTEN GAS CAP message displays on the  
Driver Information Center (DIC) if the fuel cap is not  
properly installed. See DIC Warnings and Messages on  
page 465 for more information.  
Notice: If you need a new fuel cap, be sure to get  
the right type. Your dealer can get one for you.  
If you get the wrong type, it may not fit properly.  
This may cause the malfunction indicator lamp to  
light and may damage the fuel tank and emissions  
system. See Malfunction Indicator Lamp on  
page 454  
.
6-10  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Filling a Portable Fuel Container  
WARNING:  
WARNING: (Continued)  
{
.
Bring the fill nozzle in contact with the inside  
of the fill opening before operating the nozzle.  
Contact should be maintained until the filling is  
complete.  
Never fill a portable fuel container while it is in  
the vehicle. Static electricity discharge from the  
container can ignite the fuel vapor. You can be  
badly burned and the vehicle damaged if this  
occurs. To help avoid injury to you and others:  
.
Do not smoke while pumping fuel.  
.
Do not use a cellular phone while  
pumping fuel.  
.
Dispense fuel only into approved containers.  
.
Do not fill a container while it is inside a  
vehicle, in a vehicle's trunk, pickup bed, or on  
any surface other than the ground.  
(Continued)  
6-11  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Checking Things Under  
the Hood  
WARNING:  
{
Things that burn can get on hot engine parts and  
start a fire. These include liquids like fuel, oil,  
coolant, brake fluid, windshield washer and other  
fluids, and plastic or rubber. You or others could  
be burned. Be careful not to drop or spill things  
that will burn onto a hot engine.  
WARNING:  
{
An electric fan under the hood can start up and  
injure you even when the engine is not running.  
Keep hands, clothing, and tools away from any  
underhood electric fan.  
6-12  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Hood Release  
To lift the hood:  
1. Pull the hood release  
lever with this symbol  
on it. It is located on  
the lower left side of  
the instrument panel.  
2. Then go to the front of the vehicle and find the  
secondary hood release lever, located near the  
center of the hood. Move the release lever up and  
to the right to raise the hood.  
Before closing the hood, be sure all filler caps are on  
properly. Then pull the hood down and close it firmly.  
6-13  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Engine Compartment Overview  
When you open the hood, here is what you will see:  
4.6L L37 Engine shown, 4.6L LD8 Engine similar  
6-14  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
A. Underhood Fuse Block on page 6104.  
Engine Oil  
B. Remote Positive (+) Terminal. See Jump Starting  
To ensure proper engine performance and long life,  
careful attention must be paid to engine oil. Following  
these simple, but important steps will help protect your  
investment:  
on page 638  
.
C. Windshield Washer Fluid Reservoir. See Adding  
Washer Fluidunder Windshield Washer Fluid on  
page 632  
.
.
Always use engine oil approved to the proper  
D. Engine Coolant Surge Tank and Pressure Cap.  
specification and of the proper viscosity grade. See  
Selecting the Right Engine Oil.”  
See Engine Coolant on page 626.  
.
E. Remote Negative () Terminal. See Jump Starting  
Check the engine oil level regularly and maintain  
the proper oil level. See Checking Engine Oiland  
When to Add Engine Oil.”  
on page 638  
.
F. Power Steering Fluid on page 632.  
.
Change the engine oil at the appropriate time. See  
Engine Oil Life System on page 618.  
G. Engine Oil Fill Cap. See When to Add Engine Oil”  
under Engine Oil on page 615.  
.
Always dispose of engine oil properly. See What  
to Do With Used Oil.”  
H. Engine Oil Dipstick. See Checking Engine Oil”  
under Engine Oil on page 615.  
I. Brake Master Cylinder Reservoir. See Brake  
Fluidunder Brakes on page 633.  
Checking Engine Oil  
It is a good idea to check the engine oil level at each  
fuel fill. In order to get an accurate reading, the vehicle  
must be on level ground. The engine oil dipstick handle  
is a yellow loop. See Engine Compartment Overview on  
page 614 for the location of the engine oil dipstick.  
J. Automatic Transmission Fluid Cap and Dipstick  
(Out of View). See Automatic Transmission Fluid  
on page 621  
.
K. Engine Air Cleaner/Filter on page 619.  
6-15  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Obtaining an accurate oil level reading is essential:  
Notice: Do not add too much oil. Oil levels above or  
below the acceptable operating range shown on the  
dipstick are harmful to the engine. If you find that  
you have an oil level above the operating range,  
i.e. the engine has so much oil that the oil level gets  
above the cross-hatched area that shows the proper  
operating range, the engine could be damaged. You  
should drain out the excess oil or limit your driving  
of the vehicle and seek a service professional to  
remove the excess amount of oil.  
1. If the engine has been running recently, turn off  
the engine and allow several minutes for the oil to  
drain back into the oil pan. Checking your oil level  
too soon after engine shut off will not provide an  
accurate oil level reading.  
2. Pull out the dipstick and clean it with a paper towel  
or cloth, then push it back in all the way. Remove it  
again, keeping the tip down, and check the level.  
See Engine Compartment Overview on page 614 for  
the location of the engine oil fill cap.  
When to Add Engine Oil  
Add enough oil to put the level somewhere in the proper  
operating range. Push the dipstick all the way back in  
when through.  
Selecting the Right Engine Oil  
Selecting the right engine oil depends on both the  
proper oil specification and viscosity grade:  
If the oil is below the cross-hatched area at the tip of  
the dipstick, add one liter/quart of the recommended oil  
and then recheck the level. See Selecting the Right  
Engine Oilfor an explanation of what kind of oil to use.  
For engine oil crankcase capacity, see Capacities and  
Specifications on page 6112.  
Specification  
Use and ask for engine oils with the dexos  
certification mark. Oils meeting the requirements  
of your vehicle should have the dexoscertification  
mark on the container. This certification mark  
indicates that the oil has been approved to the  
dexosspecification.  
6-16  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Viscosity Grade  
SAE 5W-30 is the best viscosity grade for the vehicle.  
Do not use other viscosity oils such as SAE 10W30,  
10W40, or 20W-50.  
Your vehicle was filled at the factory with dexos™  
approved engine oil.  
Notice: Use only engine oil that is approved to the  
dexosspecification or an equivalent engine oil  
of the appropriate viscosity grade. Engine oils  
approved to the dexosspecification will show the  
dexossymbol on the container. Failure to use the  
recommended engine oil or equivalent can result in  
engine damage not covered by the vehicle warranty.  
If you are unsure whether your oil is approved to  
the dexosspecification, ask your service provider.  
Use of Substitute Engine Oils if dexosis unavailable:  
In the event that dexosapproved engine oil is not  
available at an oil change or for maintaining proper oil  
level, you may use substitute engine oil displaying the  
API Starburst symbol and of SAE 5W-30 viscosity  
grade. Use of oils that do not meet the dexos™  
specification, however, may result in reduced  
Cold Temperature Operation: In an area of extreme  
cold, where the temperature falls below 29°C  
(20°F), an SAE 0W-30 oil should be used.  
An oil of this viscosity grade will provide easier cold  
starting for the engine at extremely low temperatures.  
performance under certain circumstances.  
6-17  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
When selecting an oil of the appropriate viscosity grade,  
be sure to always select an oil that meets the required  
specification, dexos. See Specificationfor more  
information.  
Engine Oil Life System  
When to Change Engine Oil  
This vehicle has a computer system that indicates when  
to change the engine oil and filter. This is based on  
engine revolutions and engine temperature, and not on  
mileage. Based on driving conditions, the mileage at  
which an oil change is indicated can vary considerably.  
For the oil life system to work properly, the system must  
be reset every time the oil is changed.  
Engine Oil Additives/Engine Oil Flushes  
Do not add anything to the oil. The recommended oils  
with the dexosspecification and displaying the  
dexoscertification mark are all that is needed for  
good performance and engine protection.  
Engine oil system flushes are not recommended and  
could cause engine damage not covered by the vehicle  
warranty.  
When the system has calculated that oil life has been  
diminished, it indicates that an oil change is necessary.  
A CHANGE ENGINE OIL SOON message in the Driver  
Information Center (DIC) comes on. Change the oil as  
soon as possible within the next 600 miles (1 000 km).  
It is possible that, if driving under the best conditions,  
the oil life system might indicate that an oil change is  
not necessary for up to a year. The engine oil and filter  
must be changed at least once a year and, at this time,  
the system must be reset. Your dealer has trained  
service people who will perform this work and reset the  
system. It is also important to check the oil regularly  
over the course of an oil drain interval and keep it at the  
proper level.  
What to Do with Used Oil  
Used engine oil contains certain elements that can be  
unhealthy for your skin and could even cause cancer.  
Do not let used oil stay on your skin for very long. Clean  
your skin and nails with soap and water, or a good hand  
cleaner. Wash or properly dispose of clothing or rags  
containing used engine oil. See the manufacturer's  
warnings about the use and disposal of oil products.  
Used oil can be a threat to the environment. If you  
change your own oil, be sure to drain all the oil from the  
filter before disposal. Never dispose of oil by putting it  
in the trash or pouring it on the ground, into sewers,  
or into streams or bodies of water. Recycle it by taking it  
to a place that collects used oil.  
If the system is ever reset accidentally, the oil must be  
changed at 3,000 miles (5 000 km) since the last oil  
change. Remember to reset the oil life system  
whenever the oil is changed.  
6-18  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
How to Reset the Engine Oil Life  
System  
Reset the system whenever the engine oil is changed  
so that the system can calculate the next engine oil  
change. To reset the system:  
Engine Air Cleaner/Filter  
See Engine Compartment Overview on page 614 for  
the location of the engine air cleaner/filter.  
When to Inspect the Engine Air  
Cleaner/Filter  
1. Turn the ignition to ON/RUN, with the engine off.  
Inspect the air cleaner/filter at the scheduled  
2. Press the DIC INFO button until OIL LIFE  
REMAINING displays. See DIC Operation and  
Displays on page 460.  
maintenance intervals and replace it at the first oil  
change after each 50,000 mile (80 000 km) interval.  
See Scheduled Maintenance on page 73 for more  
information. If you are driving in dusty/dirty conditions,  
inspect the filter at each engine oil change.  
3. Press and hold the DIC INFO RESET button until  
100% displays.  
4. Turn the key to LOCK/OFF.  
How to Inspect the Engine Air  
Cleaner/Filter  
To inspect the air cleaner/filter, remove the filter from  
the vehicle and lightly shake the filter to release loose  
dust and dirt. If the filter remains caked with dirt, a new  
filter is required.  
If the CHANGE ENGINE OIL SOON message comes  
back on when the vehicle is started, the engine oil life  
system has not been reset. Repeat the procedure.  
6-19  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
To inspect or replace the filter:  
To reinstall the cover:  
1. Align the two hinges located on the inboard side of  
the cover.  
2. Push the cover slightly down and towards the  
engine to engage the tabs in the hinges and align  
the two screws.  
3. Tighten the two screws on the top of the engine air  
cleaner/filter cover.  
WARNING:  
{
Operating the engine with the air cleaner/filter off  
can cause you or others to be burned. The air  
cleaner not only cleans the air; it helps to stop  
flames if the engine backfires. Use caution when  
working on the engine and do not drive with the  
air cleaner/filter off.  
1. Remove the two screws on the top of the engine  
air cleaner/filter cover.  
2. Lift up the outboard side of the cover at an angle  
while pulling toward you. This is necessary due to  
the two hinges located on the inboard side of the  
cover.  
Notice: If the air cleaner/filter is off, dirt can easily  
get into the engine, which could damage it. Always  
have the air cleaner/filter in place when you are  
driving.  
3. Remove the engine air cleaner/filter and any loose  
debris that may be found in the air cleaner base.  
4. Inspect or replace the air filter element.  
6-20  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Notice: Too much or too little fluid can damage the  
transmission. Too much can mean that some of the  
fluid could come out and fall on hot engine parts  
or exhaust system parts, starting a fire. Too little  
fluid could cause the transmission to overheat. Be  
sure to get an accurate reading if checking the  
transmission fluid.  
Automatic Transmission Fluid  
When to Check and Change Automatic  
Transmission Fluid  
A good time to check the automatic transmission fluid  
level is when the engine oil is changed.  
Wait at least 30 minutes before checking the  
transmission fluid level if you have been driving:  
Change the fluid and filter at the intervals listed in  
Scheduled Maintenance on page 73, and be sure to  
use the transmission fluid listed in Recommended  
Fluids and Lubricants on page 79.  
.
When outside temperatures are above  
32°C (90°F).  
.
At high speed for quite a while.  
How to Check Automatic Transmission  
Fluid  
Because this operation can be a little difficult, you  
may choose to have this done at the dealer service  
department.  
.
In heavy traffic especially in hot weather.  
.
While pulling a trailer.  
To get the right reading, the fluid should be at normal  
operating temperature, which is 82°C to 93°C  
(180°F to 200°F).  
If you do it yourself, be sure to follow all the instructions  
here or you could get a false reading on the dipstick.  
Get the vehicle warmed up by driving about 24 km  
(15 miles) when outside temperatures are above 10°C  
(50°F). If it is colder than 10°C (50°F), you may have to  
drive longer.  
6-21  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Then, without shutting off the engine, follow these  
steps:  
Checking the Fluid Level  
Prepare the vehicle as follows:  
1. Locate the transmission fluid cap which is located  
next to the radiator hose and below the engine air  
cleaner/filter assembly on the driver side of the  
vehicle. The cap is marked TRANS FLUID. See  
Engine Compartment Overview on page 614 for  
more information on location.  
1. Park the vehicle on a level place. Keep the engine  
running.  
2. With the parking brake applied, place the shift  
lever in P (Park).  
3. With your foot on the brake pedal, move the shift  
lever through each gear range, pausing for about  
three seconds in each range. Then, position the  
shift lever in P (Park).  
2. After removing the engine air cleaner/filter  
assembly to reach the transmission fluid cap, turn  
the cap counterclockwise to remove. Pull out the  
dipstick and wipe it with a clean rag or paper towel.  
4. Let the engine run at idle for three to five minutes.  
3. Push it back in all the way, wait three seconds, and  
then pull it back out again.  
6-22  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
If the fluid level is low, add only enough of the proper  
fluid to bring the level into the cross-hatched area on  
the dipstick.  
1. Pull out the dipstick.  
2. Using a long-neck funnel, add enough fluid at the  
dipstick hole to bring it to the proper level.  
It does not take much fluid, generally less than  
one pint (0.5 L). Do not overfill.  
4. Check both sides of the dipstick and read the lower  
level. The fluid level must be in the  
cross-hatched area.  
Notice: Use of the incorrect automatic transmission  
fluid may damage the vehicle, and the damages may  
not be covered by the vehicle's warranty. Always  
use the automatic transmission fluid listed in  
5. If the fluid level is in the acceptable range, push  
the dipstick back in all the way and turn the handle  
clockwise.  
Recommended Fluids and Lubricants on page 79.  
3. After adding fluid, recheck the fluid level as  
described under How to Check Automatic  
Transmission Fluid,earlier in this section.  
6. Reinstall the engine air cleaner/filter assembly.  
How to Add Automatic Transmission  
Fluid  
Refer to the Maintenance Schedule to determine what  
kind of transmission fluid to use. See Recommended  
Fluids and Lubricants on page 79.  
4. When the correct fluid level is obtained, push the  
dipstick back in all the way and turn the handle  
clockwise.  
6-23  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Cooling System  
The cooling system allows the engine to maintain the correct working temperature.  
4.6L L37 Engine shown, 4.6L LD8 Engine similar  
6-24  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
A. Coolant Surge Tank with Pressure Cap  
B. Electric Engine Cooling Fans  
WARNING: (Continued)  
Do not run the engine if there is a leak. If you run  
the engine, it could lose all coolant. That could  
cause an engine fire, and you could be burned.  
Get any leak fixed before you drive the vehicle.  
WARNING:  
{
An electric engine cooling fan under the hood can  
start up even when the engine is not running and  
can cause injury. Keep hands, clothing, and tools  
away from any underhood electric fan.  
Notice: Using coolant other than DEX-COOL® can  
cause premature engine, heater core, or radiator  
corrosion. In addition, the engine coolant could  
require changing sooner, at 50 000 km (30,000 miles)  
or 24 months, whichever occurs first. Any repairs  
would not be covered by the vehicle warranty.  
Always use DEX-COOL (silicate-free) coolant in the  
vehicle.  
WARNING:  
{
Heater and radiator hoses, and other engine  
parts, can be very hot. Do not touch them. If you  
do, you can be burned.  
(Continued)  
6-25  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Use a 50/50 mixture of clean, drinkable water and  
DEX-COOL® coolant. If using this mixture, nothing else  
needs to be added. This mixture:  
Engine Coolant  
The cooling system in the vehicle is filled with  
DEX-COOL® engine coolant. This coolant is designed  
to remain in the vehicle for five years or 150,000 miles  
(240 000 km), whichever occurs first.  
.
Gives freezing protection down to 34°F (37°C),  
outside temperature.  
.
Gives boiling protection up to 265°F (129°C),  
The following explains the cooling system and how to  
check and add coolant when it is low. If there is a  
problem with engine overheating, see Engine  
Overheating on page 629.  
engine temperature.  
.
Protects against rust and corrosion.  
.
Will not damage aluminum parts.  
.
Helps keep the proper engine temperature.  
What to Use  
Notice: If an improper coolant mixture is used, the  
engine could overheat and be badly damaged. The  
repair cost would not be covered by the vehicle  
warranty. Too much water in the mixture can freeze  
and crack the engine, radiator, heater core, and  
other parts.  
WARNING:  
{
Adding only plain water or some other liquid to the  
cooling system can be dangerous. Plain water  
and other liquids, can boil before the proper  
coolant mixture will. The vehicle's coolant warning  
system is set for the proper coolant mixture. With  
plain water or the wrong mixture, the engine could  
get too hot but you would not get the overheat  
warning. The engine could catch fire and you or  
others could be burned. Use a 50/50 mixture of  
clean, drinkable water and DEX-COOL coolant.  
Notice: If extra inhibitors and/or additives are used  
in the vehicle's cooling system, the vehicle could be  
damaged. Use only the proper mixture of the engine  
coolant listed in this manual for the cooling system.  
See Recommended Fluids and Lubricants on  
page 79 for more information.  
6-26  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Checking Coolant  
How to Add Coolant to the Surge Tank  
The vehicle must be on a level surface when checking  
the coolant level.  
WARNING:  
{
Check to see if coolant is visible in the coolant recovery  
tank. If the coolant inside the coolant recovery tank is  
boiling, do not do anything else until it cools down.  
If coolant is visible but the coolant level is not at or  
above the FULL COLD mark, add a 50/50 mixture of  
clean, drinkable water and DEX-COOL® coolant at the  
coolant recovery tank, but be sure the cooling system is  
cool before this is done. See Engine Coolant on  
page 626 for more information.  
You can be burned if you spill coolant on hot  
engine parts. Coolant contains ethylene glycol  
and it will burn if the engine parts are hot enough.  
Do not spill coolant on a hot engine.  
Notice: This vehicle has a specific coolant fill  
procedure. Failure to follow this procedure could  
cause the engine to overheat and be severely  
damaged.  
WARNING:  
{
An electric engine cooling fan under the hood can  
start up even when the engine is not running and  
can cause injury. Keep hands, clothing, and tools  
away from any underhood electric fan.  
6-27  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Turn the pressure cap slowly counterclockwise.  
If you hear a hiss, wait for that to stop. A hiss  
means there is still some pressure left.  
WARNING:  
{
2. Keep turning the cap and remove it.  
Steam and scalding liquids from a hot cooling  
system can blow out and burn you badly. They are  
under pressure, and if you turn the surge tank  
pressure cap even a little they can come out  
at high speed. Never turn the cap when the  
cooling system, including the surge tank pressure  
cap, is hot. Wait for the cooling system and surge  
tank pressure cap to cool if you ever have to turn  
the pressure cap.  
3. Fill the coolant surge  
tank with the proper  
mixture to the FULL  
COLD mark on the  
side of the coolant  
surge tank.  
If no coolant is visible in the surge tank, add coolant as  
follows:  
1. Remove the coolant  
surge tank pressure  
cap when the cooling  
system, including the  
coolant surge tank  
pressure cap and  
upper radiator hose, is  
no longer hot.  
6-28  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Notice: If the pressure cap is not tightly installed,  
coolant loss and possible engine damage may  
occur. Be sure the cap is properly and tightly  
secured.  
If coolant is needed, add the proper DEX-COOL®  
coolant mixture at the coolant recovery tank.  
Engine Overheating  
The vehicle has several indicators to warn of engine  
overheating.  
There is an engine temperature warning light and/or  
gauge on the instrument panel cluster. See Engine  
Coolant Temperature Warning Light on page 453 and  
Engine Coolant Temperature Gauge on page 453.  
4.6L L37 Engine shown, 4.6L LD8 Engine similar  
The vehicle may also display a ENGINE OVERHEATED  
IDLE ENGINE message or an ENGINE OVERHEATED  
STOP ENGINE message displayed in the Driver  
Information Center (DIC). See DIC Warnings and  
Messages on page 465 for more information. You will  
also hear a chime.  
4. With the coolant surge tank cap off, start the  
engine and let it run until you can feel the upper  
radiator hose getting hot. Watch out for the engine  
cooling fans.  
By this time, the coolant level inside the coolant  
surge tank may be lower. If the level is lower, add  
more of the proper mixture to the coolant surge  
tank until the level reaches the FULL COLD mark  
on the side of the coolant surge tank.  
The decision may be made not to lift the hood when  
this warning appears, but instead get service help right  
away. See Roadside Service on page 87.  
If the decision is made to lift the hood , make sure the  
vehicle is parked on a level surface.  
5. Replace the cap. Be sure the cap is handtight and  
fully seated.  
6-29  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Then check to see if the engine cooling fans are  
running. If the engine is overheating, both fans should  
be running. If they are not, do not continue to run the  
engine and have the vehicle serviced.  
WARNING: (Continued)  
If you keep driving when the vehicles engine is  
overheated, the liquids in it can catch fire. You or  
others could be badly burned. Stop the engine if  
it overheats, and get out of the vehicle until the  
engine is cool.  
Notice: Engine damage from running the engine  
without coolant is not covered by the warranty.  
Notice: If the engine catches fire while driving with  
no coolant, the vehicle can be badly damaged. The  
costly repairs would not be covered by the vehicle  
warranty. See Overheated Engine Protection  
Operating Mode on page 631 for information on  
driving to a safe place in an emergency.  
See Overheated Engine Protection Operating  
Mode on page 631 for information on driving to  
a safe place in an emergency.  
If Steam Is Coming From The Engine  
Compartment  
If No Steam Is Coming From The  
Engine Compartment  
If an engine overheat warning is displayed but no steam  
can be seen or heard, the problem may not be too  
serious. Sometimes the engine can get a little too hot  
when the vehicle:  
WARNING:  
{
Steam from an overheated engine can burn you  
badly, even if you just open the hood. Stay away  
from the engine if you see or hear steam coming  
from it. Turn it off and get everyone away from  
the vehicle until it cools down. Wait until there is  
no sign of steam or coolant before you open  
the hood.  
.
Climbs a long hill on a hot day.  
.
Stops after high-speed driving.  
.
Idles for long periods in traffic.  
.
Tows a trailer.  
(Continued)  
6-30  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
If the overheat warning is displayed with no sign of  
steam:  
Overheated Engine Protection  
Operating Mode  
1. Turn the air conditioning off.  
If an overheated engine condition exists and the  
message ENGINE OVERHEATED STOP ENGINE  
is displayed, an overheat protection mode which  
alternates firing groups of cylinders helps prevent  
engine damage. In this mode, you will notice a loss in  
power and engine performance. This operating mode  
allows your vehicle to be driven to a safe place in an  
emergency. Driving extended miles (km) and/or towing  
a trailer in the overheat protection mode should be  
avoided.  
2. Turn the heater on to the highest temperature and  
to the highest fan speed. Open the windows as  
necessary.  
3. In heavy traffic, let the engine idle in N (Neutral)  
while stopped. If it safe to do so, pull off the road,  
shift to P (Park) or N (Neutral) and let the  
engine idle.  
If the temperature overheat gauge is no longer in the  
overheat zone or an overheat warning no longer  
displays, the vehicle can be driven. Continue to drive  
the vehicle slow for about 10 minutes. Keep a safe  
vehicle distance from the vehicle in front. If the warning  
does not come back on, continue to drive normally.  
Notice: After driving in the overheated engine  
protection operating mode, to avoid engine damage,  
allow the engine to cool before attempting any  
repair. The engine oil will be severely degraded.  
Repair the cause of coolant loss, change the oil  
and reset the oil life system. See Engine Oil on  
If the warning continues, pull over, stop, and park the  
vehicle right away.  
page 615  
.
If there is no sign of steam, idle the engine for  
three minutes while parked. If the warning is still  
displayed, turn off the engine until it cools down. Also,  
see "Overheated Engine Protection Operating Mode"  
next in this section.  
6-31  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4. Replace the cap and completely tighten it.  
Power Steering Fluid  
5. Remove the cap again and look at the fluid level  
on the dipstick.  
The power steering fluid  
reservoir is located next to  
the underhood fuse block  
on the passenger side of  
the vehicle. See Engine  
Compartment Overview  
on page 614 for more  
information on location.  
The level should be at the FULL COLD mark.  
If necessary, add only enough fluid to bring the level  
up to the mark.  
What to Use  
To determine what kind of fluid to use, see  
Recommended Fluids and Lubricants on page 79  
.
Always use the proper fluid.  
Notice: Use of the incorrect fluid may damage the  
vehicle and the damages may not be covered by the  
vehicle's warranty. Always use the correct fluid  
listed in Recommended Fluids and Lubricants on  
When to Check Power Steering Fluid  
It is not necessary to regularly check power steering  
fluid unless you suspect there is a leak in the system or  
you hear an unusual noise. A fluid loss in this system  
could indicate a problem. Have the system inspected  
and repaired.  
page 79  
.
Windshield Washer Fluid  
What to Use  
When the vehicle needs windshield washer fluid, be  
sure to read the manufacturer's instructions before use.  
If the vehicle will be operating in an area where the  
temperature may fall below freezing, use a fluid that has  
sufficient protection against freezing.  
How to Check Power Steering Fluid  
To check the power steering fluid:  
1. Turn the key off and let the engine compartment  
cool down.  
2. Wipe the cap and the top of the reservoir clean.  
3. Unscrew the cap and wipe the dipstick with a  
clean rag.  
6-32  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
.
Do not use engine coolant (antifreeze) in the  
windshield washer. It can damage the  
windshield washer system and paint.  
Adding Washer Fluid  
The WASHER FLUID LOW ADD FLUID message will  
be displayed on the Driver Information Center (DIC)  
when the fluid is low. See DIC Warnings and Messages  
on page 465 for more information.  
Brakes  
Brake Fluid  
Open the cap with the  
washer symbol on it.  
Add washer fluid until the  
tank is full. See Engine  
Compartment Overview  
on page 614 for  
The brake master cylinder  
reservoir is filled with  
DOT 3 brake fluid. See  
Engine Compartment  
Overview on page 614  
for reservoir location and  
access.  
reservoir location.  
Notice:  
.
When using concentrated washer fluid,  
follow the manufacturer's instructions for  
adding water.  
.
Do not mix water with ready-to-use washer  
There are only two reasons why the brake fluid level in  
the reservoir might go down:  
fluid. Water can cause the solution to freeze  
and damage the washer fluid tank and other  
parts of the washer system. Also, water does  
not clean as well as washer fluid.  
.
The brake fluid level goes down because of normal  
brake lining wear. When new linings are installed,  
the fluid level goes back up.  
.
Fill the washer fluid tank only three-quarters  
.
A fluid leak in the brake hydraulic system can also  
full when it is very cold. This allows for fluid  
expansion if freezing occurs, which could  
damage the tank if it is completely full.  
cause a low fluid level. Have the brake hydraulic  
system fixed, since a leak means that sooner or  
later the brakes will not work well.  
6-33  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Do not top off the brake fluid. Adding fluid does not  
correct a leak. If fluid is added when the linings are  
worn, there will be too much fluid when new brake  
linings are installed. Add or remove brake fluid, as  
necessary, only when work is done on the brake  
hydraulic system.  
WARNING:  
{
With the wrong kind of fluid in the brake hydraulic  
system, the brakes might not work well. This could  
cause a crash. Always use the proper brake fluid.  
WARNING:  
{
Notice:  
.
Using the wrong fluid can badly damage  
brake hydraulic system parts. For example,  
just a few drops of mineral-based oil, such  
as engine oil, in the brake hydraulic system  
can damage brake hydraulic system parts so  
badly that they will have to be replaced. Do  
not let someone put in the wrong kind of  
fluid.  
If too much brake fluid is added, it can spill on the  
engine and burn, if the engine is hot enough. You  
or others could be burned, and the vehicle could  
be damaged. Add brake fluid only when work is  
done on the brake hydraulic system.  
If the ignition is on and the brake fluid is low, the  
SERVICE BRAKE SYSTEM message displays in the  
Driver Information Center (DIC). See DIC Warnings and  
Messages on page 465.  
.
If brake fluid is spilled on the vehicle's  
painted surfaces, the paint finish can be  
damaged. Be careful not to spill brake  
fluid on the vehicle. If you do, wash it off  
immediately. See Washing Your Vehicle on  
What to Add  
Use only new DOT 3 brake fluid from a sealed  
container. See Recommended Fluids and Lubricants on  
page 698  
.
page 79  
.
Always clean the brake fluid reservoir cap and the area  
around the cap before removing it. This helps keep dirt  
from entering the reservoir.  
6-34  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Properly torqued wheel nuts are necessary to help  
prevent brake pulsation. When tires are rotated, inspect  
brake pads for wear and evenly tighten wheel nuts  
in the proper sequence to torque specifications in  
Capacities and Specifications on page 6112.  
Brake Wear  
This vehicle has disc brakes. Disc brake pads have  
built-in wear indicators that make a high-pitched  
warning sound when the brake pads are worn and new  
pads are needed. The sound can come and go or be  
heard all the time the vehicle is moving, except when  
applying the brake pedal firmly.  
Brake linings should always be replaced as complete  
axle sets.  
Brake Pedal Travel  
WARNING:  
{
See your dealer if the brake pedal does not return to  
normal height, or if there is a rapid increase in pedal  
travel. This could be a sign that brake service might be  
required.  
The brake wear warning sound means that soon  
the brakes will not work well. That could lead to a  
crash. When the brake wear warning sound is  
heard, have the vehicle serviced.  
Brake Adjustment  
Every time the brakes are applied, with or without the  
vehicle moving, the brakes adjust for wear.  
Notice: Continuing to drive with worn-out brake  
pads could result in costly brake repair.  
Some driving conditions or climates can cause a brake  
squeal when the brakes are first applied or lightly  
applied. This does not mean something is wrong with  
the brakes.  
6-35  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Replacing Brake System Parts  
Battery  
The braking system on a vehicle is complex. Its many  
parts have to be of top quality and work well together if  
the vehicle is to have really good braking. The vehicle  
was designed and tested with top-quality brake parts.  
When parts of the braking system are replaced for  
example, when the brake linings wear down and new  
ones are installed be sure to get new approved  
replacement parts. If this is not done, the brakes might  
not work properly. For example, if someone puts in  
brake linings that are wrong for the vehicle, the balance  
between the front and rear brakes can change for the  
worse. The braking performance expected can change  
in many other ways if the wrong replacement brake  
parts are installed.  
Refer to the replacement number on the original battery  
label when a new battery is needed.  
DANGER:  
{
Battery posts, terminals, and related accessories  
contain lead and lead compounds, chemicals  
known to the State of California to cause cancer  
and reproductive harm. Wash hands after  
handling.  
The battery is under the rear seat cushion. To access  
the battery, see Rear Underseat Fuse Block on  
page 6107. Access to the battery is not necessary to  
jump start the vehicle. See Jump Starting on page 638.  
WARNING:  
{
A battery that is not properly vented can let  
sulfuric acid fumes into the area under the rear  
seat cushion. These fumes can damage the rear  
seat safety belt systems. You might not be able to  
see this damage and the safety belts might not  
(Continued)  
6-36  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
To be sure the vent hose (A) is properly attached, the  
vent hose connectors (B) must be securely reattached  
to the vent outlets (C) on each side of the battery and  
the vent assembly grommet (D) must be secured to the  
floor pan (E).  
WARNING: (Continued)  
provide the protection needed in a crash. If a  
replacement battery is ever needed, it must be  
vented in the same manner as the original battery.  
Always make sure that the vent hose is properly  
reattached before reinstalling the seat cushion.  
Vehicle Storage  
WARNING:  
{
Batteries have acid that can burn you and gas  
that can explode. You can be badly hurt if you are  
not careful. See Jump Starting on page 638  
for tips on working around a battery without  
getting hurt.  
Infrequent Usage: Remove the black, negative () cable  
from the battery to keep the battery from running down.  
Extended Storage: Remove the black, negative ()  
cable from the battery or use a battery trickle charger.  
6-37  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Notice: Ignoring these steps could result in costly  
damage to the vehicle that would not be covered by  
the warranty.  
Jump Starting  
For more information about the vehicle battery, see  
Battery on page 636.  
Trying to start the vehicle by pushing or pulling it  
will not work, and it could damage the vehicle.  
If the vehicle's battery has run down, you may want to  
use another vehicle and some jumper cables to start  
your vehicle. Be sure to use the following steps to do it  
safely.  
1. Check the other vehicle. It must have a 12-volt  
battery with a negative ground system.  
Notice: If the other vehicle's system is not a 12-volt  
system with a negative ground, both vehicles can  
be damaged. Only use vehicles with 12-volt systems  
with negative grounds to jump start your vehicle.  
WARNING:  
{
2. Get the vehicles close enough so the jumper  
cables can reach, but be sure the vehicles are not  
touching each other. If they are, it could cause a  
ground connection you do not want. You would not  
be able to start your vehicle and the bad grounding  
could damage the electrical systems.  
Batteries can hurt you. They can be dangerous  
because:  
.
They contain acid that can burn you.  
.
They contain gas that can explode or ignite.  
.
They contain enough electricity to burn you.  
To avoid the possibility of the vehicles rolling, set  
the parking brake firmly on both vehicles involved  
in the jump start procedure. Put an automatic  
transmission in P (Park) or a manual transmission  
in NEUTRAL before setting the parking brake.  
If you do not follow these steps exactly, some or  
all of these things can hurt you.  
6-38  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Notice: If you leave the radio or other accessories  
on during the jump starting procedure, they could  
be damaged. The repairs would not be covered by  
the warranty. Always turn off the radio and other  
accessories when jump starting the vehicle.  
3. Turn off the ignition on both vehicles. Unplug  
unnecessary accessories plugged into the  
cigarette lighter or the accessory power outlets.  
Turn off the radio and all lamps that are not  
needed. This will avoid sparks and help save  
both batteries. And it could save the radio!  
4.6L LD8 Engine shown,  
4.6L L37 Engine similar  
4. Open the hoods and locate the positive (+) and  
negative () terminal locations on the other vehicle.  
Your vehicle has a remote positive (+) jump starting  
terminal and a remote negative () jump starting  
terminal.  
The remote positive (+) terminal is located in the  
engine compartment on the passenger's side of  
the vehicle. Lift the red plastic cap to access the  
terminal. See Engine Compartment Overview on  
page 614 for more information on the location of  
the remote positive (+) terminal.  
A second remote positive (+) terminal is located on  
the rear underseat fuse block.  
6-39  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The remote negative () terminal is located behind  
the power steering pulley, near the engine cover.  
It is marked GND ().  
WARNING:  
{
You will not see the battery of your vehicle under  
the hood. It is located under the rear passenger's  
seat. You will not need to access the battery for  
jump starting. The remote terminals are for that  
purpose.  
Using an open flame near a battery can cause  
battery gas to explode. People have been hurt  
doing this, and some have been blinded. Use a  
flashlight if you need more light.  
Be sure the battery has enough water. You do not  
need to add water to the battery installed in your  
new vehicle. But if a battery has filler caps, be  
sure the right amount of fluid is there. If it is low,  
add water to take care of that first. If you do not,  
explosive gas could be present.  
WARNING:  
{
An electric fan can start up even when the engine  
is not running and can injure you. Keep hands,  
clothing and tools away from any underhood  
electric fan.  
Battery fluid contains acid that can burn you. Do  
not get it on you. If you accidentally get it in your  
eyes or on your skin, flush the place with water  
and get medical help immediately.  
6-40  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
6. Connect the red positive (+) cable to the remote  
positive (+) terminal location on the vehicle with the  
dead battery. Use a remote positive (+) terminal if  
the vehicle has one.  
WARNING:  
{
Fans or other moving engine parts can injure you  
badly. Keep your hands away from moving parts  
once the engine is running.  
7. Do not let the other end touch metal. Connect it to  
the positive (+) terminal location of the vehicle with  
the good battery. Use a remote positive (+) terminal  
if the vehicle has one.  
5. Check that the jumper cables do not have loose or  
missing insulation. If they do, you could get a  
shock. The vehicles could be damaged too.  
8. Now connect the black negative () cable to the  
negative () terminal location of the vehicle with the  
good battery. Use a remote negative () terminal if  
the vehicle has one.  
Before you connect the cables, here are some  
basic things you should know. Positive (+) will go  
to positive (+) or to a remote positive (+) terminal if  
the vehicle has one. Negative () will go to a  
heavy, unpainted metal engine part or to a remote  
negative () terminal if the vehicle has one.  
Do not let the other end of the cable touch  
anything until the next step. The other end of the  
negative () cable does not go to the dead battery.  
It goes to a heavy, unpainted metal engine part or  
to a remote negative () terminal on the vehicle  
with the dead battery.  
Do not connect positive (+) to negative () or you  
will get a short that would damage the battery and  
maybe other parts too. And do not connect the  
negative () cable to the negative () terminal on  
the dead battery because this can cause sparks.  
6-41  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
9. Connect the other end of the negative () cable to  
the negative () terminal location on the vehicle  
with the dead battery. Your vehicle has a remote  
negative () terminal marked GND ().  
10. Now start the vehicle with the good battery and run  
the engine for a while.  
11. Try to start the vehicle that had the dead battery.  
If it will not start after a few tries, it probably needs  
service.  
Notice: If the jumper cables are connected or  
removed in the wrong order, electrical shorting may  
occur and damage the vehicle. The repairs would  
not be covered by the vehicle warranty. Always  
connect and remove the jumper cables in the  
correct order, making sure that the cables do not  
touch each other or other metal.  
Jumper Cable Removal  
A. Heavy, Unpainted Metal Engine Part or Remote  
Negative () Terminal (GND)  
B. Good Battery or Remote Positive (+) and Remote  
Negative () Terminals  
C. Dead Battery or Remote Positive (+) Terminal  
6-42  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
To disconnect the jumper cables from both vehicles, do  
the following:  
It is recommended that the vehicle is taken to your  
dealer for service if the headlamps need to be re-aimed.  
It is possible however, to re-aim the headlamps as  
described.  
1. Disconnect the black negative () cable from the  
vehicle that had the dead battery.  
Notice: To make sure the headlamps are aimed  
properly, read all the instructions before beginning.  
Failure to follow these instructions could cause  
damage to headlamp parts.  
2. Disconnect the black negative () cable from the  
vehicle with the good battery.  
3. Disconnect the red positive (+) cable from the  
vehicle with the good battery.  
The vehicle should:  
4. Disconnect the red positive (+) cable from the other  
vehicle.  
.
Be placed so the headlamps are 25 ft. (7.6 m) from  
a light colored wall.  
5. Return the remote positive (+) terminal cover to its  
original position.  
.
Have all four tires on a level surface which is level  
all the way to the wall.  
.
Be placed so it is perpendicular to the wall.  
Headlamp Aiming  
The vehicle has a visual optical headlamp aiming  
system. The aim has been preset at the factory and  
should need no further adjustment.  
.
Not have any snow, ice, or mud on it.  
.
Be fully assembled and all other work stopped  
while headlamp aiming is being performed.  
.
Be normally loaded with a full tank of fuel and  
one person or 160 lbs (75 kg) sitting on the  
driver seat.  
However, if the vehicle is damaged in a crash, the  
headlamp aim may be affected and adjustment may be  
necessary.  
.
Have all tires properly inflated.  
If oncoming vehicles flash their high beams at you, this  
may also mean the vertical aim needs to be adjusted.  
.
Have the spare tire is in its original location in the  
vehicle.  
6-43  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Headlamp aiming is done with the vehicle's low-beam  
headlamps. The high-beam headlamps will be correctly  
aimed if the low-beam headlamps are aimed properly.  
To adjust the vertical aim:  
1. Open the hood. See Hood Release on page 613  
for more information.  
4. At a wall, measure from the ground upward (A) to  
the recorded distance from Step 3 and mark it.  
5. Draw or tape a horizontal line (B) the width of the  
vehicle at the wall where it was marked in Step 4.  
Notice: Do not cover a headlamp to improve beam  
cut-off when aiming. Covering a headlamp may  
cause excessive heat build-up which may cause  
damage to the headlamp.  
6. Turn on the low-beam headlamps and place a  
piece of cardboard or equivalent in front of the  
headlamp not being aimed. This should allow only  
the beam of light from the headlamp being aimed  
to be seen on the flat surface.  
2. Find the center line running through the lens of the  
headlamp.  
3. Record the distance from the ground to the center  
line running through the lens of the headlamp.  
6-44  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
8. Turn the vertical aiming screw until the headlamp  
beam is aimed to the horizontal tape line. Turn it  
clockwise or counterclockwise to raise or lower the  
angle of the beam.  
The top edge of the cut-off should be positioned at  
the bottom edge of the horizontal tape line.  
7. Locate the vertical headlamp aiming screws. They  
are located under the hood near each headlamp  
assembly. First lift the flap to access either of  
them. Each one is the top outboard screw by  
the Von the cover panel next to the aiming flap.  
9. Make sure that the light from the headlamp is  
positioned at the bottom edge of the horizontal  
tape line. The lamp on the left (A) shows the  
correct headlamp aim. The lamp on the right (B)  
shows the incorrect headlamp aim.  
The adjustment screw can be turned with a 6 mm  
hex wrench.  
10. Repeat Steps 7 through 9 for the opposite  
headlamp.  
6-45  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Bulb Replacement  
It is recommended that all bulbs be replaced by your  
dealer.  
Windshield Wiper Blade  
Replacement  
Windshield wiper blades should be inspected for wear  
or cracking. See Scheduled Maintenance on page 73  
for more information on wiper blade inspection.  
High Intensity Discharge (HID)  
Lighting  
Replacement blades come in different types and are  
removed in different ways. Here is how to remove the  
wiper blade:  
WARNING:  
{
1. Turn the engine off.  
2. Lift the windshield wiper arm and blade away from  
the windshield.  
The low beam high intensity discharge lighting  
system operates at a very high voltage. If you try  
to service any of the system components, you  
could be seriously injured. Have your dealer or a  
qualified technician service them.  
The vehicle may have HID headlamps. After an HID  
headlamp bulb has been replaced, you may notice that  
the beam is a slightly different shade than it was  
originally. This is normal.  
3. Pull the clip up from the blade connecting point  
and pull the blade assembly down toward the  
windshield to remove it from the wiper arm.  
6-46  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4. Install the new wiper blade onto the wiper arm  
and firmly press down on the clip to snap it into  
place.  
To remove and replace the wiper blade element:  
1. The wiper blade element has two notches at one  
end which are engaged by the bottom claw set of  
the wiper blade. At the notched end of the wiper  
blade, pull the wiper blade element from the wiper  
blade assembly.  
2. Replace the element by starting at the heel end of  
the wiper blade, which is the end nearest to the  
base of the wiper arm, and slide the wiper blade  
element, notched end last, into the wiper blade  
claw sets.  
3. Engage the last claw into the notched end of the  
wiper blade element by squeezing the wiper blade  
element at the notched area, and push the wiper  
blade element so the claw fits into the notch.  
A. Correct Installation  
B. Incorrect Installation  
For the proper type and size windshield wiper blades,  
see Maintenance Replacement Parts on page 710.  
4. Be sure the two wiper blade element notches are  
engaged by the last claw set and all the other  
claws are properly engaged in the slots of the  
wiper blade element on both sides.  
6-47  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Tires  
WARNING: (Continued)  
Your new vehicle comes with high-quality tires  
made by a leading tire manufacturer. If you ever  
have questions about your tire warranty and  
where to obtain service, see your vehicle  
Warranty booklet for details. For additional  
information refer to the tire manufacturer.  
.
Over inflated tires are more likely to be  
cut, punctured, or broken by a sudden  
impact such as when you hit a pothole.  
Keep tires at the recommended pressure.  
.
Worn or old tires can cause a crash. If your  
tread is badly worn, replace them.  
WARNING:  
{
.
Replace any tires that have been damaged by  
impacts with potholes, curbs, etc.  
.
Poorly maintained and improperly used tires  
are dangerous.  
.
Improperly repaired tires can cause a crash.  
Only your dealer or an authorized tire service  
center should repair, replace, dismount, and  
mount the tires.  
.
Overloading your tires can cause overheating  
as a result of too much flexing. You could  
have a blowout and a serious accident. See  
Loading the Vehicle on page 518.  
.
Do not spin the tires in excess of 55 km/h  
(35 mph) on slippery surfaces such as snow,  
mud, ice, etc. Excessive spinning may cause  
the tires to explode.  
.
Under inflated tires pose the same danger as  
overloaded tires. The resulting crash could  
cause serious injury. Check all tires frequently  
to maintain the recommended pressure. Tire  
pressure should be checked when your tires  
are cold.  
See High-Speed Operation on page 659 for inflation  
pressure adjustment for high speed driving.  
(Continued)  
6-48  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
(B) TPC Spec (Tire Performance Criteria  
Specification): Original equipment tires designed  
to GM's specific tire performance criteria have a  
TPC specification code molded onto the sidewall.  
GM's TPC specifications meet or exceed all  
federal safety guidelines.  
Tire Sidewall Labeling  
Useful information about a tire is molded into its  
sidewall.  
(C) DOT (Department of Transportation): The  
Department of Transportation (DOT) code  
indicates that the tire is in compliance with the  
U.S. Department of Transportation Motor Vehicle  
Safety Standards.  
(D) Tire Identification Number (TIN): The letters  
and numbers following the DOT code are the Tire  
Identification Number (TIN). The TIN shows the  
manufacturer and plant code, tire size, and date  
the tire was manufactured. The TIN is molded  
onto both sides of the tire, although only one side  
may have the date of manufacture.  
(E) Tire Ply Material: The type of cord and  
number of plies in the sidewall and under the  
tread.  
Passenger Car Tire Example  
(A) Tire Size: The tire size is a combination of  
letters and numbers used to define a particular  
tire's width, height, aspect ratio, construction type  
and service description. See the Tire Size”  
illustration later in this section for more detail.  
(F) Uniform Tire Quality Grading (UTQG): Tire  
manufacturers are required to grade tires based  
on three performance factors: treadwear, traction  
and temperature resistance. For more information  
see Uniform Tire Quality Grading on page 670  
.
6-49  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
(G) Maximum Cold Inflation Load Limit:  
Maximum load that can be carried and the  
maximum pressure needed to support that load.  
For information on recommended tire pressure  
see Inflation - Tire Pressure on page 657 and  
not be driven at speeds over 65 mph (105 km/h).  
The compact spare tire is for emergency use  
when a regular road tire has lost air and gone flat.  
See Spare Tire on page 693 and If a Tire Goes  
Flat on page 673  
.
Loading the Vehicle on page 518  
.
(B) Tire Ply Material: The type of cord and  
number of plies in the sidewall and under the  
tread.  
(C) Tire Identification Number (TIN): The Tire  
Identification Number (TIN). The TIN shows the  
manufacturer and plant code, tire size, and date  
the tire was manufactured. The TIN is molded  
onto both sides of the tire, although only one side  
may have the date of manufacture.  
(D) Maximum Cold Inflation Load Limit:  
Maximum load that can be carried and the  
maximum pressure needed to support that load.  
See Inflation - Tire Pressure on page 657 and  
Loading the Vehicle on page 518  
.
Compact Spare Tire Example  
(A) Temporary Use Only: The compact spare  
tire or temporary use tire has a tread life of  
approximately 3,000 miles (5 000 km) and should  
6-50  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
(E) Tire Inflation: The temporary use tire or  
compact spare tire should be inflated to 60 psi  
(420 kPa). For more information on tire pressure  
and inflation see Inflation - Tire Pressure on  
page 657 and Spare Tire on page 693  
.
(F) Tire Size : A combination of letters and  
numbers define a tire's width, height, aspect ratio,  
construction type and service description. The  
letter T as the first character in the tire size means  
the tire is for temporary use only.  
(G) TPC Spec (Tire Performance Criteria  
Specification): Original equipment tires designed  
to GM's specific tire performance criteria have a  
TPC specification code molded onto the sidewall.  
GM's TPC specifications meet or exceed all  
federal safety guidelines.  
Light Truck Tire Example  
(A) Tire Size: The tire size code is a combination  
of letters and numbers used to define a particular  
tire's width, height, aspect ratio, construction type  
and service description. See the Tire Size”  
illustration later in this section for more detail.  
6-51  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
(B) TPC Spec (Tire Performance Criteria  
Specification): Original equipment tires designed  
to GM's specific tire performance criteria have a  
TPC specification code molded onto the sidewall.  
GM's TPC specifications meet or exceed all  
federal safety guidelines.  
(G) Single Tire Maximum Load: Maximum load  
that can be carried and the maximum pressure  
needed to support that load when used as a  
single. For information on recommended tire  
pressure see Inflation - Tire Pressure on  
page 657  
.
(C) Dual Tire Maximum Load: Maximum load  
that can be carried and the maximum pressure  
needed to support that load when used in a  
dual configuration.  
Tire Size  
The following illustration shows an example of a  
tire size.  
(D) DOT (Department of Transportation): The  
Department of Transportation (DOT) code  
indicates that the tire is in compliance with the  
U.S. Department of Transportation Motor Vehicle  
Safety Standards.  
(E) Tire Identification Number (TIN): The letters  
and numbers following DOT code are the Tire  
Identification Number (TIN). The TIN shows the  
manufacturer and plant code, tire size, and date  
the tire was manufactured. The TIN is molded  
onto both sides of the tire, although only one side  
may have the date of manufacture.  
(A) PMetric Tire: The United States version  
of a metric tire sizing system. The letter P as the  
first character in the tire size means a passenger  
vehicle tire engineered to standards set by  
the U.S. Tire and Rim Association.  
(F) Tire Ply Material: The type of cord and  
number of plies in the sidewall and under the  
tread.  
(B) Tire Width: The threedigit number indicates  
the tire section width in millimeters from sidewall  
to sidewall.  
6-52  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
(C) Aspect Ratio: A twodigit number that  
indicates the tire heighttowidth measurements.  
For example, if the tire size aspect ratio is 60, as  
shown in item C of the illustration, it would mean  
that the tire's sidewall is 60 percent as high as it  
is wide.  
(D) Construction Code: A letter code is used to  
indicate the type of ply construction in the tire.  
The letter R means radial ply construction; the  
letter D means diagonal or bias ply construction;  
and the letter B means beltedbias ply  
construction.  
Light Truck (LTMetric) Tire  
(A) Light Truck (LTMetric) Tire: The United  
States version of a metric tire sizing system. The  
letters LT as the first two characters in the tire size  
means a light truck tire engineered to standards  
set by the U.S. Tire and Rim Association.  
(E) Rim Diameter: Diameter of the wheel in  
inches.  
(B) Tire Width: The threedigit number indicates  
the tire section width in millimeters from sidewall  
to sidewall.  
(F) Service Description: These characters  
represent the load index and speed rating of the  
tire. The load index represents the load carry  
capacity a tire is certified to carry. The speed  
rating is the maximum speed a tire is certified to  
carry a load.  
(C) Aspect Ratio: A twodigit number that  
indicates the tire heighttowidth measurements.  
For example, if the tire size aspect ratio is 75, as  
shown in item C of the light truck (LTMetric) tire  
illustration, it would mean that the tire's sidewall is  
75 percent as high as it is wide.  
6-53  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
(D) Construction Code: A letter code is used to  
indicate the type of ply construction in the tire.  
The letter R means radial ply construction; the  
letter D means diagonal or bias ply construction;  
and the letter B means beltedbias ply  
construction.  
Accessory Weight: This means the combined  
weight of optional accessories. Some examples of  
optional accessories are, automatic transmission,  
power steering, power brakes, power windows,  
power seats, and air conditioning.  
Aspect Ratio: The relationship of a tire's height to  
(E) Rim Diameter: Diameter of the wheel in  
its width.  
inches.  
Belt: A rubber coated layer of cords that is  
located between the plies and the tread. Cords  
may be made from steel or other reinforcing  
materials.  
(F) Load Range: Load Range.  
(G) Service Description: The service description  
indicates the load index and speed rating of a  
tire. If two numbers are given as in the example,  
120/116, then this represents the load index for  
single versus dual wheel usage (single/dual).  
The speed rating is the maximum speed a tire is  
certified to carry a load.  
Bead: The tire bead contains steel wires wrapped  
by steel cords that hold the tire onto the rim.  
Bias Ply Tire: A pneumatic tire in which the plies  
are laid at alternate angles less than 90 degrees  
to the centerline of the tread.  
Cold Tire Pressure: The amount of air pressure  
in a tire, measured in pounds per square inch (psi)  
or kilopascals (kPa) before a tire has built up heat  
from driving. See Inflation - Tire Pressure on  
Tire Terminology and Definitions  
Air Pressure: The amount of air inside the tire  
pressing outward on each square inch of the tire.  
Air pressure is expressed in pounds per square  
inch (psi) or kilopascal (kPa).  
page 657  
.
Curb Weight: The weight of a motor vehicle with  
standard and optional equipment including the  
maximum capacity of fuel, oil, and coolant, but  
without passengers and cargo.  
6-54  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DOT Markings: A code molded into the sidewall  
of a tire signifying that the tire is in compliance  
with the U.S. Department of Transportation (DOT)  
motor vehicle safety standards. The DOT code  
includes the Tire Identification Number (TIN), an  
alphanumeric designator which can also identify  
the tire manufacturer, production plant, brand, and  
date of production.  
Maximum Inflation Pressure: The maximum  
air pressure to which a cold tire can be inflated.  
The maximum air pressure is molded onto the  
sidewall.  
Maximum Load Rating: The load rating for a tire  
at the maximum permissible inflation pressure for  
that tire.  
Maximum Loaded Vehicle Weight: The sum of  
curb weight, accessory weight, vehicle capacity  
weight, and production options weight.  
GVWR: Gross Vehicle Weight Rating. See  
Loading the Vehicle on page 518  
.
GAWR FRT: Gross Axle Weight Rating for the  
front axle. See Loading the Vehicle on page 518  
Normal Occupant Weight: The number of  
occupants a vehicle is designed to seat multiplied  
by 150 lbs (68 kg). See Loading the Vehicle on  
.
GAWR RR: Gross Axle Weight Rating for the rear  
axle. See Loading the Vehicle on page 518  
.
page 518.  
Intended Outboard Sidewall: The side of an  
asymmetrical tire, that must always face outward  
when mounted on a vehicle.  
Occupant Distribution: Designated seating  
positions.  
Outward Facing Sidewall: The side of an  
asymmetrical tire that has a particular side that  
faces outward when mounted on a vehicle. The  
side of the tire that contains a whitewall, bears  
white lettering, or bears manufacturer, brand,  
and/or model name molding that is higher or  
deeper than the same moldings on the other  
sidewall of the tire.  
Kilopascal (kPa): The metric unit for air pressure.  
Light Truck (LTMetric) Tire: A tire used on light  
duty trucks and some multipurpose passenger  
vehicles.  
Load Index: An assigned number ranging  
from 1 to 279 that corresponds to the load  
carrying capacity of a tire.  
6-55  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Passenger (P-Metric) Tire: A tire used on  
passenger cars and some light duty trucks and  
multipurpose vehicles.  
Treadwear Indicators: Narrow bands, sometimes  
called wear bars, that show across the tread of  
a tire when only 1/16 inch (1.6 mm) of tread  
remains. See When It Is Time for New Tires on  
Recommended Inflation Pressure: Vehicle  
manufacturer's recommended tire inflation  
pressure as shown on the tire placard. See  
Inflation - Tire Pressure on page 657 and Loading  
page 667  
.
UTQGS (Uniform Tire Quality Grading  
Standards): A tire information system that  
provides consumers with ratings for a tire's  
traction, temperature, and treadwear. Ratings  
are determined by tire manufacturers using  
government testing procedures. The ratings are  
molded into the sidewall of the tire. See Uniform  
the Vehicle on page 518  
.
Radial Ply Tire: A pneumatic tire in which the  
ply cords that extend to the beads are laid at  
90 degrees to the centerline of the tread.  
Rim: A metal support for a tire and upon which  
the tire beads are seated.  
Tire Quality Grading on page 670  
.
Vehicle Capacity Weight: The number of  
designated seating positions multiplied by 150 lbs  
(68 kg) plus the rated cargo load. See Loading the  
Sidewall: The portion of a tire between the tread  
and the bead.  
Vehicle on page 518  
.
Speed Rating: An alphanumeric code assigned  
to a tire indicating the maximum speed at which a  
tire can operate.  
Vehicle Maximum Load on the Tire: Load on  
an individual tire due to curb weight, accessory  
weight, occupant weight, and cargo weight.  
Traction: The friction between the tire and the  
road surface. The amount of grip provided.  
Vehicle Placard: A label permanently attached  
to a vehicle showing the vehicle's capacity  
weight and the original equipment tire size and  
recommended inflation pressure. See Tire and  
Loading Information Labelunder Loading the  
Tread: The portion of a tire that comes into  
contact with the road.  
Vehicle on page 518  
.
6-56  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
A vehicle specific Tire and Loading Information  
label is attached to your vehicle. This label shows  
your vehicle's original equipment tires and the  
correct inflation pressures for your tires when they  
are cold. The recommended cold tire inflation  
pressure, shown on the label, is the minimum  
amount of air pressure needed to support your  
vehicle's maximum load carrying capacity.  
Inflation - Tire Pressure  
Tires need the correct amount of air pressure to  
operate effectively.  
Notice: Do not let anyone tell you that  
underinflation or overinflation is all right.  
It is not. If your tires do not have enough air  
(underinflation), you can get the following:  
.
For additional information regarding how much  
weight your vehicle can carry, and an example  
of the Tire and Loading Information label, see  
Loading the Vehicle on page 518. How you load  
your vehicle affects the vehicle handling and ride  
comfort, never load your vehicle with more weight  
than it was designed to carry.  
Tire overloading and over-heating which  
could lead to a blowout.  
.
Premature or irregular wear.  
.
Poor handling.  
.
Reduced fuel economy.  
If your tires have too much air (overinflation),  
you can get the following:  
When to Check  
.
Check your tires once a month or more. Do not  
forget to check the spare tire. If your vehicle  
has a compact spare tire, it should be at 60 psi  
(420 kPa). For additional information see Spare  
Unusual wear.  
.
Poor handling.  
.
Rough ride.  
Tire on page 693  
.
.
Needless damage from road hazards.  
6-57  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
How to Check  
Professional Vehicle  
Use a good quality pocket-type gauge to check  
tire pressure. You cannot tell if your tires are  
properly inflated simply by looking at them.  
Radial tires may look properly inflated even  
when they are underinflated. Check the tire's  
inflation pressure when the tires are cold.  
Cold means your vehicle has been sitting for  
at least three hours or driven no more than  
1 mile (1.6 km).  
The proper inflation of the tires on your  
professional vehicle depends on the type of tires  
on it.  
.
If your vehicle has P235/60R17 size tires, the  
cold inflation pressure is 41 psi (284 kPa).  
.
If your vehicle has LT235/60R17E size tires,  
the cold inflation pressure depends on the  
vehicle mass and should be determined by  
the vehicle coachbuilder. A Tire and Loading  
Information label provided by the final stage  
manufacturer should be attached to the  
Bpillar on the driver's side of the vehicle.  
If the final stage manufacturer's label is  
not present, the coachbuilder should be  
consulted. Do not use the tire pressures  
indicated on the General Motors label. These  
tire pressures are for the incomplete vehicle  
and are not the correct tire pressures for the  
completed professional vehicle.  
Remove the valve cap from the tire valve stem.  
Press the tire gauge firmly onto the valve to get a  
pressure measurement. If the cold tire inflation  
pressure matches the recommended pressure on  
the Tire and Loading Information label, no further  
adjustment is necessary. If the inflation pressure  
is low, add air until you reach the recommended  
amount.  
If you overfill the tire, release air by pushing on  
the metal stem in the center of the tire valve.  
Recheck the tire pressure with the tire gauge.  
Operation at inflation pressures below this  
recommendation may cause your tires to become  
overloaded.  
Be sure to put the valve caps back on the valve  
stems. They help prevent leaks by keeping out dirt  
and moisture.  
6-58  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
If your vehicle has P235/55R17 or P245/50R18 size  
tires, and you will be driving at speeds of 100 mph  
(160 km/h) or higher, where it is legal, set the cold  
inflation pressure to the maximum inflation pressure  
shown on the tire sidewall, or 38 psi (265 kPa),  
whichever is lower. See the example following.  
High-Speed Operation  
WARNING:  
{
Driving at high speeds, 160 km/h (100 mph)  
or higher, puts an additional strain on tires.  
Sustained high-speed driving causes excessive  
heat build up and can cause sudden tire failure.  
You could have a crash and you or others could  
be killed. Some high-speed rated tires require  
inflation pressure adjustment for high speed  
operation. When speed limits and road conditions  
are such that a vehicle can be driven at high  
speeds, make sure the tires are rated for high  
speed operation, in excellent condition, and set to  
the correct cold tire inflation pressure for the  
vehicle load.  
Example:  
You will find the maximum load and inflation pressure  
molded on the tire's sidewall, in small letters, near the  
rim flange. It will read something like this: Maximum  
load 690 kg (1521 lbs) @ 300 kPa (44 psi) Max. Press.  
For this example, you would set the inflation pressure  
for highspeed driving at 38 psi (265 kPa).  
When you end this high-speed driving, return the tires  
to the cold inflation pressure shown on the Tire and  
Loading Information label. See Loading the Vehicle on  
page 518  
.
6-59  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Please note that the TPMS is not a substitute for proper  
tire maintenance, and it is the driver's responsibility to  
maintain correct tire pressure, even if underinflation  
has not reached the level to trigger illumination of the  
TPMS low tire pressure telltale.  
Tire Pressure Monitor System  
The Tire Pressure Monitor System (TPMS) uses radio  
and sensor technology to check tire pressure levels.  
The TPMS sensors monitor the air pressure in your  
vehicle's tires and transmit tire pressure readings to a  
receiver located in the vehicle.  
Your vehicle has also been equipped with a TPMS  
malfunction indicator to indicate when the system is not  
operating properly. The TPMS malfunction indicator is  
combined with the low tire pressure telltale. When the  
system detects a malfunction, the telltale will flash  
for approximately one minute and then remain  
continuously illuminated. This sequence will continue  
upon subsequent vehicle startups as long as the  
malfunction exists.  
Each tire, including the spare (if provided), should be  
checked monthly when cold and inflated to the inflation  
pressure recommended by the vehicle manufacturer  
on the vehicle placard or tire inflation pressure label.  
(If your vehicle has tires of a different size than the size  
indicated on the vehicle placard or tire inflation pressure  
label, you should determine the proper tire inflation  
pressure for those tires.)  
When the malfunction indicator is illuminated, the  
system may not be able to detect or signal low tire  
pressure as intended. TPMS malfunctions may occur  
for a variety of reasons, including the installation of  
replacement or alternate tires or wheels on the vehicle  
that prevent the TPMS from functioning properly.  
Always check the TPMS malfunction telltale after  
replacing one or more tires or wheels on your vehicle to  
ensure that the replacement or alternate tires and  
wheels allow the TPMS to continue to function properly.  
As an added safety feature, your vehicle has been  
equipped with a tire pressure monitoring system  
(TPMS) that illuminates a low tire pressure telltale when  
one or more of your tires is significantly underinflated.  
Accordingly, when the low tire pressure telltale  
illuminates, you should stop and check your tires  
as soon as possible, and inflate them to the proper  
pressure. Driving on a significantly underinflated tire  
causes the tire to overheat and can lead to tire failure.  
Underinflation also reduces fuel efficiency and tire  
tread life, and may affect the vehicle's handling and  
stopping ability.  
See Tire Pressure Monitor Operation on page 661 for  
additional information.  
6-60  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Federal Communications Commission  
(FCC) and Industry Canada  
See Radio Frequency Statement on page 818 for  
information regarding Part 15 of the Federal  
Communications Commission (FCC) rules and Industry  
Canada Standards RSS-210/220/310.  
If the warning light comes on, stop as soon as possible  
and inflate the tires to the recommended pressure  
shown on the tire loading information label. See  
Loading the Vehicle on page 518.  
At the same time a message to check the pressure in a  
specific tire appears on the Driver Information Center  
(DIC) display. The low tire pressure warning light and  
the DIC warning message come on at each ignition  
cycle until the tires are inflated to the correct inflation  
pressure. Using the DIC, tire pressure levels can be  
viewed by the driver. For additional information and  
details about the DIC operation and displays see DIC  
Operation and Displays on page 460 and DIC  
Warnings and Messages on page 465.  
Tire Pressure Monitor Operation  
This vehicle may have a Tire Pressure Monitor System  
(TPMS). The TPMS is designed to warn the driver when  
a low tire pressure condition exists. TPMS sensors are  
mounted onto each tire and wheel assembly, excluding  
the spare tire and wheel assembly. The TPMS sensors  
monitor the air pressure in the vehicle's tires and  
transmits the tire pressure readings to a receiver  
located in the vehicle.  
The low tire pressure warning light may come on in cool  
weather when the vehicle is first started, and then turn  
off as you start to drive. This could be an early indicator  
that the air pressure in the tire(s) are getting low and  
need to be inflated to the proper pressure.  
When a low tire pressure  
condition is detected, the  
TPMS illuminates the low  
tire pressure warning light  
located on the instrument  
panel cluster.  
6-61  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
A Tire and Loading Information label, attached to  
your vehicle, shows the size of your vehicle's original  
equipment tires and the correct inflation pressure for  
your vehicle's tires when they are cold. See Loading the  
Vehicle on page 518, for an example of the Tire and  
Loading Information label and its location on your  
vehicle. Also see Inflation - Tire Pressure on page 657.  
TPMS Malfunction Light and Message  
The TPMS will not function properly if one or more of  
the TPMS sensors are missing or inoperable. When the  
system detects a malfunction, the low tire warning light  
flashes for about one minute and then stays on for the  
remainder of the ignition cycle. A DIC warning message  
is also displayed. The low tire warning light and DIC  
warning message come on at each ignition cycle until  
the problem is corrected. Some of the conditions that  
can cause the malfunction light and DIC message to  
come on are:  
Your vehicle's TPMS can warn you about a low tire  
pressure condition but it does not replace normal tire  
maintenance. See Tire Inspection and Rotation on  
page 665 and Tires on page 648.  
Notice: Tire sealant materials are not all the same.  
A non-approved tire sealant could damage the Tire  
Pressure Monitor System (TPMS) sensors. TPMS  
sensor damage caused by using an incorrect tire  
sealant is not covered by the vehicle warranty.  
Always use only the GM approved tire sealant  
available through your dealer or included in the  
vehicle.  
.
One of the road tires has been replaced with the  
spare tire. The spare tire does not have a TPMS  
sensor. The TPMS malfunction light and DIC  
message should go off once you reinstall the road  
tire containing the TPMS sensor.  
.
The TPMS sensor matching process was started  
but not completed or not completed successfully  
after rotating the vehicle's tires. The DIC message  
and TPMS malfunction light should go off once the  
TPMS sensor matching process is performed  
successfully. See TPMS Sensor Matching  
Processlater in this section.  
Factory-installed Tire Inflator Kits use a GM approved  
liquid tire sealant. Using non-approved tire sealants  
could damage the TPMS sensors. See Tire Sealant and  
Compressor Kit on page 675 for information regarding  
the inflator kit materials and instructions.  
6-62  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
.
.
.
One or more TPMS sensors are missing or  
damaged. The DIC message and the TPMS  
malfunction light should go off when the TPMS  
sensors are installed and the sensor matching  
process is performed successfully. See your dealer  
for service.  
TPMS Sensor Matching Process  
Each TPMS sensor has a unique identification code.  
Any time you rotate your vehicle's tires or replace  
one or more of the TPMS sensors, the identification  
codes will need to be matched to the new tire/wheel  
position. The sensors are matched to the tire/wheel  
positions in the following order: driver side front tire,  
passenger side front tire, passenger side rear tire, and  
driver side rear tire using a TPMS diagnostic tool. See  
your dealer for service.  
Replacement tires or wheels do not match your  
vehicle's original equipment tires or wheels.  
Tires and wheels other than those recommended  
for your vehicle could prevent the TPMS from  
functioning properly. See Buying New Tires on  
page 668  
.
The TPMS sensors can also be matched to each  
tire/wheel position by increasing or decreasing the tire's  
air pressure. If increasing the tire's air pressure, do not  
exceed the maximum inflation pressure indicated on the  
tire's sidewall.  
Operating electronic devices or being near facilities  
using radio wave frequencies similar to the TPMS  
could cause the TPMS sensors to malfunction.  
If the TPMS is not functioning it cannot detect or signal  
a low tire condition. See your dealer for service if the  
TPMS malfunction light and DIC message comes on  
and stays on.  
To decrease air-pressure out of a tire you can use the  
pointed end of the valve cap, a pencil-style air pressure  
gauge, or a key.  
You have two minutes to match the first tire/wheel  
position, and five minutes overall to match all four tire/  
wheel positions. If it takes longer than two minutes, to  
match the first tire and wheel, or more than five minutes  
to match all four tire and wheel positions the matching  
process stops and you need to start over.  
6-63  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The TPMS sensor matching process is outlined below:  
1. Set the parking brake.  
6. Proceed to the passenger side front tire, and  
repeat the procedure in Step 5.  
7. Proceed to the passenger side rear tire, and repeat  
the procedure in Step 5.  
2. Turn the ignition switch to ON/RUN with the  
engine off.  
8. Proceed to the driver side rear tire, and repeat the  
procedure in Step 5. The horn sounds two times to  
indicate the sensor identification code has been  
matched to the driver side rear tire, and the TPMS  
sensor matching process is no longer active. The  
TIRE LEARNING ACTIVE message on the DIC  
display screen goes off.  
3. Press the Remote Keyless Entry (RKE)  
transmitter's lock and unlock buttons at the same  
time for approximately five seconds. The horn  
sounds twice to signal the receiver is in relearn  
mode and TIRE LEARNING ACTIVE message  
displays on the DIC screen.  
4. Start with the driver side front tire.  
9. Turn the ignition switch to LOCK/OFF.  
5. Remove the valve cap from the valve cap stem.  
Activate the TPMS sensor by increasing or  
decreasing the tire's air pressure for five seconds,  
or until a horn chirp sounds. The horn chirp, which  
may take up to 30 seconds to sound, confirms that  
the sensor identification code has been matched to  
this tire and wheel position.  
10. Set all four tires to the recommended air pressure  
level as indicated on the Tire and Loading  
Information label.  
11. Put the valve caps back on the valve stems.  
6-64  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The purpose of a regular tire rotation is to achieve  
a uniform wear for all tires on the vehicle. This will  
ensure that your vehicle continues to perform  
most like it did when the tires were new.  
Tire Inspection and Rotation  
We recommend that you regularly inspect your  
vehicle's tires, including the spare tire, for signs of  
wear or damage. See When It Is Time for New  
Tires on page 667 for more information.  
Any time you notice unusual wear, rotate your  
tires as soon as possible and check wheel  
alignment. Also check for damaged tires or  
wheels. SeeWhen It Is Time for New Tires on  
page 667 and Wheel Replacement on page 672  
for more information.  
Always remove the tires if any of the following  
statements are true:  
.
You can see the indicators at three or more  
places around the tire.  
.
You can see cord or fabric showing through  
the tire's rubber.  
.
The tread or sidewall is cracked, cut,  
or snagged deep enough to show cord or  
fabric.  
.
The tire has a bump, bulge, or split.  
.
The tire has a puncture, cut, or other damage  
that cannot be repaired well because of the  
size or location of the damage.  
Tires should be rotated every 12 000 km  
FourTire Rotation Pattern  
(7,500 miles). See Scheduled Maintenance on  
If your vehicle has a compact spare tire, it should  
not be included in the tire rotation process. Use  
the fourtire rotation pattern shown.  
page 73  
.
6-65  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Make certain that all wheel nuts are properly  
tightened. See Wheel Nut Torqueunder  
Capacities and Specifications on page 6112  
.
WARNING:  
{
Rust or dirt on a wheel, or on the parts to  
which it is fastened, can make wheel nuts  
become loose after time. The wheel could  
come off and cause an accident. When you  
change a wheel, remove any rust or dirt from  
places where the wheel attaches to the  
vehicle. In an emergency, you can use a  
cloth or a paper towel to do this; but be  
sure to use a scraper or wire brush later,  
if needed, to get all the rust or dirt off. See  
FiveTire Rotation Pattern  
A fivetire rotation pattern may be used for your  
professional vehicle, if it has a fullsize spare tire  
and wheel assembly that matches the original  
equipment tires and wheels in size, type and  
brand. The correct fivetire rotation pattern is  
shown.  
Changing a Flat Tire on page 683  
.
After the tires have been rotated, adjust the front  
and rear inflation pressures as shown on the Tire  
and Loading Information label. See Loading the  
Lightly coat the center of the wheel hub with  
wheel bearing grease after a wheel change or tire  
rotation to prevent corrosion or rust build-up. Do  
not get grease on the flat wheel mounting surface  
or on the wheel nuts or bolts.  
Vehicle on page 518  
.
Vehicles that have the Tire Pressure Monitor  
System (TPMS) will need to have the sensors  
reset after a tire rotation is performed. See Tire  
Pressure Monitor System on page 660  
.
6-66  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
When It Is Time for New Tires  
Various factors, such as maintenance, temperatures,  
driving speeds, vehicle loading, and road conditions  
influence when you need new tires.  
The rubber in tires ages over time, even if they are not  
being used. This is also true for the spare tire, if your  
vehicle has one. Multiple conditions affect how fast this  
aging takes place, including temperatures, loading  
conditions, and inflation pressure maintenance. Tires  
will typically need to be replaced due to wear before  
they may need to be replaced due to age. Consult the  
tire manufacturer for more information on when tires  
should be replaced.  
One way to tell when it is  
time for new tires is to  
check the treadwear  
indicators, which will  
appear when your tires  
have only 1/16 inch  
Vehicle Storage  
(1.6 mm) or less of tread  
remaining. See Tire  
Inspection and Rotation  
on page 665 for  
Tires age when stored normally mounted on a parked  
vehicle. Park a vehicle that will be stored for at least  
a month in a cool, dry, clean area away from direct  
sunlight to slow aging. This area should be free of  
grease, gasoline or other substances that can  
deteriorate rubber.  
additional information.  
Parking for an extended period can cause flat spots  
on the tires that may result in vibrations while driving.  
When storing a vehicle for at least a month, remove the  
tires or raise the vehicle to reduce the weight from the  
tires.  
6-67  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Buying New Tires  
WARNING:  
{
GM has developed and matched specific tires for your  
vehicle. The original equipment tires installed on your  
vehicle, when it was new, were designed to meet  
General Motors Tire Performance Criteria Specification  
(TPC Spec) system rating. If you need replacement  
tires, GM strongly recommends that you get tires with  
the same TPC Spec rating. This way, your vehicle will  
continue to have tires that are designed to give the  
same performance and vehicle safety, during normal  
use, as the original tires.  
Tires could explode during improper service. You  
or others could be injured or killed if you attempt  
to mount or dismount a tire. Only your dealer or  
an authorized tire service center should mount  
and dismount the tires.  
GM's exclusive TPC Spec system considers over a  
dozen critical specifications that impact the overall  
performance of your vehicle, including brake system  
performance, ride and handling, traction control, and tire  
pressure monitoring performance. GM's TPC Spec  
number is molded onto the tire's sidewall near the tire  
size. If the tires have an allseason tread design, the  
TPC Spec number will be followed by an MS for mud  
and snow. See Tire Sidewall Labeling on page 649 for  
additional information.  
WARNING:  
{
Mixing tires could cause you to lose control of  
your vehicle while driving. If you mix tires of  
different sizes, brands, or types (radial and  
bias-belted tires), the vehicle may not handle  
properly, and you could have a crash. Using tires  
of different sizes, brands, or types may also cause  
damage to your vehicle. Be sure to use the  
correct size, brand, and type of tires on all wheels.  
GM recommends replacing tires in sets of four. This is  
because uniform tread depth on all tires will help keep  
your vehicle performing most like it did when the tires  
were new. Replacing less than a full set of tires can  
affect the braking and handling performance of your  
vehicle. See Tire Inspection and Rotation on page 665  
for information on proper tire rotation.  
(Continued)  
6-68  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
If you must replace your vehicle's tires with those  
that do not have a TPC Spec number, make sure they  
are the same size, load range, speed rating, and  
construction type (radial and biasbelted tires) as your  
vehicle's original tires.  
WARNING: (Continued)  
Your vehicle may have a compact spare tire and  
wheel assembly. If the vehicle has a compact  
spare tire and wheel, they have the same overall  
diameter as your vehicle's fullsize tires and  
wheels. Because they were designed and  
developed for use on your vehicle, it is all right to  
drive your vehicle with the compact spare installed  
properly. Compact spare tires are designed for  
temporary use only. See Spare Tire on  
Vehicles that have a tire pressure monitoring system  
could give an inaccurate lowpressure warning if  
nonTPC Spec rated tires are installed on your vehicle.  
NonTPC Spec rated tires may give a lowpressure  
warning that is higher or lower than the proper warning  
level you would get with TPC Spec rated tires. See Tire  
Pressure Monitor System on page 660.  
Your vehicle's original equipment tires are listed on the  
Tire and Loading Information Label. See Loading the  
Vehicle on page 518, for more information about the  
Tire and Loading Information Label and its location on  
your vehicle.  
page 693  
.
WARNING:  
{
If you use bias-ply tires on the vehicle, the  
wheel rim flanges could develop cracks after  
many miles of driving. A tire and/or wheel  
could fail suddenly, causing a crash. Use  
only radial-ply tires with the wheels on the  
vehicle.  
6-69  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Different Size Tires and Wheels  
Uniform Tire Quality Grading  
If you add wheels or tires that are a different size than  
your original equipment wheels and tires, this may  
affect the way your vehicle performs, including its  
braking, ride and handling characteristics, stability, and  
resistance to rollover. Additionally, if your vehicle has  
electronic systems such as, antilock brakes, traction  
control, and electronic stability control, the performance  
of these systems can be affected.  
Quality grades can be found where applicable  
on the tire sidewall between tread shoulder and  
maximum section width. For example:  
Treadwear 200 Traction AA  
Temperature A  
The following information relates to the system  
developed by the United States National  
Highway Traffic Safety Administration (NHTSA),  
which grades tires by treadwear, traction, and  
temperature performance. This applies only to  
vehicles sold in the United States. The grades are  
molded on the sidewalls of most passenger car  
tires. The Uniform Tire Quality Grading (UTQG)  
system does not apply to deep tread, winter-type  
snow tires, space-saver, or temporary use  
spare tires, tires with nominal rim diameters  
of 10 to 12 inches (25 to 30 cm), or to some  
limited-production tires.  
WARNING:  
{
If you add different sized wheels, your vehicle  
may not provide an acceptable level of  
performance and safety if tires not recommended  
for those wheels are selected. You may increase  
the chance that you will crash and suffer serious  
injury. Only use GM specific wheel and tire  
systems developed for your vehicle, and have  
them properly installed by a GM certified  
technician.  
While the tires available on General Motors  
passenger cars and light trucks may vary with  
respect to these grades, they must also conform  
to federal safety requirements and additional  
General Motors Tire Performance Criteria (TPC)  
standards.  
See Buying New Tires on page 668 and Accessories  
and Modifications on page 63 for additional  
information.  
6-70  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
All Passenger Car Tires Must Conform to  
Federal Safety Requirements In Addition To  
These Grades.  
assigned to this tire is based on straight-ahead  
braking traction tests, and does not include  
acceleration, cornering, hydroplaning, or peak  
traction characteristics.  
Treadwear  
Temperature A, B, C  
The treadwear grade is a comparative rating  
based on the wear rate of the tire when tested  
under controlled conditions on a specified  
government test course. For example, a tire  
graded 150 would wear one and a half (1½) times  
as well on the government course as a tire  
graded 100. The relative performance of tires  
depends upon the actual conditions of their use,  
however, and may depart significantly from the  
norm due to variations in driving habits, service  
practices and differences in road characteristics  
and climate.  
The temperature grades are A (the highest), B,  
and C, representing the tire's resistance to the  
generation of heat and its ability to dissipate heat  
when tested under controlled conditions on a  
specified indoor laboratory test wheel. Sustained  
high temperature can cause the material of the  
tire to degenerate and reduce tire life, and  
excessive temperature can lead to sudden tire  
failure. The grade C corresponds to a level of  
performance which all passenger car tires must  
meet under the Federal Motor Safety Standard  
No. 109. Grades B and A represent higher levels  
of performance on the laboratory test wheel than  
the minimum required by law. Warning: The  
temperature grade for this tire is established for a  
tire that is properly inflated and not overloaded.  
Excessive speed, underinflation, or excessive  
loading, either separately or in combination, can  
cause heat buildup and possible tire failure.  
Traction AA, A, B, C  
The traction grades, from highest to lowest,  
are AA, A, B, and C. Those grades represent  
the tire's ability to stop on wet pavement as  
measured under controlled conditions on  
specified government test surfaces of asphalt  
and concrete. A tire marked C may have poor  
traction performance. Warning: The traction grade  
6-71  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
equipment parts. This way, you will be sure to have the  
right wheel, wheel bolts, wheel nuts, and TPMS sensors  
for your vehicle.  
Wheel Alignment and Tire Balance  
The tires and wheels on your vehicle were aligned and  
balanced carefully at the factory to give you the longest  
tire life and best overall performance. Adjustments  
to wheel alignment and tire balancing will not be  
necessary on a regular basis. However, if you notice  
unusual tire wear or your vehicle pulling to one side or  
the other, the alignment might need to be checked.  
If you notice your vehicle vibrating when driving on a  
smooth road, the tires and wheels might need to be  
rebalanced. See your dealer for proper diagnosis.  
WARNING:  
{
Using the wrong replacement wheels, wheel bolts,  
or wheel nuts on your vehicle can be dangerous.  
It could affect the braking and handling of your  
vehicle, make your tires lose air and make you  
lose control. You could have a collision in which  
you or others could be injured. Always use the  
correct wheel, wheel bolts, and wheel nuts for  
replacement.  
Wheel Replacement  
Replace any wheel that is bent, cracked or badly rusted  
or corroded. If wheel nuts keep coming loose, the  
wheel, wheel bolts and wheel nuts should be replaced.  
If the wheel leaks air, replace it. Some aluminum wheels  
can sometimes be repaired. See your GM dealer if any  
of these conditions exist.  
Notice: The wrong wheel can also cause problems  
with bearing life, brake cooling, speedometer or  
odometer calibration, headlamp aim, bumper height,  
vehicle ground clearance, and tire or tire chain  
clearance to the body and chassis.  
Your GM dealer will know the kind of wheel you need.  
Each new wheel should have the same load-carrying  
capacity, diameter, width, offset and be mounted the  
same way as the one it replaces.  
If your vehicle is a professional model, the wheels have  
a unique offset and bolt hole diameter. Each of the  
wheels on the professional vehicle have eight wheels  
nuts. The wheels on the non-professional vehicle  
have five wheel nuts. See Changing a Flat Tire on  
page 683 for more information.  
If you need to replace any of your wheels, wheel bolts,  
wheel nuts, or Tire Pressure Monitor System (TPMS)  
sensors, replace them only with new GM original  
6-72  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Used Replacement Wheels  
WARNING: (Continued)  
WARNING:  
{
Use another type of traction device only if its  
manufacturer recommends it for use on the  
vehicle and tire size combination and road  
conditions. Follow that manufacturer's  
instructions. To help avoid damage to the  
vehicle, drive slowly, readjust or remove the  
device if it is contacting the vehicle, and do not  
spin the vehicle's wheels. If you do find traction  
devices that will fit, install them on the front tires.  
Putting a used wheel on the vehicle is dangerous.  
You cannot know how it has been used or how  
far it has been driven. It could fail suddenly and  
cause a crash. If you have to replace a wheel, use  
a new GM original equipment wheel.  
Tire Chains  
If a Tire Goes Flat  
WARNING:  
{
It is unusual for a tire to blowout while you are driving,  
especially if you maintain your vehicle's tires properly.  
If air goes out of a tire, it is much more likely to leak out  
slowly. But if you should ever have a blowout, here are  
a few tips about what to expect and what to do:  
Do not use tire chains. There is not enough  
clearance. Tire chains used on a vehicle without  
the proper amount of clearance can cause  
damage to the brakes, suspension or other  
vehicle parts. The area damaged by the tire  
chains could cause you to lose control of the  
vehicle and you or others may be injured in a  
crash.  
If a front tire fails, the flat tire creates a drag that pulls  
the vehicle toward that side. Take your foot off the  
accelerator pedal and grip the steering wheel firmly.  
Steer to maintain lane position, and then gently brake to  
a stop, well off the road, if possible.  
(Continued)  
6-73  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
A rear blowout, particularly on a curve, acts much like  
a skid and may require the same correction you would  
use in a skid. In any rear blowout remove your foot from  
the accelerator pedal. Get the vehicle under control by  
steering the way you want the vehicle to go. It may be  
very bumpy and noisy, but you can still steer. Gently  
brake to a stop, well off the road, if possible.  
WARNING:  
{
Lifting a vehicle and getting under it to do  
maintenance or repairs is dangerous without the  
appropriate safety equipment and training. If a  
jack is provided with the vehicle, it is designed  
only for changing a flat tire. If it is used for  
anything else, you or others could be badly  
injured or killed if the vehicle slips off the jack.  
If a jack is provided with the vehicle, only use it  
for changing a flat tire.  
WARNING:  
{
Driving on a flat tire will cause permanent damage  
to the tire. Re-inflating a tire after it has been  
driven on while severely under-inflated or flat  
may cause a blowout and a serious crash.  
Never attempt to re-inflate a tire that has been  
driven on while severely under-inflated or flat.  
Have your dealer or an authorized tire service  
center repair or replace the flat tire as soon as  
possible.  
This vehicle may come with a jack and spare tire or a  
tire sealant and compressor kit. To use the jack and  
spare tire, follow the instructions below. To use the tire  
sealant and compressor kit, see Tire Sealant and  
Compressor Kit on page 675  
.
6-74  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Tire Sealant and Compressor Kit  
WARNING:  
WARNING:  
{
{
Storing the tire sealant and compressor kit or  
other equipment in the passenger compartment of  
the vehicle could cause injury. In a sudden stop or  
collision, loose equipment could strike someone.  
Store the tire sealant and compressor kit in its  
original location.  
Idling a vehicle in an enclosed area with poor  
ventilation is dangerous. Engine exhaust may  
enter the vehicle. Engine exhaust contains  
Carbon Monoxide (CO) which cannot be seen or  
smelled. It can cause unconsciousness and even  
death. Never run the engine in an enclosed area  
that has no fresh air ventilation. For more  
If this vehicle has a tire sealant and compressor kit,  
there may not be a spare tire, tire changing equipment,  
and on some vehicles there may not be a place to store  
a tire.  
information, see Engine Exhaust on page 333.  
The tire sealant and compressor can be used to  
temporarily seal punctures up to 6 mm (¼ inch) in the  
tread area of the tire. It can also be used to inflate an  
under inflated tire.  
WARNING:  
{
Over-inflating a tire could cause the tire to rupture  
and you or others could be injured. Be sure to  
read and follow the tire sealant and compressor  
kit instructions and inflate the tire to its  
recommended pressure. Do not exceed the  
recommended pressure.  
If the tire has been separated from the wheel, has  
damaged sidewalls, or has a large puncture, the tire is  
too severely damaged for the tire sealant and  
compressor kit to be effective. See Roadside Service  
on page 87  
.
6-75  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Read and follow all of the tire sealant and compressor  
kit instructions.  
Tire Sealant  
Read and follow the safe handling instructions on the  
label adhered to the compressor.  
The kit includes:  
Check the tire sealant expiration date on the sealant  
canister. The sealant canister should be replaced before  
its expiration date. Replacement sealant canisters are  
available at your local dealer. See Removal and  
Installation of the Sealant Canisterfollowing.  
There is only enough sealant to seal one tire. After  
usage, the sealant canister and sealant/air hose  
assembly must be replaced. See Removal and  
Installation of the Sealant Canisterfollowing.  
A. On/Off Button  
D. Pressure Gauge  
E. Air Only Hose (Black)  
F. Sealant/Air Hose (Clear)  
G. Power Plug  
B. Selector Switch  
(Sealant/Air or  
Air Only)  
C. Pressure Relief  
Button  
6-76  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
See If a Tire Goes Flat on page 673 for other  
important safety warnings.  
Using the Tire Sealant and Compressor  
Kit to Temporarily Seal and Inflate a  
Punctured Tire  
Do not remove any objects that have penetrated  
the tire.  
Follow the directions closely for correct sealant usage.  
1. Remove the tire sealant and compressor kit from  
its storage location. See Tire Sealant and  
Compressor Kit Storage on page 682.  
2. Unwrap the sealant/air hose (F) and the power  
plug (G).  
3. Place the kit on the ground.  
Make sure the tire valve stem is positioned close to  
the ground so the hose will reach it.  
4. Remove the valve stem cap from the flat tire by  
turning it counterclockwise.  
5. Attach the sealant/air hose (F) onto the tire valve  
stem. Turn it clockwise until it is tight.  
6. Plug the power plug (G) into the accessory power  
outlet in the vehicle. Unplug all items from other  
accessory power outlets. See Accessory Power  
Outlet(s) on page 433.  
When using the tire sealant and compressor kit  
during cold temperatures, warm the kit in a heated  
environment for five minutes. This will help to inflate the  
tire faster.  
If the vehicle has an accessory power outlet, do  
not use the cigarette lighter.  
If the vehicle only has a cigarette lighter, use the  
cigarette lighter.  
If a tire goes flat, avoid further tire and wheel damage  
by driving slowly to a level place. Turn on the hazard  
warning flashers. See Hazard Warning Flashers on  
Do not pinch the power plug cord in the door or  
window.  
page 43  
.
6-77  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
7. Start the vehicle. The vehicle must be running  
while using the air compressor.  
Notice: If the recommended pressure cannot be  
reached after approximately 25 minutes, the vehicle  
should not be driven farther. The tire is too severely  
damaged and the tire sealant and compressor kit  
cannot inflate the tire. Remove the power plug  
from the accessory power outlet and unscrew the  
inflating hose from the tire valve. See Roadside  
Service on page 87.  
8. Turn the selector switch (B) clockwise to the  
Sealant + Air position.  
9. Press the on/off (A) button to turn the tire sealant  
and compressor kit on.  
The compressor will inject sealant and air into  
the tire.  
11. Press the on/off button (A) to turn the tire sealant  
and compressor kit off.  
The pressure gauge (D) will initially show a high  
pressure while the compressor pushes the sealant  
into the tire. Once the sealant is completely  
dispersed into the tire, the pressure will quickly  
drop and start to rise again as the tire inflates with  
air only.  
The tire is not sealed and will continue to leak  
air until the vehicle is driven and the sealant is  
distributed in the tire, therefore, Steps 12  
through 18 must be done immediately after  
Step 11.  
10. Inflate the tire to the recommended inflation  
pressure using the pressure gauge (D). The  
recommended inflation pressure can be found  
on the Tire and Loading Information label. See  
Inflation - Tire Pressure on page 657.  
Be careful while handling the tire sealant and  
compressor kit as it could be warm after usage.  
12. Unplug the power plug (G) from the accessory  
power outlet in the vehicle.  
13. Turn the sealant/air hose (F) counterclockwise to  
remove it from the tire valve stem.  
The pressure gauge (D) may read higher than the  
actual tire pressure while the compressor is on.  
Turn the compressor off to get an accurate  
pressure reading. The compressor may be turned  
on/off until the correct pressure is reached.  
14. Replace the tire valve stem cap.  
15. Replace the sealant/air hose (F), and the power  
plug (G) back in their original location.  
6-78  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
19. Stop at a safe location and check the tire pressure.  
Refer to Steps 1 through 11 under Using the Tire  
Sealant and Compressor Kit without Sealant to  
Inflate a Tire (Not Punctured).”  
16. If the flat tire was  
able to inflate to the  
recommended inflation  
pressure, remove  
the maximum speed  
label from the sealant  
canister and place  
it in a highly visible  
location.  
If the tire pressure has fallen more than 68 kPa  
(10 psi) below the recommended inflation  
pressure, stop driving the vehicle. The tire is too  
severely damaged and the tire sealant cannot seal  
the tire. See Roadside Service on page 87.  
If the tire pressure has not dropped more than  
68 kPa (10 psi) from the recommended inflation  
pressure, inflate the tire to the recommended  
inflation pressure.  
Do not exceed the speed on this label until the  
damaged tire is repaired or replaced.  
20. Wipe off any sealant from the wheel, tire, and  
vehicle.  
17. Return the equipment to its original storage  
location in the vehicle.  
21. Dispose of the used sealant canister and  
sealant/air hose (F) assembly at a local dealer or  
in accordance with local state codes and practices.  
18. Immediately drive the vehicle 8 km (5 miles) to  
distribute the sealant in the tire.  
22. Replace it with a new canister available from your  
dealer.  
23. After temporarily sealing a tire using the tire  
sealant and compressor kit, take the vehicle to an  
authorized dealer within a 161 km (100 miles) of  
driving to have the tire repaired or replaced.  
6-79  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
See If a Tire Goes Flat on page 673 for other  
important safety warnings.  
Using the Tire Sealant and Compressor  
Kit without Sealant to Inflate a Tire  
(Not Punctured)  
To use the air compressor to inflate a tire with air only  
and not sealant:  
1. Remove the tire sealant and compressor kit  
from its storage location. See Tire Sealant and  
Compressor Kit Storage on page 682.  
2. Unwrap the air only hose (E) and the power  
plug (G).  
3. Place the kit on the ground.  
Make sure the tire valve stem is positioned close to  
the ground so the hose will reach it.  
4. Remove the tire valve stem cap from the flat tire by  
turning it counterclockwise.  
5. Attach the air only hose (E) onto the tire valve  
stem by turning it clockwise until it is tight.  
6. Plug the power plug (G) into the accessory power  
outlet in the vehicle. Unplug all items from other  
accessory power outlets. See Accessory Power  
Outlet(s) on page 433.  
If the vehicle has an accessory power outlet, do  
not use the cigarette lighter.  
If a tire goes flat, avoid further tire and wheel damage  
by driving slowly to a level place. Turn on the hazard  
warning flashers. See Hazard Warning Flashers on  
If the vehicle only has a cigarette lighter, use the  
cigarette lighter.  
page 43  
.
Do not pinch the power plug cord in the door or  
window.  
6-80  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
7. Start the vehicle. The vehicle must be running  
while using the air compressor.  
11. Press the on/off button (A) to turn the tire sealant  
and compressor kit off.  
8. Turn the selector switch (B) counterclockwise to  
the Air Only position.  
Be careful while handling the tire sealant and  
compressor kit as it could be warm after usage.  
9. Press the on/off (A) button to turn the  
compressor on.  
12. Unplug the power plug (G) from the accessory  
power outlet in the vehicle.  
The compressor will inflate the tire with air only.  
13. Disconnect the air only hose (E) from the tire valve  
stem, by turning it counterclockwise, and replace  
the tire valve stem cap.  
10. Inflate the tire to the recommended inflation  
pressure using the pressure gauge (D). The  
recommended inflation pressure can be found  
on the Tire and Loading Information label. See  
Inflation - Tire Pressure on page 657.  
14. Replace the air only hose (E) and the power  
plug (G) and cord back in its original location.  
15. Place the equipment in the original storage location  
in the vehicle.  
The pressure gauge (D) may read higher than the  
actual tire pressure while the compressor is on.  
Turn the compressor off to get an accurate  
reading. The compressor may be turned on/off  
until the correct pressure is reached.  
6-81  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Removal and Installation of the Sealant  
Canister  
Tire Sealant and Compressor Kit  
Storage  
The tire sealant and compressor kit is located in the  
trunk.  
To remove the sealant canister:  
1. Open the trunk. See Trunk on page 312.  
2. Lift the cover.  
1. Remove the plastic cover.  
2. Unscrew the connector (B) from the canister (A).  
3. Pull up on the canister (A) to remove it.  
4. Replace with a new canister which is available  
from your dealer.  
3. Turn the retainer clockwise and remove the tire  
sealant and compressor kit.  
5. Push the new canister into place.  
6. Screw the connector (B) to the canister (A).  
7. Slide the plastic cover back on.  
To store the tire sealant and compressor kit, reverse the  
steps.  
6-82  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
When the vehicle has a flat tire (B), use the following  
example as a guide to assist you in the placement of  
wheel blocks (A).  
Changing a Flat Tire  
If a tire goes flat, avoid further tire and wheel damage  
by driving slowly to a level place, well off the road,  
if possible. Turn on the hazard warning flashers. See  
Hazard Warning Flashers on page 43.  
WARNING:  
{
Changing a tire can be dangerous. The vehicle  
can slip off the jack and roll over or fall on you or  
other people. You and they could be badly injured  
or even killed. Find a level place to change your  
tire. To help prevent the vehicle from moving:  
1. Set the parking brake firmly.  
2. Put the shift lever in P (Park).  
3. Turn off the engine and do not restart while  
the vehicle is raised.  
A. Wheel Block  
B. Flat Tire  
4. Do not allow passengers to remain in the  
vehicle.  
The following information explains how to use the jack  
and change a tire.  
To be even more certain the vehicle will not move,  
you should put blocks at the front and rear of the  
tire farthest away from the one being changed.  
That would be the tire, on the other side, at the  
opposite end of the vehicle.  
6-83  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3. Grab the handle and  
remove the cover.  
Removing the Spare Tire and Tools  
The equipment needed is in the trunk. To access the  
equipment:  
1. Open the trunk. See Trunk on page 312 for more  
information.  
2. Press the area at the  
front of the handle  
located on the cover so  
that the back edge  
raises.  
6-84  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The tools to be used are the jack (A) and the wheel  
wrench (B).  
4. Turn the wing nut to remove the retainer that holds  
the wrench and jack.  
5. Remove the wheel wrench, jack and spare tire  
from the trunk. See Spare Tire on page 693 for  
more information.  
6-85  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Be careful not to scratch the aluminum wheel edge  
and do not try to remove it with your hands. Then  
loosen the wheel nuts with the wheel wrench. Do  
not remove them yet.  
Removing the Flat Tire and Installing  
the Spare Tire  
1. Do a safety check before proceeding. See  
Changing a Flat Tire on page 683 for more  
information.  
3. For models with exposed lug nuts, loosen them  
using the wheel wrench. Do not remove them yet.  
2. For models having aluminum wheels with a  
center wheel cover, use the flat end of the wheel  
wrench to gently pry the wheel covers off. Store  
the wheel cover and lug nut caps in the trunk  
until you have the flat tire repaired or replaced.  
6-86  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
WARNING:  
{
Getting under a vehicle when it is jacked up is  
dangerous. If the vehicle slips off the jack, you  
could be badly injured or killed. Never get under a  
vehicle when it is supported only by a jack.  
WARNING:  
{
Raising your vehicle with the jack improperly  
positioned can damage the vehicle and even  
make the vehicle fall. To help avoid personal  
injury and vehicle damage, be sure to fit the jack  
lift head into the proper location before raising the  
vehicle.  
4. Find the jacking location from the diagram above  
and use the corresponding cutouts located in the  
plastic molding.  
The front location is (A) 8.5 inches (21 cm) from  
the rear edge of the front wheel well, and the rear  
location (B) is 3.5 inches (8.5 cm) from the front  
edge of the rear wheel well.  
Notice: If you position the jack under the rocker  
molding and attempt to raise the vehicle, you could  
break the molding and/or cause other damage to  
your vehicle. Always position the jack so that when  
the jack head is raised, it will fit firmly in the notch  
located inboard from the rocker molding.  
The notches may also be labeled JACK with an  
arrow pointing to the jacking location on the  
vehicle.  
5. Turn the jack handle counterclockwise to lower the  
jack lift head until the jack fits under the vehicle.  
6-87  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
6. Raise the jack until the metal flange fits firmly into  
the channel of the jack head.  
8. Raise the vehicle by turning the jack handle  
clockwise. Raise the vehicle far enough off the  
ground for the spare tire to fit under the vehicle.  
7. Put the spare tire near you.  
9. Remove all wheel nuts and the flat tire.  
6-88  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
11. Place the spare tire on the wheel-mounting  
surface.  
10. Remove any rust or dirt  
from the wheel bolts,  
mounting surfaces, and  
spare wheel.  
WARNING:  
{
Never use oil or grease on bolts or nuts because  
the nuts might come loose. The vehicle's wheel  
could fall off, causing a crash.  
12. Put the wheel nuts  
back on with the  
rounded end of the  
nuts toward the wheel.  
Tighten each nut by  
hand until the wheel is  
held against the hub.  
WARNING:  
{
Rust or dirt on a wheel, or on the parts to which it  
is fastened, can make wheel nuts become loose  
after time. The wheel could come off and cause  
an accident. When changing a wheel, remove any  
rust or dirt from places where the wheel attaches  
to the vehicle. In an emergency, use a cloth or  
a paper towel to do this; but be sure to use a  
scraper or wire brush later, if needed, to get all  
the rust or dirt off. See Changing a Flat Tire on  
page 683  
.
6-89  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
WARNING:  
{
Wheel nuts that are improperly or incorrectly  
tightened can cause the wheels to become loose  
or come off. The wheel nuts should be tightened  
with a torque wrench to the proper torque  
specification after replacing. Follow the torque  
specification supplied by the aftermarket  
manufacturer when using accessory locking  
wheel nuts. See Capacities and Specifications on  
page 6112 for original equipment wheel nut  
torque specifications.  
Notice: Improperly tightened wheel nuts can lead  
to brake pulsation and rotor damage. To avoid  
expensive brake repairs, evenly tighten the wheel  
nuts in the proper sequence and to the proper  
torque specification. See Capacities and  
Specifications on page 6112 for the wheel nut  
torque specification.  
13. Lower the vehicle by turning the jack handle  
counterclockwise. Lower the jack completely.  
6-90  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Storing a Flat or Spare Tire and  
Tools  
WARNING:  
{
Storing a jack, a tire, or other equipment in the  
passenger compartment of the vehicle could  
cause injury. In a sudden stop or collision, loose  
equipment could strike someone. Store all these  
in the proper place.  
5-Wheel Nuts  
8-Wheel Nuts  
14. Tighten the wheel nuts firmly in a crisscross  
sequence as shown.  
After you have put the spare tire on your vehicle, store  
the flat tire in your trunk.  
If your vehicle is equipped with wheel nut covers,  
screw the nut covers on with your fingers, then  
tighten one-quarter turn with the wheel wrench.  
Store the flat tire as far forward in the trunk as possible.  
Store the jack and wheel wrench in their compartment  
in the trunk. For storage, the jack must be raised until  
the screw end is flush with the edge of the jack.  
Notice: Wheel covers will not fit on your vehicle's  
compact spare. If you try to put a wheel cover on  
the compact spare, the cover or the spare could be  
damaged.  
The compact spare is for temporary use only. Replace  
the compact spare tire with a full-size tire as soon as  
you can.  
6-91  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
A. Cover  
B. Wing Nut  
C. Retainer  
D. Jack and Wheel Wrench  
E. Jack Container  
F. Spare Tire  
G. Bolt  
1. Open the trunk. See Trunk on page 312.  
2. Reinstall the spare tire (F), face down, making sure  
to line up the wheel center hole with the bolt (G)  
and place it on the compartment floor.  
3. Insert the jack container (E) into the spare tire (F).  
Then insert the jack and wheel wrench (D) into  
the center of the spare tire making sure to line  
up the wheel nut hole with the bolt (G) on the  
compartment floor.  
4. Secure the spare tire and the jack container with  
the retainer (C) and then the wing nut (B).  
5. Reinstall the spare tire cover (A).  
6-92  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
After installing the compact spare on the vehicle, stop  
as soon as possible and make sure the spare tire is  
correctly inflated. The compact spare is made to  
perform well at speeds up to 65 mph (105 km/h) for  
distances up to 3,000 miles (5 000 km), so you can  
finish your trip and have the full-size tire repaired or  
replaced at your convenience. Of course, it is best  
to replace the spare with a full-size tire as soon as  
possible. The spare tire will last longer and be in good  
shape in case it is needed again.  
Spare Tire  
Compact Spare Tire  
WARNING:  
{
Driving with more than one compact spare tire at  
a time could result in loss of braking and handling.  
This could lead to a crash and you or others could  
be injured. Use only one compact spare tire at  
a time.  
Notice: When the compact spare is installed, do not  
take the vehicle through an automatic car wash with  
guide rails. The compact spare can get caught on  
the rails which can damage the tire, wheel and other  
parts of the vehicle.  
This vehicle may have a compact spare tire. Although  
the compact spare tire was fully inflated when the  
vehicle was new, it can lose air after a time. Check  
the inflation pressure regularly. It should be 60 psi  
(420 kPa).  
Do not use the compact spare on other vehicles.  
And do not mix the compact spare tire or wheel with  
other wheels or tires. They will not fit. Keep the spare  
tire and its wheel together.  
Notice: Tire chains will not fit the compact spare.  
Using them can damage the vehicle and can  
damage the chains too. Do not use tire chains on  
the compact spare.  
6-93  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Spare Tire  
Appearance Care  
This vehicle may have a spare tire, which, when new,  
was fully inflated. A spare tire may lose air over time, so  
check its inflation pressure regularly. See Inflation - Tire  
Pressure on page 657 and Loading the Vehicle on  
page 518 for information regarding proper tire inflation  
and loading your vehicle. For instructions on how to  
remove, install or store a spare tire, see Removing the  
Flat Tire and Installing the Spare Tire on page 686.  
Interior Cleaning  
The vehicle's interior will continue to look its best if it is  
cleaned often. Although not always visible, dust and dirt  
can accumulate on the upholstery. Dirt can damage  
carpet, fabric, leather, and plastic surfaces. Regular  
vacuuming is recommended to remove particles from  
the upholstery. It is important to keep the upholstery  
from becoming and remaining heavily soiled. Soils  
should be removed as quickly as possible. The  
vehicle's interior may experience extremes of heat  
that could cause stains to set rapidly.  
After installing the spare tire on your vehicle, you should  
stop as soon as possible and make sure the spare is  
correctly inflated. Have the damaged or flat road tire  
repaired or replaced as soon as you can and installed  
back onto your vehicle. This way, a spare tire will be  
available in case you need it again.  
Lighter colored interiors may require more frequent  
cleaning. Use care because newspapers and garments  
that transfer color to home furnishings may also transfer  
color to the vehicle's interior.  
Your vehicle may have a different size spare tire than  
the road tire originally installed on your vehicle. This  
spare tire was developed for use on your vehicle, so it  
is all right to drive on it.  
When cleaning the vehicle's interior, only use cleaners  
specifically designed for the surfaces being cleaned.  
Permanent damage may result from using cleaners  
on surfaces for which they were not intended. Use  
glass cleaner only on glass. Remove any accidental  
over-spray from other surfaces immediately. To prevent  
over-spray, apply cleaner directly to the cleaning cloth.  
If your vehicle has a spare tire that does not match your  
vehicle's original road tires and wheels in size and type,  
do not include the spare in the tire rotation.  
6-94  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
.
Laundry detergents or dishwashing soaps with  
degreasers can leave residue that streaks and  
attracts dirt. For liquid cleaners, about 20 drops per  
gallon (3.78 L) of water is a good guide. Use only  
mild, neutral-pH soaps.  
Notice: Using abrasive cleaners when cleaning  
glass surfaces on the vehicle, could scratch the  
glass and/or cause damage to the rear window  
defogger. When cleaning the glass on the vehicle,  
use only a soft cloth and glass cleaner.  
.
.
Too much cleaner that saturates the upholstery.  
Many cleaners contain solvents that may become  
concentrated in the vehicle's breathing space.  
Before using cleaners, read and adhere to all safety  
instructions on the label. While cleaning the vehicle's  
interior, maintain adequate ventilation by opening the  
vehicle's doors and windows.  
Organic solvents such as naptha, alcohol, etc. that  
can damage the vehicle's interior.  
Fabric/Carpet  
Use a vacuum cleaner with a soft brush attachment  
frequently to remove dust and loose dirt. A canister  
vacuum with a beater bar in the nozzle may only be  
used on floor carpet and carpeted floor mats. For any  
soil, always try to remove it first with plain water or club  
soda. Before cleaning, gently remove as much of the  
soil as possible using one of the following techniques:  
Dust may be removed from small buttons and knobs  
using a small brush with soft bristles.  
Products that remove odors from the vehicle's  
upholstery and clean the vehicle's glass can be  
obtained from your dealer.  
Do not clean the vehicle using:  
.
For liquids: gently blot the remaining soil with a  
.
A knife or any other sharp object to remove a soil  
paper towel. Allow the soil to absorb into the paper  
towel until no more can be removed.  
from any interior surface.  
.
A stiff brush. It can cause damage to the vehicle's  
.
For solid dry soils: remove as much as possible  
interior surfaces.  
and then vacuum.  
.
Heavy pressure or aggressive rubbing with a  
To clean:  
cleaning cloth. Use of heavy pressure can damage  
the interior and does not improve the effectiveness  
of soil removal.  
1. Saturate a lint-free, clean white cloth with water or  
club soda.  
2. Wring the cloth to remove excess moisture.  
6-95  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3. Start on the outside edge of the soil and gently rub  
toward the center. Continue cleaning, using a clean  
area of the cloth each time it becomes soiled.  
not recommended. Do not use silicone or wax-based  
products, or those containing organic solvents to  
clean the vehicle's interior because they can alter the  
appearance by increasing the gloss in a non-uniform  
manner. Never use shoe polish on leather.  
4. Continue to gently rub the soiled area until the  
cleaning cloth remains clean.  
5. If the soil is not completely removed, use a mild  
soap solution and repeat the cleaning process that  
was used with plain water.  
TEHAMALeather  
The leather surface on the seat was not designed to be  
aggressively cleaned using any commercial product.  
Use a well wrung cloth dampened with water to remove  
dust. Do not use a wet cloth or saturate the leather  
surface with water. Allow the leather to dry naturally. If a  
soil occurs that cannot be completely removed, allow it  
to become part of the natural markings of the leather.  
The leather in the vehicle was designed to have a  
natural appearance and develop a more vintage  
appearance with use.  
If any of the soil remains, a commercial fabric cleaner  
or spot lifter may be necessary. When a commercial  
upholstery cleaner or spot lifter is to be used, test a  
small hidden area for colorfastness first. If the locally  
cleaned area gives any impression that a ring formation  
may result, clean the entire surface.  
After the cleaning process has been completed, a paper  
towel can be used to blot excess moisture from the  
fabric or carpet.  
Do not use heat to dry. Never use steam to clean  
leather. Never use spot lifters or spot removers on  
leather. It is very important to not use any commercial  
leather cleaners or coatings that are sold to preserve  
and protect leather. Not only are those products not  
necessary, they will permanently and adversely change  
the appearance and feel of the leather. Never use  
silicone or wax-based products, or those containing  
organic solvents to clean the vehicle's interior. Never  
use shoe polish on leather.  
Leather  
A soft cloth dampened with water can be used to  
remove dust. If a more thorough cleaning is necessary,  
a soft cloth dampened with a mild soap solution can  
be used. Allow the leather to dry naturally. Do not use  
heat to dry. Never use steam to clean leather. Never  
use spot lifters or spot removers on leather. Many  
commercial leather cleaners and coatings that are  
sold to preserve and protect leather may permanently  
change the appearance and feel of the leather and are  
6-96  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Instrument Panel, Vinyl, and Other  
Plastic Surfaces  
Speaker Covers  
Vacuum around a speaker cover gently, so that the  
speaker will not be damaged. Clean spots with just  
water and mild soap.  
A soft cloth dampened with water may be used to  
remove dust. If a more thorough cleaning is necessary,  
a clean soft cloth dampened with a mild soap solution  
can be used to gently remove dust and dirt. Never use  
spot lifters or removers on plastic surfaces. Many  
commercial cleaners and coatings that are sold to  
preserve and protect soft plastic surfaces may  
permanently change the appearance and feel of the  
interior and are not recommended. Do not use silicone  
or wax-based products, or those containing organic  
solvents to clean the vehicle's interior because they  
can alter the appearance by increasing the gloss in a  
non-uniform manner.  
Care of Safety Belts  
Keep belts clean and dry.  
WARNING:  
{
Do not bleach or dye safety belts. It may severely  
weaken them. In a crash, they might not be able  
to provide adequate protection. Clean safety belts  
only with mild soap and lukewarm water.  
Some commercial products may increase gloss on the  
instrument panel. The increase in gloss may cause  
annoying reflections in the windshield and even make  
it difficult to see through the windshield under certain  
conditions.  
Weatherstrips  
Silicone grease on weatherstrips will make them last  
longer, seal better, and not stick or squeak. Apply  
silicone grease with a clean cloth. During very cold,  
damp weather frequent application may be required.  
See Recommended Fluids and Lubricants on  
Wood Panels  
Use a clean cloth moistened in warm, soapy water (use  
mild dish washing soap). Dry the wood immediately with  
a clean cloth.  
page 79  
.
6-97  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
High pressure car washes may cause water to enter the  
vehicle. Avoid using high pressure washes closer than  
12 inches (30 cm) to the surface of the vehicle. Use of  
power washers exceeding 1,200 psi (8 274 kPa) can  
result in damage or removal of paint and decals.  
Washing Your Vehicle  
The best way to preserve the vehicle's finish is to keep  
it clean by washing it often.  
Notice: Certain cleaners contain chemicals that can  
damage the emblems or nameplates on the vehicle.  
Check the cleaning product label. If it states that it  
should not be used on plastic parts, do not use it on  
the vehicle or damage may occur and it would not  
be covered by the warranty.  
Cleaning Exterior Lamps/Lenses  
Use only lukewarm or cold water, a soft cloth and a  
car washing soap to clean exterior lamps and lenses.  
Follow instructions under Washing Your Vehicle on  
Do not wash the vehicle in direct sunlight. Use a car  
washing soap. Do not use cleaning agents that are  
petroleum based or that contain acid or abrasives, as  
they can damage the paint, metal or plastic on the  
vehicle. Approved cleaning products can be obtained  
from your dealer. Follow all manufacturers' directions  
regarding correct product usage, necessary safety  
precautions and appropriate disposal of any vehicle  
care product.  
page 698  
.
Finish Care  
Occasional waxing or mild polishing of the vehicle by  
hand may be necessary to remove residue from the  
paint finish. Approved cleaning products can be  
obtained from your dealer.  
If the vehicle has a basecoat/clearcoat paint finish, the  
clearcoat gives more depth and gloss to the colored  
basecoat. Always use waxes and polishes that are  
non-abrasive and made for a basecoat/clearcoat paint  
finish.  
Rinse the vehicle well, before washing and after to  
remove all cleaning agents completely. If they are  
allowed to dry on the surface, they could stain.  
Dry the finish with a soft, clean chamois or an all-cotton  
towel to avoid surface scratches and water spotting.  
6-98  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Notice: Machine compounding or aggressive  
polishing on a basecoat/clearcoat paint finish may  
damage it. Use only non-abrasive waxes and  
polishes that are made for a basecoat/clearcoat  
paint finish on the vehicle.  
Use special care with aluminum trim. To avoid  
damaging protective trim, never use auto or chrome  
polish, steam or caustic soap to clean aluminum.  
A coating of wax, rubbed to high polish, is  
recommended for all bright metal parts.  
Foreign materials such as calcium chloride and other  
salts, ice melting agents, road oil and tar, tree sap, bird  
droppings, chemicals from industrial chimneys, etc., can  
damage the vehicle's finish if they remain on painted  
surfaces. Wash the vehicle as soon as possible.  
If necessary, use non-abrasive cleaners that are  
marked safe for painted surfaces to remove foreign  
matter.  
Windshield and Wiper Blades  
Clean the outside of the windshield with glass cleaner.  
Clean the rubber blades using a lint free cloth or paper  
towel soaked with windshield washer fluid or a mild  
detergent. Wash the windshield thoroughly when  
cleaning the blades. Bugs, road grime, sap, and a  
buildup of vehicle wash/wax treatments may cause  
wiper streaking. Replace the wiper blades if they are  
worn or damaged.  
Exterior painted surfaces are subject to aging, weather  
and chemical fallout that can take their toll over a period  
of years. To help keep the paint finish looking new, keep  
the vehicle garaged or covered whenever possible.  
Wipers can be damaged by:  
.
Extreme dusty conditions  
Protecting Exterior Bright Metal Parts  
.
Sand and salt  
Bright metal parts should be cleaned regularly to keep  
their luster. Washing with water is all that is usually  
needed. However, chrome polish may be used on  
chrome or stainless steel trim, if necessary.  
.
Heat and sun  
.
Snow and ice, without proper removal  
6-99  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The surface of these wheels is similar to the painted  
surface of the vehicle. Do not use strong soaps,  
chemicals, abrasive polishes, abrasive cleaners,  
cleaners with acid, or abrasive cleaning brushes on  
them because they could damage the surface. Do not  
use chrome polish on aluminum wheels.  
Aluminum or Chrome-Plated Wheels  
and Trim  
The vehicle may have either aluminum or  
chrome-plated wheels.  
Keep the wheels clean using a soft clean cloth with mild  
soap and water. Rinse with clean water. After rinsing  
thoroughly, dry with a soft clean towel. A wax may then  
be applied.  
Notice: Using chrome polish on aluminum wheels  
could damage the wheels. The repairs would not be  
covered by the vehicle warranty. Use chrome polish  
on chrome wheels only.  
Notice: Chrome wheels and other chrome trim  
may be damaged if the vehicle is not washed after  
driving on roads that have been sprayed with  
magnesium, calcium or sodium chloride. These  
chlorides are used on roads for conditions such as  
ice and dust. Always wash the vehicle's chrome  
with soap and water after exposure.  
Use chrome polish only on chrome-plated wheels, but  
avoid any painted surface of the wheel, and buff off  
immediately after application.  
Notice: Driving the vehicle through an automatic  
car wash that has silicone carbide tire cleaning  
brushes, could damage the aluminum or  
chrome-plated wheels. The repairs would not be  
covered by the vehicle warranty. Never drive a  
vehicle that has aluminum or chrome-plated wheels  
through an automatic car wash that uses silicone  
carbide tire cleaning brushes.  
Notice: Using strong soaps, chemicals, abrasive  
polishes, cleaners, brushes, or cleaners that contain  
acid on aluminum or chrome-plated wheels, could  
damage the surface of the wheel(s). The repairs  
would not be covered by the vehicle warranty.  
Use only approved cleaners on aluminum or  
chrome-plated wheels.  
6-100  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Tires  
Underbody Maintenance  
To clean the tires, use a stiff brush with tire cleaner.  
Chemicals used for ice and snow removal and dust  
control can collect on the underbody. If these are  
not removed, corrosion and rust can develop on the  
underbody parts such as fuel lines, frame, floor pan,  
and exhaust system even though they have corrosion  
protection.  
Notice: Using petroleum-based tire dressing  
products on the vehicle may damage the paint finish  
and/or tires. When applying a tire dressing, always  
wipe off any overspray from all painted surfaces on  
the vehicle.  
At least every spring, flush these materials from the  
underbody with plain water. Clean any areas where  
mud and debris can collect. Dirt packed in close areas  
of the frame should be loosened before being flushed.  
Your dealer or an underbody car washing system can  
do this.  
Sheet Metal Damage  
If the vehicle is damaged and requires sheet metal  
repair or replacement, make sure the body repair shop  
applies anti-corrosion material to parts repaired or  
replaced to restore corrosion protection.  
Original manufacturer replacement parts will provide  
the corrosion protection while maintaining the vehicle  
warranty.  
Chemical Paint Spotting  
Some weather and atmospheric conditions can create a  
chemical fallout. Airborne pollutants can fall upon and  
attack painted surfaces on the vehicle. This damage  
can take two forms: blotchy, ring-shaped discolorations,  
and small, irregular dark spots etched into the paint  
surface.  
Finish Damage  
Any stone chips, fractures or deep scratches in the  
finish should be repaired right away. Bare metal will  
corrode quickly and may develop into major repair  
expense.  
Although no defect in the paint job causes this, we will  
repair, at no charge to the owner, the surfaces of new  
vehicles damaged by this fallout condition within  
12 months or 12,000 miles (20 000 km) of purchase,  
whichever occurs first.  
Minor chips and scratches can be repaired with  
touch-up materials available from your dealer. Larger  
areas of finish damage can be corrected in your  
dealer's body and paint shop.  
6-101  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Engine Identification  
Vehicle Identification  
The eighth character in the VIN is the engine code. This  
code identifies the vehicle's engine, specifications, and  
replacement parts. See Engine Specificationsunder  
Capacities and Specifications on page 6112 for the  
vehicle's engine code.  
Vehicle Identification Number (VIN)  
Service Parts Identification Label  
This label, on the spare tire cover, has the following  
information:  
.
Vehicle Identification Number (VIN)  
This legal identifier is in the front corner of the  
instrument panel, on the driver side. It can be seen  
through the windshield from outside. The VIN also  
appears on the Vehicle Certification and Service Parts  
labels and certificates of title and registration.  
.
Model designation  
.
Paint information  
.
Production options and special equipment  
Do not remove this label from the vehicle.  
6-102  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Headlamp Wiring  
Electrical System  
The headlamp wiring system has four individual fuses.  
An electrical overload will cause the lamps to go on and  
off, or in some cases to remain off. If this happens,  
have the headlamp wiring checked right away.  
Add-On Electrical Equipment  
Notice: Do not add anything electrical to the vehicle  
unless you check with your dealer first. Some  
electrical equipment can damage the vehicle and  
the damage would not be covered by the vehicle's  
warranty. Some add-on electrical equipment can  
keep other components from working as they  
should.  
Windshield Wiper Fuses  
The windshield wiper motor is protected by an internal  
circuit breaker. If the wiper motor overheats due to  
heavy snow, the wipers will stop until the motor cools  
and will then restart.  
Add-on equipment can drain the vehicle battery, even if  
the vehicle is not operating.  
A fuse powers the wiper motor. If the fuse blows, there  
is an electrical problem. Be sure to have it fixed.  
The vehicle has an airbag system. Before attempting to  
add anything electrical to the vehicle, see Servicing  
Your Airbag-Equipped Vehicle on page 268 and  
Adding Equipment to Your Airbag-Equipped Vehicle on  
page 269  
.
6-103  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
If you ever have a problem on the road and don't  
have a spare fuse, you can borrow one that has the  
same amperage. Just pick some feature of the vehicle  
that you can get along without like the radio or  
cigarette lighter and use its fuse, if it is the  
Power Windows and Other Power  
Options  
Circuit breakers in the fuse block protect the power  
windows and other power accessories. When the  
current load is too heavy, the circuit breaker opens and  
closes, protecting the circuit until the problem is fixed or  
goes away.  
correct amperage. Replace it as soon as you can.  
Underhood Fuse Block  
The underhood fuse block is located on the passenger  
side of the engine compartment. Remove the fuse cover  
and secondary service cover to access the fuse block.  
Fuses and Circuit Breakers  
The wiring circuits in the vehicle are protected from  
short circuits by a combination of fuses and circuit  
breakers. This greatly reduces the chance of fires  
caused by electrical problems.  
Notice: Spilling liquid on any electrical component  
on the vehicle may damage it. Always keep the  
covers on any electrical component.  
Look at the silver-colored band inside the fuse. If the  
band is broken or melted, replace the fuse. Be sure you  
replace a bad fuse with a new one of the identical size  
and rating.  
6-104  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Fuses  
Usage  
Fuses  
Usage  
1
2
3
4
Engine Control Module (ECM), Crank  
Fuel Injectors Odd  
5
6
7
8
Air Injection Reactor (AIR) Solenoid  
Oxygen Sensor  
Fuel Injectors Even  
Air Conditioning Clutch  
Emission Device  
Transmission, Ignition 1  
6-105  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Fuses  
Usage  
Fuses  
Usage  
Engine Control Module (ECM),  
Powertrain Control Module (PCM)  
24  
Starter (J-Case)  
9
Antilock Brake System (ABS) Motor  
(J-Case)  
25  
Climate Control System, Instrument  
Panel Cluster Ignition 1  
10  
26  
27  
Cooling Fan 2 (J-Case)  
Cooling Fan 1 (J-Case)  
11  
12  
13  
14  
15  
16  
17  
18  
19  
20  
21  
22  
Airbag System  
Horn  
Windshield Wiper  
Relays  
29  
Usage  
Fog Lamps  
Powertrain  
Right High-Beam Headlamp  
Left High-Beam Headlamp  
Left Low-Beam Headlamp  
Right Low-Beam Headlamp  
Windshield Washer Pump Motor  
Left Front Cornering Lamp  
Right Front Cornering Lamp  
Air Pump (J-Case)  
30  
Starter  
31  
Cooling Fan 2  
Cooling Fan 3  
Cooling Fan 1  
Air Conditioning Clutch  
Air Injection Reactor (AIR) Solenoid  
Ignition  
32  
33  
34  
35  
36  
37  
Air Pump  
Antilock Brake System (ABS)  
(J-Case)  
23  
6-106  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Rear Underseat Fuse Block  
The rear fuse block is located under the rear seat on  
the driver side. The rear seat cushion must be removed  
to access the rear fuse block.  
Removing the Rear Seat Cushion  
Notice: If you touch the exposed wires with the  
metal on the seat cushion, you could cause a short  
that could damage the battery and or wires. Avoid  
contact between the rear seat and the fuse center  
whenever you remove or reinstall the rear seat. Do  
not remove covers from any of the covered parts,  
and do not store anything under the seats.  
To remove the rear seat cushion, do the following:  
1. Pull up on the front of the cushion to release the  
front hooks.  
To access the fuse block, pull out and lift up on the  
cover latch, located at the end of the fuse block, near  
the battery cable.  
2. Pull the cushion up and out toward the front of the  
vehicle.  
6-107  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
To reinstall the rear seat cushion, do the following:  
WARNING: (Continued)  
will not be there to work for the next passenger.  
The person sitting in that position could be badly  
injured. After reinstalling the seat cushion, always  
check to be sure that the safety belts are properly  
routed and are not twisted.  
1. Buckle the center passenger position safety belt,  
then route the safety belts through the proper slots  
in the seat cushion. Do not let the safety belts get  
twisted.  
2. Slide the rear of the cushion up and under the  
seatback so the rear-locating guides hook into the  
wire loops on the back frame.  
3. With the seat cushion lowered, push rearward and  
then press down on the seat cushion until the  
spring locks on both ends engage.  
WARNING:  
{
4. Check to make sure the safety belts are properly  
routed and that no portion of any safety belt is  
trapped under the seat. Also make sure the seat  
cushion is secured.  
A safety belt that is not properly routed through  
the seat cushion or is twisted will not provide the  
protection needed in a crash. If the safety belt has  
not been routed through the seat cushion at all, it  
(Continued)  
6-108  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Fuses  
Usage  
Fuses  
Usage  
1
2
3
4
Fuel Pump  
Engine Control Module (ECM)/  
Transmission Control Module (TCM)  
5
Left Park Lamp  
Run 3 - Rear Blower  
Right Park Lamp  
6
7
Memory Module  
Right Park Lamp (optional)  
6-109  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Fuses  
8
Usage  
Fuses  
28  
Usage  
Steering Wheel Illumination  
Front Heated/Cooled Seat Module  
Run 2 - Heated/Cooled Seats  
Rear Heated Seat Module  
RPA Module  
PASS-Key® III System  
Unlock/Lock Module  
Magnetic Ride Control  
Not Used  
Retained Accessory Power 1 (RAP)  
Passenger Door Module  
Sensing and Diagnostic Module  
Accessory Power Outlets  
9
29  
10  
11  
30  
31  
12  
13  
14  
15  
16  
17  
18  
19  
20  
21  
22  
23  
24  
Body Control Module (BCM)  
(Inadvertent)  
32  
33  
34  
35  
Retained Accessory Power 2 (RAP)  
Canister Vent Solenoid  
Body Control Module (Courtesy)  
Body Control Module (Right Turn  
Signal)  
Sunroof  
36  
Body Control Module (BCM) Dim  
Body Control Module (BCM)  
Run 1-Heated Steering Wheel  
Ignition Switch  
37  
38  
39  
40  
41  
42  
43  
44  
45  
46  
Trunk Release  
Amplifier, Radio  
Body Control Module (CHMSL)  
Body Control Module  
Stoplamp (optional)  
OnStar® Module  
Driver Door Module  
Rear Lumbar  
Electronic Leveling Control Module  
Body Modules  
Body Control Module (Left Turn  
Signal)  
25  
Radio  
Door Unlatch (optional)  
Rear Defogger (J-Case)  
Cigarette Lighter, Auxiliary Power  
Outlet  
26  
27  
Navigation (Optional)  
6-110  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Fuses  
Usage  
Relays  
62  
Usage  
Electronic Leveling Control  
Compressor (J-Case)  
Unlock  
47  
63  
Lock  
48  
49  
Blower (J-Case) (optional)  
Blower (J-Case) (optional)  
64  
Run  
65  
Not Used  
66  
Door Unlatch (optional)  
Trunk Release  
Stoplamp (optional)  
Overhead Lamps (optional)  
Retained Accessory Power (RAP)  
Resistor  
Usage  
67  
50  
Terminating Resistor  
68  
69  
Relays  
51  
Usage  
70  
Front Blower (optional)  
Rear Defogger  
52  
Circuit  
Breakers  
Usage  
Electronic Leveling Control  
Compressor  
53  
54  
55  
56  
57  
Right Front Seat  
58  
59  
60  
61  
Park Lamps  
Left Front Power Seat  
Power Windows  
Fuel Pump  
License Plate Lamp (optional)  
Right Park Lamp (optional)  
Power Tilt Steering Wheel  
6-111  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Capacities and Specifications  
The following approximate capacities are given in English and metric conversions. See Recommended Fluids and  
Lubricants on page 79 for more information.  
Capacities  
Application  
Air Conditioning Refrigerant  
English  
Metric  
For the air conditioning system refrigerant charge  
amount, see the refrigerant label located under the  
hood. See your dealer for more information.  
Cooling System  
12.6 qt  
7.5 qt  
12.0 L  
7.1 L  
Engine Oil with Filter  
Fuel Tank  
18.5 gal  
7.4 qt  
70.0 L  
7.0 L  
Transmission Fluid (Bottom Pan Removal)  
Wheel Nut Torque  
100 lb ft  
140 Y  
All capacities are approximate. When adding, be sure to fill to the approximate level as recommended in this manual.  
Recheck fluid level after filling.  
Engine Specifications  
Engine  
4.6L DOHC V8 Engine  
4.6L DOHC V8 Engine  
VIN Code  
Transmission  
Automatic  
Spark Plug Gap  
0.050 in (1.27 mm)  
0.050 in (1.27 mm)  
S
6
Automatic  
6-112  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 7 Maintenance Schedule  
Maintenance Schedule . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-2  
Recommended Fluids and Lubricants . . . . . . . . . . . 7-9  
Maintenance Replacement Parts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-10  
Engine Drive Belt Routing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-11  
Maintenance Record . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-12  
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-2  
Scheduled Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-3  
Owner Checks and Services . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-7  
7-1  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The maintenance schedule is for vehicles that:  
Maintenance Schedule  
.
carry passengers and cargo within recommended  
limits on the Tire and Loading Information label.  
See Loading the Vehicle on page 518.  
Introduction  
Notice: Maintenance intervals, checks, inspections,  
recommended fluids, and lubricants are necessary  
to keep this vehicle in good working condition.  
Damage caused by failure to follow scheduled  
maintenance might not be covered by the vehicle  
warranty.  
.
are driven on reasonable road surfaces within legal  
driving limits.  
.
use the recommended fuel. See Gasoline Octane  
on page 65  
.
As the vehicle owner, you are responsible for the  
scheduled maintenance in this section. We recommend  
having your dealer perform these services. Proper  
vehicle maintenance helps to keep the vehicle in good  
working condition, improves fuel economy, and reduces  
vehicle emissions for better air quality.  
WARNING:  
{
Performing maintenance work on a vehicle can be  
dangerous. In trying to do some jobs, you can be  
seriously injured. Do your own maintenance work  
only if you have the required know-how and the  
proper tools and equipment for the job. If you  
have any doubt, see your dealer to have a  
qualified technician do the work. See Doing Your  
Own Service Work on page 64.  
Because of all the different ways people use vehicles,  
maintenance needs vary. The vehicle might need  
more frequent checks and services. Please read the  
information under Scheduled Maintenance. To keep the  
vehicle in good condition, see your dealer.  
7-2  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
At your dealer, you can be certain that you will receive  
the highest level of service available. Your dealer has  
specially trained service technicians, uses genuine  
replacement parts, as well as, uptodate tools and  
equipment to ensure fast and accurate diagnostics.  
Scheduled Maintenance  
When the Change Engine Oil Soon  
Message Displays  
Change engine oil and filter. See Engine Oil on  
page 615. An Emission Control Service.  
The proper replacement parts, fluids, and lubricants to  
use are listed in Recommended Fluids and Lubricants  
on page 79 and Maintenance Replacement Parts on  
page 710. We recommend the use of genuine parts  
from your dealer.  
When the CHANGE ENGINE OIL SOON message  
displays, service is required for the vehicle as soon as  
possible, within the next 1 000 km/600 miles. If driving  
under the best conditions, the engine oil life system  
might not indicate the need for vehicle service for more  
than a year. The engine oil and filter must be changed  
at least once a year and the oil life system must be  
reset. Your dealer has trained service technicians who  
will perform this work and reset the system. If the  
engine oil life system is reset accidentally, service the  
vehicle within 5 000 km/3,000 miles since the last  
service. Reset the oil life system whenever the oil is  
changed. See Engine Oil Life System on page 618.  
Rotation of New Tires  
To maintain ride, handling, and performance of the  
vehicle, it is important that the first rotation service for  
new tires be performed. Tires should be rotated every  
12 000 km/7,500 miles. See Tire Inspection and  
Rotation on page 665.  
When the Change Engine Oil Soon message displays,  
certain services, checks, and inspections are required.  
7-3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
.
Fluids visual leak check (or every 12 months,  
whichever occurs first). A leak in any system must  
be repaired and the fluid level checked.  
Every Engine Oil Change  
.
Change engine oil and filter. Reset oil life system.  
See Engine Oil on page 615 and Engine Oil Life  
System on page 618. An Emission Control  
Service.  
.
.
.
Engine air cleaner filter inspection. See Engine Air  
Cleaner/Filter on page 619.  
Brake system inspection (or every 12 months,  
whichever occurs first).  
.
Engine coolant level check. See Engine Coolant  
on page 626  
.
Steering and suspension inspection. Visual  
inspection for damaged, loose, or missing parts or  
signs of wear.  
.
Engine cooling system inspection. Visual  
inspection of hoses, pipes, fittings, and clamps  
and replacement, if needed.  
.
Body hinges and latches, key lock cylinders,  
console hinges, and glove box door hinges  
lubrication. See Recommended Fluids and  
Lubricants on page 79. More frequent  
lubrication may be required when the vehicle is  
exposed to a corrosive environment. Applying  
silicone grease on weatherstrips with a clean cloth  
makes them last longer, seal better, and not stick  
or squeak.  
.
.
Windshield washer fluid level check. See  
Windshield Washer Fluid on page 632.  
Windshield wiper blade inspection for wear,  
cracking, or contamination and windshield and  
wiper blade cleaning, if contaminated. See  
Windshield and Wiper Blades on page 699  
Worn or damaged wiper blade replacement. See  
.
Windshield Wiper Blade Replacement on  
page 646  
.
.
Restraint system component check. See Checking  
the Restraint Systems on page 270.  
.
.
.
Tire inflation pressures check. See Inflation - Tire  
Pressure on page 657.  
.
.
Fuel system inspection for damage or leaks.  
Tire wear inspection. See Tire Inspection and  
Rotation on page 665.  
Exhaust system and nearby heat shields  
inspection for loose or damaged components.  
Rotate tires if necessary. See Tire Inspection and  
Rotation on page 665.  
7-4  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Once a Year  
Additional Required Services  
Every 12 000 km/7,500 Miles  
.
Starter switch check. See Owner Checks and  
Services on page 77.  
.
Rotate tires. Tires should be rotated every  
.
Automatic transmission shiftlock control function  
12 000 km/7,500 miles. See Tire Inspection and  
Rotation on page 665.  
check. See Owner Checks and Services on  
page 77  
.
.
.
At Each Fuel Stop  
Ignition transmission lock check. See Owner  
Checks and Services on page 77.  
.
Engine oil level check. See Engine Oil on  
page 615  
Engine coolant level check. See Engine Coolant  
on page 626  
.
Parking brake and automatic transmission P (Park)  
mechanism check. See Owner Checks and  
Services on page 77.  
.
.
.
.
.
Accelerator pedal check for damage, high effort,  
or binding. Replace if needed.  
Windshield washer fluid level check. See  
Windshield Washer Fluid on page 632.  
Underbody flushing service.  
Once a Month  
First Engine Oil Change After Every  
40 000 km/25,000 Miles  
.
Tire inflation pressures check. See Inflation - Tire  
Pressure on page 657.  
.
.
.
Passenger compartment air filter replacement (or  
Tire wear inspection. See Tire Inspection and  
Rotation on page 665.  
every 24 months, whichever occurs first). More  
frequent replacement may be needed if you  
drive in areas with heavy traffic, areas with  
poor air quality, or areas with high dust levels.  
Replacement may also be needed if you notice  
reduced air flow, windows fogging up, or odors.  
Your dealer can help you determine when it is the  
right time to replace the filter.  
Sunroof track and seal inspection, if equipped. See  
Sunroof on page 356.  
7-5  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
First Engine Oil Change After Every  
80 000 km/50,000 Miles  
First Engine Oil Change After Every  
160 000 km/100,000 Miles  
.
.
Engine air cleaner filter replacement. See Engine  
Automatic transmission fluid and filter change  
Air Cleaner/Filter on page 619.  
(normal service). See Automatic Transmission  
Fluid on page 621.  
.
Automatic transmission fluid and filter change  
.
(severe service) for vehicles mainly driven in heavy  
city traffic in hot weather, in hilly or mountainous  
terrain, when frequently towing a trailer, or used for  
taxi, police, or delivery service. See Automatic  
Transmission Fluid on page 621.  
Spark plug replacement and spark plug wires  
inspection. An Emission Control Service.  
First Engine Oil Change After Every  
240 000 km/150,000 Miles  
.
.
Evaporative control system inspection. Check all  
Engine cooling system drain, flush, and refill  
fuel and vapor lines and hoses for proper hookup,  
routing, and condition. Check that the purge valve,  
if the vehicle has one, works properly. Replace as  
needed. An Emission Control Service. The U.S.  
Environmental Protection Agency or the California  
Air Resources Board has determined that the  
failure to perform this maintenance item will not  
nullify the emission warranty or limit recall liability  
prior to the completion of the vehicle's useful life.  
We, however, urge that all recommended  
maintenance services be performed at the  
indicated intervals and the maintenance be  
recorded.  
(or every five years, whichever occurs first). See  
Engine Coolant on page 626. An Emission  
Control Service.  
.
Engine drive belts inspection for fraying, excessive  
cracks, or obvious damage (or every 10 years,  
whichever occurs first). Replace, if needed.  
7-6  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Automatic Transmission Shift Lock  
Control Function Check  
Owner Checks and Services  
Starter Switch Check  
WARNING:  
{
WARNING:  
{
When you are doing this inspection, the vehicle  
could move suddenly. If the vehicle moves, you or  
others could be injured.  
When you are doing this inspection, the vehicle  
could move suddenly. If the vehicle moves, you or  
others could be injured.  
1. Before starting this check, be sure there is enough  
room around the vehicle. It should be parked on a  
level surface.  
1. Before starting this check, be sure there is enough  
room around the vehicle.  
2. Firmly apply both the parking brake and the regular  
2. Firmly apply the parking brake. See Parking Brake  
brake. See Parking Brake on page 329.  
on page 329  
.
Do not use the accelerator pedal, and be ready to  
turn off the engine immediately if it starts.  
Be ready to apply the regular brake immediately if  
the vehicle begins to move.  
3. Try to start the engine in each gear. The vehicle  
should start only in P (Park) or N (Neutral). If the  
vehicle starts in any other position, contact your  
dealer for service.  
3. With the engine off, turn the ignition to ON/RUN,  
but do not start the engine. Without applying the  
regular brake, try to move the shift lever out of  
P (Park) with normal effort. If the shift lever moves  
out of P (Park), contact your dealer for service.  
7-7  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Park on a fairly steep hill, with the vehicle facing  
downhill. Keeping your foot on the regular brake, set the  
parking brake.  
Ignition Transmission Lock Check  
While parked, and with the parking brake set, try to turn  
the ignition to LOCK/OFF in each shift lever position.  
.
To check the parking brake's holding ability: With  
.
The ignition should turn to LOCK/OFF only when  
the engine running and the transmission in  
N (Neutral), slowly remove foot pressure from the  
regular brake pedal. Do this until the vehicle is held  
by the parking brake only.  
the shift lever is in P (Park).  
.
The ignition key should come out only in  
LOCK/OFF.  
.
To check the P (Park) mechanism's holding ability:  
Contact your dealer if service is required.  
With the engine running, shift to P (Park). Then  
release the parking brake followed by the regular  
brake.  
Parking Brake and Automatic  
Transmission P (Park) Mechanism  
Check  
Contact your dealer if service is required.  
WARNING:  
{
When you are doing this check, the vehicle could  
begin to move. You or others could be injured and  
property could be damaged. Make sure there is  
room in front of the vehicle in case it begins to  
roll. Be ready to apply the regular brake at once  
should the vehicle begin to move.  
7-8  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Recommended Fluids and  
Lubricants  
Fluids and lubricants identified below by name, part  
number, or specification can be obtained from your  
dealer.  
Usage  
Fluid/Lubricant  
Power  
Steering  
System  
GM Power Steering Fluid  
(GM Part No. U.S. 89021184, in  
Canada 89021186).  
DEXRON®-VI Automatic Transmission  
Automatic  
Transmission Fluid.  
Usage  
Fluid/Lubricant  
Multi-Purpose Lubricant, Superlube  
(GM Part No. U.S. 12346241, in  
Canada 10953474).  
Key Lock  
Cylinders  
The engine requires engine oil  
approved to the dexosspecification.  
Oils meeting this specification can  
be identified with the dexos™  
certification mark. Look for and use only  
an engine oil that displays the dexos™  
certification mark of the proper viscosity  
grade. See Engine Oil on page 615.  
Hood Latch  
Assembly,  
Secondary  
Lubriplate Lubricant Aerosol  
(GM Part No. U.S. 12346293, in  
Engine Oil  
Latch, Pivots, Canada 992723) or lubricant meeting  
Spring Anchor, requirements of NLGI #2, Category LB  
and  
or GC-LB.  
50/50 mixture of clean, drinkable water  
and use only DEX-COOL Coolant. See  
Engine Coolant on page 626.  
Release Pawl  
Engine  
Coolant  
Multi-Purpose Lubricant, Superlube  
(GM Part No. U.S. 12346241, in  
Canada 10953474).  
Hood and  
Door Hinges  
DOT 3 Hydraulic Brake Fluid  
(GM Part No. U.S. 88862806, in  
Canada 88862807).  
Hydraulic  
Brake System  
Weatherstrip Lubricant (GM Part No.  
U.S. 3634770, in Canada 10953518)  
or Dielectric Silicone Grease  
(GM Part No. U.S. 12345579, in  
Canada 992887).  
Weatherstrip  
Conditioning  
Windshield  
Washer  
Optikleen® Washer Solvent.  
Chassis Lubricant (GM Part No.  
Parking Brake U.S. 12377985, in Canada 88901242)  
Cable Guides or lubricant meeting requirements of  
NLGI #2, Category LB or GC-LB.  
7-9  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Maintenance Replacement Parts  
Replacement parts identified here by name, part number, or specification can be obtained from your dealer.  
Part  
Engine Air Cleaner/Filter Element  
Engine Oil Filter  
GM Part Number  
22676970  
ACDelco Part Number  
A1627C  
89017342  
PF61  
Passenger Compartment Air Filter Element  
Spark Plugs  
25906375  
CF118C  
12571535  
41987  
Wiper Blades  
Driver Side 21.7 in (55.0 cm)  
Passenger Side 21.7 in (55.0 cm)  
15931977  
15931976  
7-10  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Engine Drive Belt Routing  
4.6L V8 Engines  
7-11  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Maintenance Record  
After the scheduled services are performed, record the date, odometer reading, who performed the service, and the  
type of services performed in the boxes provided. Retain all maintenance receipts.  
Maintenance Record  
Odometer  
Reading  
Date  
Serviced By  
Maintenance Stamp  
Services Performed  
7-12  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Maintenance Record (cont'd)  
Serviced By Maintenance Stamp  
Odometer  
Reading  
Date  
Services Performed  
7-13  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Maintenance Record (cont'd)  
Serviced By Maintenance Stamp  
Odometer  
Reading  
Date  
Services Performed  
7-14  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 8 Customer Assistance Information  
Customer Assistance and Information . . . . . . . . . . . 8-2  
Customer Satisfaction Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-2  
Reporting Safety Defects . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-14  
Reporting Safety Defects to the United States  
Online Owner Center . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-5  
Customer Assistance for Text Telephone (TTY)  
Government . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-14  
Reporting Safety Defects to the Canadian  
Users . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-6  
Customer Assistance Offices . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-6  
GM Mobility Reimbursement Program . . . . . . . . . . . 8-7  
Roadside Service . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-7  
Scheduling Service Appointments . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-10  
Courtesy Transportation Program . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-10  
Collision Damage Repair . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-12  
Government . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-15  
Reporting Safety Defects to General  
Motors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-15  
Service Publications Ordering Information . . . . . 8-15  
Vehicle Data Recording and Privacy . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-17  
Event Data Recorders . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-17  
OnStar® . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-18  
Navigation System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-18  
Radio Frequency Identification (RFID) . . . . . . . . . 8-18  
Radio Frequency Statement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-18  
8-1  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
STEP TWO: If after contacting a member of dealership  
management, it appears your concern cannot be  
resolved by the dealership without further help, in the  
U.S., call the Cadillac Customer Assistance Center at  
18004588006. In Canada, call the Canadian Cadillac  
Customer Communication Centre at 1-888-446-2000.  
Customer Assistance and  
Information  
Customer Satisfaction Procedure  
Your satisfaction and goodwill are important to your  
dealer and to Cadillac. Normally, any concerns with the  
sales transaction or the operation of the vehicle will be  
resolved by the dealer's sales or service departments.  
Sometimes, however, despite the best intentions of  
all concerned, misunderstandings can occur. If your  
concern has not been resolved to your satisfaction, the  
following steps should be taken:  
We encourage you to call the toll-free number in order  
to give your inquiry prompt attention. Have the following  
information available to give the Customer Assistance  
representative:  
.
Vehicle Identification Number (VIN). This is  
available from the vehicle registration or title, or the  
plate at the top left of the instrument panel and  
visible through the windshield.  
STEP ONE: Discuss your concern with a member of  
dealership management. Normally, concerns can be  
quickly resolved at that level. If the matter has already  
been reviewed with the sales, service or parts manager,  
contact the owner of the dealership or the general  
manager.  
.
Dealership name and location.  
.
Vehicle delivery date and present mileage.  
When contacting Cadillac, remember that your concern  
will likely be resolved at a dealer's facility. That is why  
we suggest following Step One first.  
8-2  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
STEP THREE U.S. Owners: Both General Motors  
and your dealer are committed to making sure you are  
completely satisfied with your new vehicle. However,  
if you continue to remain unsatisfied after following the  
procedure outlined in Steps One and Two, you can file  
with the Better Business Bureau (BBB) Auto Line®  
Program to enforce your rights.  
You may contact the BBB Auto Line Program using the  
toll-free telephone number or write them at the following  
address:  
BBB Auto Line Program  
Council of Better Business Bureaus, Inc.  
4200 Wilson Boulevard  
Suite 800  
The BBB Auto Line Program is an out of court program  
administered by the Council of Better Business Bureaus  
to settle automotive disputes regarding vehicle repairs  
or the interpretation of the New Vehicle Limited  
Warranty. Although you may be required to resort to  
this informal dispute resolution program prior to filing a  
court action, use of the program is free of charge and  
your case will generally be heard within 40 days. If you  
do not agree with the decision given in your case, you  
may reject it and proceed with any other venue for relief  
available to you.  
Arlington, VA 22203-1838  
Telephone: 1-800-955-5100  
www.dr.bbb.org/goauto  
This program is available in all 50 states and the District  
of Columbia. Eligibility is limited by vehicle age, mileage  
and other factors. General Motors reserves the right to  
change eligibility limitations and/or discontinue its  
participation in this program.  
8-3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
STEP THREE Canadian Owners: In the event that  
you do not feel your concerns have been addressed  
after following the procedure outlined in Steps One  
and Two, General Motors of Canada Limited wants  
you to be aware of its participation in a no-charge  
mediation/arbitration program. General Motors of  
Canada Limited has committed to binding arbitration of  
owner disputes involving factory-related vehicle service  
claims. The program provides for the review of the facts  
involved by an impartial third party arbiter, and may  
include an informal hearing before the arbiter. The  
program is designed so that the entire dispute  
settlement process, from the time you file your  
complaint to the final decision, should be completed  
in approximately 70 days. We believe our impartial  
program offers advantages over courts in most  
jurisdictions because it is informal, quick, and free of  
charge.  
For further information concerning eligibility in the  
Canadian Motor Vehicle Arbitration Plan (CAMVAP), call  
toll-free 18002070685, or call the General Motors  
Customer Communication Centre, 18002633777  
(English), 18002637854 (French), or write to:  
Mediation/Arbitration Program  
c/o Customer Communication Centre  
General Motors of Canada Limited  
Mail Code: CA1163005  
1908 Colonel Sam Drive  
Oshawa, Ontario L1H 8P7  
Your inquiry should be accompanied by the Vehicle  
Identification Number (VIN).  
8-4  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
My GM Canada (Canada) www.gm.ca  
Online Owner Center  
My GM Canada is a password-protected section of  
www.gm.ca where you can save information on GM  
vehicles, get personalized offers, and use handy tools  
and forms with greater ease.  
Cadillac Owner Center (U.S.) —  
www.cadillacownercenter.com  
Information and services customized for your specific  
vehicle all in one convenient place.  
Here are a few of the valuable tools and services you  
will have access to:  
.
Digital owner manual, warranty information,  
.
and more  
My Showroom: Find and save information on  
vehicles and current offers in your area.  
.
Store online service and maintenance records  
.
My Dealers: Save details such as address and  
phone number for each of your preferred GM  
dealers.  
.
Cadillac dealer locator for service nationwide  
.
Exclusive privileges and offers  
.
Recall notices for your specific vehicle  
.
My Driveway: Access quick links to parts and  
.
OnStar and GM Cardmember Services Earnings  
summaries  
service estimates, check trade-in values,  
or schedule a service appointment by adding  
the vehicles you own to your driveway profile.  
Other Helpful Links:  
.
My Preferences: Manage your profile and use tools  
and forms with greater ease.  
Cadillac www.cadillac.com  
Cadillac Merchandise www.cadillaccollection.com  
To sign up, visit the My GM.ca section within  
www.gm.ca.  
Help Center www.cadillac.com/pages/mds/  
helpcenter/faq.do  
.
FAQ (Frequently Asked Questions)  
.
Contact Us  
8-5  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
From Puerto Rico:  
Customer Assistance for Text  
Telephone (TTY) Users  
1-800-496-9992 (English)  
1-800-496-9993 (Spanish)  
To assist customers who are deaf, hard of hearing,  
or speech-impaired and who use Text Telephones  
(TTYs), Cadillac has TTY equipment available at its  
Customer Assistance Center. Any TTY user can  
communicate with Cadillac by dialing: 1-800-833-2622.  
TTY users in Canada can dial 1-800-263-3830.  
From U.S. Virgin Islands:  
1-800-496-9994  
Canada  
General Motors of Canada Limited  
Canadian Cadillac Customer Communication  
Centre, Mail Code: CA1-163-005  
1908 Colonel Sam Drive  
Oshawa, Ontario L1H 8P7  
www.gm.ca  
Customer Assistance Offices  
Cadillac encourages customers to call the toll-free  
number for assistance. However, if a customer wishes  
to write or e-mail Cadillac, the letter should be  
addressed to:  
1-888-446-2000  
1-800-263-3830 (For Text Telephone  
devices (TTYs))  
Roadside Assistance: 1-800-882-1112  
United States  
Cadillac Customer Assistance Center  
Cadillac Motor Car Division  
P.O. Box 33169  
Overseas  
Detroit, MI 48232-5169  
Please contact the local General Motors Business Unit.  
www.Cadillac.com  
1-800-458-8006  
1-800-833-2622 (For Text Telephone  
devices (TTYs))  
Roadside Assistance: 1-800-882-1112  
8-6  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
For more information on the limited offer, visit  
www.gmmobility.com or call the GM Mobility Assistance  
Center at 1-800-323-9935. Text telephone (TTY) users,  
call 1-800-833-9935.  
Mexico, Central America and Caribbean  
Islands/Countries (Except Puerto Rico  
and U.S. Virgin Islands)  
General Motors de Mexico, S. de R.L. de C.V.  
Customer Assistance Center  
Av. Ejercito Nacional #843  
Col. Granada  
General Motors of Canada also has a Mobility Program.  
Call 1-800-GM-DRIVE (463-7483) for details. TTY users  
call 1-800-263-3830.  
C.P. 11520, Mexico, D.F.  
Roadside Service  
01-800-466-0805  
Long Distance: 011-52-53 29 0805  
In the United States or Canada, call 1-800-882-1112.  
Text Telephone (TTY), U.S. only, call 1-888-889-2438.  
Service is available 24 hours a day, 365 days a year.  
GM Mobility Reimbursement  
Program  
Calling for Service  
When calling Roadside Service, have the following  
information ready:  
.
Your name, home address, and home telephone  
number  
.
Telephone number of your location  
.
Location of the vehicle  
.
Model, year, color, and license plate number of the  
vehicle  
This program is available to qualified applicants for  
cost reimbursement of eligible aftermarket adaptive  
equipment required for your vehicle, such as hand  
controls or a wheelchair/scooter lift for the vehicle.  
.
Odometer reading, Vehicle Identification  
Number (VIN), and delivery date of the vehicle  
.
Description of the problem  
8-7  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
.
Emergency Tow From a Public Road or  
Highway: Tow to the nearest Cadillac dealer for  
warranty service, or if the vehicle was in a crash  
and cannot be driven. Assistance is also given  
when the vehicle is stuck in the sand, mud,  
or snow.  
Coverage  
Services are provided up to 5 years/160 000 km  
(100,000 miles), whichever comes first.  
In the U.S., anyone driving the vehicle is covered. In  
Canada, a person driving the vehicle without permission  
from the owner is not covered.  
.
Flat Tire Change: Service to change a flat tire  
with spare tire. The spare tire, if equipped, must be  
in good condition and properly inflated. It is your  
responsibility for the repair or replacement of the  
tire if it is not covered by the warranty.  
Roadside Service is not a part of the New Vehicle  
Limited Warranty. Cadillac and General Motors of  
Canada Limited reserve the right to make any changes  
or discontinue the Roadside Service program at any  
time without notification.  
.
.
Battery Jump Start: Service to jump start a dead  
battery.  
Cadillac and General Motors of Canada Limited reserve  
the right to limit services or payment to an owner or  
driver if they decide the claims are made too often,  
or the same type of claim is made many times.  
Trip Routing Service: Detailed maps of North  
America are provided when requested either with  
the most direct route or the most scenic route.  
Additional travel information is also available. Allow  
three weeks for delivery.  
Cadillac Owner Privileges  
.
.
Trip Interruption Benefits and Service: If your  
trip is interrupted due to a warranty failure,  
incidental expenses may be reimbursed during the  
5 years/160 000 km (100,000 miles) Powertrain  
warranty period. Items considered are hotel,  
meals, and rental car.  
Emergency Fuel Delivery: Delivery of enough  
fuel for the vehicle to get to the nearest service  
station.  
.
LockOut Service: Service to unlock the vehicle  
if you are locked out. A remote unlock may be  
available if you have OnStar®. For security  
reasons, the driver must present identification  
before this service is given.  
8-8  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Cadillac Technician Roadside Service  
(U.S. only)  
Cadillac's exceptional Roadside Service is more  
than an auto club or towing service. It provides every  
Cadillac owner in the United States with the advantage  
of contacting a Cadillac advisor and, where available,  
a Cadillac trained dealer technician who can provide  
on-site service.  
Services Specific to  
CanadianPurchased Vehicles  
.
Fuel delivery: Reimbursement is approximately  
$5 Canadian. Diesel fuel delivery may be  
restricted. Propane and other fuels are not  
provided through this service.  
.
Lock-Out Service: Vehicle registration is  
required.  
A dealer technician will travel to your location within a  
30 mile radius of a participating Cadillac dealership.  
If beyond this radius, we will arrange to have your  
car towed to the nearest Cadillac dealership. Each  
technician travels with a specially equipped service  
vehicle complete with the necessary Cadillac parts and  
tools required to handle most roadside repairs.  
.
Trip Routing Service: Limit of six requests  
per year.  
.
Trip Interruption Benefits and Service:  
Pre-authorization, original detailed receipts, and  
a copy of the repair orders are required. Once  
authorization has been received, the Roadside  
Service advisor will help you make arrangements  
and explain how to receive payment.  
Services Not Included in Roadside  
Service  
.
Alternative Service: If assistance cannot be  
provided right away, the Roadside Service advisor  
may give you permission to get local emergency  
road service. You will receive payment, up to $100,  
after sending the original receipt to Roadside  
Service. Mechanical failures may be covered,  
however any cost for parts and labor for repairs  
not covered by the warranty are the owner  
responsibility.  
.
Impound towing caused by violation of any laws.  
.
Legal fines.  
.
Mounting, dismounting, or changing of snow tires,  
chains, or other traction devices.  
.
Towing or services for vehicles driven on a  
non-public road or highway.  
8-9  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Several Courtesy Transportation options are available  
to assist in reducing your inconvenience when warranty  
repairs are required.  
Scheduling Service Appointments  
When your vehicle requires warranty service, contact  
your dealer and request an appointment. By scheduling  
a service appointment and advising your service  
consultant of your transportation needs, your dealer  
can help minimize your inconvenience.  
Courtesy Transportation is not a part of the New Vehicle  
Limited Warranty. A separate booklet entitled Warranty  
and Owner Assistance Informationfurnished with each  
new vehicle provides detailed warranty coverage  
information.  
If your vehicle cannot be scheduled into the service  
department immediately, keep driving it until it can be  
scheduled for service, unless, of course, the problem is  
safety related. If it is, please call your dealership, let  
them know this, and ask for instructions.  
Transportation Options  
Warranty service can generally be completed while  
you wait. However, if you are unable to wait, GM  
helps to minimize your inconvenience by providing  
several transportation options. Depending on the  
circumstances, your dealer can offer you one of the  
following:  
If the dealer requests you to bring the vehicle for  
service, you are urged to do so as early in the work  
day as possible to allow for the same day repair.  
Courtesy Transportation Program  
Shuttle Service  
To enhance your ownership experience, we and our  
participating dealers are proud to offer Courtesy  
Transportation, a customer support program for vehicles  
with the Bumper to Bumper (Base Warranty Coverage  
period in Canada), extended powertrain, and/or  
Shuttle service is the preferred means of offering  
Courtesy Transportation. Dealers may provide shuttle  
service to get you to your destination with minimal  
interruption of your daily schedule. This includes  
oneway or roundtrip shuttle service within reasonable  
time and distance parameters of the dealer's area.  
hybridspecific warranties in both the U.S. and Canada.  
8-10  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
and meet state/provincial, local, and rental vehicle  
provider requirements. Requirements vary and  
may include minimum age requirements, insurance  
coverage, credit card, etc. You are responsible for fuel  
usage charges and may also be responsible for taxes,  
levies, usage fees, excessive mileage, or rental usage  
beyond the completion of the repair.  
Public Transportation or Fuel  
Reimbursement  
If your vehicle requires overnight warranty repairs, and  
public transportation is used instead of the dealer's  
shuttle service, the expense must be supported by  
original receipts and can only be up to the maximum  
amount allowed by GM for shuttle service. In addition,  
for U.S. customers, should you arrange transportation  
through a friend or relative, limited reimbursement for  
reasonable fuel expenses may be available. Claim  
amounts should reflect actual costs and be supported  
by original receipts. See your dealer for information  
regarding the allowance amounts for reimbursement of  
fuel or other transportation costs.  
It may not be possible to provide a like vehicle as a  
courtesy rental.  
Additional Program Information  
All program options, such as shuttle service, may not  
be available at every dealer. Please contact your dealer  
for specific information about availability. All Courtesy  
Transportation arrangements will be administered by  
appropriate dealer personnel.  
Courtesy Rental Vehicle  
Your dealer may arrange to provide you with a courtesy  
rental vehicle or reimburse you for a rental vehicle  
that you obtain if your vehicle is kept for an overnight  
warranty repair. Rental reimbursement will be limited  
and must be supported by original receipts. This  
requires that you sign and complete a rental agreement  
General Motors reserves the right to unilaterally modify,  
change, or discontinue Courtesy Transportation at any  
time and to resolve all questions of claim eligibility  
pursuant to the terms and conditions described herein  
at its sole discretion.  
8-11  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
originally designed appearance and safety performance;  
however, the history of these parts is not known. Such  
parts are not covered by your GM New Vehicle Limited  
Warranty, and any related failures are not covered by  
that warranty.  
Collision Damage Repair  
If your vehicle is involved in a collision and it is  
damaged, have the damage repaired by a qualified  
technician using the proper equipment and quality  
replacement parts. Poorly performed collision repairs  
diminish your vehicle's resale value, and safety  
performance can be compromised in subsequent  
collisions.  
Aftermarket collision parts are also available. These are  
made by companies other than GM and may not have  
been tested for your vehicle. As a result, these parts  
may fit poorly, exhibit premature durability/corrosion  
problems, and may not perform properly in subsequent  
collisions. Aftermarket parts are not covered by your  
GM New Vehicle Limited Warranty, and any vehicle  
failure related to such parts is not covered by that  
warranty.  
Collision Parts  
Genuine GM Collision parts are new parts made with  
the same materials and construction methods as the  
parts with which your vehicle was originally built.  
Genuine GM Collision parts are your best choice to  
ensure that your vehicle's designed appearance,  
durability, and safety are preserved. The use of  
Genuine GM parts can help maintain your GM New  
Vehicle Limited Warranty.  
Repair Facility  
GM also recommends that you choose a collision repair  
facility that meets your needs before you ever need  
collision repairs. Your dealer may have a collision repair  
center with GM-trained technicians and stateoftheart  
equipment, or be able to recommend a collision repair  
center that has GM-trained technicians and comparable  
equipment.  
Recycled original equipment parts may also be used for  
repair. These parts are typically removed from vehicles  
that were total losses in prior crashes. In most cases,  
the parts being recycled are from undamaged sections  
of the vehicle. A recycled original equipment GM part  
may be an acceptable choice to maintain your vehicle's  
8-12  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Give only the necessary information to police and other  
parties involved in the crash.  
Insuring Your Vehicle  
Protect your investment in your GM vehicle with  
comprehensive and collision insurance coverage. There  
are significant differences in the quality of coverage  
afforded by various insurance policy terms. Many  
insurance policies provide reduced protection to your  
GM vehicle by limiting compensation for damage  
repairs by using aftermarket collision parts. Some  
insurance companies will not specify aftermarket  
collision parts. When purchasing insurance, we  
recommend that you ensure that your vehicle will be  
repaired with GM original equipment collision parts.  
If such insurance coverage is not available from your  
current insurance carrier, consider switching to another  
insurance carrier.  
For emergency towing see Roadside Service on  
page 87  
.
Gather the following information:  
.
Driver's name, address, and telephone number  
.
Driver's license number  
.
.
.
.
.
.
Owner's name, address, and telephone number  
Vehicle license plate number  
Vehicle make, model, and model year  
Vehicle Identification Number (VIN)  
Insurance company and policy number  
General description of the damage to the other  
vehicle  
If your vehicle is leased, the leasing company may  
require you to have insurance that ensures repairs with  
Genuine GM Original Equipment Manufacturer (OEM)  
parts or Genuine Manufacturer replacement parts. Read  
your lease carefully, as you may be charged at the end  
of your lease for poor quality repairs.  
Choose a reputable repair facility that uses quality  
replacement parts. See Collision Partsearlier in this  
section.  
If the airbag has inflated, see What Will You See After  
an Airbag Inflates? on page 262.  
If a Crash Occurs  
If there has been an injury, call emergency services for  
help. Do not leave the scene of a crash until all matters  
have been taken care of. Move the vehicle only if its  
position puts you in danger, or you are instructed to  
move it by a police officer.  
8-13  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Managing the Vehicle Damage Repair  
Process  
Reporting Safety Defects  
Reporting Safety Defects to the  
United States Government  
If you believe that your vehicle has a defect  
which could cause a crash or could cause injury  
or death, you should immediately inform the  
National Highway Traffic Safety Administration  
(NHTSA) in addition to notifying General Motors.  
In the event that your vehicle requires damage repairs,  
GM recommends that you take an active role in its  
repair. If you have a pre-determined repair facility of  
choice, take your vehicle there, or have it towed there.  
Specify to the facility that any required replacement  
collision parts be original equipment parts, either  
new Genuine GM parts or recycled original GM parts.  
Remember, recycled parts will not be covered by your  
GM vehicle warranty.  
If NHTSA receives similar complaints, it may open  
an investigation, and if it finds that a safety defect  
exists in a group of vehicles, it may order a recall  
and remedy campaign. However, NHTSA cannot  
become involved in individual problems between  
you, your dealer, or General Motors.  
Insurance pays the bill for the repair, but you must  
live with the repair. Depending on your policy limits,  
your insurance company may initially value the repair  
using aftermarket parts. Discuss this with your repair  
professional, and insist on Genuine GM parts.  
Remember, if your vehicle is leased, you may be  
obligated to have the vehicle repaired with Genuine  
GM parts, even if your insurance coverage does not  
pay the full cost.  
To contact NHTSA, you may call the  
Vehicle Safety Hotline toll-free at  
1-888-327-4236 (TTY: 1-800-424-9153);  
go to http://www.safercar.gov; or write to:  
If another party's insurance company is paying for  
the repairs, you are not obligated to accept a repair  
valuation based on that insurance company's collision  
policy repair limits, as you have no contractual limits  
with that company. In such cases, you can have control  
of the repair and parts choices as long as the cost stays  
within reasonable limits.  
Administrator, NHTSA  
1200 New Jersey Avenue, S.E.  
Washington, D.C. 20590  
You can also obtain other information about motor  
vehicle safety from http://www.safercar.gov.  
8-14  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
In Canada, call 18884462000, or write:  
Reporting Safety Defects to the  
Canadian Government  
If you live in Canada, and you believe that your  
vehicle has a safety defect, notify Transport Canada  
immediately, and notify General Motors of Canada  
Limited. Call them at 1-800-333-0510 or write to:  
Canadian Cadillac Customer Communication  
Centre, Mail Code: CA1-163-005  
General Motors of Canada Limited  
1908 Colonel Sam Drive  
Oshawa, Ontario L1H 8P7  
Service Publications Ordering  
Information  
Transport Canada  
Road Safety Branch  
2780 Sheffield Road  
Ottawa, Ontario K1B 3V9  
Service Manuals  
Service Manuals have the diagnosis and repair  
information on the engines, transmission, axle,  
suspension, brakes, electrical, steering, body, etc.  
Reporting Safety Defects to General  
Motors  
In addition to notifying NHTSA (or Transport Canada) in  
a situation like this, notify General Motors.  
Service Bulletins  
Service Bulletins give additional technical service  
information needed to knowledgeably service  
General Motors cars and trucks. Each bulletin  
contains instructions to assist in the diagnosis  
and service of your vehicle.  
Call 1-800-458-8006, or write:  
Cadillac Customer Assistance Center  
Cadillac Motor Car Division  
P.O. Box 33169  
Detroit, MI 48232-5169  
8-15  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Owner Information  
Current and Past Models  
Owner publications are written specifically for owners  
and intended to provide basic operational information  
about the vehicle. The Owner Manual includes the  
Maintenance Schedule for all models.  
Technical Service Bulletins and Manuals are available  
for current and past model GM vehicles.  
ORDER TOLL FREE: 1-800-551-4123  
Monday - Friday 8:00 AM - 6:00 PM  
Eastern Time  
In-Portfolio: Includes a Portfolio, Owner Manual, and  
Warranty Booklet.  
For Credit Card Orders Only  
(VISA-MasterCard-Discover), visit Helm, Inc.,  
at: www.helminc.com  
RETAIL SELL PRICE: $35.00 (U.S.) plus handling and  
shipping fees  
Without Portfolio: Owner Manual only.  
Or you can write to:  
RETAIL SELL PRICE: $25.00 (U.S.) plus handling and  
shipping fees  
Helm, Incorporated  
P.O. Box 07130  
Detroit, MI 48207  
Prices are subject to change without notice and without  
incurring obligation. Allow ample time for delivery.  
Note to Canadian Customers: All listed prices are  
quoted in U.S. funds. Canadian residents are to make  
checks payable in U.S. funds.  
8-16  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
to vehicle dynamics and safety systems for a short  
period of time, typically 30 seconds or less. The EDR in  
this vehicle is designed to record such data as:  
Vehicle Data Recording and  
Privacy  
.
How various systems in your vehicle were  
Your GM vehicle has a number of sophisticated  
operating  
computers that record information about the vehicles  
performance and how it is driven. For example, your  
vehicle uses computer modules to monitor and control  
engine and transmission performance, to monitor the  
conditions for airbag deployment and deploy airbags in  
a crash, and, if so equipped, to provide antilock braking  
to help the driver control the vehicle. These modules  
may store data to help your dealer technician service  
your vehicle. Some modules may also store data about  
how you operate the vehicle, such as rate of fuel  
consumption or average speed. These modules may  
also retain the owners personal preferences, such as  
radio pre-sets, seat positions, and temperature settings.  
.
Whether or not the driver and passenger safety  
belts were buckled/fastened  
.
How far, if at all, the driver was pressing the  
accelerator and/or brake pedal  
.
How fast the vehicle was traveling  
This data can help provide a better understanding of the  
circumstances in which crashes and injuries occur.  
Important: EDR data is recorded by your vehicle only if  
a non-trivial crash situation occurs; no data is recorded  
by the EDR under normal driving conditions and no  
personal data (e.g., name, gender, age, and crash  
location) is recorded. However, other parties, such as  
law enforcement, could combine the EDR data with the  
type of personally identifying data routinely acquired  
during a crash investigation.  
Event Data Recorders  
This vehicle has an Event Data Recorder (EDR).  
The main purpose of an EDR is to record, in certain  
crash or near crash-like situations, such as an airbag  
deployment or hitting a road obstacle, data that will  
assist in understanding how a vehicle's systems  
performed. The EDR is designed to record data related  
To read data recorded by an EDR, special equipment  
is required, and access to the vehicle or the EDR is  
needed. In addition to the vehicle manufacturer, other  
parties, such as law enforcement, that have the special  
equipment, can read the information if they have access  
to the vehicle or the EDR.  
8-17  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
GM will not access this data or share it with others  
except: with the consent of the vehicle owner or, if the  
vehicle is leased, with the consent of the lessee; in  
response to an official request of police or similar  
government office; as part of GM's defense of litigation  
through the discovery process; or, as required by law.  
Data that GM collects or receives may also be used for  
GM research needs or may be made available to others  
for research purposes, where a need is shown and the  
data is not tied to a specific vehicle or vehicle owner.  
Radio Frequency  
Identification (RFID)  
RFID technology is used in some vehicles for functions  
such as tire pressure monitoring and ignition system  
security, as well as in connection with conveniences  
such as key fobs for remote door locking/unlocking and  
starting, and in-vehicle transmitters for garage door  
openers. RFID technology in GM vehicles does not use  
or record personal information or link with any other GM  
system containing personal information.  
OnStar®  
Radio Frequency Statement  
If your vehicle is equipped with an active OnStar  
system, that system may also record data in crash or  
near crashlike situations. The OnStar Terms and  
Conditions provides information on data collection and  
use and is available in the OnStar glove box kit, at  
www.onstar.com (U.S.) or www.onstar.ca (Canada),  
This vehicle has systems that operate on a radio  
frequency that comply with Part 15 of the Federal  
Communications Commission (FCC) rules and with  
Industry Canada Standards RSS210/220/310.  
Operation is subject to the following two conditions:  
1. The device may not cause interference.  
or by pressing the Q button and speaking to an  
advisor.  
2. The device must accept any interference received,  
including interference that may cause undesired  
operation of the device.  
Navigation System  
If the vehicle has a navigation system, use of the  
system may result in the storage of destinations,  
addresses, telephone numbers, and other trip  
information. Refer to the navigation system operating  
manual for information on stored data and for deletion  
instructions.  
Changes or modifications to any of these systems by  
other than an authorized service facility could void  
authorization to use this equipment.  
8-18  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Antenna  
A
Backglass . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-116  
Antenna, XMSatellite Radio Antenna  
System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-116  
Antilock Brake System (ABS) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-4  
Warning Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-51  
Appearance Care  
Accessories and Modifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-3  
Accessory Power . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-24  
Accessory Power Outlets . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-33  
Adaptive Cruise Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-14  
Add-On Electrical Equipment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-103  
Additives, Fuel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-6  
Air Cleaner/Filter, Engine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-19  
Air Filter, Passenger Compartment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-42  
Airbag  
Aluminum or Chrome-Plated Wheels . . . . . . . . . . . .6-100  
Care of Safety Belts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-97  
Chemical Paint Spotting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-101  
Cleaning Exterior Lamps/Lenses . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-98  
Fabric/Carpet . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-95  
Finish Care . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-98  
Finish Damage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-101  
Instrument Panel, Vinyl, and Other Plastic  
Surfaces . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-97  
Interior Cleaning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-94  
Leather . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-96  
Sheet Metal Damage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-101  
Speaker Covers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-97  
Tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-101  
Underbody Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-101  
Washing Your Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-98  
Weatherstrips . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-97  
Windshield and Wiper Blades . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-99  
Wood Panels . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-97  
Adding Equipment to Your Airbag-Equipped  
Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-69  
Airbag System  
How Does an Airbag Restrain? . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-61  
Passenger Sensing System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-64  
Servicing Your Airbag-Equipped Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . 2-68  
What Makes an Airbag Inflate? . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-61  
What Will You See After an Airbag Inflates? . . . . . . 2-62  
When Should an Airbag Inflate? . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-59  
Where Are the Airbags? . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-57  
Airbags  
Passenger Status Indicator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-48  
Readiness Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-48  
System Check . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-54  
Analog Clock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-34  
i - 1  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Audio System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-86  
Audio Steering Wheel Controls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-114  
Navigation/Radio System, see Navigation  
Manual . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-106  
Radio Reception . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-115  
Setting the Clock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-87  
Theft-Deterrent Feature . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-114  
XMSatellite Radio Antenna System . . . . . . . . . . .4-116  
Audio System(s) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-90  
Automatic Transmission  
Brakes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-33  
Antilock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-4  
Parking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-29  
System Warning Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-50  
Braking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-3  
Braking in Emergencies . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-5  
Break-In, New Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-22  
Bulb Replacement  
Fog Lamps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-29  
Headlamp Aiming . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-43  
Headlamps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-46  
High Intensity Discharge (HID) Lighting . . . . . . . . . . . 6-46  
Buying New Tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-68  
Fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-21  
Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-26  
B
C
Backglass Antenna . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-116  
Battery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-36  
Electric Power Management . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-32  
Exterior Lighting Battery Saver . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-30  
Inadvertent Power Saver . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-32  
Load Management . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-31  
Run-Down Protection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-33  
Belt Routing, Engine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-11  
Bluetooth® . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-107  
Brake  
Calibration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-10, 3-35  
California  
Perchlorate Materials Requirements . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-4  
Warning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-4  
California Fuel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-6  
Canadian Owners . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . iii  
Capacities and Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-112  
Carbon Monoxide  
Engine Exhaust . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-33  
Trunk . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-12  
Winter Driving . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-15  
Emergencies . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-5  
i - 2  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Care of  
Cleaning  
Safety Belts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-97  
CD, MP3 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-100  
Center Console Storage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-54  
Center Flex Storage Unit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-54  
Center Seat . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-9  
Central Door Unlock System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-10  
Chains, Tire . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-73  
Charging System Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-49  
Check  
Engine Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-54  
Checking Things Under the Hood . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-12  
Chemical Paint Spotting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-101  
Child Restraints  
Infants and Young Children . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-34  
Lower Anchors and Tethers for Children . . . . . . . . . . 2-41  
Older Children . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-31  
Securing a Child Restraint in a Rear Seat  
Position . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-47  
Securing a Child Restraint in the Center Front  
Seat Position . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-50  
Securing a Child Restraint in the Right Front  
Seat Position . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-50  
Systems . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-37  
Where to Put the Restraint . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-39  
Circuit Breakers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-104  
Aluminum or Chrome-Plated Wheels . . . . . . . . . . . .6-100  
Exterior Lamps/Lenses . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-98  
Fabric/Carpet . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-95  
Finish Care . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-98  
Instrument Panel, Vinyl, and Other Plastic  
Surfaces . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-97  
Interior . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-94  
Leather . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-96  
Speaker Covers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-97  
Tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-101  
Underbody Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-101  
Washing Your Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-98  
Weatherstrips . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-97  
Windshield and Wiper Blades . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-99  
Wood Panels . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-97  
Climate Control System  
Outlet Adjustment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-40  
Climate Control Systems  
Dual . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-34  
Rear . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-40  
Climate Controls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-14  
Clock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-34  
Clock, Setting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-87  
Collision Damage Repair . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-12  
Compass . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-10, 3-35  
i - 3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Compressor Kit, Tire Sealant . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-75  
Content Theft-Deterrent . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-19  
Control of a Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-3  
Convenience Net . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-56  
Coolant  
Engine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-26  
Engine Temperature Gauge . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-53  
Engine Temperature Warning Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-53  
Cooling System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-24  
Cornering Lamps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-29  
Courtesy Lamps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-30  
Courtesy Transportation Program . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-10  
Cruise Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-12  
Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-58  
Cruise Control, Active . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-14  
Cruise Control, Forward Collision Alert (FCA)  
D
Damage Repair, Collision . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-12  
Data Recorders, Event . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-17  
Daytime Running Lamps (DRL) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-28  
Defensive Driving . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-2  
Disc, MP3 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-100  
Doing Your Own Service Work . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-4  
Door  
Central Door Unlocking System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-10  
Locks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-9  
Power Locks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-10  
Programmable Automatic Door Locks . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-10  
Rear Door Security Locks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-10  
Driver Information Center (DIC) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-59  
DIC Operation and Displays . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-60  
DIC Vehicle Customization . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-77  
DIC Warnings and Messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-65  
Driving  
At Night . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-12  
Before a Long Trip . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-13  
Defensive . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-2  
Drunk . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-2  
Highway Hypnosis . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-14  
System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-6  
Cupholders . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-54  
Customer Assistance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-6  
Text Telephone (TTY) Users . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-6  
Customer Assistance Offices . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-6  
Customer Information  
Service Publications Ordering Information . . . . . . . . 8-15  
Customer Satisfaction Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-2  
i - 4  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Driving (cont.)  
Engine  
Hill and Mountain Roads . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-14  
In Rain and on Wet Roads . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-12  
Loss of Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-10  
Off-Road Recovery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-10  
Rocking Your Vehicle to Get it Out . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-17  
Winter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-15  
Driving for Better Fuel Economy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-22  
Dual Climate Control System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-34  
Air Cleaner/Filter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-19  
Check and Service Engine Soon Light . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-54  
Compartment Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-14  
Coolant . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-26  
Coolant Heater . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-25  
Coolant Temperature Gauge . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-53  
Coolant Temperature Warning Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-53  
Cooling System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-24  
Drive Belt Routing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-11  
Exhaust . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-33  
Oil . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-15  
Overheated Protection Operating Mode . . . . . . . . . . 6-31  
Overheating . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-29  
Starting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-24  
Engine Oil  
E
EDR . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-17  
Electrical Equipment, Add-On . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-103  
Electrical System  
Fuses and Circuit Breakers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-104  
Headlamp Wiring . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-103  
Power Windows and Other Power Options . . . . . .6-104  
Rear Underseat Fuse Block . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-107  
Underhood Fuse Block . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-104  
Windshield Wiper Fuses . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-103  
Electronic Immobilizer  
Life System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-18  
Entry Lighting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-30  
Event Data Recorders . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-17  
Extender, Safety Belt . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-31  
Exterior Lamps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-25  
Exterior Lighting Battery Saver . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-30  
PASS-Key® III+ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-20  
Electronic Immobilizer Operation  
PASS-Key® III+ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-20  
i - 5  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Fuel (cont.)  
F
Gasoline Octane . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-5  
Gasoline Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-6  
Gauge . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-59  
Fuel Economy  
Driving for Better . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-22  
Fuses  
Fuses and Circuit Breakers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-104  
Rear Underseat Fuse Block . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-107  
Underhood Fuse Block . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-104  
Windshield Wiper . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-103  
Filter  
Engine Air Cleaner . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-19  
Finish Damage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-101  
Flash-to-Pass . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-10  
Flashers, Hazard Warning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-3  
Flat Tire . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-73  
Flat Tire, Changing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-83  
Flat Tire, Storing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-91  
Floor Mats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-54  
Fluid  
Automatic Transmission . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-21  
Power Steering . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-32  
Windshield Washer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-32  
Fog Lamps  
Bulb Replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-29  
Footwell Lamps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-31  
Forward Collision Alert (FCA) System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-6  
Front Fog Lamps  
Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-58  
Front Storage Area . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-54  
Fuel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-5  
Additives . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-6  
California Fuel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-6  
Filling a Portable Fuel Container . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-11  
Filling the Tank . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-8  
Fuels in Foreign Countries . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-7  
G
Garage Door Opener . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-47  
Gasoline  
Octane . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-5  
Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-6  
Gauges  
Engine Coolant Temperature . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-53  
Fuel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-59  
Speedometer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-46  
Tachometer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-46  
Glove Box . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-54  
GM Mobility Reimbursement Program . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-7  
i - 6  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Hood  
Checking Things Under . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-12  
Release . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-13  
Horn . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-3  
How to Wear Safety Belts Properly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-15  
H
Hazard Warning Flashers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-3  
Head Restraints . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-2  
Headlamp Wiring . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-103  
Headlamps  
Aiming . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-43  
Bulb Replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-46  
Daytime Running Lamps (DRL) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-28  
Exterior Lamps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-25  
Flash-to-Pass . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-10  
High Intensity Discharge (HID) Lighting . . . . . . . . . . . 6-46  
High/Low Beam Changer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-6  
On Reminder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-28  
Wiper Activated . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-28  
Heated  
Steering Wheel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-4  
Heated Seats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-5  
Heater  
Engine Coolant . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-25  
High-Speed Operation, Tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-59  
Highbeam On Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-58  
Highway Hypnosis . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-14  
Hill and Mountain Roads . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-14  
I
Ignition Positions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-22  
Inadvertent Power Battery Saver . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-32  
Infants and Young Children, Restraints . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-34  
Inflation - Tire Pressure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-57  
Instrument Panel  
Brightness . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-30  
Instrument Panel Cluster . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-45  
Integrated Trailer Brake Control System (ITBC) . . . . 5-26  
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .7-2  
J
Jump Starting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-38  
i - 7  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Lights  
K
Airbag Readiness . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-48  
Antilock Brake System (ABS) Warning . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-51  
Brake System Warning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-50  
Charging System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-49  
Cruise Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-58  
Engine Coolant Temperature Warning . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-53  
Exterior Lamps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-25  
Flash-to-Pass . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-10  
Front Fog Lamps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-58  
High/Low Beam Changer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-6  
Highbeam On . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-58  
Lane Departure Warning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-52  
Lights On Reminder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-58  
Oil Pressure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-57  
On Reminder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-28  
Passenger Airbag Status Indicator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-48  
Safety Belt Reminders . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-47  
Security . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-57  
StabiliTrak® Indicator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-52  
Tire Pressure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-54  
Traction Control System (TCS) Warning . . . . . . . . . . 4-51  
Loading Your Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-18  
Lockout Switch, Valet . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-18  
Keyless Entry  
Remote (RKE) System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-4  
Keyless Entry System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-4  
Keys . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-3  
L
Labeling, Tire Sidewall . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-49  
Lamps  
Cornering . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-29  
Courtesy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-30  
Daytime Running (DRL) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-28  
Exterior Lighting Battery Saver . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-30  
Footwell . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-31  
Malfunction Indicator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-54  
Reading . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-31  
Lane Departure Warning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-45  
Lane Departure Warning Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-52  
Lap Belt . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-29  
Lap-Shoulder Belt . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-24  
LATCH System for Child Restraints . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-41  
Lighting  
Entry . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-30  
Parade Dimming . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-31  
i - 8  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Locks  
Malfunction Indicator Lamp . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-54  
Massaging Lumbar Controls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-4  
Memory Seat, Mirrors, Steering Wheel Controls . . . . .2-6  
Message  
DIC Warnings and Messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-65  
Mirrors  
Central Door Unlocking System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-10  
Door . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-9  
Lockout Protection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-11  
Power Door . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-10  
Programmable Automatic Door Locks . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-10  
Rear Door Security Locks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-10  
Loss of Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-10  
Lower Anchors and Tethers for Children . . . . . . . . . . . 2-41  
Lumbar  
Automatic Dimming Rearview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-35  
Manual Rearview Mirror with Compass and  
Temperature . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-10  
Outside Automatic Dimming Mirror . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-37  
Outside Convex Mirror . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-38  
Outside Heated Mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-38  
Outside Power Foldaway Mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-36  
Park Tilt . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-37  
MP3 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-100  
Massaging Controls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-4  
Power Controls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-4  
M
Magnetic Ride Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-8  
Maintenance Schedule  
N
Maintenance Record . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-12  
Maintenance Replacement Parts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-10  
Owner Checks and Services . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-7  
Recommended Fluids and Lubricants . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-9  
Scheduled Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-3  
Navigation System, Privacy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-18  
Navigation/Radio System, see Navigation  
Manual . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-106  
Net, Convenience . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-56  
New Vehicle Break-In . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-22  
i - 9  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
O
P
Object Detection, Side Blind Zone Alert (SBZA) . . . 3-42  
Odometer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-46  
Off-Road  
Paint, Damage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-101  
Parade Dimming . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-31  
Park  
Recovery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-10  
Oil  
Shifting Into . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-30  
Shifting Out of . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-32  
Park Aid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-38  
Park Tilt Mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-37  
Parking  
Assist . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-38  
Brake . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-29  
Over Things That Burn . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-33  
PASS-Key® III+ Electronic Immobilizer . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-20  
PASS-Key® III+ Electronic Immobilizer  
Engine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-15  
Engine Oil Life System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-18  
Pressure Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-57  
Older Children, Restraints . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-31  
Online Owner Center . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-5  
OnStar, Privacy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-18  
OnStar® System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-23  
Operation, Universal Home Remote System . . . . . . . 3-47  
Outlet Adjustment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-40  
Outlets  
Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-20  
Passenger Airbag Status Indicator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-48  
Passenger Compartment Air Filter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-42  
Passenger Sensing System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-64  
Passing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-10  
Perchlorate Materials Requirements, California . . . . . .6-4  
Performance Shifting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-29  
Phone  
Accessory Power . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-33  
Outside  
Automatic Dimming Mirror . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-37  
Convex Mirror . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-38  
Heated Mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-38  
Power Foldaway Mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-36  
Overheated Engine Protection Operating Mode . . . . 6-31  
Owner Checks and Services . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .7-7  
Owners, Canadian . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . iii  
Bluetooth® . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-107  
i - 10  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Power  
R
Door Locks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-10  
Electrical System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-104  
Lumbar Controls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-4  
Reclining Seatbacks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-8  
Retained Accessory (RAP) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-24  
Seat . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-3  
Steering Fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-32  
Tilt Wheel and Telescopic Steering Column . . . . . . . . 4-4  
Windows . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-15  
Pregnancy, Using Safety Belts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-29  
Privacy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-17  
Navigation System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-18  
OnStar . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-18  
Radio Frequency Identification (RFID) . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-18  
Program  
Radio Frequency  
Identification (RFID) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-18  
Statement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-18  
Radio(s) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-90  
Radios  
Navigation/Radio System, see Navigation  
Manual . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-106  
Reception . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-115  
Setting the Clock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-87  
Theft-Deterrent . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-114  
Reading Lamps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-31  
Rear Climate Control System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-40  
Rear Door Security Locks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-10  
Rear Heated Seats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-10  
Rear Seat Armrest . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-56  
Rearview Mirror with Compass and  
Courtesy Transportation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-10  
Programmable Automatic Door Locks . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-10  
Proposition 65 Warning, California . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-4  
Temperature . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-10  
Rearview Mirrors  
Automatic Dimming . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-35  
i - 11  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Reclining Seatbacks, Power . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-8  
Recommended Fluids and Lubricants . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .7-9  
Recreational Vehicle Towing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-24  
Reimbursement Program, GM Mobility . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-7  
Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-4  
Remote Vehicle Start . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-7  
Removing the Flat Tire and Installing the  
Spare Tire . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-86  
Removing the Spare Tire and Tools . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-84  
Replacement Parts  
Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-10  
Reporting Safety Defects  
Canadian Government . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-15  
General Motors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-15  
U.S. Government . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-14  
Restraint System Check  
S
Safety Belts  
Care of . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-97  
Extender . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-31  
How to Wear Safety Belts Properly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-15  
Lap Belt . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-29  
Lap-Shoulder Belt . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-24  
Reminders . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-47  
Safety Belts Are for Everyone . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-11  
Use During Pregnancy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-29  
Safety Defects Reporting  
Canadian Government . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-15  
General Motors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-15  
U.S. Government . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-14  
Safety Warnings and Symbols . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . iv  
Scheduled Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .7-3  
Scheduling Appointments . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-10  
Sealant Kit, Tire . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-75  
Seats  
Checking the Restraint Systems . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-70  
Replacing Restraint System Parts After a  
Crash . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-71  
Retained Accessory Power (RAP) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-24  
Roadside Service . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-7  
Rocking Your Vehicle to Get it Out . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-17  
Roof  
Center Seat . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-9  
Head Restraints . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-2  
Heated and Ventilated Seats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-5  
Heated Seats - Rear . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-10  
Massaging Lumbar . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-4  
Memory, Mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-6  
Sunroof . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-56  
Running the Vehicle While Parked . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-34  
i - 12  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seats (cont.)  
Spare Tire . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-93  
Installing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-86  
Removing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-84  
Storing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-91  
Specifications and Capacities . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-112  
Speedometer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-46  
StabiliTrak®  
Power Lumbar . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-4  
Power Reclining Seatbacks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-8  
Power Seats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-3  
Securing a Child Restraint  
Center Front Seat Position . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-50  
Rear Seat Position . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-47  
Right Front Seat Position . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-50  
Security  
Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-57  
Service . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-3  
Accessories and Modifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-3  
Adding Equipment to the Outside of the Vehicle . . . 6-5  
Doing Your Own Work . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-4  
Engine Soon Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-54  
Parts Identification Label . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-102  
Publications Ordering Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-15  
Scheduling Appointments . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-10  
Servicing Your Airbag-Equipped Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . 2-68  
Setting the Clock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-87  
Sheet Metal Damage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-101  
Shifting  
Indicator Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-52  
StabiliTrak® System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-6  
Start Vehicle, Remote . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-7  
Starting the Engine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-24  
Steering . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-8  
Heated Wheel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-4  
Steering Wheel Controls, Audio . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-114  
Steering Wheel Controls, Memory . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-6  
Steering Wheel, Power Tilt Wheel and Telescopic  
Steering Column . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-4  
Steering Wheel, Tilt Wheel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-3  
Storage Areas  
Center Console . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-54  
Center Flex Storage Unit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-54  
Convenience Net . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-56  
Cupholders . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-54  
Front Storage Area . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-54  
Glove Box . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-54  
Rear Seat Armrest . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-56  
Out of Park . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-32  
Shifting Into Park . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-30  
Side Blind Zone Alert . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-42  
Signals, Turn and Lane-Change . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-5  
i - 13  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Storing the Tire Sealant and Compressor Kit . . . . . . 6-82  
Stuck in Sand, Mud, Ice, or Snow . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-17  
Sun Visors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-17  
Sunroof . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-56  
Tires (cont.)  
High-Speed Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-59  
If a Tire Goes Flat . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-73  
Inflation - Tire Pressure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-57  
Inspection and Rotation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-65  
Installing the Spare Tire . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-86  
Pressure Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-54  
Pressure Monitor Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-61  
Pressure Monitor System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-60  
Removing the Flat Tire . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-86  
Removing the Spare Tire and Tools . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-84  
Sealant and Compressor Kit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-75, 6-82  
Sidewall Labeling . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-49  
Spare Tire . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-93  
Storing a Flat or Spare Tire and Tools . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-91  
Terminology and Definitions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-54  
Uniform Tire Quality Grading . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-70  
Wheel Alignment and Tire Balance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-72  
Wheel Replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-72  
When It Is Time for New Tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-67  
Towing  
T
Tachometer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-46  
Telescopic Steering Column, Power Tilt Wheel . . . . . .4-4  
Text Telephone (TTY) Users . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-6  
Theft-Deterrent Feature . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-114  
Theft-Deterrent Systems . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-18  
Content Theft-Deterrent . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-19  
PASS-Key® III+ Electronic Immobilizer . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-20  
PASS-Key® III+ Electronic Immobilizer  
Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-20  
Tilt Wheel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-3  
Time, Setting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-87  
Tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-48  
Aluminum or Chrome-Plated Wheels,  
Cleaning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-100  
Buying New Tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-68  
Chains . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-73  
Changing a Flat Tire . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-83  
Cleaning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-101  
Different Size . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-70  
Recreational Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-24  
Towing a Trailer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-26  
Your Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-24  
i - 14  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Traction  
V
Control System (TCS) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-6  
Control System Warning Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-51  
Magnetic Ride Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-8  
StabiliTrak® System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-6  
Transmission  
Fluid, Automatic . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-21  
Transmission Operation, Automatic . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-26  
Transportation Program, Courtesy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-10  
Trunk . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-12  
Turn and Lane-Change Signals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-5  
Turn Signal/Multifunction Lever . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-5  
Valet Lockout Switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-18  
Vehicle  
Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-3  
Loading . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-18  
Remote Start . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-7  
Running While Parked . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-34  
Symbols . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .iv  
Vehicle Customization, DIC . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-77  
Vehicle Data Recording and Privacy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-17  
Vehicle Identification  
Number (VIN) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-102  
Service Parts Identification Label . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-102  
Ventilated Seats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-5  
Ventilation Adjustment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-40  
Visors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-17  
U
Ultrasonic Front and Rear Parking Assist  
(UFRPA) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-38  
Uniform Tire Quality Grading . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-70  
Universal Home Remote System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-47  
Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-47  
i - 15  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Windshield  
W
Washer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-11  
Washer Fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-32  
Wiper Blade Replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-46  
Wiper Blades, Cleaning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-99  
Wiper Fuses . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-103  
Wipers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-10  
Winter Driving . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-15  
Wiper Activated Headlamps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-28  
Warning Lights, Gauges, and Indicators . . . . . . . . . . . 4-44  
Warnings  
DIC Warnings and Messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-65  
Hazard Flashers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-3  
Safety and Symbols . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .iv  
Wheels  
Alignment and Tire Balance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-72  
Different Size . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-70  
Replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-72  
When It Is Time for New Tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-67  
Where to Put the Child Restraint . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-39  
Windows . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-14  
Power . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-15  
X
XM Radio Messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-105  
XMSatellite Radio  
Antenna . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-116  
i - 16  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  

Belkin Laptop F5D9010 User Manual
Black Decker Vacuum Cleaner CHV1210 User Manual
Black Decker Welder VP650 User Manual
Blue Rhino Outdoor Fireplace WAD796SP User Manual
Braun Wheelchair NL955 User Manual
Brother Printer PT 1760 User Manual
Bushnell Film Camera 201960 User Manual
Campbell Hausfeld Staple Gun IN729300AV User Manual
Casio Video Game Keyboard LK200ES1A User Manual
CDA Stove HCG450 User Manual